Docs: warn against using $local_part directly in delivery
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
... / ...
CommitLineData
1. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2. This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3. converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printable and online
4. formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5. The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
6.
7. WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8. adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9. unwanted vertical space.
10. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11
12.include stdflags
13.include stdmacs
14
15. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16. This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18
19.docbook
20
21. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22. These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23. Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24. PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
25. processors.
26. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27
28.literal xml
29<?sdop
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
34?>
35.literal off
36
37. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38. This generates the outermost <book> element that wraps the entire document.
39. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40
41.book
42
43. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44. These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45. Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
47
48.set previousversion "4.93"
49.include ./local_params
50
51.set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52.set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
53
54.macro copyyear
552019
56.endmacro
57
58. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59. Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60. provided in the xfpt library.
61. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
62
63. --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name.
64
65.flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
66
67. --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68. --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be in Roman.
69
70.flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
71.flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
72
73. --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74. --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75. --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
76. --- index entry.
77
78.macro option
79.arg 5
80.oindex "&%$5%&"
81.endarg
82.arg -5
83.oindex "&%$1%&"
84.endarg
85.itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86.row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
87.endtable
88.endmacro
89
90. --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91. --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92. --- a small number of other 2-column tables override it.
93
94.macro table2 196pt 254pt
95.itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
96.endmacro
97
98. --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99. --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100. --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
101
102.macro irow
103.arg 4
104.row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
105.endarg
106.arg -4
107.arg 3
108.row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
109.endarg
110.arg -3
111.row "&I;$1" "$2"
112.endarg
113.endarg
114.endmacro
115
116. --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117. --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118. --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119. --- ID that ties them together.
120
121.macro cindex
122&<indexterm role="concept">&
123&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
124.arg 2
125&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
126.endarg
127&</indexterm>&
128.endmacro
129
130.macro scindex
131&<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132&<primary>&$2&</primary>&
133.arg 3
134&<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
135.endarg
136&</indexterm>&
137.endmacro
138
139.macro ecindex
140&<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
141.endmacro
142
143.macro oindex
144&<indexterm role="option">&
145&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
146.arg 2
147&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
148.endarg
149&</indexterm>&
150.endmacro
151
152.macro vindex
153&<indexterm role="variable">&
154&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
155.arg 2
156&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
157.endarg
158&</indexterm>&
159.endmacro
160
161.macro index
162.echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
163.endmacro
164. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165
166
167. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168. The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for ASCII
169. output formats.
170. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
171
172.literal xml
173<bookinfo>
174<title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175<titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
176<date>
177.fulldate
178</date>
179<author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180<authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181<revhistory><revision>
182.versiondatexml
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184</revision></revhistory>
185<copyright><year>
186.copyyear
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
188</bookinfo>
189.literal off
190
191
192. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193. This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194. "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195. at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
197
198.chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
199.literal xml
200
201<indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
204</indexterm>
205<indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
209</indexterm>
210<indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
213</indexterm>
214<indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
217</indexterm>
218<indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
221</indexterm>
222<indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
225</indexterm>
226<indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
230</indexterm>
231<indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
234</indexterm>
235<indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
238</indexterm>
239<indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
242</indexterm>
243<indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
246</indexterm>
247<indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
251</indexterm>
252<indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
255</indexterm>
256<indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
259</indexterm>
260<indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
263</indexterm>
264<indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
267</indexterm>
268<indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
271</indexterm>
272<indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
275</indexterm>
276<indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
279</indexterm>
280<indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
283</indexterm>
284<indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
287</indexterm>
288<indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
291</indexterm>
292<indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
295</indexterm>
296<indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
299</indexterm>
300<indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
303</indexterm>
304<indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
308</indexterm>
309<indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
312</indexterm>
313<indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
316</indexterm>
317<indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
320</indexterm>
321
322.literal off
323
324
325. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326. This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327. we can't have the .chapter line here.
328. chapter "Introduction"
329. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
330
331Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
335
336Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and UnixWare.
341Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
343
344There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
347
348The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
351
352The use, supply, or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of Exim,
354which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
357
358Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
363
364Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367&_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
368contributors.
369
370
371.section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372. Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
373
374.new
375.cindex "documentation"
376This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
377Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
378renditions of this document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
379capable of showing a change indicator.
380.wen
381
382This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
383is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
384with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
385and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
386it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
387Furthermore, this manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
388a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
389very wide interest.
390
391.cindex "books about Exim"
392An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
393introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
394SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
395(&url(https://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
396
397The book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
398Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
399with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
400published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
401
402.cindex "Debian" "information sources"
403If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
404Debian-specific features in the file
405&_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
406The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
407information.
408
409.cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
410.cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
411.cindex "change log"
412As Exim develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
413yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
414digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
415new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
416&_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
417
418Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
419incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
420they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
421can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
422
423All changes to Exim (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
424change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
425
426.cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
427This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
428that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
429directory are:
430
431.table2 100pt
432.row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
433.row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
434.row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
435.row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
436.row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
437.row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
438.row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
439.row &_openssl.txt_& "installing a current OpenSSL release"
440.endtable
441
442The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
443available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
444&<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
445
446
447
448.section "FTP site and websites" "SECID2"
449.cindex "website"
450.cindex "FTP site"
451The primary site for Exim source distributions is the &%exim.org%& FTP site,
452available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP. These services, and the &%exim.org%&
453website, are hosted at the University of Cambridge.
454
455.cindex "wiki"
456.cindex "FAQ"
457As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim website contains a number of
458differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
459online information is the Exim wiki (&url(https://wiki.exim.org)),
460which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
461examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
462The wiki site should always redirect to the correct place, which is currently
463provided by GitHub, and is open to editing by anyone with a GitHub account.
464
465.cindex Bugzilla
466An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(https://bugs.exim.org). You can use
467this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
468first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
469Please do not ask for configuration help in the bug-tracker.
470
471
472.section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
473.cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
474The following Exim mailing lists exist:
475
476.table2 140pt
477.row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
478.row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
479.row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
480.row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
481.endtable
482
483You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
484or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
485.cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
486If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
487the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
488via this web page:
489.display
490&url(https://alioth-lists.debian.net/cgi-bin/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
491.endd
492Please ask Debian-specific questions on that list and not on the general Exim
493lists.
494
495.section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
496.cindex "bug reports"
497.cindex "reporting bugs"
498Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
499via the Bugzilla (&url(https://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
500whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
501message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
502
503
504
505.section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
506.cindex "FTP site"
507.cindex "HTTPS download site"
508.cindex "distribution" "FTP site"
509.cindex "distribution" "https site"
510The master distribution site for the Exim distribution is
511.display
512&url(https://downloads.exim.org/)
513.endd
514The service is available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP.
515We encourage people to migrate to HTTPS.
516
517The content served at &url(https://downloads.exim.org/) is identical to the
518content served at &url(https://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim) and
519&url(ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim).
520
521If accessing via a hostname containing &'ftp'&, then the file references that
522follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at these sites.
523If accessing via the hostname &'downloads'& then the subdirectories described
524here are top-level directories.
525
526There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
527the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
528
529Within the top exim directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
530previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
531distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
532subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
533.display
534&_exim-n.nn.tar.xz_&
535&_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
536&_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
537.endd
538where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The three
539files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
540The &_.xz_& file is usually the smallest, while the &_.gz_& file is the
541most portable to old systems.
542
543.cindex "distribution" "signing details"
544.cindex "distribution" "public key"
545.cindex "public key for signed distribution"
546The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
547Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
548&'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
549other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
550PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from the Exim Maintainer's
551PGP keys, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
552&_Exim-Maintainers-Keyring.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
553such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
554
555At the time of the last update, releases were being made by Jeremy Harris and signed
556with key &'0xBCE58C8CE41F32DF'&. Other recent keys used for signing are those
557of Heiko Schlittermann, &'0x26101B62F69376CE'&,
558and of Phil Pennock, &'0x4D1E900E14C1CC04'&.
559
560The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
561.display
562&_exim-n.nn.tar.xz.asc_&
563&_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
564&_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
565.endd
566For each released version, the log of changes is made available in a
567separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
568find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
569
570.cindex "documentation" "available formats"
571The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
572documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
573inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
574.display
575&_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
576&_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
577&_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
578&_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
579.endd
580These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
581distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& and &_.xz_& forms.
582
583
584.section "Limitations" "SECID6"
585.ilist
586.cindex "limitations of Exim"
587.cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
588Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
589RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
590simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
591configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
592UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
593.next
594.cindex "domainless addresses"
595.cindex "address" "without domain"
596Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
597local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
598configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
599systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
600arrival.
601.next
602.cindex "transport" "external"
603.cindex "external transports"
604The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
605and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
606transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
607and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
608to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
609handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
610.next
611Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
612such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
613(that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
614other means.
615.next
616Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
617are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
618are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
619compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
620a number of common scanners are provided.
621.endlist
622
623
624.section "Runtime configuration" "SECID7"
625Exim's runtime configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
626into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
627values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
628file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
629distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
630
631
632.section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
633.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
634Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
635can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
636&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
637about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
638Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
639example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages in the queue) do so in Exim's own
640format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
6413, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
642documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
643made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
644
645Control of messages in the queue can be done via certain privileged command
646line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
647which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
648interface to Exim's command line administration options.
649
650
651
652.section "Terminology" "SECID9"
653.cindex "terminology definitions"
654.cindex "body of message" "definition of"
655The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
656It is the last part of a message and is separated from the &'header'& (see
657below) by a blank line.
658
659.cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
660When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
661delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
662&'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
663called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
664failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
665message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
666rise to further bounce messages.
667
668The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
669value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
670also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
671otherwise.
672
673The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
674destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
675down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
676until a later time.
677
678The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
679host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
680the part of an email address following the @ sign.
681
682.cindex "envelope, definition of"
683.cindex "sender" "definition of"
684A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
685body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
686be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
687sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
688envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
689messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
690
691.cindex "message" "header, definition of"
692.cindex "header section" "definition of"
693The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
694of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
695&'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
696indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
697line.
698
699.cindex "local part" "definition of"
700.cindex "domain" "definition of"
701The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to the
702part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
703@ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
704
705.cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
706.cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
707The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
708delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
709TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
710host it is running on are &'remote'&.
711
712.cindex "return path" "definition of"
713&'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
714message's envelope.
715
716.cindex "queue" "definition of"
717The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery
718because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
719Exim's case, the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
720normally no ordering of waiting messages.
721
722.cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
723The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
724and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
725is used by other MTAs and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
726the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
727
728.cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
729The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
730messages in its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
731delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
732mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
733the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
734
735
736
737
738
739
740. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
741. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
742
743.chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
744.cindex "incorporated code"
745.cindex "regular expressions" "library"
746.cindex "PCRE"
747.cindex "OpenDMARC"
748A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
749
750.ilist
751Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
752Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
753&copy; University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
754Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
755or obtain and install the full version of the library from
756&url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
757.next
758.cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
759Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
760contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
761Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
762It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
763following statements:
764
765.blockquote
766Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
767
768This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
769the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
770Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
771version.
772This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
773the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
774&url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
775some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
776restrictions applied to it).
777.endblockquote
778.next
779.cindex "SPA authentication"
780.cindex "Samba project"
781.cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
782Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
783by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
784Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
785under the Gnu GPL.
786.next
787.cindex "Cyrus"
788.cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
789.cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
790Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
791by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
792Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
793conditions expressed therein.
794
795.blockquote
796Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
797
798Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
799modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
800are met:
801
802.olist
803Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
804notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
805.next
806Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
807notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
808the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
809distribution.
810.next
811The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
812endorse or promote products derived from this software without
813prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
814details, please contact
815.display
816 Office of Technology Transfer
817 Carnegie Mellon University
818 5000 Forbes Avenue
819 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
820 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
821 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
822.endd
823.next
824Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
825acknowledgment:
826
827&"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
828at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(https://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
829
830CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
831THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
832AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
833FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
834WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
835AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
836OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
837.endlist
838.endblockquote
839
840.next
841.cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
842.cindex "X-windows"
843.cindex "Athena"
844The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
845modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
846This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
847below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
848
849.blockquote
850Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
851and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
852
853All Rights Reserved
854
855Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
856documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
857provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
858both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
859supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
860used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
861software without specific, written prior permission.
862
863DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
864ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
865DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
866ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
867WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
868ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
869SOFTWARE.
870.endblockquote
871
872.next
873.cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
874The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
875The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
876derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
877license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
878source code.
879
880.next
881Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
882not covered by any specific license requirements. It is assumed that the
883contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
884.endlist
885
886
887
888
889
890. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
891. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
892
893.chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
894 "Receiving and delivering mail"
895
896
897.section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
898.cindex "design philosophy"
899Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
900to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
901most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
902maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
903it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
904has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
905
906
907.section "Policy control" "SECID11"
908.cindex "policy control" "overview"
909Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
910Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs from being abused as
911&"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
912unsolicited junk and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
913facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
914
915.ilist
916.cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
917Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
918incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
919series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
920several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
921host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
922very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
923rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
924two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
925error code.
926.next
927An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
928case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
929.next
930When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
931provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
932spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
933which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
934.next
935When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
936host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
937function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
938whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
939is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
940.next
941Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
942software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
943Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
944.next
945After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
946the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
947runs at the start of every delivery process.
948.endlist
949
950
951
952.section "User filters" "SECID12"
953.cindex "filter" "introduction"
954.cindex "Sieve filter"
955In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
956setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
957chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
958configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
959&'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
960of filtering are available:
961
962.ilist
963Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
964by RFC 3028.
965.next
966Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
967powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
968.endlist
969
970User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
971
972
973
974.section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
975.cindex "message ids" "details of format"
976.cindex "format" "of message id"
977.cindex "id of message"
978.cindex "base62"
979.cindex "base36"
980.cindex "Darwin"
981.cindex "Cygwin"
982Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
983characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
984example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
985normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
986system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
987(avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
988id is used to construct filenames, and the names of files in those systems are
989not always case-sensitive.
990
991.cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
992The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
993Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
994within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
995be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
996the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
997somewhat eccentric:
998
999.ilist
1000The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
1001started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1002contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1003way of representing the date and time of day).
1004.next
1005After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1006received the message.
1007.next
1008There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1009.olist
1010.oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1011If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1012time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1013that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1014systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1015.next
1016If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1017the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1018(1/100) of a second.
1019.endlist
1020.endlist
1021
1022After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1023appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1024received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1025pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1026will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1027
1028
1029.section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1030.cindex "receiving mail"
1031.cindex "message" "reception"
1032The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1033TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1034SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1035there are several possibilities:
1036
1037.ilist
1038If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1039non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1040command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1041.next
1042If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1043non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1044the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1045command. This is called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1046but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1047envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1048.next
1049If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1050interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1051passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1052This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1053example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1054.next
1055A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1056(127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1057does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1058in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1059.endlist
1060
1061
1062.cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1063.cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1064In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1065constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1066qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1067option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1068SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1069certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender addresses
1070unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1071address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1072different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1073users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1074users to change sender addresses.
1075
1076Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1077checking by the non-SMTP ACL if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1078(either over TCP/IP or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1079number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1080individual recipients or the entire message can be rejected if local policy
1081requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1082&<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1083
1084Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1085received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1086connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1087queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1088configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1089message is received.
1090
1091
1092
1093
1094
1095.section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1096.cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1097.cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1098When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1099first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1100the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1101the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1102file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1103
1104.cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1105By default, all these message files are held in a single directory called
1106&_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1107not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1108improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1109used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1110whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1111processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1112overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1113affect file system performance.
1114
1115The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1116the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1117any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1118a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1119first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1120
1121.cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1122Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1123(see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1124both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1125If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1126example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1127generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1128rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1129different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1130addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1131delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1132&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1133
1134
1135
1136.section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1137.cindex "message" "life of"
1138.cindex "message" "frozen"
1139A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1140its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1141administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1142cannot proceed &-- for example when a message can neither be delivered to its
1143recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1144spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1145
1146.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1147.cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1148An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1149corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1150addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1151to be sent.
1152
1153.oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1154.oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1155There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1156&%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1157The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to all frozen messages.
1158
1159.cindex "message" "log file for"
1160.cindex "log" "file for each message"
1161While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1162attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1163delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1164lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1165These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator and are normally
1166deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1167The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1168&%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1169systems.
1170
1171.cindex "journal file"
1172.cindex "file" "journal"
1173All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1174spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1175address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1176message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1177addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1178is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1179Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1180minimize the possibility of data loss.
1181
1182Should the system or Exim crash after a successful delivery but before
1183the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1184time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1185updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1186deliveries caused by crashes.
1187
1188
1189
1190.section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1191.cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1192.cindex "router" "definition of"
1193.cindex "transport" "definition of"
1194The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1195&'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1196number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1197specify which ones are included in the binary. Runtime options specify which
1198ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1199
1200.cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1201Each driver that is specified in the runtime configuration is an &'instance'&
1202of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1203you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1204option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1205instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1206instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1207configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1208the driver's features in general.
1209
1210A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1211its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1212converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1213alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1214to be bounced.
1215
1216A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1217spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1218transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1219&'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1220to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1221several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1222
1223.cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1224An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1225turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1226specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1227detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1228address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1229
1230To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1231routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1232routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1233configuration.
1234
1235The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1236addresses in domains that are not recognized specifically by the local host.
1237Typically these are addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1238is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1239its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1240match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1241find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1242assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1243configured to fail the address.
1244
1245The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1246&"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1247aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1248original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1249router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1250address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1251
1252The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1253address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1254see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1255local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1256the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1257the address is bounced.
1258
1259
1260
1261.section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1262.cindex "router" "for verification"
1263.cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1264As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1265are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1266one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1267sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1268&%-bvs%& command line options.
1269
1270When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1271does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1272detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1273when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1274sends all messages to a message-scanning program unless they have been
1275previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1276checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1277would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1278
1279
1280
1281
1282.section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1283.cindex "router" "running details"
1284.cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1285.cindex "router" "result of running"
1286As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1287running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1288passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1289the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1290the following:
1291
1292.ilist
1293&'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1294transport or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1295original address ceases
1296.oindex "&%unseen%&"
1297unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1298can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1299for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1300passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1301end of routing.
1302
1303Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1304starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1305setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1306child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1307&%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1308.next
1309&'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1310requests that the address be passed to another router. By default, the address
1311is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1312&%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1313must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1314.next
1315&'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1316recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1317this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1318set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1319&'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1320.next
1321&'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1322the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1323original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1324.next
1325&'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1326database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1327processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1328next time the message is considered for delivery.
1329.next
1330&'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1331its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1332.endlist
1333
1334If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1335any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1336situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1337making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1338router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1339
1340Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1341met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1342You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1343when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1344facility for this purpose.
1345
1346
1347.section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1348.cindex "case of local parts"
1349.cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1350.cindex "duplicate addresses"
1351Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1352and remote transports and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1353check, local parts are treated case-sensitively. This happens only when
1354actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1355routed addresses are shown.
1356
1357
1358
1359.section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1360.cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1361.cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1362The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1363order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1364described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1365
1366.ilist
1367.cindex affix "router precondition"
1368The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1369the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1370suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1371skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1372removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1373of any other conditions.
1374.next
1375Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1376only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1377&%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1378address.
1379Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1380&%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1381sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1382you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1383Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1384.next
1385If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1386run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1387when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1388makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1389having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1390.next
1391Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1392opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1393Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1394.next
1395Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1396check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1397.next
1398If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1399of domains that it defines.
1400.next
1401.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1402.vindex "&$local_part$&"
1403.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1404.cindex affix "router precondition"
1405If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1406the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1407&%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1408part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1409that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1410that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1411&$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1412.next
1413.vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1414.vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1415.vindex "&$home$&"
1416If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1417an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1418local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1419user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1420remaining preconditions.
1421.next
1422If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1423because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1424later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1425subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1426could lead to confusion.
1427.next
1428If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1429set of addresses that it defines.
1430.next
1431If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1432specified files is tested.
1433.next
1434.cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1435If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1436uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1437Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1438.endlist
1439
1440
1441Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1442it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1443part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1444&%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1445&%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1446going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1447example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1448
1449
1450
1451.section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1452.cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1453When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1454
1455.ilist
1456If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1457filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1458message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1459fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1460files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1461filtering'&.
1462.cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1463(&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1464
1465Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1466&<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1467filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1468if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1469be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1470condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1471filter.
1472.next
1473Each recipient address is offered to each configured router, in turn, subject to
1474its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1475address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1476can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1477processed entirely independently of each other.
1478.next
1479.cindex "routing" "loops in"
1480.cindex "loop" "while routing"
1481A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1482transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1483is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1484Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1485from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1486process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1487which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1488.next
1489When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1490handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1491doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1492local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1493collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1494addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1495address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1496addresses to the same domain.
1497.next
1498Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1499non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1500deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1501to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1502run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1503one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1504The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1505deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1506.next
1507.cindex "queue runner"
1508When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1509database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1510address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1511Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1512reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1513queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1514follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1515better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1516causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1517.next
1518.cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1519Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1520deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1521retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1522reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1523not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1524.next
1525If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1526appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1527for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1528messages to other addresses.
1529.next
1530.cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1531If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1532the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1533&'deferred'&.
1534.next
1535When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1536handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1537deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1538.endlist
1539
1540
1541
1542
1543.section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1544.cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1545.cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1546.cindex "queue runner"
1547Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1548attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1549uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1550intervals or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1551not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1552first attempt will remain in your queue forever. A queue runner process works
1553its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1554passed its retry time.
1555You can run several queue runners at once.
1556
1557Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1558address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1559should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1560bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1561error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1562as permanent.
1563
1564
1565
1566.section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1567.cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1568There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1569particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1570connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1571detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1572Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1573is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1574impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1575also apply.
1576
1577If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1578waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1579connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1580deferred,
1581.cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1582Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1583SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1584for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1585connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1586one connection.
1587
1588
1589
1590.section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1591.cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1592.cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1593When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1594bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1595errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1596delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1597many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1598attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1599message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1600See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1601
1602.cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1603Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1604failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1605automatically.
1606
1607.cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1608A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1609obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1610address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1611forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1612failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1613&<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1614of the list.
1615
1616
1617
1618.section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1619.cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1620If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1621itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left in the queue,
1622but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1623that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1624for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1625&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1626
1627
1628
1629
1630
1631. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1632. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1633
1634.chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1635.scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1636
1637.section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1638Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1639creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1640&_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1641
1642.table2 140pt
1643.irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1644.irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1645 documented"
1646.irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1647.irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1648.irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1649.irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1650 instructions"
1651.endtable
1652
1653Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1654following subdirectories are created:
1655
1656.table2 140pt
1657.irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1658.irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1659.irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1660.irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1661.irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1662.irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1663.irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1664.endtable
1665
1666The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory and are built
1667with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1668that may be useful to some sites.
1669
1670
1671.section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1672.cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1673The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1674a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1675source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1676Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1677system.
1678.cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1679Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1680the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1681architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1682overridden if necessary.
1683.cindex compiler requirements
1684.cindex compiler version
1685A C99-capable compiler will be required for the build.
1686
1687
1688.section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1689.cindex "PCRE library"
1690Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1691modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need to
1692install the PCRE package or the PCRE development package for your operating
1693system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1694process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1695headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1696and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1697or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1698If your operating system has no
1699PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1700from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1701More information on PCRE is available at &url(https://www.pcre.org/).
1702
1703.section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1704.cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1705.cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1706Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1707DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1708databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1709different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1710
1711.cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1712.cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1713.cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1714.cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1715If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1716Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1717may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1718you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1719
1720.cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1721Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1722via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1723versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1724some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1725distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1726versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1727Berkeley DB library.
1728
1729Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1730use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1731possibilities:
1732
1733.olist
1734A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1735Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1736.next
1737.cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1738The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1739compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1740&_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1741filename is used unmodified.
1742.next
1743.cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1744The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1745operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1746programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1747.next
1748If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1749file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1750the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1751.next
1752To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1753Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
17542.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions when Exim last revamped support were numbered 4.&'x'&.
1755Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All versions of
1756Berkeley DB could be obtained from
1757&url(http://www.sleepycat.com/), which is now a redirect to their new owner's
1758page with far newer versions listed.
1759It is probably wise to plan to move your storage configurations away from
1760Berkeley DB format, as today there are smaller and simpler alternatives more
1761suited to Exim's usage model.
1762.next
1763.cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1764Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1765&url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/tdb/files/). It has its own interface, and also
1766operates on a single file.
1767.endlist
1768
1769.cindex "USE_DB"
1770.cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1771Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1772to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1773USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1774&_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1775.code
1776USE_DB=yes
1777.endd
1778Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1779error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1780
1781At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1782thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1783configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1784Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1785configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1786&_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1787
1788As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1789necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1790in one of these lines:
1791.code
1792DBMLIB = -ldb
1793DBMLIB = -ltdb
1794.endd
1795Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1796place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1797the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1798file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1799this example:
1800.code
1801INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1802DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1803.endd
1804There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1805file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1806
1807
1808
1809.section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1810.cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1811.cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1812.cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1813.cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1814Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1815independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1816&_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1817&_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1818therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1819building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1820&_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1821
1822There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1823without them. They are the location of the runtime configuration file
1824(CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1825(BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1826maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1827a colon-separated list of filenames; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1828
1829There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1830at runtime, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1831machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1832directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1833you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at runtime, so that errors
1834detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1835be logged.
1836
1837.cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1838Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1839access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1840facilities, you need to set
1841.code
1842WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1843.endd
1844in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1845chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1846
1847
1848.cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1849.cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1850If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1851required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1852your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1853happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1854&_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1855
1856This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1857operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1858to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1859configuration files, for example, to change the C compiler, which
1860defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1861do this.
1862
1863
1864
1865.section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1866.cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1867.cindex "RFC 2047"
1868The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1869described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1870in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1871character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1872mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1873(default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1874supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1875
1876However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1877very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1878&url(https://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1879systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1880&[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1881.code
1882HAVE_ICONV=yes
1883.endd
1884to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1885
1886
1887
1888.section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1889.cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1890.cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1891.cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1892.cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1893Exim is usually built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1894command as per RFC 2487. It can also support clients that expect to
1895start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1896&%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1897line option).
1898
1899If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1900OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1901implementing SSL.
1902
1903If you do not want TLS support you should set
1904.code
1905DISABLE_TLS=yes
1906.endd
1907in &_Local/Makefile_&.
1908
1909If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1910.code
1911USE_OPENSL=yes
1912TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1913.endd
1914in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1915OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1916.code
1917USE_OPENSSL=yes
1918TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1919TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1920.endd
1921.cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1922If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1923.code
1924USE_OPENSSL=yes
1925USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1926.endd
1927.cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1928If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1929.code
1930USE_GNUTLS=yes
1931TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1932.endd
1933in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1934library and include files. For example:
1935.code
1936USE_GNUTLS=yes
1937TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1938TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1939.endd
1940.cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1941If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1942.code
1943USE_GNUTLS=yes
1944USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1945.endd
1946
1947You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1948specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1949given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1950
1951
1952
1953
1954.section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1955
1956.cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1957.cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1958.cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1959.cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1960Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1961SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1962alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1963already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1964should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1965&_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1966&_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1967EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1968you might have
1969.code
1970USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1971CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1972EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1973.endd
1974in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1975files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1976.code
1977exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1978.endd
1979in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1980the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1981All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1982can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1983&_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1984configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1985further details.
1986
1987
1988.section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1989.cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1990Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1991&`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1992it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1993where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1994library files.
1995
1996Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1997defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1998currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1999as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
2000over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
2001Exim used to
2002have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
2003withdrawn.
2004
2005
2006
2007.section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
2008.cindex "lookup modules"
2009.cindex "dynamic modules"
2010.cindex ".so building"
2011On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2012the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2013on demand.
2014This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2015library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2016dependencies.
2017Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2018
2019Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2020installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2021measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2022for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2023Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2024see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2025
2026Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2027&`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2028For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2029on demand:
2030.code
2031LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
2032LOOKUP_SQLITE=2
2033LOOKUP_MYSQL=2
2034.endd
2035
2036
2037.section "The building process" "SECID29"
2038.cindex "build directory"
2039Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2040created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2041operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2042For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2043&_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2044.cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2045Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2046
2047If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2048a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2049&_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2050&'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2051then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2052number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2053makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2054directory, should this ever be necessary.
2055
2056If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2057&_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2058FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2059
2060
2061
2062.section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2063The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2064unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2065output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2066appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2067each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2068get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2069.code
2070FULLECHO='' make -e
2071.endd
2072The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2073command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2074given in addition to the short output.
2075
2076
2077
2078.section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2079.cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2080The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2081consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2082values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2083more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2084convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2085order:
2086.display
2087&_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2088&_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2089&_Local/Makefile_&
2090&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2091&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2092&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2093&_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2094.endd
2095.cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2096.cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2097.cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2098where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2099architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2100process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2101and are often not needed.
2102
2103The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2104called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2105the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2106values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2107Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2108fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2109of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2110that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2111to find out what values are being used on your system.
2112
2113
2114&_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2115therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2116needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2117file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2118default values are.
2119
2120
2121.cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2122If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2123or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2124need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2125putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2126.cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2127when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2128formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2129compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2130called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2131Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2132default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2133containing the lines
2134.code
2135CC=cc
2136CFLAGS=-std1
2137.endd
2138If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2139these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2140
2141Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2142files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2143the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2144
2145
2146.cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2147.cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2148.cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2149.cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2150Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2151lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2152not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2153and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2154which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2155case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2156.code
2157LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2158LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2159LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2160.endd
2161and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2162&_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2163libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2164.cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2165However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2166the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2167files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2168binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause runtime configuration
2169errors.
2170
2171.cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2172.cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2173Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2174about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2175being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2176makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2177variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2178name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2179&'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2180with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2181syntax. For instance:
2182.code
2183LOOKUP_SQLITE=yes
2184LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2185AUTH_GSASL=yes
2186AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2187AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2188AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2189.endd
2190
2191.cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2192Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2193subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2194.code
2195EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2196.endd
2197must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2198chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2199
2200.cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2201The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2202operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2203with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2204monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2205The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2206.code
2207X11=/usr/X11R6
2208XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2209XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2210.endd
2211These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2212example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2213.code
2214X11=/usr/openwin
2215XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2216XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2217.endd
2218If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2219definition of all three of these variables into your
2220&_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2221
2222.cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2223If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2224variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2225default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2226command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2227
2228.cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2229There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2230use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2231EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2232binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2233libraries.
2234
2235.cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2236The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2237files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2238necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2239&_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2240
2241
2242.section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2243.cindex "&_os.h_&"
2244.cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2245The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2246&_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2247normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2248recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2249are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2250
2251
2252
2253.section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2254.cindex "building Eximon"
2255A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2256where the files that are involved are
2257.display
2258&_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2259&_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2260&_Local/eximon.conf_&
2261&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2262&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2263&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2264.endd
2265.cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2266As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2267&_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2268&_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2269variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2270EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2271LOG_DEPTH at runtime.
2272.ecindex IIDbuex
2273
2274
2275.section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2276.cindex "installing Exim"
2277.cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2278The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2279arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2280whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2281.cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2282The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2283going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2284&'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2285install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2286some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2287it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2288chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2289
2290.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2291Exim's runtime configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2292in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2293exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2294by the installation script. If a runtime configuration file already exists, it
2295is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2296alternative files, no default is installed.
2297
2298.cindex "system aliases file"
2299.cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2300One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2301default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2302The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2303SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2304If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2305and outputs a comment to the user.
2306
2307The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2308aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2309kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2310&_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2311Exim's configuration if necessary.
2312
2313The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2314and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2315running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2316directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2317other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2318over SMTP.
2319
2320It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2321distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2322command such as
2323.code
2324make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2325.endd
2326This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2327paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2328configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2329For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2330but this usage is deprecated.
2331
2332.cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2333Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2334&'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2335upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2336directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2337INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2338
2339For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2340to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2341installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2342for example, &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2343called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2344of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2345from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2346
2347.cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2348If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2349real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2350command:
2351.code
2352make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2353.endd
2354The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2355script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2356the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2357directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2358command:
2359.code
2360(cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2361.endd
2362.cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2363There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2364
2365.ilist
2366&%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2367to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2368.next
2369&%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2370installed binary.
2371.endlist
2372
2373INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2374.code
2375make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2376.endd
2377The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2378to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2379without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2380.code
2381make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2382.endd
2383
2384
2385
2386.section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2387.cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2388Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2389reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2390distribution. Instead it is available separately from the FTP site (see section
2391&<<SECTavail>>&).
2392
2393If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2394source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2395install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2396
2397
2398
2399.section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2400.cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2401When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2402exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2403directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2404necessary.
2405
2406
2407
2408
2409.section "Testing" "SECID34"
2410.cindex "testing" "installation"
2411Having installed Exim, you can check that the runtime configuration file is
2412syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2413Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2414.code
2415exim -bV
2416.endd
2417If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2418Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2419the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2420other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2421Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2422example,
2423.display
2424&`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2425.endd
2426should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2427.display
2428&`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2429.endd
2430a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2431This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2432user agent. For example:
2433.code
2434exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2435From: user@your.domain.example
2436To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2437Subject: Testing Exim
2438
2439This is a test message.
2440^D
2441.endd
2442The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2443In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2444arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2445
2446.cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2447If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2448&'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2449of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2450&%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2451with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2452.display
2453&`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2454.endd
2455You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2456produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2457For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2458relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2459&<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2460
2461.cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2462.cindex "lock files"
2463One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2464local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2465&"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2466writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2467is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2468directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2469that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2470&(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2471approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2472&[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2473agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2474see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2475
2476One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2477the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2478&%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2479port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2480&'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2481incoming SMTP mail.
2482
2483Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2484be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2485within the runtime configuration, all other file and directory names
2486that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2487production version.
2488
2489
2490.section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2491.cindex "replacing another MTA"
2492Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2493general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2494is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2495operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2496binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2497normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2498or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2499.cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2500a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2501privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2502and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2503
2504.cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2505.cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2506Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2507example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2508&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2509described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2510as follows:
2511.code
2512sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2513send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2514mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2515newaliases /usr/bin/true
2516.endd
2517Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2518your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2519favourite user agent.
2520
2521You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2522have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2523various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2524command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2525use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2526&'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2527
2528
2529
2530.section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2531.cindex "upgrading Exim"
2532If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2533version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2534call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2535.cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2536.cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2537to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2538new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2539version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2540configuration file.
2541
2542
2543
2544
2545.section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2546.cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2547The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2548.code
2549/etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2550.endd
2551If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2552fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2553for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2554(that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2555solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2556.code
2557pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2558.endd
2559to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2560
2561Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2562still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2563(the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2564
2565
2566
2567
2568. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2569. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2570
2571.chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2572.scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2573.scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2574Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2575each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2576options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2577some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2578combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2579The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2580
2581
2582.section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2583.cindex "&'mailq'&"
2584If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2585were present before any other options.
2586The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2587standard output.
2588This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2589that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2590&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2591
2592.cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2593If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2594were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2595&%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2596format.
2597
2598.cindex "&'rmail'&"
2599If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2600&%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2601Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2602
2603.cindex "&'runq'&"
2604.cindex "queue runner"
2605If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2606were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2607option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2608
2609.cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2610.cindex "alias file" "building"
2611.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2612If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2613&%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2614This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2615the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2616command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2617
2618
2619.section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2620Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2621available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2622user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2623EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2624&%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2625
2626.ilist
2627.cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2628.cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2629The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2630&%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2631supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2632configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2633
2634.cindex '&"From"& line'
2635.cindex "envelope from"
2636.cindex "envelope sender"
2637Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2638&"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2639Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2640See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2641users to set envelope senders.
2642
2643.cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2644.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2645.cindex "header lines" "From:"
2646.cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
2647For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2648header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2649&'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2650
2651Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2652protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2653locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2654have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2655users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2656that are available to trusted users.
2657.next
2658.cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2659.cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2660The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2661Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2662The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2663
2664Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2665operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2666necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2667the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2668
2669By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2670Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2671However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2672option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2673
2674Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2675is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2676false.
2677.endlist
2678
2679
2680&*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2681edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2682getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2683&<<CHAPconf>>&.
2684
2685
2686
2687
2688.section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2689Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2690of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2691a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2692format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2693on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2694with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2695outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2696
2697. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2698. Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2699. options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2700. creates a man page for the options.
2701. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2702
2703.literal xml
2704<!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2705.literal off
2706
2707
2708.vlist
2709.vitem &%--%&
2710.oindex "--"
2711.cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2712This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2713therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2714rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2715
2716.vitem &%--help%&
2717.oindex "&%--help%&"
2718This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2719The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2720no arguments.
2721
2722.vitem &%--version%&
2723.oindex "&%--version%&"
2724This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2725displayed.
2726
2727.vitem &%-Ac%& &&&
2728 &%-Am%&
2729.oindex "&%-Ac%&"
2730.oindex "&%-Am%&"
2731These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2732ignored by Exim.
2733
2734.vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2735.oindex "&%-B%&"
2736.cindex "8-bit characters"
2737.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2738This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2739clean; it ignores this option.
2740
2741.vitem &%-bd%&
2742.oindex "&%-bd%&"
2743.cindex "daemon"
2744.cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2745.cindex "queue runner"
2746This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2747the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2748that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2749
2750The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2751(debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2752disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2753stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2754
2755By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2756all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2757ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2758&<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2759
2760When a listening daemon
2761.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2762.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2763is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2764configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2765in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2766PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2767running as root.
2768
2769When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2770process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2771used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2772
2773The SIGHUP signal
2774.cindex "SIGHUP"
2775.cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2776.cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2777.cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2778.cindex signal "to reload configuration"
2779.cindex daemon "reload configuration"
2780.cindex reload configuration
2781can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2782whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2783means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2784of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2785referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2786because these are reread each time they are used.
2787
2788.vitem &%-bdf%&
2789.oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2790This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2791from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2792
2793.vitem &%-be%&
2794.oindex "&%-be%&"
2795.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2796.cindex "expansion" "testing"
2797Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2798prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2799files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2800of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2801
2802If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2803to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2804used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2805function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2806test data. A line history is supported.
2807
2808Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2809continuations. As in Exim's runtime configuration, white space at the start of
2810continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2811string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2812configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2813message-specific values (such as &$message_exim_id$&) are set, because no message
2814is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2815
2816&*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2817files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2818the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2819of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2820
2821Macro processing is done on lines before string-expansion: new macros can be
2822defined and macros will be expanded.
2823Because macros in the config file are often used for secrets, those are only
2824available to admin users.
2825
2826.vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2827.oindex "&%-bem%&"
2828.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2829.cindex "expansion" "testing"
2830This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2831of a file. For example:
2832.code
2833exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2834.endd
2835The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2836message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2837variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2838no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2839recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2840&$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2841line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2842&%-be%&).
2843
2844.vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2845.oindex "&%-bF%&"
2846.cindex "system filter" "testing"
2847.cindex "testing" "system filter"
2848This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2849tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2850system filters are recognized.
2851
2852.vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2853.oindex "&%-bf%&"
2854.cindex "filter" "testing"
2855.cindex "testing" "filter file"
2856.cindex "forward file" "testing"
2857.cindex "testing" "forward file"
2858.cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2859This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2860to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2861there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2862supplied.
2863
2864If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2865can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2866filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2867.code
2868exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2869.endd
2870This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2871variables that are used by the user filter.
2872
2873If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2874.code
2875# Exim filter
2876# Sieve filter
2877.endd
2878it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2879that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2880&<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2881redirection lists.
2882
2883The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2884detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2885with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2886separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2887
2888When testing a filter file,
2889.cindex "&""From""& line"
2890.cindex "envelope from"
2891.cindex "envelope sender"
2892.oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2893the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2894or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2895that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2896can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2897options).
2898
2899.vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2900.oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2901.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2902This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2903tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2904&$qualify_domain$&.
2905
2906.vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2907.oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2908This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2909tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2910process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2911suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2912actually being delivered.
2913
2914.vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2915.oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2916.cindex affix "filter testing"
2917This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2918file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2919prefix.
2920
2921.vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2922.oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2923.cindex affix "filter testing"
2924This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2925file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2926suffix.
2927
2928.vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2929.oindex "&%-bh%&"
2930.cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2931.cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2932.cindex "testing" "relay control"
2933.cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2934.cindex "policy control" "testing"
2935.cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2936This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2937standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2938after a full stop. For example:
2939.code
2940exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2941exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2942.endd
2943When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2944of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2945conversion to the canonical form is
2946&`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2947
2948Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2949include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2950This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2951messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2952test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2953
2954&*Warning 1*&:
2955.cindex "RFC 1413"
2956You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2957information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2958an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2959connection.
2960
2961&*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2962are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2963occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2964
2965Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2966written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2967lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2968can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2969and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2970session were authenticated.
2971
2972The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2973output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2974acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2975
2976Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2977plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2978specialized SMTP test program such as
2979&url(https://www.jetmore.org/john/code/swaks/,swaks).
2980
2981.vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2982.oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2983This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2984verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2985updating the callout cache database.
2986
2987.vitem &%-bi%&
2988.oindex "&%-bi%&"
2989.cindex "alias file" "building"
2990.cindex "building alias file"
2991.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2992Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2993Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2994this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2995tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2996recognized.
2997
2998If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2999configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
3000the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
3001The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
3002use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
3003if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
3004&%-bi%& is a no-op.
3005
3006. // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
3007.vitem &%-bI:help%&
3008.oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
3009.cindex "querying exim information"
3010We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
3011information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
3012consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
3013synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
3014options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
3015
3016.vitem &%-bI:dscp%&
3017.oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
3018.cindex "DSCP" "values"
3019This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
3020recognised DSCP names.
3021
3022.vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
3023.oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
3024.cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
3025This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
3026Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
3027useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
3028&`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
3029compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3030way to guarantee a correct response.
3031
3032.vitem &%-bm%&
3033.oindex "&%-bm%&"
3034.cindex "local message reception"
3035This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3036locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3037command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3038argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3039default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3040if no other conflicting option is present.
3041
3042If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3043qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3044options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3045suppressing this for special cases.
3046
3047Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3048the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3049
3050.cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3051The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3052action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3053
3054The format
3055.cindex "message" "format"
3056.cindex "format" "message"
3057.cindex "&""From""& line"
3058.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3059.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3060of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3061compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3062.code
3063From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3064From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3065.endd
3066(with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3067is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3068authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3069matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3070option, which can be changed if necessary.
3071
3072.oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3073The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3074&%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3075preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3076trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3077
3078.vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3079.oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3080.cindex "testing", "malware"
3081.cindex "malware scan test"
3082This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file or directory
3083(depending on the used scanner interface),
3084using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3085this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3086the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3087not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3088will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3089
3090Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3091using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3092user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3093This option requires admin privileges.
3094
3095The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3096there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3097administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3098
3099.vitem &%-bnq%&
3100.oindex "&%-bnq%&"
3101.cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3102By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3103without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3104is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3105envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3106&%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3107defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3108
3109Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3110being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3111content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3112header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3113syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3114
3115The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3116messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3117addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3118unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3119
3120
3121.vitem &%-bP%&
3122.oindex "&%-bP%&"
3123.cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3124.cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3125If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3126main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3127of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3128arguments, for example:
3129.code
3130exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3131.endd
3132.cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3133.cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3134.cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3135However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3136configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3137users, the output is as in this example:
3138.code
3139mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3140.endd
3141If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3142output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3143
3144If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the runtime
3145configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3146backward compatibility.)
3147If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3148is the name of the file that was actually used.
3149
3150.cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3151If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3152name will not be output.
3153
3154.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3155.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3156If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3157directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3158respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3159sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3160written directly into the spool directory.
3161
3162If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3163.code
3164exim -bP +local_domains
3165.endd
3166it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3167local part) and outputs what it finds.
3168
3169.cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3170.cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3171.cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3172If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3173followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3174that driver are output. For example:
3175.code
3176exim -bP transport local_delivery
3177.endd
3178The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3179options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3180using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3181&%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3182settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3183&%authenticators%&.
3184
3185.cindex "environment"
3186If &%environment%& is given as an argument, the set of environment
3187variables is output, line by line. Using the &%-n%& flag suppresses the value of the
3188variables.
3189
3190.cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3191If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3192are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3193for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3194The output format is one item per line.
3195For the "-bP macro <name>" form, if no such macro is found
3196the exit status will be nonzero.
3197
3198.vitem &%-bp%&
3199.oindex "&%-bp%&"
3200.cindex "queue" "listing messages in"
3201.cindex "listing" "messages in the queue"
3202This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3203standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3204just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3205admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3206to allow any user to see the queue.
3207
3208Each message in the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3209.code
321025m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3211 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3212 <other addresses>
3213.endd
3214.cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3215.cindex "size" "of message"
3216The first line contains the length of time the message has been in the queue
3217(in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3218identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3219envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3220&"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3221the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3222before the sender address.
3223
3224.cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3225If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3226&"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3227
3228The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3229displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3230been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3231expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3232displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3233complete.
3234
3235
3236.vitem &%-bpa%&
3237.oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3238This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3239that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3240alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3241of just &"D"&.
3242
3243
3244.vitem &%-bpc%&
3245.oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3246.cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3247This option counts the number of messages in the queue, and writes the total
3248to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3249&%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3250
3251
3252.vitem &%-bpr%&
3253.oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3254This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3255chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3256lots of messages in the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3257going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3258
3259.vitem &%-bpra%&
3260.oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3261This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3262
3263.vitem &%-bpru%&
3264.oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3265This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3266
3267
3268.vitem &%-bpu%&
3269.oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3270This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3271addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3272forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3273router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3274
3275
3276.vitem &%-brt%&
3277.oindex "&%-brt%&"
3278.cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3279.cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3280This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3281arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3282and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3283.code
3284exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3285Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3286.endd
3287See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3288argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3289&'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3290contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3291retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3292with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3293rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3294sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3295used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3296.code
3297exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3298Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3299.endd
3300
3301.vitem &%-brw%&
3302.oindex "&%-brw%&"
3303.cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3304.cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3305This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3306a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3307complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3308would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3309&<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3310
3311.vitem &%-bS%&
3312.oindex "&%-bS%&"
3313.cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3314.cindex "batched SMTP input"
3315This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3316for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3317submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3318input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3319input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3320&%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3321believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3322
3323The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3324dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3325provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3326
3327As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3328messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3329Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3330&%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3331
3332Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3333as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3334QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3335
3336.cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3337If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3338error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3339was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3340was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3341
3342More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3343&<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3344
3345.vitem &%-bs%&
3346.oindex "&%-bs%&"
3347.cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3348.cindex "local SMTP input"
3349This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3350on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3351policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3352Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3353messages to the MTA.
3354
3355In
3356.cindex "sender" "source of"
3357this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3358set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3359Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3360the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3361&%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3362&%-bnq%& option is used.
3363
3364.cindex "inetd"
3365The
3366&%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3367using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3368whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3369&'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3370above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3371Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3372the listening daemon.
3373
3374.vitem &%-bt%&
3375.oindex "&%-bt%&"
3376.cindex "testing" "addresses"
3377.cindex "address" "testing"
3378This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3379as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3380written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3381user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3382sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3383
3384If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3385right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3386
3387Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3388&[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3389security issues.
3390
3391Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3392(compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3393written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3394&%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3395genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3396program.
3397
3398.cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3399The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3400failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3401code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3402
3403.cindex "duplicate addresses"
3404&*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3405addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3406This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3407always shown.
3408
3409&*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3410routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3411message,
3412.oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3413you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3414&%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3415default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3416whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3417those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3418doing such tests.
3419
3420.vitem &%-bV%&
3421.oindex "&%-bV%&"
3422.cindex "version number of Exim"
3423This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3424number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3425It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3426specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3427name of the runtime configuration file that is in use.
3428
3429As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3430configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3431values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3432detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3433alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3434realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3435dynamic testing facilities.
3436
3437.vitem &%-bv%&
3438.oindex "&%-bv%&"
3439.cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3440.cindex "address" "verification"
3441This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3442taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3443not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3444happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3445(see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3446including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3447
3448If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3449failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3450usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3451
3452If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3453right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3454
3455Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3456&[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3457security issues.
3458
3459Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3460that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3461router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3462verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3463address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3464
3465If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3466address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3467latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3468causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3469addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3470and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3471to succeed.
3472
3473When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3474and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3475considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3476
3477The
3478.cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3479return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3480failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3481code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3482
3483If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3484address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3485sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3486calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3487
3488.vitem &%-bvs%&
3489.oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3490This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3491than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3492might happen.
3493
3494.vitem &%-bw%&
3495.oindex "&%-bw%&"
3496.cindex "daemon"
3497.cindex "inetd"
3498.cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3499This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3500similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3501and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3502
3503In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3504listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3505inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3506each port only when the first connection is received.
3507
3508If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3509which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3510
3511.vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3512.oindex "&%-C%&"
3513.cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3514.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3515.cindex "alternate configuration file"
3516This option causes Exim to find the runtime configuration file from the given
3517list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3518compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single filename,
3519but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3520file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3521proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3522
3523When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3524from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3525runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3526However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3527file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3528which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3529listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3530CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3531not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3532
3533Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3534configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3535even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3536running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3537delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3538test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3539in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3540
3541If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3542prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3543must start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3544However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3545CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3546usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3547unset, any filename can be used with &%-C%&.
3548
3549ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3550to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3551broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3552configuration file.
3553
3554The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3555syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3556caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3557require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3558specified by this option.
3559
3560
3561.vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3562.oindex "&%-D%&"
3563.cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3564This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3565(see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3566unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3567If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3568completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3569
3570If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3571colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3572supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3573not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3574the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3575to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3576regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3577
3578The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3579command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3580string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3581synonymous:
3582.code
3583exim -DABC ...
3584exim -DABC= ...
3585.endd
3586To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3587quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3588example:
3589.code
3590exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3591.endd
3592&%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3593Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3594
3595
3596.vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3597.oindex "&%-d%&"
3598.cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3599.cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3600This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3601error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3602database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3603filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3604writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3605return code.
3606
3607When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3608standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3609some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3610made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3611of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3612debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3613no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3614are:
3615.display
3616&`acl `& ACL interpretation
3617&`auth `& authenticators
3618&`deliver `& general delivery logic
3619&`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3620&`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3621&`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3622&`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3623&`filter `& filter handling
3624&`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3625&`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3626&`ident `& ident lookup
3627&`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3628&`lists `& matching things in lists
3629&`load `& system load checks
3630&`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3631 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3632&`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3633&`memory `& memory handling
3634&`noutf8 `& modifier: avoid UTF-8 line-drawing
3635&`pid `& modifier: add pid to debug output lines
3636&`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3637&`queue_run `& queue runs
3638&`receive `& general message reception logic
3639&`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3640&`retry `& retry handling
3641&`rewrite `& address rewriting
3642&`route `& address routing
3643&`timestamp `& modifier: add timestamp to debug output lines
3644&`tls `& TLS logic
3645&`transport `& transports
3646&`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3647&`verify `& address verification logic
3648&`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3649.endd
3650The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3651for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3652tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3653is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3654generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3655turn everything off.
3656
3657.cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3658.cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3659The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3660with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3661unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3662rather than stderr.
3663
3664The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3665&`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3666However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3667daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3668automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3669run in parallel.
3670
3671The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3672of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3673in processing.
3674
3675.cindex debugging "UTF-8 in"
3676.cindex UTF-8 "in debug output"
3677The &`noutf8`& selector disables the use of
3678UTF-8 line-drawing characters to group related information.
3679When disabled. ascii-art is used instead.
3680Using the &`+all`& option does not set this modifier,
3681
3682If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3683any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3684
3685.vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3686.oindex "&%-dd%&"
3687This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3688starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3689subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3690behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3691
3692.vitem &%-dropcr%&
3693.oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3694This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3695handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3696described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3697
3698.vitem &%-E%&
3699.oindex "&%-E%&"
3700.cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3701This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3702failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3703and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3704generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3705could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3706follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3707new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3708
3709.vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3710.oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3711There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3712called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3713example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3714form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3715
3716.vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3717.oindex "&%-F%&"
3718.cindex "sender" "name"
3719.cindex "name" "of sender"
3720This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3721message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3722entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3723their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3724between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3725
3726.vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3727.oindex "&%-f%&"
3728.cindex "sender" "address"
3729.cindex "address" "sender"
3730.cindex "trusted users"
3731.cindex "envelope from"
3732.cindex "envelope sender"
3733.cindex "user" "trusted"
3734This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3735message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3736by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3737users to use it.
3738
3739Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3740trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3741options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3742of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3743domain.
3744
3745There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3746can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3747never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3748string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3749examples of shell commands:
3750.code
3751exim -f '<>' user@domain
3752exim -f "" user@domain
3753.endd
3754In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3755with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3756&%-bv%& options.
3757
3758Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3759it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3760refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3761though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3762
3763White
3764.cindex "&""From""& line"
3765space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3766given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3767locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3768&"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3769if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3770
3771.vitem &%-G%&
3772.oindex "&%-G%&"
3773.cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3774This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3775.code
3776control = suppress_local_fixups
3777.endd
3778for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3779bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3780in future.
3781
3782As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3783this option.
3784
3785.vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3786.oindex "&%-h%&"
3787.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3788This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3789Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3790headers.)
3791
3792.vitem &%-i%&
3793.oindex "&%-i%&"
3794.cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3795.cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3796This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3797line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3798no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3799command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3800
3801.vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3802.oindex "&%-L%&"
3803.cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3804This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3805file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3806Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3807read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3808effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3809
3810The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3811
3812.vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3813.oindex "&%-M%&"
3814.cindex "forcing delivery"
3815.cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3816.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3817This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3818any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3819delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3820and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3821
3822Retry
3823.cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3824hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3825the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3826to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3827which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3828for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3829
3830The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3831not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3832produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3833use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3834
3835.vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3836.oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3837.cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3838.cindex "recipient" "adding"
3839This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3840message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3841id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3842active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3843can be used only by an admin user.
3844
3845.vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3846 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3847.oindex "&%-MC%&"
3848.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3849.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3850.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3851This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3852by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3853an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3854given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3855must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3856
3857.vitem &%-MCA%&
3858.oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3859This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3860by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3861connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3862
3863.vitem &%-MCD%&
3864.oindex "&%-MCD%&"
3865This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3866by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3867remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3868
3869.vitem &%-MCG%&&~<&'queue&~name'&>
3870.oindex "&%-MCG%&"
3871This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3872by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3873alternate queue is used, named by the following argument.
3874
3875.vitem &%-MCK%&
3876.oindex "&%-MCK%&"
3877This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3878by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that a
3879remote host supports the ESMTP &_CHUNKING_& extension.
3880
3881.vitem &%-MCP%&
3882.oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3883This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3884by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3885which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3886
3887.vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3888.oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3889This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3890by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3891started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3892together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3893signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3894messages through the same SMTP connection.
3895
3896.vitem &%-MCS%&
3897.oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3898This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3899by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3900SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3901connection.
3902
3903.vitem &%-MCT%&
3904.oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3905This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3906by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3907host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3908
3909.vitem &%-MCt%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>&~<&'port'&>&~<&'cipher'&>
3910.oindex "&%-MCt%&"
3911This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3912by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3913connection is being proxied by a parent process for handling TLS encryption.
3914The arguments give the local address and port being proxied, and the TLS cipher.
3915
3916.vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3917.oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3918.cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3919.cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3920This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message, in turn,
3921but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3922that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3923provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3924order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3925However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3926respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3927overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3928If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3929&%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3930and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3931
3932.vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3933.oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3934.cindex "message" "changing sender"
3935.cindex "sender" "changing"
3936This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3937given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3938&"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3939be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3940is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3941This option can be used only by an admin user.
3942
3943.vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3944.oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3945.cindex "freezing messages"
3946.cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3947This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3948prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3949either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3950However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3951attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3952user.
3953
3954.vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3955.oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3956.cindex "giving up on messages"
3957.cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3958.cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3959This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3960including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3961their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3962is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3963Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3964user.
3965
3966.vitem &%-MG%&&~<&'queue&~name'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3967.oindex "&%-MG%&"
3968.cindex queue named
3969.cindex "named queues"
3970.cindex "queue" "moving messages"
3971This option requests that each listed message be moved from its current
3972queue to the given named queue.
3973The destination queue name argument is required, but can be an empty
3974string to define the default queue.
3975If the messages are not currently located in the default queue,
3976a &%-qG<name>%& option will be required to define the source queue.
3977
3978.vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3979.oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3980.cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3981This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3982as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3983message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3984altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3985
3986.vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3987.oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
3988.cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3989.cindex "recipient" "removing"
3990.cindex "removing recipients"
3991This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3992(&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3993the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3994addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3995(in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3996can be used only by an admin user.
3997
3998.vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3999.oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
4000.cindex "removing messages"
4001.cindex "abandoning mail"
4002.cindex "message" "manually discarding"
4003This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
4004bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
4005the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
4006only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
4007placed in the queue.
4008
4009. .new
4010. .vitem &%-MS%&
4011. .oindex "&%-MS%&"
4012. .cindex REQUIRETLS
4013. This option is used to request REQUIRETLS processing on the message.
4014. It is used internally by Exim in conjunction with -E when generating
4015. a bounce message.
4016. .wen
4017
4018.vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4019.oindex "&%-Mset%&"
4020.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
4021.cindex "expansion" "testing"
4022This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
4023string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
4024the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
4025&$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
4026available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
4027make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
4028user. See also &%-bem%&.
4029
4030.vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4031.oindex "&%-Mt%&"
4032.cindex "thawing messages"
4033.cindex "unfreezing messages"
4034.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
4035.cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
4036This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
4037&"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
4038messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
4039by an admin user.
4040
4041.vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4042.oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
4043.cindex "listing" "message body"
4044.cindex "message" "listing body of"
4045This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
4046written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4047
4048.vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4049.oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
4050.cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
4051.cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
4052This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
4053be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
4054only by an admin user.
4055
4056.vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4057.oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
4058.cindex "listing" "message headers"
4059.cindex "header lines" "listing"
4060.cindex "message" "listing header lines"
4061This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
4062written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4063
4064.vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4065.oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
4066.cindex "listing" "message log"
4067.cindex "message" "listing message log"
4068This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
4069the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4070
4071.vitem &%-m%&
4072.oindex "&%-m%&"
4073This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
4074treats it that way too.
4075
4076.vitem &%-N%&
4077.oindex "&%-N%&"
4078.cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
4079.cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
4080This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
4081level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
4082it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
4083had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
4084database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4085than &"=>"&.
4086
4087Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4088user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4089words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4090which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4091address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4092routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4093the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4094for that message.
4095
4096.vitem &%-n%&
4097.oindex "&%-n%&"
4098This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4099For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4100When combined with &%-bP%& it makes the output more terse (suppresses
4101option names, environment values and config pretty printing).
4102
4103.vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4104.oindex "&%-O%&"
4105This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4106Exim.
4107
4108.vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4109.oindex "&%-oA%&"
4110.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4111This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4112alternative alias filename. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4113description above.
4114
4115.vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4116.oindex "&%-oB%&"
4117.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4118.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4119.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4120This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4121be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4122transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4123
4124.vitem &%-odb%&
4125.oindex "&%-odb%&"
4126.cindex "background delivery"
4127.cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4128This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4129including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4130messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4131delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4132processes to finish.
4133
4134When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4135leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4136and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4137This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4138
4139If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4140(&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4141overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4142setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4143
4144.vitem &%-odf%&
4145.oindex "&%-odf%&"
4146.cindex "foreground delivery"
4147.cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4148This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4149accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4150&%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4151and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4152
4153The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4154process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4155during deliveries.
4156
4157However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4158false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4159
4160If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4161message is left in the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4162process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4163restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4164
4165
4166.vitem &%-odi%&
4167.oindex "&%-odi%&"
4168This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4169Sendmail.
4170
4171.vitem &%-odq%&
4172.oindex "&%-odq%&"
4173.cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4174.cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4175.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4176This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4177including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4178not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4179are placed in the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4180process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4181&%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4182conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4183forces queueing.
4184
4185.vitem &%-odqs%&
4186.oindex "&%-odqs%&"
4187.cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4188This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4189However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4190&%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4191configuration file is in effect.
4192
4193When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4194message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4195also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4196in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4197done at this time, so the message remains in the queue until a subsequent queue
4198runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4199messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4200host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4201configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4202&%-qq%& option.
4203
4204.vitem &%-oee%&
4205.oindex "&%-oee%&"
4206.cindex "error" "reporting"
4207If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4208example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4209message.
4210
4211.cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4212Provided
4213this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4214exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4215is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4216This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4217
4218.vitem &%-oem%&
4219.oindex "&%-oem%&"
4220.cindex "error" "reporting"
4221.cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4222This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4223return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4224This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4225
4226.vitem &%-oep%&
4227.oindex "&%-oep%&"
4228.cindex "error" "reporting"
4229If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4230error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4231.cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4232The return code is 1 for all errors.
4233
4234.vitem &%-oeq%&
4235.oindex "&%-oeq%&"
4236.cindex "error" "reporting"
4237This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4238effect as &%-oep%&.
4239
4240.vitem &%-oew%&
4241.oindex "&%-oew%&"
4242.cindex "error" "reporting"
4243This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4244effect as &%-oem%&.
4245
4246.vitem &%-oi%&
4247.oindex "&%-oi%&"
4248.cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4249This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4250line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4251single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4252lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4253&'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4254
4255.vitem &%-oitrue%&
4256.oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4257This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4258
4259.vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4260.oindex "&%-oMa%&"
4261.cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4262A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4263with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4264over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4265&%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4266other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4267
4268The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4269number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4270.code
4271exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4272.endd
4273An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4274followed by a colon and the port number:
4275.code
4276exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4277.endd
4278The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4279port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4280are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4281whichever one is last.
4282
4283.vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4284.oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
4285.cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4286See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4287option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4288name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4289This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4290authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4291
4292.vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4293.oindex "&%-oMai%&"
4294.cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4295See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4296option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4297This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4298where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4299&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4300
4301.vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4302.oindex "&%-oMas%&"
4303.cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4304See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4305option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4306overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4307messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4308default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4309specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4310&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4311
4312.vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4313.oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4314.cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4315See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4316option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4317using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4318&$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4319
4320.vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4321.oindex "&%-oMm%&"
4322.cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4323See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4324option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4325delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4326messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4327abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4328running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4329
4330The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4331The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4332is sending the bounce.
4333
4334.vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4335.oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4336.cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4337.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4338See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4339option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4340&$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4341or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4342SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4343&<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4344one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4345be set by &%-oMr%&. Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4346
4347.vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4348.oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4349.cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4350See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4351option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4352present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4353uses the name it is given.
4354
4355.vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4356.oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4357.cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4358See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4359option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4360local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4361used, when there is no default.
4362
4363.vitem &%-om%&
4364.oindex "&%-om%&"
4365.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4366In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4367message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4368expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4369
4370.vitem &%-oo%&
4371.oindex "&%-oo%&"
4372.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4373This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4374whatever that means.
4375
4376.vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4377.oindex "&%-oP%&"
4378.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4379.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4380This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4381value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4382written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4383without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4384because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4385
4386.new
4387.vitem &%-oPX%&
4388.oindex "&%-oPX%&"
4389.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4390.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4391This option is not intended for general use.
4392The daemon uses it when terminating due to a SIGTEM, possibly in
4393combination with &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>.
4394It causes the pid file to be removed.
4395.wen
4396
4397.vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4398.oindex "&%-or%&"
4399.cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4400This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4401set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4402by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4403described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4404
4405.vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4406.oindex "&%-os%&"
4407.cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4408.cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4409This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4410applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4411the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4412for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4413
4414.vitem &%-ov%&
4415.oindex "&%-ov%&"
4416This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4417
4418.vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4419.oindex "&%-oX%&"
4420.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4421.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4422.cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4423This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4424is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4425of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4426in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4427file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid filename.
4428
4429.vitem &%-pd%&
4430.oindex "&%-pd%&"
4431.cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4432This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4433chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4434option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4435needed.
4436
4437.vitem &%-ps%&
4438.oindex "&%-ps%&"
4439.cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4440This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4441chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4442option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4443started.
4444
4445.vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4446.oindex "&%-p%&"
4447For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4448.display
4449&`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4450.endd
4451It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4452host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4453Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4454to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4455or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4456Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4457
4458.vitem &%-q%&
4459.oindex "&%-q%&"
4460.cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4461This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4462configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4463relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4464and &%-S%& options).
4465
4466.cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4467If other commandline options do not specify an action,
4468the &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4469waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4470for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4471process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4472have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4473
4474If
4475.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4476.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4477.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4478the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4479passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4480proceeding.
4481
4482When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4483process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4484mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4485this to be repeated periodically.
4486
4487Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4488random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4489If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4490MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4491
4492It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4493order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4494&%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4495
4496.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4497The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4498behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4499appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4500
4501.vitem &%-qq...%&
4502.oindex "&%-qq%&"
4503.cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4504.cindex "queue" "routing"
4505.cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4506An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4507stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4508every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4509transports are run.
4510
4511.cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4512The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4513is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4514complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4515place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4516delivered down a single SMTP
4517.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4518.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4519.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4520connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4521This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4522intermittently.
4523
4524.vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4525.oindex "&%-qi%&"
4526.cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4527If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4528those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4529delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages in the queue using
4530&%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4531
4532.vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4533.oindex "&%-qf%&"
4534.cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4535.cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4536If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4537message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4538their retry times are tried.
4539
4540.vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4541.oindex "&%-qff%&"
4542.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4543If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4544frozen or not.
4545
4546.vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4547.oindex "&%-ql%&"
4548.cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4549The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4550be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains in the queue
4551for later delivery.
4552
4553.vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]][l][G<name>[/<time>]]]%&
4554.oindex "&%-qG%&"
4555.cindex queue named
4556.cindex "named queues"
4557.cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4558If the &'G'& flag and a name is present, the queue runner operates on the
4559queue with the given name rather than the default queue.
4560The name should not contain a &'/'& character.
4561For a periodic queue run (see below)
4562append to the name a slash and a time value.
4563
4564If other commandline options specify an action, a &'-qG<name>'& option
4565will specify a queue to operate on.
4566For example:
4567.code
4568exim -bp -qGquarantine
4569mailq -qGquarantine
4570exim -qGoffpeak -Rf @special.domain.example
4571.endd
4572
4573.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4574When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4575lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4576starting message id. For example:
4577.code
4578exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4579.endd
4580Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4581second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4582are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4583.code
4584exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4585.endd
4586just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4587&%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4588that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4589mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4590are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4591queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4592
4593.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4594.cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4595.cindex "periodic queue running"
4596When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4597starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4598(whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4599&%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4600single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4601combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4602.code
4603/usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4604.endd
4605Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4606process every 30 minutes.
4607
4608When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4609pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4610
4611.vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4612.oindex "&%-qR%&"
4613This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4614compatibility.
4615
4616.vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4617.oindex "&%-qS%&"
4618This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4619
4620.vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4621.oindex "&%-R%&"
4622.cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4623.cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4624.cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4625The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4626is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4627which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4628<&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4629
4630This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4631perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4632queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4633address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4634way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4635regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4636
4637If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4638you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4639.code
4640exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4641.endd
4642This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4643every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4644applied to each queue run.
4645
4646Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4647are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4648information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4649means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4650existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4651address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4652will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4653information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4654address will be skipped.
4655
4656.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4657If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4658all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4659&'ff'& is present.
4660
4661The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4662to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4663command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4664effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4665an arbitrary command instead.
4666
4667.vitem &%-r%&
4668.oindex "&%-r%&"
4669This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4670
4671.vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4672.oindex "&%-S%&"
4673.cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4674.cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4675This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4676message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4677conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4678has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4679
4680.vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4681.oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4682This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4683recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4684&"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4685
4686.vitem &%-t%&
4687.oindex "&%-t%&"
4688.cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4689.cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4690.cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4691.cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4692When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4693input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4694from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4695from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4696takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4697
4698.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4699If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4700is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4701the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4702and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4703Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4704Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4705argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4706Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4707instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4708&%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4709
4710.cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4711If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4712recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4713lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4714with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4715&%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4716
4717RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4718message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4719added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4720not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4721nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4722In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4723are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4724once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4725&%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4726
4727.vitem &%-ti%&
4728.oindex "&%-ti%&"
4729This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4730compatibility with Sendmail.
4731
4732.vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4733.oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4734.cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4735.cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4736This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4737incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4738&%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4739&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4740
4741
4742.vitem &%-U%&
4743.oindex "&%-U%&"
4744.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4745Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4746documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4747syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4748set. Exim ignores this option.
4749
4750.vitem &%-v%&
4751.oindex "&%-v%&"
4752This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4753describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4754receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4755dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4756the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4757selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4758unconditional.
4759
4760.vitem &%-x%&
4761.oindex "&%-x%&"
4762AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4763National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4764It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4765this option.
4766
4767.vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4768.oindex "&%-X%&"
4769This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4770to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4771
4772.vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4773.oindex "&%-z%&"
4774This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4775Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4776Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4777under most shells.
4778.endlist
4779
4780.ecindex IIDclo1
4781.ecindex IIDclo2
4782
4783
4784. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4785. Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4786. line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4787. creates a man page for the options.
4788. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4789
4790.literal xml
4791<!-- === End of command line options === -->
4792.literal off
4793
4794
4795
4796
4797
4798. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4799. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4800
4801
4802.chapter "The Exim runtime configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4803 "The runtime configuration file"
4804
4805.cindex "runtime configuration"
4806.cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4807.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4808.cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4809.cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4810.cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4811Exim uses a single runtime configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4812binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4813because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4814control.
4815
4816If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4817writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4818The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4819errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4820not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4821actually alter the string.
4822
4823The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4824reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4825most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4826give a colon-separated list of filenames, in which case Exim uses the first
4827existing file in the list.
4828
4829.cindex "EXIM_USER"
4830.cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4831.cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4832.cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4833.cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4834.cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4835The runtime configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4836specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4837configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4838group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4839CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4840
4841&*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4842to root, anybody who is able to edit the runtime configuration file has an
4843easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4844CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4845who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4846
4847Up to Exim version 4.72, the runtime configuration file was also permitted to
4848be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4849since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4850compromise the Exim user account.
4851
4852A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4853is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4854defines just one filename, the installation process copies the default
4855configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4856CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4857&<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4858configuration.
4859
4860
4861
4862.section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4863.cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4864A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4865option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4866&%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4867unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4868CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4869is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4870is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4871installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4872specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4873
4874Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4875with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4876listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4877testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4878delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4879Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4880the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4881can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4882message in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4883&%-M%&).
4884
4885If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4886prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4887start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4888There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any
4889filename can be used with &%-C%&.
4890
4891One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4892option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4893configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4894non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4895If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4896completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4897
4898The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4899to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4900necessarily be discarded.
4901WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4902considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4903values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4904is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4905transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4906values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4907
4908Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4909share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4910If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4911looks for a file whose name is the configuration filename followed by a dot
4912and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4913file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4914each filename in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4915
4916In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4917different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4918help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4919
4920
4921
4922.section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4923.cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4924.cindex "format" "configuration file"
4925Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4926option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4927are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4928is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
4929space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
4930
4931.ilist
4932&'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4933&<<CHAPACL>>&).
4934.next
4935.cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4936&'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4937are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4938.next
4939&'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4940addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4941&<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4942.next
4943&'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4944define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4945&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4946.next
4947&'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4948If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4949defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4950are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4951&<<CHAPretry>>&.
4952.next
4953&'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4954when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4955chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4956.next
4957&'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4958want to use this feature, you must set
4959.code
4960LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4961.endd
4962in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4963facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4964.endlist
4965
4966.cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4967.cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4968.cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4969Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4970
4971Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4972leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4973# character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4974and does not introduce a comment.
4975
4976Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4977the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4978backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4979lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4980appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4981
4982A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4983default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4984change settings as required.
4985
4986The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4987described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4988respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4989items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4990onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4991described.
4992
4993
4994
4995.section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4996.cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4997.cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4998.cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4999.cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
5000You can include other files inside Exim's runtime configuration file by
5001using this syntax:
5002.display
5003&`.include`& <&'filename'&>
5004&`.include_if_exists`& <&'filename'&>
5005.endd
5006on a line by itself. Double quotes round the filename are optional. If you use
5007the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
5008second form does nothing for non-existent files.
5009The first form allows a relative name. It is resolved relative to
5010the directory of the including file. For the second form an absolute filename
5011is required.
5012
5013Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
5014configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
5015If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
5016because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
5017
5018The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
5019comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
5020for example:
5021.code
5022hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
5023 .include /some/file
5024.endd
5025Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
5026process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
5027inclusion appears.
5028
5029
5030
5031.section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
5032.cindex "macro" "description of"
5033.cindex "configuration file" "macros"
5034If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
5035&"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
5036definition, and must be of the form
5037.display
5038<&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
5039.endd
5040The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
5041in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
5042continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
5043space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
5044a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
5045
5046Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
5047definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
5048ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
5049
5050.section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
5051Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
5052files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
5053scanned for each, in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
5054replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
5055for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
5056the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
5057define
5058.display
5059&`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
5060&`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
5061.endd
5062but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
5063error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
5064before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
5065consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
5066line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
5067comment line or a &`.include`& line.
5068
5069
5070.section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
5071Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
5072(or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
5073&'='&. For example:
5074.code
5075MAC = initial value
5076...
5077MAC == updated value
5078.endd
5079Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
5080subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
5081the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
5082Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
5083.code
5084MAC = initial value
5085...
5086MAC == MAC and something added
5087.endd
5088This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
5089from a number of other files.
5090
5091.section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
5092The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
5093&%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
5094used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
5095using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
5096file to be ignored.
5097
5098
5099
5100.section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
5101As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
5102up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
5103strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
5104.code
5105ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
5106 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
5107.endd
5108This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
5109.code
5110data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
5111.endd
5112In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
5113address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
5114section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
5115
5116
5117.section "Builtin macros" "SECTbuiltinmacros"
5118Exim defines some macros depending on facilities available, which may
5119differ due to build-time definitions and from one release to another.
5120All of these macros start with an underscore.
5121They can be used to conditionally include parts of a configuration
5122(see below).
5123
5124The following classes of macros are defined:
5125.display
5126&` _HAVE_* `& build-time defines
5127&` _DRIVER_ROUTER_* `& router drivers
5128&` _DRIVER_TRANSPORT_* `& transport drivers
5129&` _DRIVER_AUTHENTICATOR_* `& authenticator drivers
5130&` _LOG_* `& log_selector values
5131&` _OPT_MAIN_* `& main config options
5132&` _OPT_ROUTERS_* `& generic router options
5133&` _OPT_TRANSPORTS_* `& generic transport options
5134&` _OPT_AUTHENTICATORS_* `& generic authenticator options
5135&` _OPT_ROUTER_*_* `& private router options
5136&` _OPT_TRANSPORT_*_* `& private transport options
5137&` _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_*_* `& private authenticator options
5138.endd
5139
5140Use an &"exim -bP macros"& command to get the list of macros.
5141
5142
5143.section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5144.cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5145.cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5146You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5147&`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5148portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5149read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5150
5151The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5152be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5153that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5154line. Thus:
5155.code
5156.ifdef AAA
5157message_size_limit = 50M
5158.else
5159message_size_limit = 100M
5160.endif
5161.endd
5162sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5163(or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5164otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5165is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5166obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5167
5168Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5169it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5170in this line"& will always be true.
5171
5172Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5173to clarify complicated nestings.
5174
5175
5176
5177.section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5178.cindex "common option syntax"
5179.cindex "syntax of common options"
5180.cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5181For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5182each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5183lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5184these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5185space) and then the value. For example:
5186.code
5187qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5188.endd
5189.cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5190.cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5191.cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5192Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5193accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5194line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5195word &"hide"&. For example:
5196.code
5197hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5198.endd
5199For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5200.code
5201mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5202.endd
5203If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5204all instances of the same driver.
5205
5206The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5207that are found in option settings.
5208
5209
5210.section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5211.cindex "format" "boolean"
5212.cindex "boolean configuration values"
5213.oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5214.oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5215Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5216different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5217the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5218if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5219boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5220&"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5221the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5222.code
5223queue_only
5224queue_only = true
5225.endd
5226The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5227.code
5228no_queue_only
5229queue_only = false
5230.endd
5231You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5232
5233
5234
5235
5236.section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5237.cindex "integer configuration values"
5238.cindex "format" "integer"
5239If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5240hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5241number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5242with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5243hexadecimal number.
5244
5245If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5246it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024;
5247if by the letter G, 1024x1024x1024.
5248When the values
5249of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
52501024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5251and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5252used.
5253
5254
5255.section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5256.cindex "integer format"
5257.cindex "format" "octal integer"
5258If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5259interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5260Such options are always output in octal.
5261
5262
5263.section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5264.cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5265.cindex "format" "fixed point"
5266If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5267integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5268
5269
5270
5271.section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5272.cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5273.cindex "format" "time interval"
5274A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5275the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5276
5277.table2 30pt
5278.irow &%s%& seconds
5279.irow &%m%& minutes
5280.irow &%h%& hours
5281.irow &%d%& days
5282.irow &%w%& weeks
5283.endtable
5284
5285For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5286intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5287is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5288
5289
5290
5291.section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5292.cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5293.cindex "format" "string"
5294If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5295or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5296consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5297the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5298removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5299Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5300appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5301therefore equivalent:
5302.code
5303trusted_users = uucp:mail
5304trusted_users = uucp:\
5305 # This comment line is ignored
5306 mail
5307.endd
5308.cindex "string" "quoted"
5309.cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5310If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5311double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5312continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5313
5314.table2 100pt
5315.irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5316.irow &`\n`& "newline"
5317.irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5318.irow &`\t`& "tab"
5319.irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5320.irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5321 character"
5322.endtable
5323
5324If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5325character, that character replaces the pair.
5326
5327Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5328insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5329trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5330current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5331in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5332and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5333
5334
5335.section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5336.cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5337Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5338by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5339circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5340is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5341strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5342However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5343backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5344within a quoted configuration string.
5345
5346
5347.section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5348.cindex "user name" "format of"
5349.cindex "format" "user name"
5350.cindex "groups" "name format"
5351.cindex "format" "group name"
5352User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5353above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5354either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5355&[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5356
5357
5358.section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5359.cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5360.cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5361.cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5362The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5363default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5364the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5365&"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5366are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5367particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5368&<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5369
5370In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5371input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5372&<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5373in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5374on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5375start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5376example, the list
5377.code
5378local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5379.endd
5380contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5381
5382&*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5383list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5384colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5385be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5386
5387.section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5388.cindex "list separator" "changing"
5389.cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5390Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5391introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5392with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5393character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5394above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5395.code
5396local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5397.endd
5398This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5399&%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5400confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5401
5402.cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5403.cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5404It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5405code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5406must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5407are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5408sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5409interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5410generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5411.code
5412domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5413.endd
5414This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5415to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5416expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5417the value in quotes. For example:
5418.code
5419local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5420.endd
5421Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5422doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5423set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5424enclosing an empty list item.
5425
5426
5427
5428.section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5429.cindex "list" "empty item in"
5430An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5431separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5432.code
5433senders = user@domain :
5434.endd
5435contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5436in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5437items, the second of which is empty:
5438.code
5439senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5440.endd
5441&*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5442are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5443would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5444just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5445.code
5446senders = :
5447.endd
5448In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5449is at the end of the list.
5450
5451
5452
5453
5454.section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5455.cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5456There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5457and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5458instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5459a sequence of lines like this:
5460.display
5461<&'instance name'&>:
5462 <&'option'&>
5463 ...
5464 <&'option'&>
5465.endd
5466In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5467followed by three options settings:
5468.code
5469localuser:
5470 driver = accept
5471 check_local_user
5472 transport = local_delivery
5473.endd
5474For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5475setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5476settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5477deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5478a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5479described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5480
5481You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5482the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5483
5484The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5485passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5486transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5487authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5488them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5489server.
5490
5491.cindex "generic options"
5492.cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5493Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5494and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5495same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5496&%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5497.cindex "private options"
5498The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5499they all have default values.
5500
5501The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5502precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5503this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5504
5505Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5506elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5507with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5508a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5509instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5510confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5511configuration lines:
5512.code
5513remote_smtp:
5514 driver = smtp
5515.endd
5516create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5517&(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5518different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5519instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5520thus:
5521.code
5522special_smtp:
5523 driver = smtp
5524 port = 1234
5525 command_timeout = 10s
5526.endd
5527The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5528these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5529lines.
5530
5531Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5532list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5533defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5534option.
5535
5536
5537
5538
5539
5540
5541. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5542. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5543
5544.chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5545.scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5546.cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5547The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5548is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5549the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5550configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5551of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5552itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5553initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5554mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5555
5556
5557
5558.section "Macros" "SECTdefconfmacros"
5559All macros should be defined before any options.
5560
5561One macro is specified, but commented out, in the default configuration:
5562.code
5563# ROUTER_SMARTHOST=MAIL.HOSTNAME.FOR.CENTRAL.SERVER.EXAMPLE
5564.endd
5565If all off-site mail is expected to be delivered to a "smarthost", then set the
5566hostname here and uncomment the macro. This will affect which router is used
5567later on. If this is left commented out, then Exim will perform direct-to-MX
5568deliveries using a &(dnslookup)& router.
5569
5570In addition to macros defined here, Exim includes a number of built-in macros
5571to enable configuration to be guarded by a binary built with support for a
5572given feature. See section &<<SECTbuiltinmacros>>& for more details.
5573
5574
5575.section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5576The main (global) configuration option settings section must always come first
5577in the file, after the macros.
5578The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is the line
5579.code
5580# primary_hostname =
5581.endd
5582This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5583to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5584can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5585it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5586
5587The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5588.code
5589domainlist local_domains = @
5590domainlist relay_to_domains =
5591hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5592.endd
5593These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5594domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5595domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5596configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5597
5598The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5599later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5600on the local host.
5601
5602.cindex "@ in a domain list"
5603There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5604of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5605called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5606be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5607the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5608
5609The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5610list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5611controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5612domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5613domain is permitted.
5614
5615The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5616used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5617that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5618loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5619submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5620hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5621
5622Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5623we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5624and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5625
5626The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5627.code
5628acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5629acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5630.endd
5631These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5632during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5633command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5634respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5635&'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5636section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5637accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5638to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5639contents of a message to be checked.
5640
5641Two commented-out option settings are next:
5642.code
5643# av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5644# spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5645.endd
5646These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5647content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5648scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5649details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5650
5651Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5652.code
5653# tls_advertise_hosts = *
5654# tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5655# tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5656.endd
5657These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5658support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5659first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5660connecting to this server; in this case, the wildcard means all clients. The
5661other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5662key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5663More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5664
5665Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5666.code
5667# daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5668# tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5669.endd
5670.cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5671.cindex "port" "for message submission"
5672.cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5673.cindex "submissions protocol"
5674.cindex "smtps protocol"
5675.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5676.cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
5677.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5678.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5679These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5680server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5681TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5682more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&).
5683Mail submission from mail clients (MUAs) should be separate from inbound mail
5684to your domain (MX delivery) for various good reasons (eg, ability to impose
5685much saner TLS protocol and ciphersuite requirements without unintended
5686consequences).
5687RFC 6409 (previously 4409) specifies use of port 587 for SMTP Submission,
5688which uses STARTTLS, so this is the &"submission"& port.
5689RFC 8314 specifies use of port 465 as the &"submissions"& protocol,
5690which should be used in preference to 587.
5691You should also consider deploying SRV records to help clients find
5692these ports.
5693Older names for &"submissions"& are &"smtps"& and &"ssmtp"&.
5694
5695Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5696.code
5697# qualify_domain =
5698# qualify_recipient =
5699.endd
5700The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5701complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5702receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5703the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5704you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5705addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5706
5707.cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5708The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5709addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5710(an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5711.code
5712# allow_domain_literals
5713.endd
5714The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5715Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5716quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5717try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5718people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5719&'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5720
5721The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5722.code
5723never_users = root
5724.endd
5725It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5726convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5727setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5728The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5729list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5730FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5731contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5732FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5733
5734When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5735Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5736line,
5737.code
5738host_lookup = *
5739.endd
5740specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5741in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5742information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5743or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5744Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5745because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5746unreachable.
5747
5748The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
57491413 (hence their names):
5750.code
5751rfc1413_hosts = *
5752rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5753.endd
5754These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5755Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5756terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5757of an incoming SMTP connection.
5758If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5759information, you can change this.
5760
5761This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5762and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5763.code
5764prdr_enable = true
5765.endd
5766
5767When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5768be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5769if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5770find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5771.code
5772# sender_unqualified_hosts =
5773# recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5774.endd
5775show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5776and recipient addresses, respectively.
5777
5778The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5779over the default:
5780.code
5781log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5782 +tls_certificate_verified
5783.endd
5784
5785The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5786.code
5787# percent_hack_domains =
5788.endd
5789It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5790This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5791anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5792
5793The next two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5794concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5795message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5796occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5797address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5798bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5799are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5800always bounce messages.
5801.code
5802ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5803timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5804.endd
5805The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5806discarded after 2 days in the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5807message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5808after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5809bounce message ever lasts a week.
5810
5811Exim queues it's messages in a spool directory. If you expect to have
5812large queues, you may consider using this option. It splits the spool
5813directory into subdirectories to avoid file system degradation from
5814many files in a single directory, resulting in better performance.
5815Manual manipulation of queued messages becomes more complex (though fortunately
5816not often needed).
5817.code
5818# split_spool_directory = true
5819.endd
5820
5821In an ideal world everybody follows the standards. For non-ASCII
5822messages RFC 2047 is a standard, allowing a maximum line length of 76
5823characters. Exim adheres that standard and won't process messages which
5824violate this standard. (Even ${rfc2047:...} expansions will fail.)
5825In particular, the Exim maintainers have had multiple reports of
5826problems from Russian administrators of issues until they disable this
5827check, because of some popular, yet buggy, mail composition software.
5828.code
5829# check_rfc2047_length = false
5830.endd
5831
5832If you need to be strictly RFC compliant you may wish to disable the
58338BITMIME advertisement. Use this, if you exchange mails with systems
5834that are not 8-bit clean.
5835.code
5836# accept_8bitmime = false
5837.endd
5838
5839Libraries you use may depend on specific environment settings. This
5840imposes a security risk (e.g. PATH). There are two lists:
5841&%keep_environment%& for the variables to import as they are, and
5842&%add_environment%& for variables we want to set to a fixed value.
5843Note that TZ is handled separately, by the $%timezone%$ runtime
5844option and by the TIMEZONE_DEFAULT buildtime option.
5845.code
5846# keep_environment = ^LDAP
5847# add_environment = PATH=/usr/bin::/bin
5848.endd
5849
5850
5851.section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5852.cindex "default" "ACLs"
5853.cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5854In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5855It starts with the line
5856.code
5857begin acl
5858.endd
5859and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5860&'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5861and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5862
5863.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5864The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5865RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5866are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5867rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5868result of the ACL processing.
5869.code
5870acl_check_rcpt:
5871.endd
5872This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5873ACL, and names it.
5874.code
5875accept hosts = :
5876.endd
5877This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5878But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5879names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5880list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5881host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5882important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5883
5884What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5885messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5886input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5887manner.
5888.code
5889deny message = Restricted characters in address
5890 domains = +local_domains
5891 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5892
5893deny message = Restricted characters in address
5894 domains = !+local_domains
5895 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5896.endd
5897These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5898characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5899Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5900&"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5901in Internet mail addresses.
5902
5903The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5904addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5905option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5906in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5907programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5908at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5909characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5910policy of being as safe as possible.
5911
5912The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5913to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5914first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5915&'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5916reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5917&'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5918
5919The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5920block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5921or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5922have to modify this rule.
5923
5924Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5925allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5926common convention of local parts constructed as
5927&"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5928the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5929with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5930filename (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5931that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5932is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5933
5934The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5935allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5936and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5937with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5938local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5939and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5940(or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5941.code
5942accept local_parts = postmaster
5943 domains = +local_domains
5944.endd
5945This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5946local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5947&'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5948reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5949&'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5950
5951The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5952by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5953in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5954.code
5955require verify = sender
5956.endd
5957This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5958ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5959address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5960see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5961addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5962used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5963discusses the details of address verification.
5964.code
5965accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5966 control = submission
5967.endd
5968This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5969hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5970verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5971that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5972second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5973is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5974messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5975&'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5976probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5977.code
5978accept authenticated = *
5979 control = submission
5980.endd
5981This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5982Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5983likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5984authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5985examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5986fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5987.code
5988require message = relay not permitted
5989 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5990.endd
5991This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5992one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5993.code
5994require verify = recipient
5995.endd
5996This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5997fails, the address is rejected.
5998.code
5999# deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
6000# is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
6001# $dnslist_text
6002# dnslists = black.list.example
6003#
6004# warn dnslists = black.list.example
6005# add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
6006# a black list at $dnslist_domain
6007# log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
6008.endd
6009These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
6010sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
6011from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
6012line.
6013.code
6014# require verify = csa
6015.endd
6016This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
6017authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
6018records.
6019.code
6020accept
6021.endd
6022The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
6023address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
6024.code
6025acl_check_data:
6026.endd
6027This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
6028of this ACL are commented out:
6029.code
6030# deny malware = *
6031# message = This message contains a virus \
6032# ($malware_name).
6033.endd
6034These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
6035viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
6036suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
6037virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
6038.code
6039# warn spam = nobody
6040# message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
6041# X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
6042# X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
6043# X-Spam_report: $spam_report
6044.endd
6045These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
6046SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
6047and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
6048&`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
6049series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
6050whatever the spam score.
6051.code
6052accept
6053.endd
6054This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
6055
6056
6057.section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
6058.cindex "default" "routers"
6059.cindex "routers" "default"
6060The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
6061by the line
6062.code
6063begin routers
6064.endd
6065Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
6066messages. An address is passed to each router, in turn, until it is either
6067accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
6068matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
6069manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
6070.code
6071# domain_literal:
6072# driver = ipliteral
6073# domains = !+local_domains
6074# transport = remote_smtp
6075.endd
6076.cindex "domain literal" "default router"
6077This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
6078support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
6079you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
6080&%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
6081
6082Which router is used next depends upon whether or not the ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6083macro has been defined, per
6084.code
6085.ifdef ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6086smarthost:
6087#...
6088.else
6089dnslookup:
6090#...
6091.endif
6092.endd
6093
6094If ROUTER_SMARTHOST has been defined, either at the top of the file or on the
6095command-line, then we route all non-local mail to that smarthost; otherwise, we'll
6096perform DNS lookups for direct-to-MX lookup. Any mail which is to a local domain will
6097skip these routers because of the &%domains%& option.
6098
6099.code
6100smarthost:
6101 driver = manualroute
6102 domains = ! +local_domains
6103 transport = smarthost_smtp
6104 route_data = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6105 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0.0.0.0 ; 127.0.0.0/8 ; ::1
6106 no_more
6107.endd
6108This router only handles mail which is not to any local domains; this is
6109specified by the line
6110.code
6111domains = ! +local_domains
6112.endd
6113The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
6114exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
6115that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
6116the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
6117indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
6118passed on to the following routers.
6119
6120The name of the router driver is &(manualroute)& because we are manually
6121specifying how mail should be routed onwards, instead of using DNS MX.
6122While the name of this router instance is arbitrary, the &%driver%& option must
6123be one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6124
6125With no pre-conditions other than &%domains%&, all mail for non-local domains
6126will be handled by this router, and the &%no_more%& setting will ensure that no
6127other routers will be used for messages matching the pre-conditions. See
6128&<<SECTrouprecon>>& for more on how the pre-conditions apply. For messages which
6129are handled by this router, we provide a hostname to deliver to in &%route_data%&
6130and the macro supplies the value; the address is then queued for the
6131&(smarthost_smtp)& transport.
6132
6133.code
6134dnslookup:
6135 driver = dnslookup
6136 domains = ! +local_domains
6137 transport = remote_smtp
6138 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
6139 no_more
6140.endd
6141The &%domains%& option behaves as per smarthost, above.
6142
6143The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
6144and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
6145the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
6146instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
6147one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6148
6149The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
6150DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
6151router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
6152specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
6153in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
6154the address fails and is bounced.
6155
6156The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
6157be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
6158encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
6159whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
6160Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
6161email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
6162continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
6163out.
6164.code
6165system_aliases:
6166 driver = redirect
6167 allow_fail
6168 allow_defer
6169 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
6170# user = exim
6171 file_transport = address_file
6172 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6173.endd
6174Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
6175domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
6176alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
6177data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
6178the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
6179the next router.
6180
6181&_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
6182often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
6183file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
6184&_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
6185.code
6186userforward:
6187 driver = redirect
6188 check_local_user
6189# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6190# local_part_suffix_optional
6191 file = $home/.forward
6192# allow_filter
6193 no_verify
6194 no_expn
6195 check_ancestor
6196 file_transport = address_file
6197 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6198 reply_transport = address_reply
6199.endd
6200This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
6201redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
6202individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
6203local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
6204router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
6205namely:
6206.code
6207# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6208# local_part_suffix_optional
6209.endd
6210.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
6211show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
6212is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
6213by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
6214variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
6215presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
6216the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
6217
6218When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
6219home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
6220declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
6221redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
6222
6223.cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
6224Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
6225files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
6226is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
6227of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
6228filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
6229separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
6230
6231The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
6232verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
6233There are two reasons for doing this:
6234
6235.olist
6236Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
6237checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
6238unnecessary work.
6239.next
6240More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
6241command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
6242The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
6243It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
6244this time.
6245.endlist
6246
6247The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
6248address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6249works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6250forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6251
6252The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6253forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6254auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6255.code
6256a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6257.endd
6258the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6259transport.
6260.code
6261localuser:
6262 driver = accept
6263 check_local_user
6264# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6265# local_part_suffix_optional
6266 transport = local_delivery
6267.endd
6268The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6269part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6270the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6271routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6272same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6273
6274
6275.section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6276.cindex "default" "transports"
6277.cindex "transports" "default"
6278Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6279only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6280not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6281.code
6282begin transports
6283.endd
6284Two remote transports and four local transports are defined.
6285.code
6286remote_smtp:
6287 driver = smtp
6288 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6289.ifdef _HAVE_PRDR
6290 hosts_try_prdr = *
6291.endif
6292.endd
6293This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6294The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6295The &%message_size_limit%& usage is a hack to avoid sending on messages
6296with over-long lines.
6297
6298The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is
6299negotiated between client and server and not expected to cause problems
6300but can be disabled if needed. The built-in macro _HAVE_PRDR guards the
6301use of the &%hosts_try_prdr%& configuration option.
6302
6303The other remote transport is used when delivering to a specific smarthost
6304with whom there must be some kind of existing relationship, instead of the
6305usual federated system.
6306
6307.code
6308smarthost_smtp:
6309 driver = smtp
6310 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6311 multi_domain
6312 #
6313.ifdef _HAVE_TLS
6314 # Comment out any of these which you have to, then file a Support
6315 # request with your smarthost provider to get things fixed:
6316 hosts_require_tls = *
6317 tls_verify_hosts = *
6318 # As long as tls_verify_hosts is enabled, this won't matter, but if you
6319 # have to comment it out then this will at least log whether you succeed
6320 # or not:
6321 tls_try_verify_hosts = *
6322 #
6323 # The SNI name should match the name which we'll expect to verify;
6324 # many mail systems don't use SNI and this doesn't matter, but if it does,
6325 # we need to send a name which the remote site will recognize.
6326 # This _should_ be the name which the smarthost operators specified as
6327 # the hostname for sending your mail to.
6328 tls_sni = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6329 #
6330.ifdef _HAVE_OPENSSL
6331 tls_require_ciphers = HIGH:!aNULL:@STRENGTH
6332.endif
6333.ifdef _HAVE_GNUTLS
6334 tls_require_ciphers = SECURE192:-VERS-SSL3.0:-VERS-TLS1.0:-VERS-TLS1.1
6335.endif
6336.endif
6337.ifdef _HAVE_PRDR
6338 hosts_try_prdr = *
6339.endif
6340.endd
6341After the same &%message_size_limit%& hack, we then specify that this Transport
6342can handle messages to multiple domains in one run. The assumption here is
6343that you're routing all non-local mail to the same place and that place is
6344happy to take all messages from you as quickly as possible.
6345All other options depend upon built-in macros; if Exim was built without TLS support
6346then no other options are defined.
6347If TLS is available, then we configure "stronger than default" TLS ciphersuites
6348and versions using the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option, where the value to be
6349used depends upon the library providing TLS.
6350Beyond that, the options adopt the stance that you should have TLS support available
6351from your smarthost on today's Internet, so we turn on requiring TLS for the
6352mail to be delivered, and requiring that the certificate be valid, and match
6353the expected hostname. The &%tls_sni%& option can be used by service providers
6354to select an appropriate certificate to present to you and here we re-use the
6355ROUTER_SMARTHOST macro, because that is unaffected by CNAMEs present in DNS.
6356You want to specify the hostname which you'll expect to validate for, and that
6357should not be subject to insecure tampering via DNS results.
6358
6359For the &%hosts_try_prdr%& option see the previous transport.
6360
6361All other options are defaulted.
6362.code
6363local_delivery:
6364 driver = appendfile
6365 file = /var/mail/$home
6366 delivery_date_add
6367 envelope_to_add
6368 return_path_add
6369# group = mail
6370# mode = 0660
6371.endd
6372This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6373traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6374local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6375directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6376under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6377show how this can be done.
6378
6379Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6380&'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6381similarly-named options above.
6382.code
6383address_pipe:
6384 driver = pipe
6385 return_output
6386.endd
6387This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6388redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6389option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6390be returned to the sender.
6391.code
6392address_file:
6393 driver = appendfile
6394 delivery_date_add
6395 envelope_to_add
6396 return_path_add
6397.endd
6398This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6399redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6400&(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6401.code
6402address_reply:
6403 driver = autoreply
6404.endd
6405This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6406filter files.
6407
6408
6409
6410.section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6411.cindex "retry" "default rule"
6412.cindex "default" "retry rule"
6413The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6414Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6415introduced by the line
6416.code
6417begin retry
6418.endd
6419In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6420errors:
6421.code
6422* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6423.endd
6424This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
64252 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
64261.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6427is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced. The time is
6428measured from first failure, not from the time the message was received.
6429
6430If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6431if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6432temporary errors into permanent errors.
6433
6434
6435.section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6436The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6437.code
6438begin rewrite
6439.endd
6440contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6441rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6442
6443
6444
6445.section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6446.cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6447The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6448.code
6449begin authenticators
6450.endd
6451defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6452configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6453which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6454standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6455mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6456to support most MUA software.
6457
6458The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6459.code
6460#PLAIN:
6461# driver = plaintext
6462# server_set_id = $auth2
6463# server_prompts = :
6464# server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6465# server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6466.endd
6467And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6468.code
6469#LOGIN:
6470# driver = plaintext
6471# server_set_id = $auth1
6472# server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6473# server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6474# server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6475.endd
6476
6477The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6478in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6479&%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6480that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6481i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6482when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6483when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6484need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6485
6486The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6487password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6488To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6489expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6490
6491Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6492usercode and password are in different positions.
6493Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6494
6495.ecindex IIDconfiwal
6496
6497
6498
6499. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6500. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6501
6502.chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6503
6504.cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6505.cindex "PCRE"
6506Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6507uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6508matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6509regular expressions is discussed in
6510online Perl manpages, in
6511many Perl reference books, and also in
6512Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6513O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6514. --- the http: URL here redirects to another page with the ISBN in the URL
6515. --- where trying to use https: just redirects back to http:, so sticking
6516. --- to the old URL for now. 2018-09-07.
6517
6518The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6519are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6520description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6521the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6522the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6523case-insensitive.
6524
6525In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6526it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6527or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6528second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6529.code
6530domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6531.endd
6532The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6533precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6534of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6535regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6536backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6537normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6538matched.
6539
6540There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6541recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6542string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6543these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6544it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6545match anywhere in the subject string.
6546
6547In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6548you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6549.code
6550domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6551.endd
6552matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6553You need to use:
6554.code
6555domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6556.endd
6557if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6558$ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6559
6560
6561
6562. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6563. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6564
6565.chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6566.scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6567.scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6568.cindex "lookup" "description of"
6569Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6570messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6571
6572.olist
6573A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6574cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6575lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6576can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6577&<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6578The key for the lookup is specified as part of the string expansion.
6579.next
6580Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6581way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6582returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6583succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6584chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6585The key for the lookup is given by the context in which the list is expanded.
6586.endlist
6587
6588String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6589that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6590involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6591if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6592time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6593chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6594
6595.section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6596It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6597lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6598processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6599Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6600.code
6601domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6602domains = lsearch;/some/file
6603.endd
6604The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6605No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6606defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6607The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6608file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6609.code
6610192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6611192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6612.endd
6613When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6614possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6615
6616In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6617Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6618in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6619.code
6620domain1:
6621domain2:
6622.endd
6623Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6624matches the list item.
6625
6626It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6627Consider a file containing lines like this:
6628.code
6629192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6630.endd
6631If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6632first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6633causes a second lookup to occur.
6634
6635The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6636available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6637lookup is permitted.
6638
6639
6640.section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6641.cindex "lookup" "types of"
6642.cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6643Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6644
6645.ilist
6646The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6647and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6648lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6649.next
6650.cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6651The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6652key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6653Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6654.endlist
6655
6656The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6657the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6658default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6659.code
6660LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6661LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6662.endd
6663which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6664For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6665libraries and header files before building Exim.
6666
6667
6668
6669
6670.section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6671.cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6672.cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6673The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6674
6675.ilist
6676.cindex "cdb" "description of"
6677.cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6678.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6679&(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6680string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6681indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6682re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6683aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb and
6684tools for building the files can be found in several places:
6685.display
6686&url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html)
6687&url(https://www.corpit.ru/mjt/tinycdb.html)
6688&url(https://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb)
6689&url(https://github.com/philpennock/cdbtools) (in Go)
6690.endd
6691A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6692because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6693However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6694you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6695.next
6696.cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6697.cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6698.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6699&(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6700DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6701zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6702&<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6703
6704.cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6705For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6706when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6707using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6708the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6709that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6710other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6711.next
6712.cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6713.cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6714.cindex "sasldb2"
6715.cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6716&(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6717interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6718ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6719authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6720&_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6721&(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6722.next
6723.cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6724.cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6725.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6726.cindex "Courier"
6727.cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6728.cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6729&(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6730is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6731if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6732other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6733use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6734calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6735utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6736by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6737.next
6738.cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6739.cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6740&(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6741whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6742contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6743the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6744symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6745lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6746&<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6747.next
6748.cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6749.cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6750&(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6751terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6752file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6753IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6754being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6755.code
67561.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6757192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6758"abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6759"abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6760.endd
6761The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6762file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6763key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6764&"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6765&(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6766
6767&*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6768&(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6769lookup types support only literal keys.
6770
6771&*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6772the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6773&<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6774
6775&*Warning 3*&: Do not use an IPv4-mapped IPv6 address for a key; use the
6776IPv4, in dotted-quad form. (Exim converts IPv4-mapped IPv6 addresses to this
6777notation before executing the lookup.)
6778.next
6779.cindex lookup json
6780.cindex json "lookup type"
6781.cindex JSON expansions
6782&(json)&: The given file is a text file with a JSON structure.
6783An element of the structure is extracted, defined by the search key.
6784The key is a list of subelement selectors
6785(colon-separated by default but changeable in the usual way)
6786which are applied in turn to select smaller and smaller portions
6787of the JSON structure.
6788If a selector is numeric, it must apply to a JSON array; the (zero-based)
6789nunbered array element is selected.
6790Otherwise it must apply to a JSON object; the named element is selected.
6791The final resulting element can be a simple JSON type or a JSON object
6792or array; for the latter two a string-representation os the JSON
6793is returned.
6794For elements of type string, the returned value is de-quoted.
6795.next
6796.cindex "linear search"
6797.cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6798.cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6799.cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6800&(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6801line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6802end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6803letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6804in the file is used.
6805
6806White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6807line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6808continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6809space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6810junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6811colon, for example:
6812.code
6813baduser: :fail:
6814.endd
6815Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6816middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6817that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6818wildcarding of any kind.
6819
6820.cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6821.cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6822In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6823characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6824If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6825matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6826contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6827quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6828quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6829
6830.next
6831.cindex "NIS lookup type"
6832.cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6833.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6834&(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6835the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6836&(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6837reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6838aliases; the full map names must be used.
6839
6840.next
6841.cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6842.cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6843.cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6844.cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6845&(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6846&(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6847the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6848that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6849used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6850
6851.cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6852Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6853file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6854&`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6855
6856. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6857. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6858
6859.olist
6860The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6861.code
6862 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6863 *fish data for anythingfish
6864.endd
6865.next
6866The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6867example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6868.code
6869 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6870.endd
6871Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6872expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6873string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6874.code
6875 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6876.endd
6877The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6878expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6879For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6880.code
6881 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6882.endd
6883
6884If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6885either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6886ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6887colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6888escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6889
6890&*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6891match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6892is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6893takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6894&((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6895
6896.next
6897Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6898is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6899lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6900example:
6901.code
6902 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6903.endd
6904The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6905.endlist olist
6906
6907Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6908continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6909be followed by optional colons.
6910
6911&*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6912&((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6913lookup types support only literal keys.
6914
6915.next
6916.cindex "lookup" "spf"
6917If Exim is built with SPF support, manual lookups can be done
6918(as opposed to the standard ACL condition method.
6919For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
6920.endlist ilist
6921
6922
6923.section "Query-style lookup types" "SECTquerystylelookups"
6924.cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6925.cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6926The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6927many of them are given in later sections.
6928
6929.ilist
6930.cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6931.cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6932&(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6933are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6934records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6935.next
6936.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6937.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6938&(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6939.next
6940.cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6941.cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6942&(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6943returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6944that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6945called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6946any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6947.next
6948.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6949.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6950&(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6951MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6952.next
6953.cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6954.cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6955&(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6956the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6957.next
6958.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6959.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6960&(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6961Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6962.next
6963.cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6964.cindex "passwd lookup type"
6965.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6966&(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6967lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6968success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6969lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6970password value. For example:
6971.code
6972*:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6973.endd
6974.next
6975.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6976.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6977&(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6978PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6979
6980.next
6981.cindex "Redis lookup type"
6982.cindex lookup Redis
6983&(redis)&: The format of the query is either a simple get or simple set,
6984passed to a Redis database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6985
6986.next
6987.cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6988.cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6989&(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a filename followed by an SQL statement
6990that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6991
6992.next
6993&(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6994not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6995.next
6996.cindex "whoson lookup type"
6997.cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6998. --- still http:-only, 2018-09-07
6999&(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
7000allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
7001address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
7002obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
7003at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
7004superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
7005&"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
7006.code
7007require condition = \
7008 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
7009.endd
7010The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
7011the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
7012this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
7013one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
7014.endlist
7015
7016
7017
7018.section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
7019.cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
7020Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
7021completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
7022reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
7023options such as a list of local domains.
7024
7025When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
7026of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
7027temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
7028or may give up altogether.
7029
7030
7031
7032.section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
7033.cindex "wildcard lookups"
7034.cindex "lookup" "default values"
7035.cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7036.cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
7037.cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
7038In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
7039that is to be used if a lookup fails.
7040
7041&*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
7042lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
7043specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
7044
7045If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
7046and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
7047provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
7048
7049.cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
7050.cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
7051.cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
7052Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
7053&%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
7054character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
7055by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
7056that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
7057take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
7058For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
7059.code
7060data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
7061.endd
7062Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
7063looks up these keys, in this order:
7064.code
7065jane@eyre.example
7066*@eyre.example
7067*
7068.endd
7069The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
7070&(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
7071complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
7072Exim move on to try the next key.
7073
7074
7075
7076.section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
7077.cindex "partial matching"
7078.cindex "wildcard lookups"
7079.cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
7080.cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7081.cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
7082The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
7083match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
7084being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
7085information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
7086domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
7087a key in a DBM file is
7088.code
7089*.dates.fict.example
7090.endd
7091then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
7092&'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
7093by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
7094file.
7095
7096&*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
7097also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
7098&<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
7099
7100Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
7101keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
7102be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
7103partial matching keys
7104beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
7105Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
7106unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
7107
7108Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
7109the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
7110is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
7111is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
7112fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
7113start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
7114remains.
7115
7116A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
7117by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
7118&%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
7119modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
7120subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
7121up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
7122.code
71232250.dates.fict.example
7124*.2250.dates.fict.example
7125*.dates.fict.example
7126*.fict.example
7127.endd
7128As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
7129finishes.
7130
7131.cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
7132.cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
7133The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
7134changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
7135formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
7136parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
7137.code
7138domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
7139.endd
7140In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7141&`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
7142components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
7143other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
7144.code
7145domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
7146.endd
7147For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7148&`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
7149
7150If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
7151just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
7152down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
7153
7154.ilist
7155If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
7156.next
7157If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
7158example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
7159.next
7160Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
7161remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
7162for &"*"& on its own.
7163.next
7164Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
7165.endlist
7166
7167
7168If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
7169&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
7170this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
7171specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
7172prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
7173lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
7174&"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
7175
7176The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
7177in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
7178dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
7179in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
7180subject key is always followed by a dot.
7181
7182
7183
7184
7185.section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
7186.cindex "lookup" "caching"
7187.cindex "caching" "lookup data"
7188Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
7189lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
7190of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
7191single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
7192
7193For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
7194another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
7195many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
7196the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
7197closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
7198own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
7199
7200The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
7201strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
7202complete.
7203
7204
7205
7206
7207.section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
7208.cindex "lookup" "quoting"
7209.cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
7210When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
7211is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
7212the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
7213.code
7214[name=$local_part]
7215.endd
7216will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
7217For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
7218.code
7219[name="$local_part"]
7220.endd
7221but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
7222NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
7223rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
7224of the following form is provided:
7225.code
7226${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
7227.endd
7228For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
7229.code
7230[name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
7231.endd
7232See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
7233operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
7234lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
7235
7236
7237
7238
7239.section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
7240.cindex "dnsdb lookup"
7241.cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
7242.cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7243The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
7244of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
7245an expansion string could contain:
7246.code
7247${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
7248.endd
7249If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
7250is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
7251&`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
7252&<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
7253
7254The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
7255and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
7256If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
7257
7258For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
7259concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
7260depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
7261between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
7262by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
7263.code
7264${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
7265.endd
7266It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7267white space is ignored.
7268For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
7269an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
7270separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
7271
7272.cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7273When the type is PTR,
7274the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
7275&%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
7276.code
7277${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
7278.endd
7279If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
7280altered and nothing is added.
7281
7282.cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7283.cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7284For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7285each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
7286port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
7287The field separator can be modified as above.
7288
7289.cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7290.cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7291For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
7292unless a field separator is specified.
7293To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
7294For SPF records the
7295default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
7296.code
7297${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
7298${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
7299${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
7300.endd
7301It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7302white space is ignored.
7303
7304.cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7305For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
7306successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
7307Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
7308specified.
7309.code
7310${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
7311.endd
7312
7313.section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
7314.cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
7315.cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
7316.cindex "options" "dnsdb"
7317Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
7318each followed by a comma,
7319that may appear before the record type.
7320
7321The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
7322temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
7323a defer-option modifier.
7324The possible keywords are
7325&"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
7326With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
7327whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
7328ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
7329With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
7330error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
7331succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
7332.code
7333${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7334${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7335.endd
7336Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
7337yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
7338
7339.cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
7340Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
7341The possible keywords are
7342&"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
7343With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
7344with the lookup.
7345With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7346is not labelled as authenticated data
7347is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7348The default is &"lax"&.
7349
7350See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7351
7352.cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7353.cindex "DNS" timeout
7354Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7355The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7356(e.g. &"5s"&).
7357The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7358
7359Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7360The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7361The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7362
7363.cindex caching "of dns lookup"
7364.cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7365.cindex DNS TTL
7366Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7367The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7368value of the set of returned DNS records.
7369
7370
7371.section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
7372.cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7373By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7374each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7375the pseudo-type MXH:
7376.code
7377${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7378.endd
7379In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7380returned.
7381
7382.cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7383Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7384records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7385component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7386records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7387error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7388but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7389top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7390.code
7391${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7392${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7393.endd
7394Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7395the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7396the name servers for &%edu%&.
7397
7398You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7399top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7400sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7401given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7402for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7403such a list.
7404
7405.cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7406A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7407records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7408&<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7409not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7410result of a successful lookup such as:
7411.code
7412${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7413.endd
7414has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7415The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7416authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7417
7418.cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7419The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7420and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7421(see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7422.code
7423${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7424.endd
7425
7426
7427.section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7428In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7429However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7430&(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7431the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7432.code
7433${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7434${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7435${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7436.endd
7437In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7438the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7439to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7440case, it does not treat it as a list.
7441
7442The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7443in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7444different separator can be specified, as described above.
7445
7446
7447
7448
7449.section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7450.cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7451.cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7452.cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7453The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7454become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7455implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7456contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7457the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7458it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7459indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7460your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7461.code
7462LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7463LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7464LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7465LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7466LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7467.endd
7468If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7469same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7470
7471There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7472the way they handle the results of a query:
7473
7474.ilist
7475&(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7476gives an error.
7477.next
7478&(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7479Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7480.next
7481&(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7482from all of them are returned.
7483.endlist
7484
7485
7486For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7487Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7488the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7489First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7490
7491
7492.section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7493.cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7494An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7495the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7496.code
7497data = ${lookup ldap \
7498 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7499 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7500.endd
7501.cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7502The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7503secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7504encrypted TLS connection is used.
7505
7506With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7507LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7508See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7509
7510Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7511controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7512&_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7513your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7514&_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7515certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7516running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7517methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7518&_exim.conf_&.
7519
7520
7521.section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7522.cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7523Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7524and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7525within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7526reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7527
7528The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7529filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7530the string:
7531.code
7532* => \2A
7533( => \28
7534) => \29
7535\ => \5C
7536.endd
7537in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7538to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7539.code
7540! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
7541.endd
7542are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7543.code
7544${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7545.endd
7546yields
7547.code
7548%20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7549.endd
7550Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7551.code
7552a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7553.endd
7554The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7555base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7556by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7557.code
7558, + " \ < > ;
7559.endd
7560It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7561before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7562is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7563.code
7564${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7565.endd
7566yields
7567.code
7568%5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7569.endd
7570Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7571.code
7572\ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7573.endd
7574There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7575authentication below.
7576
7577
7578.section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7579.cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7580The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7581is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7582an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7583by starting it with
7584.code
7585ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7586.endd
7587If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7588used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7589taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7590colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7591handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7592returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7593are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7594Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7595failures, and timeouts.
7596
7597For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7598of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7599&%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7600doubled. For example
7601.code
7602ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7603.endd
7604If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7605to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7606the local host) is used.
7607
7608If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7609a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7610&`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7611to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7612not available.
7613
7614For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7615for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7616can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7617the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7618.code
7619ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7620.endd
7621When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7622&`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7623.code
7624${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7625.endd
7626When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7627a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7628specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7629socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7630&%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7631or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7632the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7633backup host.
7634
7635If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7636specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7637&%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7638
7639.ilist
7640Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7641interface.
7642.next
7643Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7644.endlist
7645
7646
7647Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7648&%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7649
7650
7651
7652.section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7653.cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7654The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7655information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7656be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7657spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7658when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7659them. The following names are recognized:
7660.display
7661&`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7662&`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7663&`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7664&`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7665&`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7666&`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7667&`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7668&`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7669.endd
7670The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7671&"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7672must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7673library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7674
7675.cindex LDAP timeout
7676.cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7677The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7678backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7679enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7680network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7681&'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7682LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7683if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7684SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7685Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7686
7687The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7688set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7689
7690The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7691to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7692default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7693server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7694different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7695different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7696alternate list (colon-separated).
7697
7698Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7699values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7700.code
7701${lookup ldap
7702 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7703 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7704 {$value}fail}
7705.endd
7706The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7707any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7708which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7709non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7710
7711The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7712connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7713on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7714
7715When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7716removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7717some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7718quoting has two advantages:
7719
7720.ilist
7721It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7722DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7723.next
7724It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7725.endlist
7726
7727For example, a setting such as
7728.code
7729USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7730.endd
7731should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7732
7733Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7734expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7735field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7736does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7737.code
7738PASS=${quote:$3}
7739.endd
7740The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7741SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7742&<<CHAPexpand>>&.
7743
7744
7745
7746.section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7747.cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7748The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7749as a sequence of values, for example
7750.code
7751cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
7752.endd
7753The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7754search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7755the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7756values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7757you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7758directory.
7759
7760In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7761result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7762has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
7763part of an attribute's value is doubled.
7764
7765If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7766strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7767quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7768backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7769Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7770(permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7771Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7772output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7773same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7774
7775Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7776LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7777&%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7778&%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
7779(they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
7780
7781.code
7782ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7783value1.1,value1,,2
7784
7785ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7786value two
7787
7788ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
7789value1.1,value1,,2,value two
7790
7791ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7792attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7793
7794ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7795objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7796.endd
7797You can
7798make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7799results of LDAP lookups.
7800The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7801individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7802The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7803of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7804The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7805comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7806
7807
7808
7809
7810.section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7811.cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7812.cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7813NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7814and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7815contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7816of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7817values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7818.code
7819[name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7820.endd
7821might return the string
7822.code
7823name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7824home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7825.endd
7826(split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7827.code
7828[name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7829.endd
7830would just return
7831.code
7832Martin Guerre
7833.endd
7834with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7835for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7836operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7837
7838
7839
7840.section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7841.cindex "SQL lookup types"
7842.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7843.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7844.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7845.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7846.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7847.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7848.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7849.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7850.cindex "Redis lookup type"
7851.cindex lookup Redis
7852Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, Redis,
7853and SQLite
7854databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7855might be
7856.code
7857${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7858 {$value}fail}
7859.endd
7860If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7861field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7862.code
7863${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7864 {$value}}
7865.endd
7866might be
7867.code
7868home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7869.endd
7870Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7871quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7872field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7873.code
7874Mister X
7875.endd
7876If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7877with a newline between the data for each row.
7878
7879
7880.section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase, and Redis" "SECID72"
7881.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7882.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7883.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7884.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7885.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7886.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7887.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7888.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7889.cindex "Redis lookup type"
7890.cindex lookup Redis
7891If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase or Redis lookups are used, the
7892&%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, &%ibase_servers%&,
7893or &%redis_servers%&
7894option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7895information.
7896(For MySQL and PostgreSQL, the global option need not be set if all
7897queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7898&<<SECTspeserque>>&.)
7899For all but Redis
7900each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7901items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7902Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7903name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7904.code
7905hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7906.endd
7907Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7908&"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7909option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7910.code
7911hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7912 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7913.endd
7914For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7915because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7916query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7917a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7918found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7919servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7920
7921For Redis the global option need not be specified if all queries contain their
7922own server information &-- see section &<<SECTspeserque>>&.
7923If specified, the option must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7924information.
7925Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of three items:
7926host, database number, and password.
7927.olist
7928The host is required and may be either an IPv4 address and optional
7929port number (separated by a colon, which needs doubling due to the
7930higher-level list), or a Unix socket pathname enclosed in parentheses
7931.next
7932The database number is optional; if present that number is selected in the backend
7933.next
7934The password is optional; if present it is used to authenticate to the backend
7935.endlist
7936
7937The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7938convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7939respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7940itself are escaped with backslashes.
7941
7942The &%quote_redis%& expansion operator
7943escapes whitespace and backslash characters with a backslash.
7944
7945.section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7946For MySQL, PostgreSQL and Redis lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7947it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7948done by starting the query with
7949.display
7950&`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7951.endd
7952Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7953.olist
7954If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7955global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7956of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7957taken from there.
7958.next
7959If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7960.endlist
7961The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7962Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7963successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7964
7965This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7966are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7967master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7968like this:
7969.code
7970mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7971 slave2/db/name/pw:\
7972 master/db/name/pw
7973.endd
7974In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7975.code
7976${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7977.endd
7978That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7979the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7980option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7981.code
7982${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7983.endd
7984
7985
7986.section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7987For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7988causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7989socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
7990An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
7991the default value is &"exim"&.
7992The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7993.display
7994<&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
7995 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7996.endd
7997Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7998the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7999
8000No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
8001the queries.
8002
8003If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
8004or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
8005
8006&*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
8007anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
8008is zero because no rows are affected.
8009
8010
8011.section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
8012PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
8013This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
8014However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
8015database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
8016looks like this:
8017.code
8018hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
8019.endd
8020In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
8021given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
8022visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
8023
8024If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
8025update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
8026affected.
8027
8028.section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
8029.cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
8030.cindex "sqlite lookup type"
8031SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a filename is required in
8032addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
8033daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
8034of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
8035separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
8036contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
8037.code
8038${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
8039 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
8040.endd
8041In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
8042.code
8043domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
8044 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
8045.endd
8046The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
8047quote, which it doubles.
8048
8049.cindex timeout SQLite
8050.cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
8051The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
8052internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
8053update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
8054are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
8055waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
8056to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
8057option.
8058
8059.section "More about Redis" "SECTredis"
8060.cindex "lookup" "Redis"
8061.cindex "redis lookup type"
8062Redis is a non-SQL database. Commands are simple get and set.
8063Examples:
8064.code
8065${lookup redis{set keyname ${quote_redis:objvalue plus}}}
8066${lookup redis{get keyname}}
8067.endd
8068
8069As of release 4.91, "lightweight" support for Redis Cluster is available.
8070Requires &%redis_servers%& list to contain all the servers in the cluster, all
8071of which must be reachable from the running exim instance. If the cluster has
8072master/slave replication, the list must contain all the master and slave
8073servers.
8074
8075When the Redis Cluster returns a "MOVED" response to a query, Exim does not
8076immediately follow the redirection but treats the response as a DEFER, moving on
8077to the next server in the &%redis_servers%& list until the correct server is
8078reached.
8079
8080.ecindex IIDfidalo1
8081.ecindex IIDfidalo2
8082
8083
8084. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8085. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8086
8087.chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
8088 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
8089 "Domain, host, and address lists"
8090.scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
8091A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
8092email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
8093contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
8094are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
8095arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
8096
8097Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
8098host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
8099different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
8100general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
8101
8102Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
8103support all the complexity available in
8104domain, host, address and local part lists.
8105
8106
8107
8108.section "Expansion of lists" "SECTlistexpand"
8109.cindex "expansion" "of lists"
8110Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used.
8111
8112&'Exception: the router headers_remove option, where list-item
8113splitting is done before string-expansion.'&
8114
8115The result of
8116expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
8117into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
8118but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
8119&<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
8120discusses the way to specify empty list items.
8121
8122
8123If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
8124testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
8125expansion failures cause temporary errors.
8126
8127If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
8128other special characters in the expression must be protected against
8129misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
8130the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
8131expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
8132.code
8133deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
8134 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
8135.endd
8136The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
8137&`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
8138senders based on the receiving domain.
8139
8140
8141
8142
8143.section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
8144.cindex "list" "negation"
8145.cindex "negation" "in lists"
8146Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
8147leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
8148defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
8149it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
8150(respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
8151
8152The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
8153subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
8154subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
8155subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
8156was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
8157.code
8158domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
8159.endd
8160matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
8161neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
8162list is positive. However, if the setting were
8163.code
8164domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
8165.endd
8166then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
8167list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
8168as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
8169
8170Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
8171the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
8172item.
8173
8174
8175
8176.section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
8177.cindex "list" "filename in"
8178If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute
8179filename (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
8180processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
8181filenames are not allowed,
8182and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
8183Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
8184lines:
8185
8186.ilist
8187For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
8188file, it and all following characters are ignored.
8189.next
8190Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
8191address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
8192white space or the start of the line. For example:
8193.code
8194not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
8195.endd
8196.endlist
8197
8198Putting a filename in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
8199file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
8200is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
8201so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
8202
8203If a filename is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
8204within the file is inverted. For example, if
8205.code
8206hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
8207.endd
8208and the file contains the lines
8209.code
8210!a.b.c
8211*.b.c
8212.endd
8213then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
8214any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
8215
8216
8217
8218.section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
8219As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
8220to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
8221confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
8222an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
8223sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
8224non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
8225always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
8226
8227If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
8228list, just give the filename on its own, without a search type, as described
8229in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
8230&(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
8231
8232
8233
8234
8235.section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
8236.cindex "named lists"
8237.cindex "list" "named"
8238A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
8239which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
8240particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
8241places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
8242the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
8243a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
8244locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
8245.code
8246domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
8247.endd
8248Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
8249for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
8250configured with the line
8251.code
8252domains = +local_domains
8253.endd
8254The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
8255except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
8256.code
8257dnslookup:
8258 driver = dnslookup
8259 domains = ! +local_domains
8260 transport = remote_smtp
8261 no_more
8262.endd
8263The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
8264the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
8265respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
8266equals sign and the list itself. For example:
8267.code
8268hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
8269addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
8270.endd
8271A named list may refer to other named lists:
8272.code
8273domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
8274domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
8275domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
8276.endd
8277&*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
8278effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
8279out to the higher level. For example, consider:
8280.code
8281domainlist dom1 = !a.b
8282domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
8283.endd
8284The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
8285list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
8286means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
8287.code
8288domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
8289.endd
8290where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
8291referenced lists if you can.
8292
8293Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
8294address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
8295lists. So, if you have a setting such as
8296.code
8297domains = +local_domains
8298.endd
8299on several of your routers
8300or in several ACL statements,
8301the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
8302if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
8303references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
8304the same each time they are referenced.
8305
8306By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
8307extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
8308is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
8309hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
8310
8311
8312
8313.section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
8314.cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
8315.cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
8316At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
8317configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
8318write
8319.code
8320ALIST = host1 : host2
8321auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
8322.endd
8323it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
8324.code
8325auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
8326.endd
8327Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
8328list, and write
8329.code
8330hostlist alist = host1 : host2
8331auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
8332.endd
8333the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
8334.code
8335auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
8336.endd
8337
8338
8339.section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
8340.cindex "list" "caching of named"
8341.cindex "caching" "named lists"
8342While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
8343it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
8344the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
8345that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
8346an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
8347message. For example:
8348.code
8349domainlist special_domains = \
8350 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
8351.endd
8352This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
8353address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
8354in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
8355cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
8356same list each time.
8357
8358By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
8359cache the result anyway. For example:
8360.code
8361domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
8362.endd
8363If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
8364the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
8365
8366
8367
8368.section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
8369.cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
8370.cindex "list" "domain list"
8371Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
8372The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
8373
8374.ilist
8375.cindex "primary host name"
8376.cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
8377.oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
8378.cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
8379.cindex "@ in a domain list"
8380If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
8381as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
8382possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
8383differ only in their names.
8384.next
8385.cindex "@[] in a domain list"
8386.cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
8387.cindex "domain literal"
8388If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
8389in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
8390only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
8391&%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
8392control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
8393In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
8394.next
8395.cindex "@mx_any"
8396.cindex "@mx_primary"
8397.cindex "@mx_secondary"
8398.cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
8399If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
8400has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
8401.oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
8402&%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
8403are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
8404local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
8405but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
8406preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
8407
8408The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8409performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8410example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8411resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8412options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8413
8414Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8415patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8416list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8417ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8418on a router). For example:
8419.code
8420domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8421.endd
8422This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8423the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8424
8425The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8426host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8427contain negative items.
8428
8429Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8430be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8431list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8432.code
8433domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8434 an.other.domain : ...
8435.endd
8436so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8437involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8438.code
8439domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8440 an.other.domain ? ...
8441.endd
8442.next
8443.cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8444.cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8445.cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8446If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8447are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8448domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8449list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8450matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8451list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8452&'cipher.key.ex'&.
8453
8454.next
8455.cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8456.cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8457If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8458expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8459function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8460Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8461default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8462with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8463are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8464
8465&*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8466must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8467use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8468it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8469expression by expansion, of course).
8470.next
8471.cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8472.cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8473If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8474semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8475must be a filename in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8476&"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8477.code
8478domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8479.endd
8480The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8481key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8482only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8483is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8484or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8485&$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8486other statements in the same ACL.
8487
8488.next
8489Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8490&`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8491.code
8492domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8493.endd
8494This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8495works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8496
8497.next
8498.cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8499Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8500a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8501original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8502select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8503value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8504expansion variable.
8505.next
8506If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8507semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8508pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8509chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8510.code
8511hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8512 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8513.endd
8514In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8515example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8516whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8517&%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8518variable and can be referred to in other options.
8519.next
8520.cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8521If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8522between the pattern and the domain.
8523.endlist
8524
8525Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8526.code
8527domainlist funny_domains = \
8528 @ : \
8529 lib.unseen.edu : \
8530 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8531 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8532 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8533 nis;domains.byname : \
8534 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8535.endd
8536There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8537an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8538explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8539but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8540patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8541patterns earlier.
8542
8543
8544
8545.section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8546.cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8547.cindex "list" "host list"
8548Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8549example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8550may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8551two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8552pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8553You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8554involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8555
8556
8557.section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8558.cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8559.cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8560If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8561involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8562process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8563not used.
8564
8565.cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8566The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8567the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8568
8569
8570
8571.section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8572.cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8573If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8574the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8575&`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8576list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8577systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8578concerns.)
8579
8580The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8581inspecting its IP address:
8582
8583.ilist
8584If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8585with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8586to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8587&[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8588This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8589with the IP address of the subject host.
8590
8591If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8592lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8593ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8594temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8595what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8596
8597.next
8598.cindex "@ in a host list"
8599If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8600domain name, as just described.
8601
8602.next
8603If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8604subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8605IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8606be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8607separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8608without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8609IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8610that can never match a client host.
8611
8612.next
8613.cindex "@[] in a host list"
8614If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8615the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8616interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8617.code
8618accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8619accept hosts = @[]
8620.endd
8621.next
8622.cindex "CIDR notation"
8623If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8624example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8625host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8626included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8627specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8628significant end of the address.
8629
8630&*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8631of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8632address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8633addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8634.code
8635192.168.23.236/31
8636.endd
8637matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
863832 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8639matches.
8640
8641Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8642.code
8643recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8644 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8645.endd
8646The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8647appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8648For example:
8649.code
8650recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8651.endd
8652could make use of a file containing
8653.code
8654172.16.0.0/12
86553ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8656.endd
8657to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8658addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8659changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8660.code
8661recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8662 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8663.endd
8664The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8665list.
8666.endlist
8667
8668
8669
8670.section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8671 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8672.cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8673When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8674address, the pattern takes this form:
8675.display
8676&`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8677.endd
8678For example:
8679.code
8680hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8681.endd
8682The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8683IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8684letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8685&(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8686quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8687returned by the lookup is not used.
8688
8689.cindex "IP address" "masking"
8690.cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8691Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8692patterns of this form:
8693.display
8694&`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8695.endd
8696For example:
8697.code
8698net24-dbm;/networks.db
8699.endd
8700The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8701length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8702mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8703is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8704&"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8705
8706When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8707of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8708terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8709to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8710recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8711(notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8712For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8713converted using colons and not dots.
8714In all cases except IPv4-mapped IPv6, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8715addresses are always used.
8716The latter are converted to IPv4 addresses, in dotted-quad form.
8717
8718Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8719colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8720However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8721configurations.
8722
8723&*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8724IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8725the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8726case the IP address is used on its own.
8727
8728
8729
8730.section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8731.cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8732.cindex "unknown host name"
8733.cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8734There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8735remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8736complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8737address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8738above.)
8739
8740If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8741patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8742Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8743DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8744Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8745effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8746Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8747
8748Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8749against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8750
8751By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8752if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8753&[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8754are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8755security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8756for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8757Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8758discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8759found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8760
8761There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8762found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8763
8764.cindex "host" "alias for"
8765.cindex "alias for host"
8766As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8767of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8768
8769.ilist
8770.cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8771If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8772the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8773&'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8774requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8775expression.
8776.next
8777.cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8778.cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8779If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8780matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8781expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8782case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8783syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8784example,
8785.code
8786^(a|b)\.c\.d$
8787.endd
8788is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8789&'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8790that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8791string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8792part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8793.code
8794sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8795.endd
8796&*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8797&`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8798example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8799required.
8800.endlist
8801
8802
8803
8804
8805.section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8806.cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8807While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8808name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8809from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8810behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8811
8812&*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8813apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8814
8815.cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8816.cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8817Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8818lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8819Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8820does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8821To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8822&`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8823not recognized in an indirected file).
8824
8825.ilist
8826If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8827cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8828.code
8829host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8830.endd
8831rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8832any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8833
8834.next
8835If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8836be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8837example:
8838.code
8839accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8840 192.168.4.5
8841.endd
8842accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8843whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8844name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8845.endlist
8846
8847Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8848list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8849list.
8850
8851.section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8852 "SECTmixwilhos"
8853.cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8854
8855This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8856as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8857wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8858
8859.ilist
8860If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8861IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8862addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8863.code
8864accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8865.endd
8866The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8867left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8868without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8869a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8870pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8871&%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8872if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8873
8874.next
8875If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8876address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8877.code
8878accept hosts = *.friend.example
8879accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8880.endd
8881If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8882&<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8883&`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8884this section.
8885.endlist
8886
8887
8888.section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8889 "SECTtemdnserr"
8890.cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8891.cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8892.cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8893A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8894&%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8895host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
8896&`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8897section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8898host lists such as whitelists.
8899
8900
8901
8902.section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8903 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8904.cindex "unknown host name"
8905.cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8906If a pattern is of the form
8907.display
8908<&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8909.endd
8910for example
8911.code
8912dbm;/host/accept/list
8913.endd
8914a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8915lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8916is not used.
8917
8918&*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8919keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8920addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8921&<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8922two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8923lookup, both using the same file.
8924
8925
8926
8927.section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8928If a pattern is of the form
8929.display
8930<&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8931.endd
8932the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8933data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8934&$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8935.code
8936hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8937 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8938.endd
8939The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8940can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8941use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8942operator.
8943
8944If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8945looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8946&<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8947
8948Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8949host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8950&`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8951still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8952effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8953See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8954
8955
8956
8957
8958
8959.section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8960.cindex "list" "address list"
8961.cindex "address list" "empty item"
8962.cindex "address list" "patterns"
8963Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8964is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8965always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8966list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8967using this option setting:
8968.code
8969senders = :
8970.endd
8971The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8972data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8973detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8974and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8975
8976Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8977example:
8978.code
8979senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8980.endd
8981A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8982character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8983semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8984subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8985with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8986the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8987wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8988.code
8989deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8990 *@+hostile_domains:\
8991 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8992 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8993.endd
8994.cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8995.cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8996If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8997specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8998treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8999
9000If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
9001contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
9002address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
9003domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
9004is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
9005.code
9006deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
9007.endd
9008
9009The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
9010address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
9011senders:
9012
9013.ilist
9014.cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
9015.cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
9016If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
9017done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
9018You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
9019as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
9020to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
9021.code
9022deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
9023 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
9024.endd
9025The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
9026start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
9027
9028.next
9029.cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
9030Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
9031lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
9032example:
9033.code
9034deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
9035 mysql;select address from blocked where \
9036 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
9037.endd
9038Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
9039lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
9040not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
9041always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
9042
9043Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
9044cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
9045panic log.
9046.cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
9047However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
9048&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
9049default. For example, with this lookup:
9050.code
9051accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
9052.endd
9053the file could contains lines like this:
9054.code
9055user1@domain1.example
9056*@domain2.example
9057.endd
9058and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
9059that are tried is:
9060.code
9061nimrod@jaeger.example
9062*@jaeger.example
9063*
9064.endd
9065&*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
9066would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
9067
9068&*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
9069.code
9070deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
9071deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
9072.endd
9073The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
9074because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
9075domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
9076.endlist
9077
9078
9079The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
9080If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
9081always fails.
9082
9083
9084.ilist
9085.cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
9086.cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
9087.cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
9088If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
9089(for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
9090split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
9091it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
9092from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
9093of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
9094
9095.cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
9096The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
9097keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
9098patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
9099even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
9100with
9101.code
9102deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
9103.endd
9104the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
9105.code
9106baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
9107.endd
9108to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
9109
9110.cindex "local part" "starting with !"
9111If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
9112has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
9113may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
9114but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
9115surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
9116.code
9117aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
9118 spammer3 : spammer4
9119.endd
9120As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
9121doubling.
9122
9123If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
9124of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
9125list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
9126might have entries like
9127.code
9128aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
9129xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
9130*: ^\d{8}$
9131.endd
9132in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
9133local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
9134each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
9135chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
9136
9137.cindex "loop" "in lookups"
9138It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
9139them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
9140
9141.next
9142The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
9143lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
9144can only return a single list of local parts.
9145.endlist
9146
9147&*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
9148in these two examples:
9149.code
9150senders = +my_list
9151senders = *@+my_list
9152.endd
9153In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
9154example it is a named domain list.
9155
9156
9157
9158
9159.section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
9160.cindex "case of local parts"
9161.cindex "address list" "case forcing"
9162.cindex "case forcing in address lists"
9163Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
9164case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
9165Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
9166Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
9167blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
9168lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
9169default.
9170
9171The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
9172address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
9173comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
9174the address list itself, in files included as plain filenames, and in any file
9175that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
9176keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
9177works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
9178case-independent.
9179
9180.cindex "&`+caseful`&"
9181To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
9182an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
9183part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
9184longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
9185lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
9186performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
9187become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
9188
9189
9190
9191.section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
9192.cindex "list" "local part list"
9193.cindex "local part" "list"
9194Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
9195lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
9196setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
9197set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
9198case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
9199matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
9200&%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
9201option is case-sensitive from the start.
9202
9203If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
9204comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
9205only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
9206Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
9207that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
9208&`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
9209Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
9210types.
9211.ecindex IIDdohoadli
9212
9213
9214
9215
9216. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9217. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9218
9219.chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
9220.scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
9221Many strings in Exim's runtime configuration are expanded before use. Some of
9222them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
9223
9224When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
9225.cindex expansion "string concatenation"
9226when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
9227start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
9228below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
9229escape character, as described in the following section.
9230
9231Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
9232dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
9233options for which string expansion is performed are marked with &dagger; after
9234the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
9235conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
9236reasons,
9237.cindex "tainted data" expansion
9238.cindex expansion "tainted data"
9239and expansion of data deriving from the sender (&"tainted data"&)
9240is not permitted.
9241
9242
9243
9244.section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
9245.cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
9246An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
9247backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
9248character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
9249If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
9250required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
9251the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
9252
9253.cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
9254A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
9255two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
9256expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
9257.code
9258deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
9259.endd
9260On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
9261without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
9262string.
9263
9264
9265
9266.section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
9267.cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
9268A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
9269expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
9270carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
9271octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
9272backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
9273encoding.
9274
9275These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
9276in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
9277and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
9278
9279
9280.section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
9281.cindex "expansion" "testing"
9282.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
9283.oindex "&%-be%&"
9284Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
9285takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
9286arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
9287to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
9288since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
9289value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
9290database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
9291and &%nhash%&.
9292
9293Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
9294instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
9295using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
9296
9297.oindex "&%-bem%&"
9298If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
9299from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
9300option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a filename. The file is
9301read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
9302.code
9303exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
9304.endd
9305The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
9306Exim message identifier. For example:
9307.code
9308exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
9309.endd
9310This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
9311is therefore restricted to admin users.
9312
9313
9314.section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
9315.cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
9316A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
9317alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
9318(which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
9319used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
9320instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
9321the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
9322that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
9323its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
9324from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
9325taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
9326being expanded.
9327
9328
9329
9330
9331.section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
9332The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
9333between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
9334outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
9335white space is significant.
9336
9337.vlist
9338.vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
9339.cindex "expansion" "variables"
9340Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
9341.code
9342$local_part
9343${domain}
9344.endd
9345The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
9346characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
9347&'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
9348section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
9349given, the expansion fails.
9350
9351.vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9352.cindex "expansion" "operators"
9353The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
9354<&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
9355.code
9356${lc:$local_part}
9357.endd
9358The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
9359leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
9360below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
9361one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
9362string easier to understand.
9363
9364.vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9365This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9366expansion item below.
9367
9368
9369.vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9370.cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
9371.cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
9372The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
9373arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
9374Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
9375arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
9376and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
9377are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
9378a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
9379the result of the expansion.
9380If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
9381the expansion result is an empty string.
9382If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
9383
9384
9385.vitem "&*${authresults{*&<&'authserv-id'&>&*}}*&"
9386.cindex authentication "results header"
9387.cindex headers "authentication-results:"
9388.cindex authentication "expansion item"
9389This item returns a string suitable for insertion as an
9390&'Authentication-Results:'&
9391header line.
9392The given <&'authserv-id'&> is included in the result; typically this
9393will be a domain name identifying the system performing the authentications.
9394Methods that might be present in the result include:
9395.code
9396none
9397iprev
9398auth
9399spf
9400dkim
9401.endd
9402
9403Example use (as an ACL modifier):
9404.code
9405 add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
9406.endd
9407This is safe even if no authentication results are available.
9408
9409
9410.vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
9411 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9412.cindex "expansion" "extracting certificate fields"
9413.cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
9414.cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
9415The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
9416The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
9417the certificate. Supported fields are:
9418.display
9419&`version `&
9420&`serial_number `&
9421&`subject `& RFC4514 DN
9422&`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
9423&`notbefore `& time
9424&`notafter `& time
9425&`sig_algorithm `&
9426&`signature `&
9427&`subj_altname `& tagged list
9428&`ocsp_uri `& list
9429&`crl_uri `& list
9430.endd
9431If the field is found,
9432<&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9433otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9434variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9435is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9436
9437If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9438key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9439extracted is used.
9440
9441Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9442
9443The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9444output a Distinguished Name string which is
9445not quite
9446parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9447(the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9448RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9449a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9450result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9451The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9452a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9453Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9454
9455The field selectors marked as "time" above
9456take an optional modifier of "int"
9457for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9458Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9459in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9460
9461The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9462newline-separated by default,
9463(embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9464The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9465a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9466
9467The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9468prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9469Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9470which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9471if so the element tags are omitted.
9472
9473If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9474
9475.vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9476 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9477.cindex &%dlfunc%&
9478This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9479This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9480.code
9481EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
9482.endd
9483set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9484object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9485(but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9486
9487There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function.
9488
9489When compiling
9490a local function that is to be called in this way,
9491first &_DLFUNC_IMPL_& should be defined,
9492and second &_local_scan.h_& should be included.
9493The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9494are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9495must have the following type:
9496.code
9497int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9498.endd
9499Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9500function should return one of the following values:
9501
9502&`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9503into the expanded string that is being built.
9504
9505&`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9506from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9507
9508&`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9509taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9510
9511&`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9512
9513When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9514you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9515configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9516
9517
9518.vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9519.cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9520.cindex "environment" "values from"
9521The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9522removed.
9523This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9524If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9525and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9526
9527Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9528appear, for example:
9529.code
9530${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9531.endd
9532This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9533{<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9534
9535If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9536search failure.
9537If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9538search success.
9539
9540The environment is adjusted by the &%keep_environment%& and
9541&%add_environment%& main section options.
9542
9543
9544.vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9545 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9546.cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9547.cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9548The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9549white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9550must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9551The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9552.display
9553<&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9554.endd
9555.vindex "&$value$&"
9556where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9557values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9558values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9559described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9560for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9561the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9562otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9563variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9564is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9565
9566If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9567key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9568extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9569yield &"2001"&:
9570.code
9571${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9572${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9573.endd
9574Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9575appear, for example:
9576.code
9577${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9578.endd
9579This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9580{<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9581
9582.vitem "&*${extract json{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9583 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
9584 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9585 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9586.cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON object"
9587.cindex JSON expansions
9588The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9589white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9590must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9591The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9592.display
9593{ <&'"key1"'&> : <&'value1'&> , <&'"key2"'&> , <&'value2'&> ... }
9594.endd
9595.vindex "&$value$&"
9596The braces, commas and colons, and the quoting of the member name are required;
9597the spaces are optional.
9598Matching of the key against the member names is done case-sensitively.
9599For the &"json"& variant,
9600if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
9601trailing quotes.
9602For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
9603leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
9604. XXX should be a UTF-8 compare
9605
9606The results of matching are handled as above.
9607
9608
9609.vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9610 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9611.cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9612.cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9613The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9614apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9615This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9616behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9617extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9618argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9619<&'string3'&> as before.
9620
9621The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9622separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9623The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9624counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9625number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9626number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9627expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9628provided. For example:
9629.code
9630${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9631.endd
9632yields &"42"&, and
9633.code
9634${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9635.endd
9636yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9637empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9638
9639
9640.vitem "&*${extract json {*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
9641 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
9642 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
9643 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9644.cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON array"
9645.cindex JSON expansions
9646The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9647apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9648
9649Field selection and result handling is as above;
9650there is no choice of field separator.
9651For the &"json"& variant,
9652if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
9653trailing quotes.
9654For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
9655leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
9656
9657
9658.vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9659.cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9660.cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9661.vindex "&$item$&"
9662After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9663default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
9664For each item
9665in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9666evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9667item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9668separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9669input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9670.code
9671${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}}
9672.endd
9673yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9674to what it was before. See also the &%map%& and &%reduce%& expansion items.
9675
9676
9677.vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9678.cindex "hash function" "textual"
9679.cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9680This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9681early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9682(numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9683
9684The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9685<&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9686<&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9687use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9688.code
9689${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9690.endd
9691The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9692or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9693Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9694function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9695first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9696.code
9697abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9698.endd
9699If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9700letters appear. For example:
9701.display
9702&`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9703&`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9704&`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9705.endd
9706
9707.vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9708 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9709 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9710 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9711 "&*$lheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9712 &*$lh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9713 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9714 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9715.cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9716.vindex "&$header_$&"
9717.vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9718.vindex "&$lheader_$&"
9719.vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9720.cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9721.cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9722.cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9723Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9724.code
9725$header_reply-to:
9726.endd
9727The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9728internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9729lines) may be present.
9730
9731The difference between the four pairs of expansions is in the way
9732the data in the header line is interpreted.
9733
9734.ilist
9735.cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9736&%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9737processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9738
9739.next
9740.cindex "list" "of header lines"
9741&%lheader%& gives a colon-separated list, one element per header when there
9742are multiple headers with a given name.
9743Any embedded colon characters within an element are doubled, so normal Exim
9744list-processing facilities can be used.
9745The terminating newline of each element is removed; in other respects
9746the content is &"raw"&.
9747
9748.next
9749.cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9750&%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9751or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9752character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9753&"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9754.cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9755produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9756what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9757
9758.next
9759&%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9760standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9761be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9762returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9763&[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9764a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9765.endlist ilist
9766
9767In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9768command of the following form:
9769.code
9770headers charset "UTF-8"
9771.endd
9772This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9773subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9774character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9775option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9776value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9777ISO-8859-1.
9778
9779Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9780any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9781&'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9782if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9783
9784Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9785this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9786message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9787filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9788router or transport are not accessible.
9789
9790For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in
9791ACLs that are obeyed before the data phase completes,
9792because the header structure is not set up until the message is received.
9793They are visible in DKIM, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
9794Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9795are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9796point they are added.
9797When any of the above ACLs ar
9798running, however, header lines added by earlier ACLs are visible.
9799
9800Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9801following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9802this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9803white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
9804expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
9805expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
9806section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
9807header.)
9808
9809If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9810to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9811&%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9812each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9813newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9814newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9815those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9816junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9817
9818
9819.vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9820.cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9821.cindex &%hmac%&
9822This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9823shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9824RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9825&`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9826cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9827or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9828present. For example:
9829.code
9830${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9831.endd
9832For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9833produces:
9834.code
9835dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9836.endd
9837As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9838an Exim configuration:
9839.code
9840SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9841.endd
9842In a router or a transport you could then have:
9843.code
9844headers_add = \
9845 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9846 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9847 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9848.endd
9849Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9850&'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9851this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9852host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9853using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example, by using the
9854&'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9855
9856
9857.vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9858.cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9859.cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9860If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9861item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9862in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9863.code
9864${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9865.endd
9866The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9867true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9868be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9869case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9870&<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9871
9872If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9873is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9874cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9875.code
9876condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9877.endd
9878you can use
9879.code
9880condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9881.endd
9882
9883
9884
9885.vitem &*${imapfolder{*&<&'foldername'&>&*}}*&
9886.cindex expansion "imap folder"
9887.cindex "&%imapfolder%& expansion item"
9888This item converts a (possibly multilevel, or with non-ASCII characters)
9889folder specification to a Maildir name for filesystem use.
9890For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMDA>>&.
9891
9892
9893
9894.vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9895.cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9896.cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9897The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9898strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9899you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9900change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9901some of the braces:
9902.code
9903${length_<n>:<string>}
9904.endd
9905The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> bytes or the whole
9906of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9907&%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9908All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
9909
9910
9911.vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9912 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9913.cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9914.cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9915.cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9916The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9917apart from an optional leading minus,
9918and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9919
9920After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9921default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
9922
9923The first field of the list is numbered one.
9924If the number is negative, the fields are
9925counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9926The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9927then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9928
9929If the modulus of the
9930number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9931the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9932
9933For example:
9934.code
9935${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9936.endd
9937yields &"42"&, and
9938.code
9939${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9940.endd
9941yields &"result: 42"&.
9942
9943If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9944If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9945extracted is used.
9946You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9947
9948
9949.vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9950 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9951This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9952described in the next item.
9953
9954.vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9955 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9956.cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9957.cindex "file" "lookups"
9958.cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9959The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9960discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9961lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9962<&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9963
9964If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9965a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9966other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9967in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9968out by the system administrator.
9969
9970.vindex "&$value$&"
9971If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9972During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9973lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9974level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9975the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9976string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9977lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9978original lookup fails.
9979
9980If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9981data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9982expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9983the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9984appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9985to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9986{<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9987successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9988
9989For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9990search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9991type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9992&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9993
9994.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9995If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9996and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9997They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9998
9999This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
10000.code
10001${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
10002.endd
10003This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
10004the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
10005.code
10006${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
10007 {$value}fail}
10008.endd
10009
10010
10011.vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
10012.cindex "expansion" "list creation"
10013.vindex "&$item$&"
10014After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10015default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10016For each item
10017in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
10018expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
10019for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
10020setting is not included in the output. For example:
10021.code
10022${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
10023.endd
10024expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
10025value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &%filter%&
10026and &%reduce%& expansion items.
10027
10028.vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10029.cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10030.cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10031The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10032<&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10033if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10034can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10035.code
10036${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10037.endd
10038The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
10039the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
10040processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
10041slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
10042example,
10043.code
10044${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
10045.endd
10046returns the string &"6/33"&.
10047
10048
10049
10050.vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
10051.cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
10052.cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
10053This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
10054interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
10055expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
10056additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
10057name of the subroutine, is nine.
10058
10059The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
10060the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
10061way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
10062Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
10063return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
10064not its contents.
10065
10066If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
10067with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
10068Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
10069
10070The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
10071out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10072
10073
10074.vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
10075.cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
10076The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
10077keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
10078it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
10079to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
10080as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
10081and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10082
10083.vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
10084 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
10085.cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
10086This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
10087checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
10088yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
10089empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
10090prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
10091version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
10092variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
10093
10094These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
10095retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
10096against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
10097which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
10098
10099The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
10100string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
10101result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
10102whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
10103is the expansion of the third argument.
10104
10105All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
10106However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
10107For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10108
10109.vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
10110.cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
10111.cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
10112.cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
10113The filename and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
10114then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
10115the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
10116newlines are left in the string.
10117String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
10118you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
10119the string expansion fails.
10120
10121The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
10122locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10123
10124
10125
10126.vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
10127 {*&<&'options'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
10128.cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
10129.cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
10130.cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
10131This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
10132string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
10133examples:
10134.code
10135${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
10136${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
10137.endd
10138For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
10139For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
10140a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
10141number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
10142optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
10143example:
10144.code
10145${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
10146.endd
10147Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
10148one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
10149both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
10150unless it is an empty string; and no terminating NUL is ever sent)
10151and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
10152is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
10153extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
10154.code
10155${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
10156.endd
10157
10158The third argument is a list of options, of which the first element is the timeout
10159and must be present if the argument is given.
10160Further elements are options of form &'name=value'&.
10161Two option types is currently recognised: shutdown and tls.
10162The first defines whether (the default)
10163or not a shutdown is done on the connection after sending the request.
10164Example, to not do so (preferred, eg. by some webservers):
10165.code
10166${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:shutdown=no}}
10167.endd
10168The second, tls, controls the use of TLS on the connection. Example:
10169.code
10170${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:tls=yes}}
10171.endd
10172The default is to not use TLS.
10173If it is enabled, a shutdown as descripbed above is never done.
10174
10175A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
10176that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
10177turns them into spaces:
10178.code
10179${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
10180.endd
10181As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
10182happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
10183addition, the following errors can occur:
10184
10185.ilist
10186Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
10187.next
10188Failure to connect the socket;
10189.next
10190Failure to write the request string;
10191.next
10192Timeout on reading from the socket.
10193.endlist
10194
10195By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
10196you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
10197errors occurs. For example:
10198.code
10199${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
10200 {socket failure}}
10201.endd
10202You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
10203expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
10204and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
10205if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
10206non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
10207
10208The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
10209locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10210
10211
10212.vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10213.cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
10214.cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
10215.vindex "&$value$&"
10216.vindex "&$item$&"
10217This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
10218<&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
10219separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10220Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
10221assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
10222list is assigned to &$item$&, in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
10223them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
10224iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
10225added to the expansion output. The &%reduce%& expansion item can be used in a
10226number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
10227.code
10228${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
10229.endd
10230The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
10231can be found:
10232.code
10233${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
10234.endd
10235At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
10236restored to what they were before. See also the &%filter%& and &%map%&
10237expansion items.
10238
10239.vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
10240This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
10241expansion item in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
10242
10243.vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
10244 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10245.cindex "expansion" "running a command"
10246.cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
10247The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
10248split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
10249in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
10250executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
10251a shell, you must explicitly code it.
10252
10253Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
10254which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
10255simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
10256script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
10257variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
10258quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
10259in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
10260around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
10261variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
10262character.
10263
10264The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
10265and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
10266.cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
10267.vindex "&$value$&"
10268If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
10269and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
10270from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
10271<&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
10272expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
10273&$value$&.
10274
10275If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
10276can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
10277command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
10278of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
10279
10280.vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
10281The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
10282In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
10283troubleshoot:
10284.code
10285warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
10286 log_message = Output of id: $value
10287.endd
10288If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
10289shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
10290.code
10291${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
10292.endd
10293
10294.vindex "&$runrc$&"
10295The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
10296remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
10297.code
10298if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
10299 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
10300 ...
10301endif
10302.endd
10303If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
10304the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
10305commands.
10306
10307&*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
10308option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
10309testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
10310by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
10311
10312The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
10313out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10314
10315
10316.vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
10317.cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
10318.cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
10319This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
10320option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
10321modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
10322into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
10323a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
10324.code
10325${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
10326.endd
10327yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
10328if any $, } or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
10329substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
10330.code
10331${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
10332.endd
10333yields &"defabc"&, and
10334.code
10335${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
10336.endd
10337yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
10338the regular expression from string expansion.
10339
10340The regular expression is compiled in 8-bit mode, working against bytes
10341rather than any Unicode-aware character handling.
10342
10343
10344.vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
10345.cindex sorting "a list"
10346.cindex list sorting
10347.cindex expansion "list sorting"
10348After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10349default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10350The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
10351of a two-argument expansion condition.
10352The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
10353The comparison should return true when applied to two values
10354if the first value should sort before the second value.
10355The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
10356the element being placed in &$item$&,
10357to give values for comparison.
10358
10359The item result is a sorted list,
10360with the original list separator,
10361of the list elements (in full) of the original.
10362
10363Examples:
10364.code
10365${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
10366.endd
10367sorts a list of numbers, and
10368.code
10369${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
10370.endd
10371will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
10372
10373
10374.vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10375.cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10376.cindex "substring extraction"
10377.cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
10378The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10379<&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10380if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10381can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10382.code
10383${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10384.endd
10385The second number is optional (in both notations).
10386If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
10387omitted.
10388
10389The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
10390&%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
10391length required. For example
10392.code
10393${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
10394.endd
10395If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
10396null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
10397length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
10398given offset. The first byte (character) in the string has offset zero.
10399
10400The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
10401from the right-hand end of its operand. The last byte (character) is offset -1,
10402the second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
10403.code
10404${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
10405.endd
10406yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
10407length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
10408the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
10409.code
10410${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
10411.endd
10412yields an empty string, but
10413.code
10414${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
10415.endd
10416yields &"1"&.
10417
10418When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
10419is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all bytes (characters) in the
10420string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
10421no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
10422.code
10423${substr_-1:abcde}
10424${substr{-1}{abcde}}
10425.endd
10426yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
10427
10428All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10429
10430
10431
10432.vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
10433 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
10434.cindex "expansion" "character translation"
10435.cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
10436This item does single-character (in bytes) translation on its subject string. The second
10437argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
10438matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
10439replacement list. For example
10440.code
10441${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
10442.endd
10443yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
10444last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
10445last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
10446place.
10447
10448All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10449
10450.endlist
10451
10452
10453
10454.section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
10455.cindex "expansion" "operators"
10456For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
10457the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
10458The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
10459following operations can be performed:
10460
10461.vlist
10462.vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10463.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10464.cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
10465The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
10466header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
10467not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10468
10469The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
10470
10471
10472.vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10473.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10474.cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
10475The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
104762822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
10477operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
10478result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
10479doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
10480Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
10481
10482It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
10483separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
10484character. For example:
10485.code
10486${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
10487.endd
10488expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. The string is expanded
10489first, so if the expanded string starts with >, it may change the output
10490separator unintentionally. This can be avoided by setting the output
10491separator explicitly:
10492.code
10493${addresses:>:$h_from:}
10494.endd
10495
10496Compare the &%address%& (singular)
10497expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
10498address. See the &%filter%&, &%map%&, and &%reduce%& items for ways of
10499processing lists.
10500
10501To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
10502a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
10503unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
10504email address separator. For the example header line:
10505.code
10506From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
10507.endd
10508The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
10509properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
10510It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
10511example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
10512de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
10513The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
10514quoted. The fourth example shows SMTPUTF8 handling.
10515.code
10516# exim -be '${addresses:From: \
10517=?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
10518user@example.com
10519# exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
10520Last:user@example.com
10521# exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
10522user@example.com
10523# exim -be '${addresses:フィル <フィリップ@example.jp>}'
10524フィリップ@example.jp
10525.endd
10526
10527.vitem &*${base32:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10528.cindex "&%base32%& expansion item"
10529.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10530The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10531base 32 and output as a (empty, for zero) string of characters.
10532Only lowercase letters are used.
10533
10534.vitem &*${base32d:*&<&'base-32&~digits'&>&*}*&
10535.cindex "&%base32d%& expansion item"
10536.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10537The string must consist entirely of base-32 digits.
10538The number is converted to decimal and output as a string.
10539
10540.vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10541.cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
10542.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10543The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10544base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
10545the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
10546its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive
10547filenames), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just
10548to be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
10549
10550.vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
10551.cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
10552.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10553The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
10554environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
10555identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
10556string.
10557
10558.vitem &*${base64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10559.cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10560.cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10561.cindex "&%base64%& expansion item"
10562.cindex certificate "base64 of DER"
10563This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10564
10565If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10566returns the base64 encoding of the DER form of the certificate.
10567
10568
10569.vitem &*${base64d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10570.cindex "expansion" "base64 decoding"
10571.cindex "base64 decoding" "in string expansion"
10572.cindex "&%base64d%& expansion item"
10573This operator converts a base64-encoded string into the un-coded form.
10574
10575
10576.vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10577.cindex "domain" "extraction"
10578.cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
10579The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
10580from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10581
10582
10583.vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10584.cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
10585.cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
10586If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
10587escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
10588significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
10589is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
10590
10591.vitem &*${escape8bit:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10592.cindex "expansion" "escaping 8-bit characters"
10593.cindex "&%escape8bit%& expansion item"
10594If the string contains and characters with the most significant bit set,
10595they are converted to escape sequences starting with a backslash.
10596Backslashes and DEL characters are also converted.
10597
10598
10599.vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10600.cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
10601.cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
10602.cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
10603These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
10604expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
10605arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
10606logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
10607integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
10608C programming language):
10609.table2 70pt 300pt
10610.irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
10611.irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
10612.irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
10613.irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
10614.irow "" "and (&&)"
10615.irow "" "xor (^)"
10616.irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
10617.endtable
10618Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
10619space is permitted before or after operators.
10620
10621For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
10622hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
10623decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
10624permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
10625times, which often do have leading zeros.
10626
10627A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10628or 1024*1024*1024,
10629respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10630a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10631
10632.display
10633&`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10634&`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10635&`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10636&`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10637&`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
10638&`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10639&`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10640&`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10641&`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10642&`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
10643&`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10644.endd
10645
10646As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10647.code
10648deny message = Too many bad recipients
10649 condition = \
10650 ${if and { \
10651 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10652 { \
10653 < \
10654 {$recipients_count} \
10655 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10656 } \
10657 }{yes}{no}}
10658.endd
10659The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10660fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10661
10662
10663.vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10664.cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10665The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10666example,
10667.code
10668${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10669.endd
10670first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10671and then re-expands what it has found.
10672
10673
10674.vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10675.cindex "Unicode"
10676.cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10677.cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10678.cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10679The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10680email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10681to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10682UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10683converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10684the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10685
10686Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10687ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10688For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10689way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10690characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10691single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10692translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10693
10694
10695.vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10696.cindex "hash function" "textual"
10697.cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10698The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10699be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10700change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10701.code
10702${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10703.endd
10704See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10705abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10706
10707
10708
10709.vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10710.cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10711.cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10712.cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10713This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10714be useful for processing the output of the various hashing functions.
10715
10716
10717
10718.vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10719.cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10720.cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10721This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10722escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10723as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example, a
10724byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10725
10726
10727.vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10728.cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
10729.cindex "IP address" normalisation
10730This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
10731of hex digits including leading zeroes.
10732A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10733Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10734
10735.vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10736.cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
10737.cindex "IP address" normalisation
10738.cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
10739This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
10740Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
10741set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
10742A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10743Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10744
10745
10746.vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10747.cindex "case forcing in strings"
10748.cindex "string" "case forcing"
10749.cindex "lower casing"
10750.cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10751.cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10752This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10753.code
10754${lc:$local_part}
10755.endd
10756Case is defined per the system C locale.
10757
10758.vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10759.cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10760.cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10761The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10762can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10763changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10764.code
10765${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10766.endd
10767See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10768&%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10769when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10770All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10771
10772
10773.vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10774.cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10775.cindex "list" "item count"
10776.cindex "list" "count of items"
10777.cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10778The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10779
10780
10781.vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10782.cindex "expansion" "named list"
10783.cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10784The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10785expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10786If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10787and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10788Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10789matching list is returned.
10790
10791
10792.vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10793.cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10794.cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10795The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10796extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10797empty.
10798The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
10799
10800
10801.vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10802.cindex "masked IP address"
10803.cindex "IP address" "masking"
10804.cindex "CIDR notation"
10805.cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10806.cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10807If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10808slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10809expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10810masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10811the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10812.code
10813${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10814.endd
10815returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10816be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10817address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10818terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10819.code
10820${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10821.endd
10822returns the string
10823.code
108243ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10825.endd
10826Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10827
10828
10829.vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10830.cindex "MD5 hash"
10831.cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10832.cindex certificate fingerprint
10833.cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10834The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10835as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10836
10837If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10838returns the MD5 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10839
10840
10841.vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10842.cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10843.cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10844The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10845that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10846strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10847.code
10848${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10849.endd
10850See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10851
10852
10853.vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10854.cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10855.cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10856.cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10857The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10858is an empty string or
10859contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10860Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10861Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10862respectively For example,
10863.code
10864${quote:ab"*"cd}
10865.endd
10866becomes
10867.code
10868"ab\"*\"cd"
10869.endd
10870The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10871variable or a message header.
10872
10873.vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10874.cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10875This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10876required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10877example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10878If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10879(or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10880
10881This quoting determination is not SMTPUTF8-aware, thus quoting non-ASCII data
10882will likely use the quoting form.
10883Thus &'${quote_local_part:フィル}'& will always become &'"フィル"'&.
10884
10885
10886.vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10887.cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10888This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10889query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10890the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10891.code
10892${quote_ldap:two * two}
10893.endd
10894returns
10895.code
10896two%20%5C2A%20two
10897.endd
10898For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10899yields an unchanged string.
10900
10901
10902.vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10903.cindex "random number"
10904This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10905supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10906on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10907If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10908If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10909for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10910Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10911srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10912random().
10913
10914
10915.vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10916.cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10917This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10918dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
10919dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10920for DNS. For example,
10921.code
10922${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10923${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10924.endd
10925returns
10926.code
109274.2.0.192
10928f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10929.endd
10930
10931
10932.vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10933.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10934.cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10935.cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10936This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10937encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10938assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10939&%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
10940contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10941characters
10942.code
10943? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10944.endd
10945it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10946string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10947characters.
10948
10949
10950.vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10951.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10952.cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10953.cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10954This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10955bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10956character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10957not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10958
10959&*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10960access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10961to use this operator as well.
10962
10963
10964
10965.vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10966.cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10967.cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10968.cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10969The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10970characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10971variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10972
10973
10974.vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10975.cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10976.cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10977.cindex certificate fingerprint
10978.cindex "&%sha1%& expansion item"
10979The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10980it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10981
10982If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10983returns the SHA-1 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10984
10985
10986.vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10987 &*${sha2:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10988 &*${sha2_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10989.cindex "SHA-256 hash"
10990.cindex "SHA-2 hash"
10991.cindex certificate fingerprint
10992.cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
10993.cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
10994.cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
10995The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash value of the string
10996and returns
10997it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10998
10999If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11000returns the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
11001
11002The operator can also be spelled &%sha2%& and does the same as &%sha256%&
11003(except for certificates, which are not supported).
11004Finally, if an underbar
11005and a number is appended it specifies the output length, selecting a
11006member of the SHA-2 family of hash functions.
11007Values of 256, 384 and 512 are accepted, with 256 being the default.
11008
11009
11010.vitem &*${sha3:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11011 &*${sha3_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11012.cindex "SHA3 hash"
11013.cindex "expansion" "SHA3 hashing"
11014.cindex "&%sha3%& expansion item"
11015The &%sha3%& operator computes the SHA3-256 hash value of the string
11016and returns
11017it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11018
11019If a number is appended, separated by an underbar, it specifies
11020the output length. Values of 224, 256, 384 and 512 are accepted;
11021with 256 being the default.
11022
11023The &%sha3%& expansion item is only supported if Exim has been
11024compiled with GnuTLS 3.5.0 or later,
11025or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later.
11026The macro "_CRYPTO_HASH_SHA3" will be defined if it is supported.
11027
11028
11029.vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11030.cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
11031.cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
11032.cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
11033The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
11034function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
11035expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
11036series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
11037except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
11038a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
1103910-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
11040&"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
11041can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
11042
11043The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
11044the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
11045systems for files larger than 2GB.
11046
11047.vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11048.cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
11049Now deprecated, a synonym for the &%base64%& expansion operator.
11050
11051
11052
11053.vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11054.cindex "expansion" "string length"
11055.cindex "string" "length in expansion"
11056.cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
11057The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
11058decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
11059All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11060
11061
11062.vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11063.cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
11064.cindex "substring extraction"
11065.cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
11066The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
11067can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
11068that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11069.code
11070${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
11071.endd
11072See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
11073abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
11074All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11075
11076.vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11077.cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
11078.cindex "time interval" "decoding"
11079This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
11080seconds.
11081
11082.vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11083.cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
11084.cindex "time interval" "formatting"
11085The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
11086represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
11087number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
11088&`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
11089
11090.vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11091.cindex "case forcing in strings"
11092.cindex "string" "case forcing"
11093.cindex "upper casing"
11094.cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
11095.cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
11096This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
11097Case is defined per the system C locale.
11098
11099.vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11100.cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
11101.cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
11102.cindex "incorrect utf-8"
11103.cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
11104.cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
11105This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
11106In versions of Exim before 4.92, this did not correctly do so for a truncated
11107final codepoint's encoding, and the character would be silently dropped.
11108If you must handle detection of this scenario across both sets of Exim behavior,
11109the complexity will depend upon the task.
11110For instance, to detect if the first character is multibyte and a 1-byte
11111extraction can be successfully used as a path component (as is common for
11112dividing up delivery folders), you might use:
11113.code
11114condition = ${if inlist{${utf8clean:${length_1:$local_part}}}{:?}{yes}{no}}
11115.endd
11116(which will false-positive if the first character of the local part is a
11117literal question mark).
11118
11119.vitem "&*${utf8_domain_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11120 "&*${utf8_domain_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11121 "&*${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11122 "&*${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&"
11123.cindex expansion UTF-8
11124.cindex UTF-8 expansion
11125.cindex EAI
11126.cindex internationalisation
11127.cindex "&%utf8_domain_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11128.cindex "&%utf8_domain_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11129.cindex "&%utf8_localpart_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11130.cindex "&%utf8_localpart_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11131These convert EAI mail name components between UTF-8 and a-label forms.
11132For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
11133.endlist
11134
11135
11136
11137
11138
11139
11140.section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
11141.scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
11142The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
11143while expanding strings:
11144
11145.vlist
11146.vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
11147.cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
11148.cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
11149Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
11150condition.
11151
11152.vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11153.cindex "numeric comparison"
11154.cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
11155There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
11156are:
11157.display
11158&`= `& equal
11159&`== `& equal
11160&`> `& greater
11161&`>= `& greater or equal
11162&`< `& less
11163&`<= `& less or equal
11164.endd
11165For example:
11166.code
11167${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
11168.endd
11169Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
11170two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
11171optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
11172lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
11173As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
11174zero.
11175
11176In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
11177<&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
1117810M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
11179
11180
11181.vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
11182 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
11183.cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
11184.cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
11185The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
11186arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
11187Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
11188arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
11189and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
11190are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
11191a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
11192the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
11193If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
11194If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
11195
11196.vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11197.cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11198.cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
11199This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
11200a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
11201(case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
11202false if zero.
11203An empty string is treated as false.
11204Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
11205thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
11206All other string values will result in expansion failure.
11207
11208When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
11209make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
11210For example:
11211.code
11212${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
11213.endd
11214
11215
11216.vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11217.cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11218.cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
11219Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
11220where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
11221loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
11222and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
11223true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
11224
11225Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
11226
11227.vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11228.cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
11229.cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
11230.cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
11231This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
11232authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
11233necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
11234included in the binary.
11235
11236The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
11237compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
11238be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
11239encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
11240does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
11241&[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
11242Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
11243string in LDAP form is:
11244.code
11245{md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
11246.endd
11247If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
11248be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
11249.code
11250${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
11251.endd
11252The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
11253supported:
11254
11255.ilist
11256.cindex "MD5 hash"
11257.cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
11258&%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11259printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11260length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
11261(as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
11262hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
11263comparison fails.
11264
11265.next
11266.cindex "SHA-1 hash"
11267&%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11268printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11269length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
11270If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
11271SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
11272
11273.next
11274.cindex "&[crypt()]&"
11275&%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
11276only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
11277systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
11278whatever its length.
11279
11280.next
11281.cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
11282&%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
11283use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
11284modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
11285.endlist
11286Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
11287&[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
11288HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
11289operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
11290the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
11291support &[crypt16()]&.
11292
11293Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
11294it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
11295turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
11296&[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
11297algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
11298
11299However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
11300functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
11301Exim is seen as very low priority.
11302
11303If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
11304comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
11305determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
11306default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
11307function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
11308
11309.vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
11310.cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
11311.cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
11312The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
11313variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
11314variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
11315.code
11316${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
11317.endd
11318Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
11319variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
11320
11321.vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
11322 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
11323.cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
11324This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
11325exists in the message. For example,
11326.code
11327${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
11328.endd
11329&*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
11330the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
11331
11332.vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11333 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11334.cindex "string" "comparison"
11335.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11336.cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
11337.cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
11338The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
11339resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
11340letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent, where
11341case is defined per the system C locale.
11342
11343.vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
11344.cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
11345.cindex "file" "existence test"
11346.cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
11347The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
11348condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
11349is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
11350users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
11351
11352.vitem &*first_delivery*&
11353.cindex "delivery" "first"
11354.cindex "first delivery"
11355.cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
11356.cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
11357This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
11358attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
11359
11360
11361.vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11362 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11363.cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11364.cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
11365.cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
11366.vindex "&$item$&"
11367These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
11368the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
11369the normal method (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
11370The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
11371be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
11372condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
11373.ilist
11374For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
11375the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
11376items in the list, the overall condition is false.
11377.next
11378For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
11379and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
11380all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
11381.endlist
11382Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
11383items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
11384that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
11385list separator is changed to a comma:
11386.code
11387${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
11388.endd
11389The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &%forany%& or &%forall%& is
11390being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
11391
11392To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
11393
11394.vitem "&*forall_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11395 "&*forany_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11396 "&*forall_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11397 "&*forany_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11398.cindex JSON "iterative conditions"
11399.cindex JSON expansions
11400.cindex expansion "&*forall_json*& condition"
11401.cindex expansion "&*forany_json*& condition"
11402.cindex expansion "&*forall_jsons*& condition"
11403.cindex expansion "&*forany_jsons*& condition"
11404As for the above, except that the first argument must, after expansion,
11405be a JSON array.
11406The array separator is not changeable.
11407For the &"jsons"& variants the elements are expected to be JSON strings
11408and have their quotes removed before the evaluation of the condition.
11409
11410
11411
11412.vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11413 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11414.cindex "string" "comparison"
11415.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11416.cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
11417.cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
11418The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11419string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
11420comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
11421case-independent.
11422Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11423
11424.vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11425 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11426.cindex "string" "comparison"
11427.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11428.cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
11429.cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
11430The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11431string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
11432includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
11433case-independent.
11434Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11435
11436.vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11437 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11438.cindex "string" "comparison"
11439.cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11440Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
11441strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
11442is true.
11443For the case-independent &%inlisti%& condition, case is defined per the system C locale.
11444
11445These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
11446Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
11447.code
11448${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
11449 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
11450${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
11451 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
11452.endd
11453
11454.vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11455 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11456 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11457.cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
11458.cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
11459.cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
11460.cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
11461.cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
11462The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
11463an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
11464&%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
11465
11466For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
11467which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
11468colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
11469hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
11470component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
11471
11472&*Note*&: The checks used to be just on the form of the address; actual numerical
11473values were not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passed the IPv4
11474check.
11475This is no longer the case.
11476
11477The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
11478host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
11479.code
11480${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
11481.endd
11482to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
11483
11484.vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
11485.cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
11486.cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
11487.cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
11488This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
11489&<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
11490queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
11491query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
11492password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
11493server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
11494with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
11495will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
11496of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
11497this can be used.
11498
11499
11500.vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11501 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11502.cindex "string" "comparison"
11503.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11504.cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
11505.cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
11506The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11507string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
11508comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
11509case-independent.
11510Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11511
11512.vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11513 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11514.cindex "string" "comparison"
11515.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11516.cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
11517.cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
11518The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11519string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
11520includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
11521case-independent.
11522Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11523
11524
11525.vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11526.cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
11527.cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
11528.cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
11529The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
11530expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
11531regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
11532escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
11533(curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
11534premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
11535&`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
11536For example,
11537.code
11538${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
11539.endd
11540If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
11541backslashes is also required.
11542
11543The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
11544The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
11545metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
11546and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
11547the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
11548metacharacter at an appropriate point.
11549All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware,
11550but we might change this in a future Exim release.
11551
11552.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
11553At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
11554substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
11555succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
11556will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
11557of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
11558combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
11559variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
11560
11561.vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11562.cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
11563See &*match_local_part*&.
11564
11565.vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11566.cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
11567See &*match_local_part*&.
11568
11569.vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11570.cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
11571This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
11572be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
11573address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
11574list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
11575.code
11576${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
11577.endd
11578The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
11579
11580.ilist
11581An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
11582.next
11583A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
11584.next
11585An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
11586useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
11587in a single test such as
11588. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11589. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
11590. ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
11591. ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
11592.code
11593 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
11594.endd
11595where the first item in the list is the empty string.
11596.next
11597The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
11598.next
11599Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
11600even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
11601address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
11602&*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
11603masks. For example:
11604.code
11605 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
11606.endd
11607It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
11608do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
11609address mask, for example:
11610.code
11611 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
11612.endd
11613However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
11614just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
11615.code
11616 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
11617.endd
11618.endlist ilist
11619
11620Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11621Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11622
11623Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
11624
11625.vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11626.cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
11627.cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
11628.cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
11629.cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
11630This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
11631possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
11632condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
11633example is:
11634.code
11635${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
11636.endd
11637In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
11638list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument
11639is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
11640Thus, you can use conditions like this:
11641.code
11642${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
11643.endd
11644.cindex "&`+caseful`&"
11645For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
11646item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
11647have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
11648caselessly.
11649
11650Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11651Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11652
11653&*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
11654hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
11655how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
11656matched using &%match_ip%&.
11657
11658.vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
11659.cindex "PAM authentication"
11660.cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
11661.cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
11662.cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
11663.cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
11664&'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
11665(&url(https://mirrors.edge.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
11666available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
11667distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
11668the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
11669.code
11670SUPPORT_PAM=yes
11671.endd
11672in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
11673in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
11674
11675The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
11676colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
11677The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
11678taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
11679The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
11680from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
11681request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
11682
11683There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
11684characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
11685separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
11686item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
11687of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
11688.code
11689server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
11690.endd
11691For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
11692.code
11693server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
11694.endd
11695In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
11696running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
11697messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
11698. --- 2018-09-07: the pam_exim modified variant has gone, removed claims re using Exim via that
11699
11700
11701.vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11702.cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
11703.cindex "Cyrus"
11704.cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
11705.cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
11706This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
11707This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
11708that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
11709deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
11710
11711The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11712the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11713building Exim. For example:
11714.code
11715CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
11716.endd
11717You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11718the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11719from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
11720access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
11721
11722The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
11723password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
11724configuration, you might have this:
11725.code
11726server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
11727.endd
11728Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
11729.code
11730server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
11731.endd
11732.vitem &*queue_running*&
11733.cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
11734.cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
11735.cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
11736This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
11737initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
11738
11739
11740.vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
11741.cindex "Radius"
11742.cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
11743.cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
11744Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11745set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11746the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11747support.
11748
11749With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11750library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11751this library, you need to set
11752.code
11753RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11754.endd
11755in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11756&%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11757.code
11758RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
11759.endd
11760in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
11761You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
11762Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
11763
11764The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
11765Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
11766the authentication is successful. For example:
11767.code
11768server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
11769.endd
11770
11771
11772.vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
11773 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
11774.cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
11775.cindex "Cyrus"
11776.cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
11777.cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
11778This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
11779daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
11780Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
11781by a process that is not running as root.
11782
11783The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11784the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11785building Exim. For example:
11786.code
11787CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
11788.endd
11789You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11790the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11791from the Cyrus SASL library.
11792
11793Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
11794two are mandatory. For example:
11795.code
11796server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
11797.endd
11798The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
11799in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11800realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11801.endlist vlist
11802
11803
11804
11805.section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11806.cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11807Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11808and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11809conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11810sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11811the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11812
11813
11814.vlist
11815.vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11816.cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11817.cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11818The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11819any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11820For example,
11821.code
11822${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11823.endd
11824When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11825evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11826numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11827
11828.vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11829.cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11830.cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11831The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11832all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11833sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11834the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11835parsed but not evaluated.
11836.endlist
11837.ecindex IIDexpcond
11838
11839
11840
11841
11842.section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11843.cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11844This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11845of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11846support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11847
11848.vlist
11849.vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11850.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11851When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11852captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11853processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11854In the expansion condition case
11855they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11856values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11857variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11858precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11859Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11860matching condition.
11861
11862.vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11863Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11864any arguments are copied to these variables,
11865any unused variables being made empty.
11866
11867.vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11868Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11869can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11870long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11871example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11872variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11873used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11874same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11875with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11876during subsequent delivery.
11877
11878.vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11879These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11880are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11881received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11882message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11883also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11884message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11885and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11886delivery.
11887
11888.vitem &$acl_narg$&
11889Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11890this variable has the number of arguments.
11891
11892.vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11893.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11894After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11895message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11896be preserved by coding like this:
11897.code
11898warn !verify = sender
11899 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11900.endd
11901You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11902&%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11903failure.
11904
11905.vitem &$address_data$&
11906.vindex "&$address_data$&"
11907This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11908value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11909and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11910the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11911for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11912user filter files.
11913
11914If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11915a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11916conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11917to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11918of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11919from the child's routing.
11920
11921If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11922sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11923&$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11924address.
11925
11926In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11927after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11928these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11929
11930.vitem &$address_file$&
11931.vindex "&$address_file$&"
11932When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11933to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11934is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11935default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11936.code
11937/home/r2d2/savemail
11938.endd
11939then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11940contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11941.cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11942For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11943then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11944to the relevant file.
11945
11946.vitem &$address_pipe$&
11947.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11948When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11949this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11950
11951.vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11952.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11953These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11954&<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPtlsauth>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11955
11956.vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11957.cindex "authentication" "id"
11958.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11959When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11960preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11961&$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11962user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11963in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11964&$sender_host_authenticated$&.
11965
11966When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
11967the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
11968process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
11969command line option.
11970This second case also sets up information used by the
11971&$authresults$& expansion item.
11972
11973.vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11974.cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
11975.vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
11976When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11977will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
11978id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
11979available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
11980A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
11981authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
11982the ACL's as well.
11983
11984
11985.vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
11986.cindex "sender" "authenticated"
11987.cindex "authentication" "sender"
11988.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
11989.vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
11990When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
11991SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
11992described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
11993&"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
11994available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
11995sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
11996
11997.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11998When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
11999value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
12000name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
12001can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
12002
12003
12004.vitem &$authentication_failed$&
12005.cindex "authentication" "failure"
12006.vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
12007This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
12008command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
12009possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
12010(&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
12011&"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
12012is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
12013negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
12014an undefined mechanism.
12015
12016.vitem &$av_failed$&
12017.cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
12018This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
12019extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
12020problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
12021the ACL malware condition.
12022
12023.vitem &$body_linecount$&
12024.cindex "message body" "line count"
12025.cindex "body of message" "line count"
12026.vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
12027When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12028number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
12029
12030.vitem &$body_zerocount$&
12031.cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
12032.cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
12033.cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12034.vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
12035When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12036number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
12037
12038.vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
12039.vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
12040This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
12041it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
12042chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12043
12044.vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
12045.vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
12046This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
12047up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
12048file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12049
12050.vitem &$caller_gid$&
12051.cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
12052.vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12053The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12054not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
12055&$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12056incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
12057
12058.vitem &$caller_uid$&
12059.cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
12060.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12061The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12062not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
12063&$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12064incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
12065
12066.vitem &$callout_address$&
12067.vindex "&$callout_address$&"
12068After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
12069address that was connected to.
12070
12071.vitem &$compile_number$&
12072.vindex "&$compile_number$&"
12073The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
12074of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
12075compilations of the same version of Exim.
12076
12077.vitem &$config_dir$&
12078.vindex "&$config_dir$&"
12079The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
12080&$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
12081contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
12082&$config_dir$& is ".".
12083
12084.vitem &$config_file$&
12085.vindex "&$config_file$&"
12086The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
12087
12088.vitem &$dmarc_domain_policy$& &&&
12089 &$dmarc_status$& &&&
12090 &$dmarc_status_text$& &&&
12091 &$dmarc_used_domains$&
12092Results of DMARC verification.
12093For details see section &<<SECDMARC>>&.
12094
12095.vitem &$dkim_verify_status$&
12096Results of DKIM verification.
12097For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12098
12099.vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
12100 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
12101 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
12102 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
12103 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
12104 &$dkim_algo$& &&&
12105 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
12106 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
12107 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
12108 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
12109 &$dkim_created$& &&&
12110 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
12111 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
12112 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
12113 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
12114 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
12115 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
12116 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
12117 &$dkim_key_length$&
12118These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
12119For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12120
12121.vitem &$dkim_signers$&
12122.vindex &$dkim_signers$&
12123When a message has been received this variable contains
12124a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
12125For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12126
12127.vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
12128 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
12129 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
12130 &$dnslist_value$&
12131.vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
12132.vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
12133.vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
12134.vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
12135.cindex "black list (DNS)"
12136When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
12137the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
12138looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
12139main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
12140
12141.vitem &$domain$&
12142.vindex "&$domain$&"
12143When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
12144contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
12145case for &$domain$&.
12146
12147Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12148&$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
12149is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
12150message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
12151
12152When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
12153RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
12154have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
12155at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
12156the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
12157which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
12158
12159.oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
12160At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
12161set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
12162
12163The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
12164
12165.ilist
12166When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
12167the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
12168&$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
12169normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
12170is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
12171&$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
12172the &(smtp)& transport.
12173
12174.next
12175When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12176&$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
12177it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
12178rewrite domains by file lookup.
12179
12180.next
12181With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
12182&$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
12183a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
12184is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
12185that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
12186recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
12187
12188.next
12189.cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
12190.oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
12191When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
12192the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
12193.endlist
12194
12195
12196.vitem &$domain_data$&
12197.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
12198When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
12199means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
12200of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
12201address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
12202transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
12203used.
12204
12205&$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
12206domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
12207the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
12208to nothing.
12209
12210.vitem &$exim_gid$&
12211.vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
12212This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
12213
12214.vitem &$exim_path$&
12215.vindex "&$exim_path$&"
12216This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
12217
12218.vitem &$exim_uid$&
12219.vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
12220This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
12221
12222.vitem &$exim_version$&
12223.vindex "&$exim_version$&"
12224This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
12225The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
12226Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
12227There may be other characters following the minor version.
12228This value may be overridden by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
12229
12230.vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
12231This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
12232inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
12233be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
12234characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
12235See the full description in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
12236
12237.vitem &$headers_added$&
12238.vindex "&$headers_added$&"
12239Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
12240the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
12241The headers are a newline-separated list.
12242
12243.vitem &$home$&
12244.vindex "&$home$&"
12245When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
12246directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
12247means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
12248explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
12249by a setting on the transport itself.
12250
12251When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
12252of the environment variable HOME, which is subject to the
12253&%keep_environment%& and &%add_environment%& main config options.
12254
12255.vitem &$host$&
12256.vindex "&$host$&"
12257If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
12258list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
12259to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
12260to local and remote transports.
12261
12262.cindex "transport" "filter"
12263.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12264For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
12265&$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
12266particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
12267using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
12268&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
12269is connected.
12270
12271When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
12272&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
12273client is connected.
12274
12275
12276.vitem &$host_address$&
12277.vindex "&$host_address$&"
12278This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
12279for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
12280when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
12281
12282.vitem &$host_data$&
12283.vindex "&$host_data$&"
12284If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
12285result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
12286allows you, for example, to do things like this:
12287.code
12288deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
12289message = $host_data
12290.endd
12291.vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12292.cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
12293.vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12294This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
12295message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
12296name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
12297variables is set to &"1"&.
12298
12299.ilist
12300If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
12301succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12302
12303.next
12304If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
12305tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
12306lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
12307.endlist ilist
12308
12309Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
12310single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
12311names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
12312is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
12313&$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
12314IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
12315sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
12316lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
12317the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
12318&"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
12319
12320.cindex authentication "expansion item"
12321Performing these checks sets up information used by the
12322&%authresults%& expansion item.
12323
12324
12325.vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
12326.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12327See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
12328
12329.vitem &$host_port$&
12330.vindex "&$host_port$&"
12331This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
12332for an outbound connection.
12333
12334.vitem &$initial_cwd$&
12335.vindex "&$initial_cwd$&
12336This variable contains the full path name of the initial working
12337directory of the current Exim process. This may differ from the current
12338working directory, as Exim changes this to "/" during early startup, and
12339to &$spool_directory$& later.
12340
12341.vitem &$inode$&
12342.vindex "&$inode$&"
12343The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
12344option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
12345of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
12346a unique name for the file.
12347
12348.vitem &$interface_address$&
12349.vindex "&$interface_address$&"
12350This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
12351
12352.vitem &$interface_port$&
12353.vindex "&$interface_port$&"
12354This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
12355
12356.vitem &$item$&
12357.vindex "&$item$&"
12358This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
12359conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
12360&*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
12361empty.
12362
12363.vitem &$ldap_dn$&
12364.vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
12365This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
12366contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
12367lookup.
12368
12369.vitem &$load_average$&
12370.vindex "&$load_average$&"
12371This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
12372is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
12373variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
12374
12375.vitem &$local_part$&
12376.vindex "&$local_part$&"
12377When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
12378variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
12379delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
12380session), &$local_part$& is not set.
12381
12382Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12383&$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
12384&$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
12385because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
12386once.
12387
12388.new
12389&*Warning*&: the content of this variable is provided by a potential attacker.
12390Consider carefully the implications of using it unvalidated as a name
12391for file access.
12392This presents issues for users' &_.forward_& and filter files.
12393For traditional full user accounts, use &%check_local_users%& and the &$home$&
12394variable rather than this one.
12395For virtual users, store a suitable pathname component in the database
12396which is used for account name validation, and use that retrieved value
12397rather than this variable.
12398.wen
12399
12400.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12401.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12402.cindex affix variables
12403If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
12404value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
12405any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
12406&$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
12407
12408When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
12409result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
12410the parent address, not to the filename or command (see &$address_file$& and
12411&$address_pipe$&).
12412
12413When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
12414local part of the recipient address.
12415
12416When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12417&$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
12418it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
12419
12420In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
12421the addresses
12422.code
12423"abc:xyz"@test.example
12424abc\:xyz@test.example
12425.endd
12426the value of &$local_part$& is
12427.code
12428abc:xyz
12429.endd
12430If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
12431inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
12432have:
12433.code
12434data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
12435.endd
12436&*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
12437to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
12438&%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
12439
12440.vitem &$local_part_data$&
12441.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
12442When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
12443lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
12444router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
12445to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
12446handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
12447
12448&$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
12449matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
12450available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
12451variable expands to nothing.
12452
12453.vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
12454.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12455.cindex affix variables
12456When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12457specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12458variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12459
12460.vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
12461.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12462When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12463specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12464variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12465
12466.vitem &$local_scan_data$&
12467.vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
12468This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
12469a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
12470
12471.vitem &$local_user_gid$&
12472.vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
12473See &$local_user_uid$&.
12474
12475.vitem &$local_user_uid$&
12476.vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
12477This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
12478&%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
12479are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
12480and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
12481router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
12482are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
12483
12484.vitem &$localhost_number$&
12485.vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
12486This contains the expanded value of the
12487&%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
12488been read.
12489
12490.vitem &$log_inodes$&
12491.vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
12492The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
12493log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
12494referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
12495the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
12496
12497.vitem &$log_space$&
12498.vindex "&$log_space$&"
12499The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
12500partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
12501whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
12502ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
12503the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
12504
12505
12506.vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
12507.vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
12508This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
12509a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
12510.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12511It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
12512&"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
12513and &"yes"& if it was.
12514Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
12515the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
12516as authenticated data.
12517
12518.vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
12519.vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
12520This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
12521&(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
12522&%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
12523contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
12524without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
12525variable is empty.
12526
12527.vitem &$malware_name$&
12528.vindex "&$malware_name$&"
12529This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
12530content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
12531when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
12532
12533.vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
12534.vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
12535.cindex "maximum" "line length"
12536.cindex "line length" "maximum"
12537This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
12538received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
12539character(s).
12540It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12541
12542.vitem &$message_age$&
12543.cindex "message" "age of"
12544.vindex "&$message_age$&"
12545This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
12546of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
12547delivery attempt.
12548
12549.vitem &$message_body$&
12550.cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12551.cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12552.cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12553.vindex "&$message_body$&"
12554.oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
12555This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
12556being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
12557number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
12558&%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
12559
12560.oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
12561By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
12562easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
12563this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
12564zeros are always converted into spaces.
12565
12566.vitem &$message_body_end$&
12567.cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12568.cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12569.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
12570This variable contains the final portion of a message's
12571body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
12572&$message_body$&.
12573
12574.vitem &$message_body_size$&
12575.cindex "body of message" "size"
12576.cindex "message body" "size"
12577.vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
12578When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
12579in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
12580separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
12581also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12582
12583If the spool file is wireformat
12584(see the &%spool_files_wireformat%& main option)
12585the CRLF line-terminators are included in the count.
12586
12587.vitem &$message_exim_id$&
12588.vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
12589When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12590unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
12591An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
12592received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
12593line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
12594&`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
12595
12596.vitem &$message_headers$&
12597.vindex &$message_headers$&
12598This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
12599is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
12600lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
12601same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
12602
12603.vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
12604.vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
12605This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
12606contents of header lines is done.
12607
12608.vitem &$message_id$&
12609This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
12610
12611.vitem &$message_linecount$&
12612.vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
12613This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
12614message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
12615During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
12616number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
12617routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
12618&'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
12619lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
12620from the body is not counted.
12621
12622As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
12623appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
12624&$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
12625file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
12626header and the body).
12627
12628Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
12629.code
12630deny message = Too many lines in message header
12631 condition = \
12632 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
12633.endd
12634In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
12635message has not yet been received.
12636
12637This variable is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12638
12639.vitem &$message_size$&
12640.cindex "size" "of message"
12641.cindex "message" "size"
12642.vindex "&$message_size$&"
12643When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
12644most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
12645message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
12646deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
12647expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
12648doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
12649precise size of the file that has been written. See also
12650&$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12651
12652.cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
12653While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
12654contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
12655value may not, of course, be truthful.
12656
12657.vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
12658A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
12659available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
12660details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
12661
12662.vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
12663These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
12664of the &%add%& command in filter files.
12665
12666.vitem &$original_domain$&
12667.vindex "&$domain$&"
12668.vindex "&$original_domain$&"
12669When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12670same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
12671generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
12672variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
12673differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
12674aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
12675single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
12676
12677If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12678filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12679part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12680
12681.vitem &$original_local_part$&
12682.vindex "&$local_part$&"
12683.vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
12684When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12685same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
12686local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
12687part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
12688filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
12689the original address.
12690
12691If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
12692case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
12693This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
12694one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
12695delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
12696
12697If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12698filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12699part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12700
12701.vitem &$originator_gid$&
12702.cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
12703.cindex "sender" "gid"
12704.vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12705.vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
12706This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
12707message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
12708gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
12709normally the gid of the Exim user.
12710
12711.vitem &$originator_uid$&
12712.cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
12713.cindex "sender" "uid"
12714.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12715.vindex "&$originator_uid$&"
12716The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
12717messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
12718For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
12719user.
12720
12721.vitem &$parent_domain$&
12722.vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
12723This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
12724above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12725
12726.vitem &$parent_local_part$&
12727.vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
12728This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
12729(see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12730
12731.vitem &$pid$&
12732.cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
12733.vindex "&$pid$&"
12734This variable contains the current process id.
12735
12736.vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
12737.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12738.cindex "transport" "filter"
12739.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
12740This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
12741&`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
12742&(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
12743(described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
12744It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
12745variable"& error if encountered.
12746
12747.vitem &$primary_hostname$&
12748.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
12749This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
12750configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
12751a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
12752&[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
12753qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
12754
12755
12756.vitem &$proxy_external_address$& &&&
12757 &$proxy_external_port$& &&&
12758 &$proxy_local_address$& &&&
12759 &$proxy_local_port$& &&&
12760 &$proxy_session$&
12761These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol
12762or SOCKS5 support.
12763For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
12764
12765.vitem &$prdr_requested$&
12766.cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
12767This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
12768current message, otherwise &"no"&.
12769
12770.vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
12771This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12772which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12773&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12774
12775.vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
12776This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12777which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12778&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12779
12780.vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
12781This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12782which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12783&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12784
12785.vitem &$qualify_domain$&
12786.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12787The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
12788
12789.vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
12790.vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
12791The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
12792or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
12793
12794.vitem &$queue_name$&
12795.vindex &$queue_name$&
12796.cindex "named queues"
12797.cindex queues named
12798The name of the spool queue in use; empty for the default queue.
12799
12800.vitem &$r_...$&
12801.vindex &$r_...$&
12802.cindex router variables
12803Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& option of a router.
12804They can be given any name that starts with &$r_$&.
12805The values persist for the address being handled through subsequent routers
12806and the eventual transport.
12807
12808.vitem &$rcpt_count$&
12809.vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
12810When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12811RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
12812RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
12813
12814.vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
12815.vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
12816.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
12817When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12818RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12819temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
12820
12821.vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
12822.vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
12823When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12824RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12825permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
12826
12827.vitem &$received_count$&
12828.vindex "&$received_count$&"
12829This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
12830including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
12831is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
12832delivering.
12833
12834.vitem &$received_for$&
12835.vindex "&$received_for$&"
12836If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
12837variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
12838built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
12839the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
12840
12841.vitem &$received_ip_address$&
12842.vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
12843As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
12844variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
12845is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
12846&$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
12847the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
12848option.
12849
12850As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
12851could be used, for example, to make the filename for a TLS certificate depend
12852on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
12853values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
12854messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
12855time.
12856For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
12857
12858.vitem &$received_port$&
12859.vindex "&$received_port$&"
12860See &$received_ip_address$&.
12861
12862.vitem &$received_protocol$&
12863.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
12864When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
12865protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
12866by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
12867&"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
12868(encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
12869is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
12870connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
12871
12872Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
12873automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
12874&%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
12875encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
12876where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
12877STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
12878
12879The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
12880messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
12881identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
12882
12883.vitem &$received_time$&
12884.vindex "&$received_time$&"
12885This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
12886as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12887
12888.vitem &$recipient_data$&
12889.vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
12890This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
12891condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
12892until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
12893.display
12894&`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12895&`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
12896.endd
12897&*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12898method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12899The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12900expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12901
12902.vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
12903.vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
12904In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
12905information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
12906
12907.ilist
12908&"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
12909was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
12910
12911.next
12912&"route"&: Routing failed.
12913
12914.next
12915&"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
12916or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
12917MAIL).
12918
12919.next
12920&"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
12921.next
12922
12923&"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
12924.endlist
12925
12926The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
12927rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
12928
12929.vitem &$recipients$&
12930.vindex "&$recipients$&"
12931This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
12932a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
12933is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
12934unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
12935cases:
12936
12937.olist
12938In a system filter file.
12939.next
12940In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
12941is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
12942&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
12943&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
12944.next
12945From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
12946.endlist
12947
12948
12949.vitem &$recipients_count$&
12950.vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
12951When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
12952envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
12953from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
12954increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
12955
12956
12957.vitem &$regex_match_string$&
12958.vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
12959This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
12960&%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
12961
12962.vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
12963.cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
12964When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
12965these variables contain the
12966captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
12967
12968
12969.vitem &$reply_address$&
12970.vindex "&$reply_address$&"
12971When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
12972&'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
12973contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
12974white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
12975decoding or character code translation takes place.
12976
12977.vitem &$return_path$&
12978.vindex "&$return_path$&"
12979When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
12980the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
12981in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
12982same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
12983mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
12984for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
12985address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
12986that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
12987the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
12988envelope sender.
12989
12990.vitem &$return_size_limit$&
12991.vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
12992This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
12993
12994.vitem &$router_name$&
12995.cindex "router" "name"
12996.cindex "name" "of router"
12997.vindex "&$router_name$&"
12998During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
12999
13000.vitem &$runrc$&
13001.cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
13002.vindex "&$runrc$&"
13003This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
13004&%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
13005assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
13006preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
13007reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
13008another.
13009
13010.vitem &$self_hostname$&
13011.oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
13012.vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
13013When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
13014local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
13015One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
13016happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
13017original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
13018
13019.vitem &$sender_address$&
13020.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
13021When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
13022that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
13023is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
13024value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
13025
13026.vitem &$sender_address_data$&
13027.vindex "&$address_data$&"
13028.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
13029If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
13030sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
13031distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
13032after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
13033longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
13034
13035.vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
13036.vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
13037The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
13038
13039.vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
13040.vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
13041The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
13042
13043.vitem &$sender_data$&
13044.vindex "&$sender_data$&"
13045This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
13046in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
13047value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
13048this:
13049.display
13050&`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
13051&`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
13052.endd
13053&*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
13054method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
13055The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
13056expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
13057
13058.vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
13059.vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
13060When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
13061name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
13062brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
13063enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
13064issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
13065looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
13066&%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
13067start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
13068verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
13069the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
13070the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
13071
13072.vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
13073.vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
13074This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
13075.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13076done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
13077
13078.vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
13079.vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
13080When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
13081command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
13082set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
13083the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
13084
13085.vitem &$sender_host_address$&
13086.vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
13087When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
13088this variable contains that
13089host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
13090
13091.vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
13092.vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
13093This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
13094driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
13095received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
13096&$authenticated_id$&.
13097
13098.vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
13099.vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
13100If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
13101(by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
13102otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
13103resolver library states that both
13104the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
13105other times, this variable is false.
13106
13107.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13108It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
13109library, by setting:
13110.code
13111dns_dnssec_ok = 1
13112.endd
13113
13114Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
13115validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
13116
13117If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
13118mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
13119
13120This requires that your system resolver library support EDNS0 (and that
13121DNSSEC flags exist in the system headers). If the resolver silently drops
13122all EDNS0 options, then this will have no effect. OpenBSD's asr resolver
13123is known to currently ignore EDNS0, documented in CAVEATS of asr_run(3).
13124
13125
13126.vitem &$sender_host_name$&
13127.vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
13128When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13129host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
13130other means, this variable is empty.
13131
13132.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
13133If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
13134&$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
13135A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
13136via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
13137any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
13138&$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
13139
13140.vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
13141However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
13142DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
13143&$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
13144
13145Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
13146host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
13147in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
13148is set to &"1"&.
13149
13150Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
13151maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
13152these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
13153following are true:
13154
13155.ilist
13156A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
13157.next
13158The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
13159configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
13160to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
13161.next
13162Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
13163that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
13164&<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
13165.next
13166The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
13167In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
13168EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
13169.next
13170The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
13171domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
13172. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
13173. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
13174.code
13175 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
13176.endd
13177which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
13178IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
13179.endlist
13180
13181
13182.vitem &$sender_host_port$&
13183.vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
13184When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
13185number that was used on the remote host.
13186
13187.vitem &$sender_ident$&
13188.vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
13189When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13190identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
13191been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
13192called Exim.
13193
13194.vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
13195A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
13196&%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
13197&<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
13198
13199.vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
13200.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
13201.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
13202.vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
13203This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
13204either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
13205there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
13206there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
13207the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
13208followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
13209first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
13210the parentheses.
13211
13212There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
13213was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
13214address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
13215all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
13216into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
13217
13218.vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
13219.vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
13220In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
13221about the failure. The details are the same as for
13222&$recipient_verify_failure$&.
13223
13224.vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
13225.vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
13226This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13227been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
13228used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
13229on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
13230connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
13231
13232.vitem &$sending_port$&
13233.vindex "&$sending_port$&"
13234This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13235been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
13236connections, see &$received_port$&.
13237
13238.vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
13239.vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
13240During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
13241host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
13242&$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
13243value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
13244
13245.vitem &$smtp_command$&
13246.vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
13247During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
13248entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
13249the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
13250.code
13251MAIL FROM:<>
13252MAIL FROM: <>
13253.endd
13254For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
13255command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
13256rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
13257the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
13258
13259.vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
13260.cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
13261.vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
13262While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
13263argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
13264space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
13265somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
13266
13267.vitem &$smtp_command_history$&
13268.cindex SMTP "command history"
13269.vindex "&$smtp_command_history$&"
13270A comma-separated list (with no whitespace) of the most-recent SMTP commands
13271received, in time-order left to right. Only a limited number of commands
13272are remembered.
13273
13274.vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
13275.vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
13276This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
13277daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
13278in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
13279connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
13280the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
13281never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
13282there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
13283single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
13284daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
13285
13286.vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
13287These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
13288that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
13289filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
13290example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
13291message is junk mail.
13292
13293.vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
13294A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
13295is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
13296&<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
13297
13298.vitem &$spf_header_comment$& &&&
13299 &$spf_received$& &&&
13300 &$spf_result$& &&&
13301 &$spf_result_guessed$& &&&
13302 &$spf_smtp_comment$&
13303These variables are only available if Exim is built with SPF support.
13304For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
13305
13306.vitem &$spool_directory$&
13307.vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
13308The name of Exim's spool directory.
13309
13310.vitem &$spool_inodes$&
13311.vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
13312The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
13313being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
13314If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
13315is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
13316
13317.vitem &$spool_space$&
13318.vindex "&$spool_space$&"
13319The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
13320Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
13321variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
13322find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
13323value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
13324megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
13325.code
13326condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
13327.endd
13328See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
13329
13330
13331.vitem &$thisaddress$&
13332.vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
13333This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
13334command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
13335command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
13336interfaces to mail filtering'&.
13337
13338.vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
13339.vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
13340Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13341on the inbound connection; the meaning of
13342this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13343If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13344The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
13345when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
13346
13347The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
13348except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13349the outbound.
13350
13351.vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
13352.vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
13353Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13354on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
13355this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13356If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13357
13358.vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
13359.vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
13360.cindex certificate variables
13361This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13362inbound connection when the message was received.
13363It is only useful as the argument of a
13364&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13365or a &%def%& condition.
13366
13367&*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
13368when a list of more than one
13369file is used for &%tls_certificate%&, this variable is not reliable.
13370The macro "_TLS_BAD_MULTICERT_IN_OURCERT" will be defined for those versions.
13371
13372.vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
13373.vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
13374This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13375inbound connection when the message was received.
13376It is only useful as the argument of a
13377&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13378or a &%def%& condition.
13379If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13380which is not the leaf.
13381
13382.vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
13383.vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
13384This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13385outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13386&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13387or a &%def%& condition.
13388
13389.vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
13390.vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
13391This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13392outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13393&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13394or a &%def%& condition.
13395If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13396which is not the leaf.
13397
13398.vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
13399.vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
13400This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
13401message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
13402
13403The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
13404except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13405the outbound.
13406
13407.vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
13408.vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
13409This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
13410outbound SMTP connection was made,
13411and &"0"& otherwise.
13412
13413.vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
13414.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13415.vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
13416When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13417connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
13418example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
13419received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
13420&$tls_in_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
13421non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
13422
13423The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
13424but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
13425becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
13426
13427.vitem &$tls_in_cipher_std$&
13428.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher_std$&"
13429As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
13430
13431.vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
13432.vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
13433This variable is
13434cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
13435and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
13436&<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
13437details of the &(smtp)& transport.
13438
13439.vitem &$tls_out_cipher_std$&
13440.vindex "&$tls_out_cipher_std$&"
13441As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
13442
13443.vitem &$tls_out_dane$&
13444.vindex &$tls_out_dane$&
13445DANE active status. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13446
13447.vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
13448.vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
13449When a message is received from a remote client connection
13450the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
13451.code
134520 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
134531 No response to request
134542 Response not verified
134553 Verification failed
134564 Verification succeeded
13457.endd
13458
13459.vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
13460.vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
13461When a message is sent to a remote host connection
13462the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
13463See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
13464
13465.vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
13466.vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
13467.vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
13468.cindex certificate "extracting fields"
13469When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13470connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
13471the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13472&$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13473If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13474which is not the leaf.
13475
13476The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
13477except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13478the outbound.
13479
13480.vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
13481.vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
13482When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13483connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
13484the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13485&$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13486If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13487which is not the leaf.
13488
13489.vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
13490.vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
13491.vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
13492.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13493When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
13494Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
13495If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
13496some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
13497will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
13498a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
13499used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
13500
13501The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
13502except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13503the outbound.
13504
13505.vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
13506.vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
13507.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13508During outbound
13509SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
13510the transport.
13511
13512.vitem &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13513.vindex &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13514Bitfield of TLSA record types found. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13515
13516.vitem &$tls_in_ver$&
13517.vindex "&$tls_in_ver$&"
13518When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP connection
13519this variable is set to the protocol version, eg &'TLS1.2'&.
13520
13521.vitem &$tls_out_ver$&
13522.vindex "&$tls_out_ver$&"
13523When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP connection
13524this variable is set to the protocol version.
13525
13526
13527.vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
13528.vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
13529The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
13530files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
13531
13532.vitem &$tod_epoch$&
13533.vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
13534The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13535
13536.vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
13537.vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
13538The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13539
13540.vitem &$tod_full$&
13541.vindex "&$tod_full$&"
13542A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
13543+0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
13544positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
13545values for those that are behind (west).
13546
13547.vitem &$tod_log$&
13548.vindex "&$tod_log$&"
13549The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
135501995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
13551
13552.vitem &$tod_logfile$&
13553.vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
13554This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
13555is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
13556flag.
13557
13558.vitem &$tod_zone$&
13559.vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
13560This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
13561-0500.
13562
13563.vitem &$tod_zulu$&
13564.vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
13565This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
13566by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
13567
13568.vitem &$transport_name$&
13569.cindex "transport" "name"
13570.cindex "name" "of transport"
13571.vindex "&$transport_name$&"
13572During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
13573
13574.vitem &$value$&
13575.vindex "&$value$&"
13576This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
13577or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
13578&*reduce*& expansion.
13579
13580.vitem &$verify_mode$&
13581.vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
13582While a router or transport is being run in verify mode or for cutthrough delivery,
13583contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
13584Otherwise, empty.
13585
13586.vitem &$version_number$&
13587.vindex "&$version_number$&"
13588The version number of Exim. Same as &$exim_version$&, may be overridden
13589by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
13590
13591.vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
13592.vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
13593This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13594delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13595
13596.vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
13597.vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
13598This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13599delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13600.endlist
13601.ecindex IIDstrexp
13602
13603
13604
13605. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13606. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13607
13608.chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
13609.scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
13610Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
13611Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
13612use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
13613your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
13614the line
13615.code
13616EXIM_PERL = perl.o
13617.endd
13618in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
13619
13620
13621.section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
13622.oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
13623Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
13624&%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
13625no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
13626interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
13627the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
13628option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
13629a newly created Perl interpreter.
13630
13631The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
13632need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
13633should usually be something like
13634.code
13635perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
13636.endd
13637where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
13638use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
13639soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
13640the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
13641its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
13642fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
13643necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
13644the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
13645two ways:
13646
13647.ilist
13648.oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
13649Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
13650a startup when Exim is entered.
13651.next
13652The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
13653overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
13654.endlist
13655
13656There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
13657initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
13658
13659.ilist
13660.oindex "&%perl_taintmode%&"
13661.cindex "Perl" "taintmode"
13662To provide more security executing Perl code via the embedded Perl
13663interpreter, the &%perl_taintmode%& option can be set. This enables the
13664taint mode of the Perl interpreter. You are encouraged to set this
13665option to a true value. To avoid breaking existing installations, it
13666defaults to false.
13667
13668
13669.section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
13670When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
13671of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
13672by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
13673forms:
13674.code
13675${perl{foo}}
13676${perl{foo}{argument}}
13677${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
13678.endd
13679which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
13680arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
13681with an error message of the form
13682.code
13683Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
13684.endd
13685The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
13686it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
13687return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
13688an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
13689by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
13690that was passed to &%die%&.
13691
13692
13693.section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
13694Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
13695is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
13696the Perl code
13697.code
13698my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
13699.endd
13700makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
13701Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
13702&$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
13703
13704If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
13705&'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
13706expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
13707an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
13708
13709.cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
13710.cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
13711Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
13712&'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
13713debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
13714&'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
13715timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
13716
13717
13718.section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
13719.cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
13720You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
13721Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
13722before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
13723SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
13724is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
13725error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
13726avoided, but the output is lost.
13727
13728.cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
13729The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
13730Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
13731you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
13732output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
13733change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
13734For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
13735.code
13736$SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
13737.endd
13738Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
13739example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
13740include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
13741as the first subroutine argument.
13742.ecindex IIDperl
13743
13744
13745. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13746. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13747
13748.chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
13749 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
13750 "Starting the daemon"
13751.cindex "daemon" "starting"
13752.cindex "interface" "listening"
13753.cindex "network interface"
13754.cindex "interface" "network"
13755.cindex "IP address" "for listening"
13756.cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
13757.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
13758.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13759A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
13760hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
13761or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
13762works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
13763In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
13764IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
13765knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
13766
13767.olist
13768When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
13769and ports to listen on.
13770.next
13771When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
13772are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
13773processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
13774same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
13775when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
13776local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
13777option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
13778as an error situation.
13779.next
13780When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
13781for the outgoing connection.
13782.endlist
13783
13784
13785Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
13786of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
13787addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
13788standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
13789rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
13790
13791In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
13792interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
13793options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
13794chapter describes how they operate.
13795
13796When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
13797actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
13798
13799
13800
13801.section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
13802When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
13803option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
13804following options:
13805
13806.ilist
13807&%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
13808or service names.
13809(For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
13810.next
13811&%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
13812listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
13813.endlist
13814
13815The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
13816described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
13817it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
13818colons. For example:
13819.code
13820local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
13821 192.168.23.65 ; \
13822 ::1 ; \
13823 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
13824.endd
13825There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
13826in &%local_interfaces%&:
13827
13828.olist
13829The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
13830on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
13831.code
13832local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
13833 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
13834.endd
13835.next
13836The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
13837with a colon separator, for example:
13838.code
13839local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
13840 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
13841.endd
13842.endlist
13843
13844When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
13845default setting contains just one port:
13846.code
13847daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13848.endd
13849If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
13850specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
13851&%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
13852&_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
13853IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
13854
13855
13856
13857.section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
13858The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
13859as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
13860case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
13861instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
13862default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13863.code
13864local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13865.endd
13866when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
13867.code
13868local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13869.endd
13870Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
13871
13872
13873
13874.section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
13875The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
13876&%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
13877instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
13878option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
13879the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
13880exim.
13881
13882The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
13883changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) if required.
13884If there are any items that do not
13885contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
13886&%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
13887items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13888replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
13889.code
13890-oX 1225
13891.endd
13892overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
13893whereas
13894.code
13895-oX 192.168.34.5.1125
13896.endd
13897overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
13898(However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
13899value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
13900
13901
13902
13903.section "Support for the submissions (aka SSMTP or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
13904.cindex "submissions protocol"
13905.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
13906.cindex "smtps protocol"
13907.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
13908.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
13909Exim supports the use of TLS-on-connect, used by mail clients in the
13910&"submissions"& protocol, historically also known as SMTPS or SSMTP.
13911For some years, IETF Standards Track documents only blessed the
13912STARTTLS-based Submission service (port 587) while common practice was to support
13913the same feature set on port 465, but using TLS-on-connect.
13914If your installation needs to provide service to mail clients
13915(Mail User Agents, MUAs) then you should provide service on both the 587 and
13916the 465 TCP ports.
13917
13918If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a list of port numbers or
13919service names, connections to those ports must first establish TLS, before
13920proceeding to the application layer use of the SMTP protocol.
13921
13922The common use of this option is expected to be
13923.code
13924tls_on_connect_ports = 465
13925.endd
13926per RFC 8314.
13927There is also a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports
13928to behave in this way when a daemon is started.
13929
13930&*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
13931daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
13932&%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
13933because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
13934connections via the daemon.)
13935
13936
13937
13938
13939.section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
13940.cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
13941IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
13942can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
13943interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
13944address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
13945percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
13946adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
13947.code
13948fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
13949.endd
13950To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
13951allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
13952to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
13953percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
13954address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
13955&[getaddrinfo()]&. If
13956.code
13957IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
13958.endd
13959is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
13960Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
13961instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
13962function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
13963&[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
13964
13965.section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
13966.cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13967Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
13968run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
13969using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
13970connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
13971.oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
13972&%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13973activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13974that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
13975etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13976to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13977
13978On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
13979disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
13980option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
13981and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
13982IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
13983
13984
13985
13986.section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
13987The default case in an IPv6 environment is
13988.code
13989daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13990local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13991.endd
13992This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
13993Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
13994the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
13995read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
13996
13997To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
13998.code
13999daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
14000.endd
14001(leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
14002.code
14003local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
14004 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
14005.endd
14006To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
14007IPv4 loopback address only:
14008.code
14009local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
14010.endd
14011To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
14012.code
14013local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
14014.endd
14015&*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
14016
14017
14018
14019.section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
14020The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
14021whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
14022addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
14023treated as local.
14024
14025For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
14026the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
14027available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
14028(that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
14029
14030Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
14031many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
14032email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
14033interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
14034&%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
14035&"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
14036used for listening. Consider this example:
14037.code
14038local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
14039 192.168.53.235 ; \
14040 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
14041
14042extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14043.endd
14044The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
14045address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
14046Exim is routing.
14047
14048In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
14049address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
14050desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
14051these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
14052This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
14053during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
14054host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
14055addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
14056
14057
14058
14059.section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
14060Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
14061allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
14062there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
14063&%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
14064description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
14065details.
14066
14067
14068
14069
14070. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14071. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14072
14073.chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
14074.scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
14075.scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
14076The first part of the runtime configuration file contains three types of item:
14077
14078.ilist
14079Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
14080&<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
14081.next
14082Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
14083&"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
14084section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
14085.next
14086Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
14087(with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
14088&"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
14089only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
14090settings.
14091.endlist
14092
14093This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
14094types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
14095in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
14096are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
14097an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
14098listed in more than one group.
14099
14100.section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
14101.table2
14102.row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
14103.row &%debug_store%& "do extra internal checks"
14104.row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14105.row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
14106.row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
14107.row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
14108.row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
14109.row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
14110.row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
14111.row &%spool_wireformat%& "use wire-format spool data files when possible"
14112.row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
14113.endtable
14114
14115
14116.section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
14117.table2
14118.row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
14119.row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14120.row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
14121.row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
14122.row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
14123.row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
14124.endtable
14125
14126
14127
14128.section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
14129.table2
14130.row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
14131.row &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& "require admin for various checks"
14132.row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
14133.row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
14134.row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14135.row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14136.row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
14137.row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
14138.row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
14139.row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
14140.row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
14141.row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
14142.endtable
14143
14144
14145
14146.section "Logging" "SECID99"
14147.table2
14148.row &%event_action%& "custom logging"
14149.row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
14150.row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14151.row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
14152.row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
14153.row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
14154.row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
14155.row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
14156.row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
14157.row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
14158.row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
14159.row &%syslog_pid%& "pid in syslog lines"
14160.row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
14161.row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
14162.row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
14163.endtable
14164
14165
14166
14167.section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
14168.table2
14169.row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
14170.row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
14171.row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
14172.row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
14173.endtable
14174
14175
14176
14177.section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
14178.table2
14179.row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
14180.row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14181.row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14182.row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
14183.row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
14184.row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
14185.row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
14186.row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
14187.row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
14188.row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
14189.row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
14190.row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
14191.row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
14192.row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
14193.row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
14194.endtable
14195
14196
14197
14198.section "Message ids" "SECID102"
14199.table2
14200.row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
14201.row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
14202.endtable
14203
14204
14205
14206.section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
14207.table2
14208.row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
14209.row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
14210.row &%perl_taintmode%& "enable taint mode in Perl"
14211.endtable
14212
14213
14214
14215.section "Daemon" "SECID104"
14216.table2
14217.row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
14218.row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
14219.row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
14220.row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
14221.row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
14222.row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14223.row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14224.endtable
14225
14226
14227
14228.section "Resource control" "SECID105"
14229.table2
14230.row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14231.row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
14232.row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14233.row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
14234.row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
14235.row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
14236.row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14237.row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14238.row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14239.row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14240.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14241.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14242.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14243.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14244.row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14245.row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14246 connection"
14247.row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14248.row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14249.row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14250.row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
14251.row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14252.endtable
14253
14254
14255
14256.section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
14257.table2
14258.row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
14259.row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
14260.row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
14261.row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
14262.row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
14263.row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
14264.row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
14265.row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
14266.row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
14267.row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
14268.row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
14269.row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
14270.row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
14271.row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
14272.row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
14273.row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
14274.row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
14275.row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
14276.row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
14277.row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
14278.row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
14279.row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14280 words""&"
14281.row &%dns_cname_loops%& "follow CNAMEs returned by resolver"
14282.row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
14283.row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
14284.row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14285.row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14286.row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
14287.row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
14288.row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
14289.row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
14290.row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
14291.row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14292.row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14293.row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
14294.row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
14295.row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
14296.row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
14297.row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
14298.row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14299.row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
14300.row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
14301.endtable
14302
14303
14304
14305.section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
14306.table2
14307.row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
14308 item"
14309.row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
14310 item"
14311.row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
14312.row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
14313.row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
14314.endtable
14315
14316
14317
14318.section "TLS" "SECID108"
14319.table2
14320.row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
14321.row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
14322.row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
14323.row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14324.row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
14325.row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
14326.row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
14327.row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
14328.row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
14329.row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
14330.row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
14331.row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
14332.row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
14333.row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
14334.row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
14335.row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
14336.row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
14337.endtable
14338
14339
14340
14341.section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
14342.table2
14343.row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
14344.row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
14345.row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
14346.row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
14347.row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
14348.row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
14349.row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
14350.row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
14351.endtable
14352
14353
14354
14355.section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
14356.table2
14357.row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14358.row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14359.row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
14360.row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14361.row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
14362.row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
14363.row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
14364.row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
14365.endtable
14366
14367
14368
14369
14370.section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
14371.table2
14372.row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
14373.endtable
14374
14375
14376
14377
14378
14379.section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
14380See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
14381
14382.table2
14383.row &%dkim_verify_hashes%& "DKIM hash methods accepted for signatures"
14384.row &%dkim_verify_keytypes%& "DKIM key types accepted for signatures"
14385.row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domains for which DKIM ACL is run"
14386.row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14387.row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14388.row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
14389.row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
14390.row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
14391.row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
14392.row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
14393.row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14394.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14395.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14396.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14397.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14398.row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14399.row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14400 connection"
14401.row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14402.row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
14403.row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
14404.row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14405.row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14406.row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
14407.row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
14408.row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
14409.row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
14410.row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
14411.row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
14412.row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
14413.row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
14414.row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
14415.row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14416.row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14417.endtable
14418
14419
14420
14421.section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
14422.table2
14423.row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
14424.row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
14425.row &%chunking_advertise_hosts%& "advertise CHUNKING to these hosts"
14426.row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
14427.row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
14428.row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
14429.row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14430.row &%pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14431.row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
14432.row &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& "advertise SMTPUTF8 to these hosts"
14433.row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14434.endtable
14435
14436
14437
14438.section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
14439.table2
14440.row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
14441.row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
14442.row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
14443.row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14444 words""&"
14445.row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14446.row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14447.row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
14448.row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
14449.row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
14450.row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
14451.row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14452.row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
14453.row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
14454.row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
14455.endtable
14456
14457
14458
14459.section "System filter" "SECID115"
14460.table2
14461.row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
14462.row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
14463 directory"
14464.row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
14465.row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
14466.row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
14467.row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
14468.row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
14469.endtable
14470
14471
14472
14473.section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
14474.table2
14475.row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14476.row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
14477.row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
14478.row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
14479.row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
14480.row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
14481.row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
14482.row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
14483.row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
14484.row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
14485.row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
14486.row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
14487.row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
14488.row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
14489.row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
14490.row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14491.row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
14492.row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
14493.row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
14494.row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
14495.row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14496.row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
14497.row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
14498.row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
14499.endtable
14500
14501
14502
14503.section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
14504.table2
14505.row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
14506.row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
14507.row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
14508.row &%bounce_return_linesize_limit%& "limit on returned message line length"
14509.row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
14510.row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
14511.row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
14512.row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
14513.row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
14514.row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
14515.row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
14516.row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
14517.row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
14518.row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14519.row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
14520.endtable
14521
14522
14523
14524.section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
14525Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
14526&dagger;.
14527
14528.option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
14529.cindex "8BITMIME"
14530.cindex "8-bit characters"
14531.cindex "log" "selectors"
14532.cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
14533This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
14534EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
14535However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
14536takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
14537
14538Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
14539feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
14540It now defaults to true.
14541A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
14542.display
14543&url(https://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
14544.endd
14545
14546To log received 8BITMIME status use
14547.code
14548log_selector = +8bitmime
14549.endd
14550
14551.option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
14552.cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
14553.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14554This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
14555read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14556further details.
14557
14558.option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14559This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
14560messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
14561SMTP messages.
14562
14563.option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
14564.cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
14565.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14566This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
14567non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14568
14569.option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
14570.cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
14571.cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
14572This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
14573received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14574
14575.option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
14576.cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
14577This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
14578See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14579
14580.option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
14581.cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
14582This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
14583processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
14584acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14585
14586.option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
14587.cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
14588.cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
14589.cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
14590.cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
14591This option defines the ACL that,
14592if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
14593is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
14594processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
14595acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14596
14597.option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
14598.cindex DKIM "ACL for"
14599This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
14600(by default, or as specified in the dkim_verify_signers option)
14601of a received message.
14602See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>& for further details.
14603
14604.option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
14605.cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
14606This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
14607received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14608
14609.option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
14610.cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
14611This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
14612received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14613
14614.option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
14615.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
14616.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
14617This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
14618command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14619
14620
14621.option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
14622.cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
14623This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
14624received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14625
14626.option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
14627.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
14628This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
14629a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
14630&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
14631
14632.option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14633.cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
14634This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
14635extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
14636section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
14637
14638.option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
14639.cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
14640This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
14641ends without a QUIT command being received.
14642See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14643
14644.option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
14645This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
14646received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14647further details.
14648
14649.option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
14650.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
14651This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
14652received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14653
14654.option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
14655.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
14656This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
14657received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14658
14659.option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
14660.cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
14661This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
14662received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14663
14664.option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
14665.cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
14666This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
14667received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14668
14669.option add_environment main "string list" empty
14670.cindex "environment" "set values"
14671This option adds individual environment variables that the
14672currently linked libraries and programs in child processes may use.
14673Each list element should be of the form &"name=value"&.
14674
14675See &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the environment of &(pipe)& transports.
14676
14677.option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
14678.cindex "admin user"
14679This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
14680current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
14681colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
14682programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
14683admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
14684not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
14685To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
14686
14687.option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
14688.cindex "domain literal"
14689If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
14690email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
14691format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
14692has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
14693
14694Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
14695format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
14696addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
14697&%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
14698domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
14699configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
14700the local host's IP addresses.
14701
14702
14703.option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
14704.cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
14705It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
14706and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
14707MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
14708that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
14709practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
14710&%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
14711recommended, except when you have no other choice.
14712
14713.option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
14714.cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
14715.cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
14716Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
14717camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
14718that at least two other MTAs permit this.
14719This option allows Exim users to experiment if they wish.
14720
14721If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
14722UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
14723letters, digits, and hyphens.
14724
14725If Exim is built with internationalization support
14726and the SMTPUTF8 ESMTP option is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>&)
14727this option can be left as default.
14728Without that,
14729if you want to look up such domain names in the DNS, you must also
14730adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
14731suitable setting is:
14732.code
14733dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
14734 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
14735.endd
14736Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
14737.code
14738dns_check_names_pattern =
14739.endd
14740That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
14741
14742
14743.option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14744.cindex "authentication" "advertising"
14745.cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
14746If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
14747response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
14748Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
14749Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
14750advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
14751authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
14752&%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
14753authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
14754
14755Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
14756and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
14757not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
14758authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
14759to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
14760which Exim advertises AUTH.
14761
14762.cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
14763If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
14764is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
14765option is expanded, with a setting like this:
14766.code
14767auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
14768.endd
14769.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
14770If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
14771the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
14772expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
14773
14774
14775.option auto_thaw main time 0s
14776.cindex "thawing messages"
14777.cindex "unfreezing messages"
14778If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
14779new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
14780this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
14781being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
14782saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
14783
14784&*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
14785&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
14786thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
14787
14788
14789.option av_scanner main string "see below"
14790This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
14791It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
14792.code
14793sophie:/var/run/sophie
14794.endd
14795If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
14796before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
14797
14798
14799.option bi_command main string unset
14800.oindex "&%-bi%&"
14801This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
14802the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
14803just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
14804required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
14805
14806
14807.option bounce_message_file main string unset
14808.cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
14809.cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
14810This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
14811for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
14812chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
14813
14814
14815.option bounce_message_text main string unset
14816When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
14817message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
14818delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
14819
14820.option bounce_return_body main boolean true
14821.cindex "bounce message" "including body"
14822This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
14823bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
14824causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
14825value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
14826message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
14827error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
14828point at which the error was detected are returned.
14829.cindex "bounce message" "including original"
14830
14831.option bounce_return_linesize_limit main integer 998
14832.cindex "size" "of bounce lines, limit"
14833.cindex "bounce message" "line length limit"
14834.cindex "limit" "bounce message line length"
14835This option sets a limit in bytes on the line length of messages
14836that are returned to senders due to delivery problems,
14837when &%bounce_return_message%& is true.
14838The default value corresponds to RFC limits.
14839If the message being returned has lines longer than this value it is
14840treated as if the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& (below) restriction was exceeded.
14841
14842The option also applies to bounces returned when an error is detected
14843during reception of a message.
14844In this case lines from the original are truncated.
14845
14846The option does not apply to messages generated by an &(autoreply)& transport.
14847
14848
14849.option bounce_return_message main boolean true
14850If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
14851bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
14852&%bounce_return_body%&.
14853
14854
14855.option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
14856.cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
14857.cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
14858.cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
14859This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
14860senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
14861limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
14862any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
14863that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
14864
14865When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
14866greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
14867added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
14868to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
14869size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
14870messages.
14871
14872.option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
14873.cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
14874.cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
14875.cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
14876This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
14877bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
14878connection. A typical setting might be:
14879.code
14880bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14881.endd
14882which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
14883.code
14884MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14885.endd
14886The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
14887address.
14888
14889.option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
14890.cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
14891.cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
14892This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
14893domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14894section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14895
14896
14897.option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
14898This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
14899domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14900section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14901
14902
14903.option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
14904This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
14905address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14906section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14907
14908
14909.option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
14910This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
14911address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14912section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14913
14914
14915.option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
14916This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
14917callout verification. The default value is
14918.code
14919$primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
14920.endd
14921See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
14922
14923
14924.option check_log_inodes main integer 100
14925See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14926
14927
14928.option check_log_space main integer 10M
14929See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14930
14931.oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
14932.cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
14933.option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
14934RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
14935system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
14936word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
14937multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
14938exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
14939of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
14940set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
14941
14942
14943.option check_spool_inodes main integer 100
14944See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14945
14946
14947.option check_spool_space main integer 10M
14948.cindex "checking disk space"
14949.cindex "disk space, checking"
14950.cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14951The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
14952message is accepted.
14953
14954.vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
14955.vindex "&$log_space$&"
14956.vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
14957.vindex "&$spool_space$&"
14958When any of these options are nonzero, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
14959want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
14960testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
14961&$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
14962
14963
14964&%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
14965either value is greater than zero, for example:
14966.code
14967check_spool_space = 100M
14968check_spool_inodes = 100
14969.endd
14970The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
14971SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
14972transit.
14973
14974&%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
14975files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
14976&%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
14977
14978If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
14979incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
14980error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
14981SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
14982&%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
14983&%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
14984
14985The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
14986number of kilobytes (though specified in bytes).
14987If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
14988
14989For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
14990failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
14991it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
14992
14993There is a slight performance penalty for these checks.
14994Versions of Exim preceding 4.88 had these disabled by default;
14995high-rate installations confident they will never run out of resources
14996may wish to deliberately disable them.
14997
14998.option chunking_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14999.cindex CHUNKING advertisement
15000.cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
15001The CHUNKING extension (RFC3030) will be advertised in the EHLO message to
15002these hosts.
15003Hosts may use the BDAT command as an alternate to DATA.
15004
15005.option commandline_checks_require_admin main boolean &`false`&
15006.cindex "restricting access to features"
15007This option restricts various basic checking features to require an
15008administrative user.
15009This affects most of the &%-b*%& options, such as &%-be%&.
15010
15011.option debug_store main boolean &`false`&
15012.cindex debugging "memory corruption"
15013.cindex memory debugging
15014This option, when true, enables extra checking in Exim's internal memory
15015management. For use when a memory corruption issue is being investigated,
15016it should normally be left as default.
15017
15018.option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
15019.cindex "port" "for daemon"
15020.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
15021This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
15022listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
15023backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
15024
15025.option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
15026.cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
15027This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
15028the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
15029(typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
15030defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
15031&%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
15032
15033.option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
15034See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
15035
15036.option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
15037.cindex "warning of delay"
15038.cindex "delay warning, specifying"
15039.cindex "queue" "delay warning"
15040When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
15041intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
15042after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
15043string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
15044message has been in the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
15045between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
15046with
15047.code
15048delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
15049.endd
15050the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
15051the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
15052because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
15053just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
15054.code
15055delay_warning = 6h
15056.endd
15057messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
15058a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
15059.code
15060delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
15061.endd
15062Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
15063which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
15064Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
15065
15066.option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
15067.vindex "&$domain$&"
15068The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
15069deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
15070expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
15071forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
15072&"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
15073not sent. The default is:
15074.code
15075delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
15076 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
15077 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
15078 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
15079 } {no}{yes}}
15080.endd
15081This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
15082&'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
15083&"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
15084&"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
15085
15086.option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
15087.cindex "unprivileged delivery"
15088.cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
15089If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
15090delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
15091the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
15092of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
15093chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
15094
15095.option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
15096.cindex "load average"
15097.cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
15098When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
15099becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
15100ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
15101See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15102
15103
15104.option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
15105.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
15106Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
15107message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15108handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
15109should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
15110removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
15111occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15112
15113.option disable_fsync main boolean false
15114.cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
15115This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
15116ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
15117a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
15118build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
15119really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
15120distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
15121
15122When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
15123updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
15124such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
15125Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
15126
15127
15128.option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
15129.cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
15130If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
15131activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
15132that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
15133etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
15134to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
15135
15136
15137.new
15138.option dkim_verify_hashes main "string list" "sha256 : sha512"
15139.cindex DKIM "selecting signature algorithms"
15140This option gives a list of hash types which are acceptable in signatures,
15141.wen
15142and an order of processing.
15143Signatures with algorithms not in the list will be ignored.
15144
15145Acceptable values include:
15146.code
15147sha1
15148sha256
15149sha512
15150.endd
15151
15152Note that the acceptance of sha1 violates RFC 8301.
15153
15154.option dkim_verify_keytypes main "string list" "ed25519 : rsa"
15155This option gives a list of key types which are acceptable in signatures,
15156and an order of processing.
15157Signatures with algorithms not in the list will be ignored.
15158
15159.option dkim_verify_minimal main boolean false
15160If set to true, verification of signatures will terminate after the
15161first success.
15162
15163.option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
15164.cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
15165This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
15166It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
15167the ACL once for each signature in the message.
15168See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
15169
15170
15171.option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
15172.cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
15173DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
15174&"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
15175keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
15176incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
15177may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
15178anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
15179This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
15180by a setting such as this:
15181.code
15182dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
15183.endd
15184This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
15185&[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
15186since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
15187&(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
15188when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
15189options are applied after this global option.
15190
15191.option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
15192.cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
15193When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
15194names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
15195the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
15196contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
15197a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
15198done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
15199value of this option. The default pattern is
15200.code
15201dns_check_names_pattern = \
15202 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
15203.endd
15204which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
15205they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
15206permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
15207accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
15208&%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
15209empty string.
15210
15211.option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
15212This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
15213DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15214
15215.option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
15216This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
15217reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
15218section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15219
15220.option dns_cname_loops main integer 1
15221.cindex DNS "CNAME following"
15222This option controls the following of CNAME chains, needed if the resolver does
15223not do it internally.
15224As of 2018 most should, and the default can be left.
15225If you have an ancient one, a value of 10 is likely needed.
15226
15227The default value of one CNAME-follow is needed
15228thanks to the observed return for an MX request,
15229given no MX presence but a CNAME to an A, of the CNAME.
15230
15231
15232.option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
15233.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15234.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15235If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15236DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
15237default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
15238
15239If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
15240
15241
15242.option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
15243.cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
15244.cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
15245.cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
15246When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
15247looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
15248(A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
15249domain matches this list.
15250
15251This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
15252not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
15253servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
15254Note that all lookups, including those done for verification, are affected;
15255this will result in verify failure for IPv6 connections or ones using names
15256only valid for IPv6 addresses.
15257
15258
15259.option dns_retrans main time 0s
15260.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15261.cindex timeout "dns lookup"
15262.cindex "DNS" timeout
15263The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
15264retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
15265defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
15266time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
15267totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
15268take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
15269parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
15270but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
15271to set in them.
15272See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
15273
15274
15275.option dns_retry main integer 0
15276See &%dns_retrans%& above.
15277
15278
15279.option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
15280.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15281.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15282If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
15283(Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
15284DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
15285match with this expanded domain list.
15286
15287Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
15288authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
15289bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
15290mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
15291Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
15292a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
15293
15294Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
15295to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
15296zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
15297
15298If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
15299in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
15300authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
15301authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
15302record in the authoritative section is used instead.
15303
15304.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15305.option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
15306.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15307.cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
15308.cindex "DNS" "OpenBSD
15309If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15310DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
15311the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
15312on.
15313
15314If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
15315
15316OpenBSD's asr resolver routines are known to ignore the EDNS0 option; this
15317means that DNSSEC will not work with Exim on that platform either, unless Exim
15318is linked against an alternative DNS client library.
15319
15320
15321.option drop_cr main boolean false
15322This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
15323handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
15324described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
15325
15326.option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15327.cindex "bounce messages" "success"
15328.cindex "DSN" "success"
15329.cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
15330DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
15331and accepted from, these hosts.
15332Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
15333and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
15334A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
15335A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
15336are sent.
15337
15338.option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
15339.cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
15340.cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
15341This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
15342bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
15343Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
15344.code
15345dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
15346.endd
15347The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
15348panic is logged, and the default value is used.
15349
15350.option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
15351.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
15352Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
15353message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15354handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
15355message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
15356be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
15357the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
15358delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15359
15360
15361.option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
15362.cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
15363.cindex "copy of bounce message"
15364Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
15365generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
15366coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
15367items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
15368a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
15369must be enclosed in double quotes.
15370
15371Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
15372(see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
15373the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
15374items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
15375are examined. For example:
15376.code
15377errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
15378 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
15379 postmaster@mydomain.example
15380.endd
15381.vindex "&$domain$&"
15382.vindex "&$local_part$&"
15383The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
15384and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
15385there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
15386.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
15387variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
15388
15389
15390.option errors_reply_to main string unset
15391.cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
15392By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
15393.display
15394&`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
15395.endd
15396.oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
15397where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
15398A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
15399&(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
15400overrides the default.
15401
15402Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
15403&%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
15404and warning messages. For example:
15405.code
15406errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
15407.endd
15408The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
15409address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
15410&%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
15411own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
15412not used.
15413
15414
15415.option event_action main string&!! unset
15416.cindex events
15417This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
15418For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
15419
15420
15421.option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
15422.cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
15423.cindex "Exim group"
15424This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15425privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
15426option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
15427of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
15428configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
15429security issues.
15430
15431
15432.option exim_path main string "see below"
15433.cindex "Exim binary, path name"
15434This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
15435needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
15436the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
15437is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
15438other place.
15439&*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
15440you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
15441where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
15442settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
15443
15444
15445.option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
15446.cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
15447.cindex "Exim user"
15448This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15449privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
15450time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
15451options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
15452
15453Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
15454&[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
15455not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
15456used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
15457
15458
15459.option exim_version main string "current version"
15460.cindex "Exim version"
15461.cindex customizing "version number"
15462.cindex "version number of Exim" override
15463This option overrides the &$version_number$&/&$exim_version$& that Exim reports in
15464various places. Use with care; this may fool stupid security scanners.
15465
15466
15467.option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
15468This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
15469routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
15470&<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
15471
15472
15473. Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15474. for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15475
15476.option "extract_addresses_remove_arguments" main boolean true &&&
15477 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
15478.oindex "&%-t%&"
15479.cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
15480.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
15481According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
15482are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
15483envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
15484line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
15485behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
15486command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
15487&%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
15488argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
15489addresses.
15490
15491
15492.option finduser_retries main integer 0
15493.cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
15494On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
15495distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
15496related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
15497Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
15498errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
15499many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
15500retries.
15501
15502.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
15503You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
15504a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
15505search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
15506
15507
15508
15509.option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
15510.cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
15511On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
15512ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
15513delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
15514&%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
15515feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
15516warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
15517freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
15518is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
15519supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
15520message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
15521freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
15522log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
15523logging that you require.
15524
15525
15526.option gecos_name main string&!! unset
15527.cindex "HP-UX"
15528.cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
15529Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
15530password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
15531looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
15532headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
15533of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
15534it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
15535upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
15536
15537When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
15538expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
15539login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
15540user's name.
15541
15542.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
15543Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
15544pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
15545name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
15546.code
15547gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
15548gecos_name = $1
15549.endd
15550
15551.option gecos_pattern main string unset
15552See &%gecos_name%& above.
15553
15554
15555.option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
15556This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
15557server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
15558implementations of TLS.
15559
15560
15561.option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
15562This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
15563the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
15564
15565See
15566&url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
15567for documentation.
15568
15569
15570
15571.option headers_charset main string "see below"
15572This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
15573&"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
15574default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
15575ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
15576insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
15577
15578
15579
15580.option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
15581.cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
15582.cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
15583This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
15584section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
15585&_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
15586sections are rejected.
15587
15588
15589.option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
15590.cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
15591.cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
15592This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
15593all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
15594header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
15595zero means &"no limit"&.
15596
15597
15598
15599
15600.option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15601.cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
15602.cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
15603Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
15604mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
15605some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
15606this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
15607if you want to do semantic checking.
15608See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
15609set.
15610
15611
15612.option helo_allow_chars main string unset
15613.cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
15614.cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
15615.cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
15616This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
15617all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
15618hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
15619.code
15620helo_allow_chars = _
15621.endd
15622Note that the value is one string, not a list.
15623
15624
15625.option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
15626.cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15627.cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15628If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
15629list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
15630default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
15631its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
15632do.
15633
15634
15635.option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15636.cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
15637.cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
15638By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
15639&%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
15640to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
15641condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
15642Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
15643to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
15644necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
15645encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
15646Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
15647
15648When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
15649&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
15650EHLO command either:
15651
15652.ilist
15653is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
15654.next
15655.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
15656.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
15657matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
15658calling host address, or
15659.next
15660when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
15661.endlist
15662
15663However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
15664fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
15665be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
15666
15667If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
15668.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15669&$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
15670
15671.option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15672.cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
15673.cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
15674Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
15675backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
15676name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
15677&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
15678rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
15679If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
15680error.
15681
15682.option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15683.cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
15684.cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
15685This option allows mail for particular domains to be held in the queue
15686manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
15687&%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
15688verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
15689item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
15690it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
15691
15692This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
15693delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
15694configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
15695domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
15696&%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
15697
15698A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
15699messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
15700time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
15701retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
15702
15703
15704.option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
15705.cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
15706Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
15707is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
15708&%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
15709option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
15710default configuration file contains
15711.code
15712host_lookup = *
15713.endd
15714which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
15715is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
15716
15717After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
15718has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
15719this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
15720
15721.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
15722.vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
15723After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
15724unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
15725&%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
15726&`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
15727
15728
15729.option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
15730This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
15731to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
15732first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
15733if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
15734if you want.
15735
15736&*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
15737multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
15738&_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
15739case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
15740
15741
15742
15743.option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
15744.cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
15745If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
15746as soon as the connection is made.
15747This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
15748nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
15749connections immediately.
15750
15751The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
15752ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
15753sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
15754incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
15755chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
15756
15757
15758.option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
15759.cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
15760This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
15761happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
15762you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
15763127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
15764the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
15765list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
15766local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
15767.code
15768hosts_connection_nolog = :
15769.endd
15770If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
15771
15772
15773
15774.option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
15775.cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
15776This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
15777connections. For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
15778
15779
15780.option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
15781.cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
15782.cindex "host" "treated as local"
15783If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
15784if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
15785records
15786or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
15787host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
15788
15789This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
15790&`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
15791section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
15792&(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
15793that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
15794chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
15795interfaces and recognizing the local host.
15796
15797
15798.option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
15799.cindex "InterBase" "server list"
15800This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
15801to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15802The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
15803
15804
15805
15806.option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
15807.cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
15808.cindex "discarding bounce message"
15809This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
15810that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
15811suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
15812
15813After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
15814because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
15815message has been in the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
15816the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
15817again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
15818bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
15819for frozen messages. For example,
15820.code
15821ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
15822.endd
15823retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
15824failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
15825failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
15826value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
15827dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
15828&%timeout_frozen_after%&.
15829
15830
15831.option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15832.cindex "&""From""& line"
15833.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15834Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
15835the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
15836message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
15837such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
15838match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
15839process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
15840&%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
15841
15842
15843.option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
15844See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
15845
15846.option keep_environment main "string list" unset
15847.cindex "environment" "values from"
15848This option contains a string list of environment variables to keep.
15849You have to trust these variables or you have to be sure that
15850these variables do not impose any security risk. Keep in mind that
15851during the startup phase Exim is running with an effective UID 0 in most
15852installations. As the default value is an empty list, the default
15853environment for using libraries, running embedded Perl code, or running
15854external binaries is empty, and does not not even contain PATH or HOME.
15855
15856Actually the list is interpreted as a list of patterns
15857(&<<SECTlistexpand>>&), except that it is not expanded first.
15858
15859WARNING: Macro substitution is still done first, so having a macro
15860FOO and having FOO_HOME in your &%keep_environment%& option may have
15861unexpected results. You may work around this using a regular expression
15862that does not match the macro name: ^[F]OO_HOME$.
15863
15864Current versions of Exim issue a warning during startup if you do not mention
15865&%keep_environment%& in your runtime configuration file and if your
15866current environment is not empty. Future versions may not issue that warning
15867anymore.
15868
15869See the &%add_environment%& main config option for a way to set
15870environment variables to a fixed value. The environment for &(pipe)&
15871transports is handled separately, see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for
15872details.
15873
15874
15875.option keep_malformed main time 4d
15876This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
15877have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
15878next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
15879logged.
15880
15881
15882.option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
15883.cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
15884.cindex certificate "directory for LDAP"
15885This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
15886a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15887While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15888Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15889and constrained to be a directory.
15890
15891
15892.option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
15893.cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
15894.cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15895This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
15896a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15897While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15898Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15899and constrained to be a file.
15900
15901
15902.option ldap_cert_file main string unset
15903.cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
15904.cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15905This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
15906Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15907Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
15908
15909
15910.option ldap_cert_key main string unset
15911.cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
15912.cindex certificate "key for LDAP"
15913This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
15914to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15915Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
15916identity to be proven.
15917
15918
15919.option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
15920.cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
15921This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
15922the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
15923cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
15924
15925
15926.option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
15927.cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
15928This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
15929LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
15930details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
15931with LDAP support.
15932
15933
15934.option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
15935.cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
15936This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
15937A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
15938See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
15939Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
15940to hard/demand.
15941
15942
15943.option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
15944.cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
15945If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
15946connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
15947"STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
15948of SSL-on-connect.
15949In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
15950by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
15951This option is ignored for &`ldapi`& connections.
15952
15953
15954.option ldap_version main integer unset
15955.cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
15956This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
15957LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
15958-1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
15959the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
15960has been built with LDAP support.
15961
15962
15963
15964.option local_from_check main boolean true
15965.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
15966.cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
15967When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15968an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
15969checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
15970the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
15971
15972&*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
15973locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
15974&%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15975
15976You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
15977on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
15978&'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
15979and the default qualify domain.
15980
15981If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
15982and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
15983&'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
15984&%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
15985
15986.cindex "envelope from"
15987.cindex "envelope sender"
15988These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
15989is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
15990&%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
15991
15992For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
15993request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
15994has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15995
15996
15997
15998
15999.option local_from_prefix main string unset
16000When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
16001matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
16002ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
16003done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
16004appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
16005&%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
16006example, if
16007.code
16008local_from_prefix = *-
16009.endd
16010is set, a &'From:'& line containing
16011.code
16012From: anything-user@your.domain.example
16013.endd
16014will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
16015matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
16016qualify domain.
16017
16018
16019.option local_from_suffix main string unset
16020See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
16021
16022
16023.option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
16024This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
16025listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
16026&<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
16027options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
16028&%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
16029&%local_interfaces%& is
16030.code
16031local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
16032.endd
16033when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
16034.code
16035local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
16036.endd
16037
16038.option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
16039.cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
16040.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
16041This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
16042&<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
16043the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
16044message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
16045non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
16046
16047
16048
16049.option local_sender_retain main boolean false
16050.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
16051When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
16052an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
16053do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
16054also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
16055See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
16056&<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
16057
16058
16059
16060
16061.option localhost_number main string&!! unset
16062.cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
16063.cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
16064.vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
16065Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
16066uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
16067value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
16068after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
16069host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
16070range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
16071systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
16072&$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
16073characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
16074time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
16075section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
16076
16077
16078
16079.option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
16080.cindex "log" "file path for"
16081This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
16082files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
16083when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
16084name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or runtime,
16085or if the option is unset at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
16086they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
16087A path must start with a slash.
16088To send to syslog, use the word &"syslog"&.
16089Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
16090section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
16091used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
16092variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
16093configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
16094&_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
16095early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
16096
16097
16098.option log_selector main string unset
16099.cindex "log" "selectors"
16100This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
16101writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
16102minus characters. For example:
16103.code
16104log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
16105.endd
16106A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
16107logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
16108
16109
16110.option log_timezone main boolean false
16111.cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
16112.vindex "&$tod_log$&"
16113.vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
16114By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
16115timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
16116in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
16117avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
16118&%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
16119timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
16120of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
16121&$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
16122another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
16123
16124
16125.option lookup_open_max main integer 25
16126.cindex "too many open files"
16127.cindex "open files, too many"
16128.cindex "file" "too many open"
16129.cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
16130.cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
16131This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
16132lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
16133Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
16134file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
16135recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
16136actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
16137as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
16138open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
16139&%lookup_open_max%&.
16140
16141
16142.option max_username_length main integer 0
16143.cindex "length of login name"
16144.cindex "user name" "maximum length"
16145.cindex "limit" "user name length"
16146Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
16147&[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
16148this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
16149an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
16150
16151
16152.option message_body_newlines main bool false
16153.cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
16154.cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
16155.vindex "&$message_body$&"
16156.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16157By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
16158the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
16159option is set true, this no longer happens.
16160
16161
16162.option message_body_visible main integer 500
16163.cindex "body of message" "visible size"
16164.cindex "message body" "visible size"
16165.vindex "&$message_body$&"
16166.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16167This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
16168&$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
16169
16170
16171.option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
16172.cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
16173If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
16174(domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
16175locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
16176means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
16177Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
16178Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
16179replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
16180empty string, the option is ignored.
16181
16182
16183.option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
16184If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
16185the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
16186message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
16187take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
16188the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
16189it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
16190yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
16191before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
16192that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
16193means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
16194colons will become hyphens.
16195
16196
16197.option message_logs main boolean true
16198.cindex "message logs" "disabling"
16199.cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
16200If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
16201&_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
16202Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
16203minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
16204per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
16205which is not affected by this option.
16206
16207
16208.option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
16209.cindex "message" "size limit"
16210.cindex "limit" "message size"
16211.cindex "size" "of message, limit"
16212This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
16213value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
16214to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
16215TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
16216optionally followed by K or M.
16217
16218&*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
16219other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
16220the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
16221error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
16222&%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16223
16224Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
16225exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
16226failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
16227an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
16228the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
16229message that an individual transport can process.
16230
16231If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
16232maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
16233failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
16234virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
16235probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
16236default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
16237some problems may result.
16238
16239A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
16240SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
16241SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
16242
16243
16244.option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
16245.cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
16246This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
16247.code
16248SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
16249.endd
16250in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
16251moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
16252and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
16253standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
16254lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
16255
16256
16257.option mua_wrapper main boolean false
16258Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
16259it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
16260contains a full description of this facility.
16261
16262
16263
16264.option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
16265.cindex "MySQL" "server list"
16266This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
16267be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
16268option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
16269
16270
16271.option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
16272This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
16273message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
16274recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
16275It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
16276safety precaution.
16277
16278When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
16279list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
16280the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
16281contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
16282can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
16283
16284If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
16285&%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
16286example is
16287.code
16288never_users = root:daemon:bin
16289.endd
16290Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
16291harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
16292transport driver.
16293
16294
16295.option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2 +no_sslv3 +single_dh_use +no_ticket +no_renegotiation"
16296.cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
16297This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
16298by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
16299each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
16300
16301This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
16302available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
16303The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
16304the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
16305list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
16306&"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
16307names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
16308
16309Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
16310SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
16311yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
16312adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
16313invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
16314
16315The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
16316
16317Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
16318"+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
16319with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
16320some now infamous attacks.
16321
16322Examples:
16323.code
16324# Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
16325openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
16326 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
16327
16328# Disable older protocol versions:
16329openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
16330.endd
16331
16332Possible options may include:
16333.ilist
16334&`all`&
16335.next
16336&`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
16337.next
16338&`cipher_server_preference`&
16339.next
16340&`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
16341.next
16342&`ephemeral_rsa`&
16343.next
16344&`legacy_server_connect`&
16345.next
16346&`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
16347.next
16348&`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
16349.next
16350&`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
16351.next
16352&`netscape_challenge_bug`&
16353.next
16354&`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
16355.next
16356&`no_compression`&
16357.next
16358&`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
16359.next
16360&`no_sslv2`&
16361.next
16362&`no_sslv3`&
16363.next
16364&`no_ticket`&
16365.next
16366&`no_tlsv1`&
16367.next
16368&`no_tlsv1_1`&
16369.next
16370&`no_tlsv1_2`&
16371.next
16372&`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
16373.next
16374&`single_dh_use`&
16375.next
16376&`single_ecdh_use`&
16377.next
16378&`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
16379.next
16380&`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
16381.next
16382&`tls_block_padding_bug`&
16383.next
16384&`tls_d5_bug`&
16385.next
16386&`tls_rollback_bug`&
16387.endlist
16388
16389As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
16390all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
16391to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
16392to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
16393release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
16394where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
16395
16396
16397.option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
16398.cindex "Oracle" "server list"
16399This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
16400to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
16401The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
16402
16403
16404.option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16405.cindex "&""percent hack""&"
16406.cindex "source routing" "in email address"
16407.cindex "address" "source-routed"
16408The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
16409percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
16410replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
16411also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
16412option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
16413but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
16414an ACL.
16415
16416&*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
16417trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
16418if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
16419implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
16420routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
16421a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
16422local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
16423
16424
16425.option perl_at_start main boolean false
16426.cindex "Perl"
16427This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
16428interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
16429
16430
16431.option perl_startup main string unset
16432.cindex "Perl"
16433This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
16434interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
16435
16436.option perl_taintmode main boolean false
16437.cindex "Perl"
16438This option enables the taint mode of the embedded Perl interpreter.
16439
16440
16441.option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
16442.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
16443This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
16444data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
16445&<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
16446PostgreSQL support.
16447
16448
16449.option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
16450.cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
16451.cindex "pid file, path for"
16452This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
16453process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
16454to the host name:
16455.code
16456pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
16457.endd
16458If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
16459spool directory.
16460The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
16461option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
16462of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
16463
16464
16465.option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16466.cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
16467This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
16468PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
16469control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
16470&%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
16471for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
16472that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
16473not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
16474
16475.option pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16476.cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
16477.cindex "pipelining" PIPE_CONNECT
16478If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
16479this option controls which hosts the facility is advertised to
16480and from which pipeline early-connection (before MAIL) SMTP
16481commands are acceptable.
16482When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
16483
16484See also the &%hosts_pipe_connect%& smtp transport option.
16485
16486Currently the option name &"X_PIPE_CONNECT"& is used.
16487
16488
16489.option prdr_enable main boolean false
16490.cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
16491This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
16492to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
16493If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
16494If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
16495an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
16496is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
16497
16498.option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
16499.cindex "message logs" "preserving"
16500If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
16501completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
16502called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
16503purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
16504volume of mail. Use with care!
16505
16506
16507.option primary_hostname main string "see below"
16508.cindex "name" "of local host"
16509.cindex "host" "name of local"
16510.cindex "local host" "name of"
16511.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16512This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
16513HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
16514option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
16515The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
16516server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
16517
16518If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
16519name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
16520contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
16521&[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
16522version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
16523explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
16524
16525
16526.option print_topbitchars main boolean false
16527.cindex "printing characters"
16528.cindex "8-bit characters"
16529By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
1653032&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
16531when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
16532sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
16533is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
16534characters.
16535
16536This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
16537&(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
16538the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
16539described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
16540Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
16541standards.
16542
16543
16544.option process_log_path main string unset
16545.cindex "process log path"
16546.cindex "log" "process log"
16547.cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
16548This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
16549&"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
16550utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
16551in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
16552can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
16553different spool directories.
16554
16555
16556.option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
16557.cindex "restricting access to features"
16558.oindex "&%-M%&"
16559.oindex "&%-R%&"
16560.oindex "&%-q%&"
16561The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
16562admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
16563&%queue_list_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16564
16565
16566.option qualify_domain main string "see below"
16567.cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
16568.cindex "address" "qualification"
16569This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
16570addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
16571recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
16572are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
16573also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
16574locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
16575
16576Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
16577unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
16578&%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
16579addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
16580necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
16581addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
16582&%primary_hostname%& value.
16583
16584
16585.option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
16586This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
16587addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
16588
16589
16590
16591.option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16592.cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
16593.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16594.cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
16595This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
16596A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
16597domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
16598next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
16599
16600
16601.option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
16602.cindex "restricting access to features"
16603.oindex "&%-bp%&"
16604The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
16605queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
16606&%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
16607See also &%prod_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16608
16609
16610.option queue_only main boolean false
16611.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16612.cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
16613If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
16614whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits in the queue for the
16615next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
16616delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
16617
16618The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
16619and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
16620&%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
16621&%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
16622
16623
16624.option queue_only_file main string unset
16625.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16626.cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
16627This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
16628one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
16629it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
16630each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
16631For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
16632&"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
16633.code
16634queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
16635.endd
16636causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
16637&_/some/file_& exists.
16638
16639
16640.option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
16641.cindex "load average"
16642.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16643.cindex "message" "queueing by load"
16644If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
16645all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
16646happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
16647the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
16648the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16649false.
16650
16651Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
16652option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
16653determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
16654&%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16655
16656
16657.option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
16658.cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
16659When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
16660because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
16661all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
16662This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
16663threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
16664connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
16665circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
16666where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16667should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
16668re-evaluated for each message.
16669
16670
16671.option queue_only_override main boolean true
16672.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16673When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
16674setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
16675&%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
16676to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
16677
16678
16679.option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
16680.cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
16681If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
16682in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
16683must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
16684single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
16685and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
16686single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
16687the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
16688avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
16689&%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
16690when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
16691large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
16692
16693
16694
16695.option queue_run_max main integer&!! 5
16696.cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
16697This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
16698can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
16699but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
16700start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
16701very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
16702however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
16703started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
16704
16705Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
16706the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
16707run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
16708the daemon's command line.
16709
16710.cindex queues named
16711.cindex "named queues"
16712To set limits for different named queues use
16713an expansion depending on the &$queue_name$& variable.
16714
16715.option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16716.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16717.cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
16718When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
16719received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
16720However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
16721&%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
16722message waits in the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
16723has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
16724when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
16725over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
16726SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
16727&%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
16728&%queue_domains%&.
16729
16730
16731.option receive_timeout main time 0s
16732.cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
16733This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
16734maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
16735the value is zero, it will wait forever. This setting is overridden by the
16736&%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
16737controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
16738
16739.option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
16740.cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
16741.cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
16742This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
16743added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
16744on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
16745used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
16746added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
16747&"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
16748header lines.
16749The default setting is:
16750
16751.code
16752received_header_text = Received: \
16753 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
16754 {${if def:sender_ident \
16755 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
16756 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
16757 by $primary_hostname \
16758 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol }}\
16759 ${if def:tls_ver { ($tls_ver)}}\
16760 ${if def:tls_in_cipher_std { tls $tls_in_cipher_std\n\t}}\
16761 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
16762 ${if def:sender_address \
16763 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
16764 id $message_exim_id\
16765 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
16766.endd
16767
16768The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
16769support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
16770locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
16771header lines such as the following:
16772.code
16773Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
16774by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
16775(envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
16776id 16IOWa-00019l-00
16777for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
16778Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
16779id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
16780.endd
16781Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
16782the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
16783checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
16784message was accepted.
16785
16786
16787.option received_headers_max main integer 30
16788.cindex "loop" "prevention"
16789.cindex "mail loop prevention"
16790.cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
16791When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
16792counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
16793have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
16794This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
16795
16796
16797.option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16798.cindex "unqualified addresses"
16799.cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16800This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16801recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
16802qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
16803affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
16804addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
16805host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
16806or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
16807option was not set.
16808
16809
16810.option recipients_max main integer 0
16811.cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
16812.cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
16813If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
16814original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
16815by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
16816all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
16817Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
16818done.
16819
16820.cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
16821&*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
16822RCPT commands in a single message.
16823
16824
16825.option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
16826If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
16827recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
16828error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
16829error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
16830initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
16831for the remaining recipients at a later time.
16832
16833
16834.option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
16835.cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
16836This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
16837hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
16838does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
16839message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
16840have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
16841deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
16842deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
16843each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
16844same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
16845&%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
16846with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
16847tagged with its process id.
16848
16849This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
16850message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
16851manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
16852deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
16853is received.
16854
16855.cindex "number of deliveries"
16856.cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
16857If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
16858need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
16859are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
16860daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
16861fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
16862runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
16863delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
16864then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
16865&%remote_max_parallel%&.
16866
16867If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
16868&%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
16869doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
16870host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
16871
16872
16873.option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16874.cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
16875.cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
16876When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
16877domain into the order given by this list. For example,
16878.code
16879remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
16880.endd
16881would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
16882then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
16883
16884
16885.option retry_data_expire main time 7d
16886.cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
16887This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
16888database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
16889host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
16890past failures.
16891
16892
16893.option retry_interval_max main time 24h
16894.cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
16895.cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
16896Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
16897intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
16898straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
16899retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
16900the default value.
16901
16902
16903.option return_path_remove main boolean true
16904.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
16905RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
16906&'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
16907The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
16908MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
16909in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
16910&'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
16911received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
16912the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
16913
16914
16915.option return_size_limit main integer 100K
16916This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16917
16918
16919.option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
16920.cindex "RFC 1413"
16921.cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
16922RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
16923an item in the list.
16924The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
16925for the system.
16926
16927.option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
16928.cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
16929.cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
16930This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
16931no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
16932
16933
16934.option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16935.cindex "unqualified addresses"
16936.cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16937This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16938sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
16939&%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
16940not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
16941it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
16942&%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
16943using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
16944
16945
16946.option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
16947.cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
16948.cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
16949This option controls logging of slow lookups.
16950If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
16951and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
16952Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
16953
16954
16955
16956.option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
16957.cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
16958This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
16959TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
16960connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
16961other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
16962still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
16963this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
16964connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
16965tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
16966hours to detect unreachable hosts.
16967
16968
16969
16970.option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
16971.cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
16972.cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16973.cindex "inetd"
16974This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
16975that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
16976control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
16977value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
16978non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
16979set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16980
16981A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
16982has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
16983that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
16984and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
16985
16986
16987.option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
16988.cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
16989.cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
16990Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
16991the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
16992check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
16993client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
16994client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
16995
16996When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
16997allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
16998but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
16999or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
17000starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
17001counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
17002following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
17003MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
17004
17005
17006.option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17007You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
17008check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
17009changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
17010live with.
17011
17012
17013. Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
17014. for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
17015. We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
17016. non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
17017. zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
17018. html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
17019. inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
17020. searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
17021. the option name to split.
17022
17023.option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
17024 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
17025.cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
17026.cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
17027The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
17028prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
17029results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
17030response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
17031precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
17032seen).
17033
17034
17035.option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
17036.cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
17037.cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
17038This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
17039host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
17040expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
17041reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
17042connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
17043is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
17044of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
17045required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
17046
17047&*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
17048constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
17049happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
17050without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
17051could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
17052doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
17053
17054
17055
17056.option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
17057.cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
17058.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17059.cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
17060If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
17061listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
17062in the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
17063fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
17064subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
17065to all messages received in the same connection.
17066
17067A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
17068if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
17069also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
17070various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
17071
17072
17073. See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
17074
17075.option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
17076 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
17077.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17078.cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
17079This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
17080automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
17081the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
17082and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
17083number, subsequent messages are placed in the queue, but no delivery processes
17084are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
17085restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
17086systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
17087dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
17088
17089
17090.option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
17091.cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
17092.cindex "host" "reserved"
17093When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
17094number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
17095that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
17096&%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
17097restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
17098of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
17099of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
17100the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
17101individual host.
17102
17103For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
17104set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
17105connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
17106provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
17107
17108
17109.option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
17110.cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
17111.cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
17112.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
17113This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
17114several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
17115is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
17116responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
17117incoming HELO or EHLO command.
17118
17119.vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
17120The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
17121is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
17122in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
17123
17124If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
17125expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
17126used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
17127panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
17128value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
17129For example:
17130.code
17131smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
17132 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
17133.endd
17134
17135Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
17136messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
17137verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
17138&%helo_data%& value.
17139
17140.option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
17141.cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
17142.cindex "banner for SMTP"
17143.cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
17144.cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
17145This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
17146positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
17147.code
17148smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
17149 $version_number $tod_full
17150.endd
17151Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
17152multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
17153appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
17154in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
17155multiline response).
17156
17157
17158.option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
17159.cindex "checking disk space"
17160.cindex "disk space, checking"
17161.cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
17162When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
17163option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
17164spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
17165leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
17166is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
17167
17168
17169.option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
17170.cindex "connection backlog"
17171.cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
17172.cindex "backlog of connections"
17173This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
17174this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
17175of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
17176attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
17177say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
17178out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
17179value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
17180attacks by SYN flooding.
17181
17182
17183.option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
17184.cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
17185.cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
17186The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
17187the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
17188synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
17189fewer, but they still exist.
17190
17191Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
17192for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
17193client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
17194SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
17195for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
17196input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
17197does detect many instances.
17198
17199The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
17200If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
17201hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
17202(see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
17203
17204
17205
17206.option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
17207.cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
17208.vindex "&$domain$&"
17209If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
17210command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
17211chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
17212are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
17213argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
17214example:
17215.code
17216smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
17217 $sender_host_address
17218.endd
17219A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
17220complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
17221run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
17222a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
17223receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
17224the command.
17225
17226
17227.option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
17228.cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
17229When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
17230one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
17231section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
17232
17233
17234.option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
17235.cindex "load average"
17236If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
17237accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
17238If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
17239the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
17240systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
17241&%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
17242
17243
17244
17245.option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
17246.cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
17247.cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
17248Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
17249particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
17250.code
17251RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
17252.endd
17253causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
17254(The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
17255example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
17256too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
17257dropped. The limit is set by this option.
17258
17259.cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
17260When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
17261&"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
17262Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
17263&%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
17264not count towards the limit.
17265
17266
17267
17268.option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
17269.cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
17270.cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
17271If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
17272Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
17273that subvert web
17274clients
17275into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
17276non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
17277
17278
17279
17280.option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17281.cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
17282.cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
17283.cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
17284Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
17285can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
17286recipients.
17287
17288Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
17289facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
17290&%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
17291&<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
17292
17293When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
17294&%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
17295rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
17296respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
17297values:
17298
17299.ilist
17300A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
17301.next
17302An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
17303fractional parts are allowed here.
17304.next
17305A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
17306.next
17307A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
17308because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
17309.endlist
17310
17311For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
17312first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
17313.code
17314smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
17315smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
17316.endd
17317The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
17318two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
17319seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
17320delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
17321
17322
17323.option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
17324See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
17325
17326
17327.option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
17328See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
17329
17330
17331.option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
17332.cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
17333.cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
17334This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
17335input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
17336data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
17337the message is abandoned.
17338A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
17339.code
17340SMTP command timeout on connection from...
17341SMTP data timeout on connection from...
17342.endd
17343The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
17344means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
17345
17346If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
17347expanded before use and may depend on
17348&$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
17349
17350
17351.oindex "&%-os%&"
17352The value set by this option can be overridden by the
17353&%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
17354this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
17355of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
17356timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
17357
17358
17359.option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17360This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
17361&%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
17362
17363
17364.option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
17365.cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
17366.cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
17367In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
17368&"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
17369reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
17370to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
17371policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
17372&%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
17373example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
17374.code
17375550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
17376550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
17377.endd
17378
17379
17380.option smtputf8_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17381.cindex "SMTPUTF8" "advertising"
17382When Exim is built with support for internationalised mail names,
17383the availability thereof is advertised in
17384response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17385chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>& for details of Exim's support for internationalisation.
17386
17387
17388.option spamd_address main string "127.0.0.1 783"
17389This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
17390extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
17391See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
17392
17393
17394
17395.option spf_guess main string "v=spf1 a/24 mx/24 ptr ?all"
17396This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support.
17397See section &<<SECSPF>>& for more details.
17398
17399
17400
17401.option split_spool_directory main boolean false
17402.cindex "multiple spool directories"
17403.cindex "spool directory" "split"
17404.cindex "directories, multiple"
17405If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
17406subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
17407sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
17408subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
17409arrival of the message.
17410
17411Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
17412where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
17413directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
17414directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
17415are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
17416
17417It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
17418changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
17419&"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
17420after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
17421automatically deleted.
17422
17423When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
17424changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
17425trying to deliver each one, in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
17426sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
17427sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
17428spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
17429particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages in the queue. However,
17430if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
17431entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
17432
17433
17434.option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
17435.cindex "spool directory" "path to"
17436This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
17437it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
17438configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
17439string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
17440&$primary_hostname$&.
17441
17442If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
17443that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
17444log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
17445Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
17446as failures in the configuration file.
17447
17448By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
17449tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
17450
17451.option spool_wireformat main boolean false
17452.cindex "spool directory" "file formats"
17453If this option is set, Exim may for some messages use an alternative format
17454for data-files in the spool which matches the wire format.
17455Doing this permits more efficient message reception and transmission.
17456Currently it is only done for messages received using the ESMTP CHUNKING
17457option.
17458
17459The following variables will not have useful values:
17460.code
17461$max_received_linelength
17462$body_linecount
17463$body_zerocount
17464.endd
17465
17466Users of the local_scan() API (see &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&),
17467and any external programs which are passed a reference to a message data file
17468(except via the &"regex"&, &"malware"& or &"spam"&) ACL conditions)
17469will need to be aware of the different formats potentially available.
17470
17471Using any of the ACL conditions noted will negate the reception benefit
17472(as a Unix-mbox-format file is constructed for them).
17473The transmission benefit is maintained.
17474
17475.option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
17476.cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
17477This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
17478access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
17479
17480.option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
17481.cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
17482This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
17483variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
17484is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
17485&<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
17486
17487.option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
17488.cindex "angle brackets, excess"
17489If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
17490items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
17491treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
17492passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
17493option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
17494
17495
17496.option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
17497.cindex "trailing dot on domain"
17498.cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
17499If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
17500ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
17501MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
17502domain causes a syntax error.
17503However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
17504syntax checking.
17505
17506
17507.option syslog_duplication main boolean true
17508.cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
17509When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
17510separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
17511be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
17512separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
17513nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
17514particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
17515both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
17516containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
17517Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
17518the LOG_ALERT priority.
17519
17520
17521.option syslog_facility main string unset
17522.cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
17523This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17524syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
17525&"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
17526If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17527details of Exim's logging.
17528
17529
17530.option syslog_pid main boolean true
17531.cindex "syslog" "pid"
17532If &%syslog_pid%& is set false, the PID on Exim's log lines are
17533omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. (Syslog normally prefixes
17534the log lines with the PID of the logging process automatically.) You need
17535to enable the &`+pid`& log selector item, if you want Exim to write it's PID
17536into the logs.) See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17537
17538
17539
17540.option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
17541.cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
17542This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17543syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
17544&<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17545
17546
17547
17548.option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
17549.cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
17550If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
17551omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17552details of Exim's logging.
17553
17554
17555.option system_filter main string&!! unset
17556.cindex "filter" "system filter"
17557.cindex "system filter" "specifying"
17558.cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
17559This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
17560the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
17561must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
17562generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
17563appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
17564which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
17565&<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
17566A forced expansion failure results in no filter operation.
17567
17568
17569.option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
17570.vindex "&$address_file$&"
17571This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
17572&%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
17573implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
17574During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17575
17576
17577.option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
17578.cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
17579This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
17580command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
17581the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17582
17583.option system_filter_group main string unset
17584.cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
17585This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
17586gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
17587with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
17588
17589.option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
17590.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
17591.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
17592This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
17593is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
17594contains the pipe command.
17595
17596
17597.option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
17598.cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
17599This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
17600is used in a system filter.
17601
17602
17603.option system_filter_user main string unset
17604.cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
17605If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
17606delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
17607process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
17608Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
17609is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
17610configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
17611specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
17612&%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
17613
17614If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
17615under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
17616transport option overrides.
17617
17618
17619.option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
17620.cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
17621.cindex "Nagle algorithm"
17622.cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
17623If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
17624TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
17625turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
17626performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
17627should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
17628However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
17629this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
17630daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
17631TCP_NODELAY.
17632
17633
17634.option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
17635.cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
17636.cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
17637If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
17638message of any kind that has been in the queue for longer than the given time
17639is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
17640bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
17641sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
17642If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
17643frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
17644
17645&*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
17646frozen messages remain in the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
17647messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
17648
17649
17650.option timezone main string unset
17651.cindex "timezone, setting"
17652.cindex "environment" "values from"
17653The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
17654running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
17655created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
17656to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
17657.code
17658timezone = UTC
17659.endd
17660The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
17661or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
17662is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
17663time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
17664runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
17665unfortunately not all, operating systems.
17666
17667
17668.option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17669.cindex "TLS" "advertising"
17670.cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
17671.cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
17672When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
17673of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
17674response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17675chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
17676Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
17677using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If TLS support for incoming connections
17678is not required the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
17679
17680
17681.option tls_certificate main string list&!! unset
17682.cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
17683.cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
17684The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17685files which contain the server's certificates (in PEM format).
17686Commonly only one file is needed.
17687The server's private key is also
17688assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
17689&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17690
17691&*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
17692receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
17693use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
17694option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
17695
17696&*Note*&: If you use filenames based on IP addresses, change the list
17697separator in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) to avoid confusion under IPv6.
17698
17699&*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
17700when a list of more than one
17701file is used, the &$tls_in_ourcert$& variable is unreliable.
17702The macro "_TLS_BAD_MULTICERT_IN_OURCERT" will be defined for those versions.
17703
17704If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
17705if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
17706Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
17707&<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
17708
17709If this option is unset or empty a fresh self-signed certificate will be
17710generated for every connection.
17711
17712.option tls_crl main string&!! unset
17713.cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
17714.cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
17715This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
17716be the name of a file that contains CRLs in PEM format.
17717
17718Under OpenSSL the option can specify a directory with CRL files.
17719
17720&*Note:*& Under OpenSSL the option must, if given, supply a CRL
17721for each signing element of the certificate chain (i.e. all but the leaf).
17722For the file variant this can be multiple PEM blocks in the one file.
17723
17724See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17725
17726
17727.option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
17728.cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
17729The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
17730the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
17731interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
17732suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
17733
17734The value must be at least 1024.
17735
17736The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
17737hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
17738by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
17739
17740If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
17741number.
17742
17743Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
17744little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
17745larger prime than requested.
17746
17747
17748.option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
17749.cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
17750The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
17751to be used by Exim.
17752
17753This option is ignored for GnuTLS version 3.6.0 and later.
17754The library manages parameter negotiation internally.
17755
17756&*Note: The Exim Maintainers strongly recommend,
17757for other TLS library versions,
17758using a filename with site-generated
17759local DH parameters*&, which has been supported across all versions of Exim. The
17760other specific constants available are a fallback so that even when
17761"unconfigured", Exim can offer Perfect Forward Secrecy in older ciphersuites in TLS.
17762
17763If &%tls_dhparam%& is a filename starting with a &`/`&,
17764then it names a file from which DH
17765parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
17766PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
17767OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
17768fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
17769loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
17770and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
17771
17772If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
17773loaded by Exim.
17774
17775If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
17776Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
17777does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
17778See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
17779
17780If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
17781a default DH prime; the default is Exim-specific but lacks verifiable provenance.
17782
17783In older versions of Exim the default was the 2048 bit prime described in section
177842.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
17785in IKE is assigned number 23.
17786
17787Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
17788of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526, RFC 5114, RFC 7919, or from other
17789sources. As names, Exim uses a standard specified name, else "ike" followed by
17790the number used by IKE, or "default" which corresponds to
17791&`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17792
17793The available standard primes are:
17794&`ffdhe2048`&, &`ffdhe3072`&, &`ffdhe4096`&, &`ffdhe6144`&, &`ffdhe8192`&,
17795&`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
17796&`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
17797&`ike22`&, &`ike23`& and &`ike24`&.
17798
17799The available additional primes are:
17800&`exim.dev.20160529.1`&, &`exim.dev.20160529.2`& and &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17801
17802Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
17803Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
17804The open cryptographic community has suspicions about the integrity of some
17805of the later IKE values, which led into RFC7919 providing new fixed constants
17806(the "ffdhe" identifiers).
17807
17808At this point, all of the "ike" values should be considered obsolete;
17809they're still in Exim to avoid breaking unusual configurations, but are
17810candidates for removal the next time we have backwards-incompatible changes.
17811
17812The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
17813to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
17814whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
17815tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
17816need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
17817userbase.
17818
17819Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
17820is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
17821applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
17822used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
17823mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
17824prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
17825acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
17826
17827
17828.option tls_eccurve main string&!! &`auto`&
17829.cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
17830This option selects a EC curve for use by Exim when used with OpenSSL.
17831It has no effect when Exim is used with GnuTLS.
17832
17833After expansion it must contain a valid EC curve parameter, such as
17834&`prime256v1`&, &`secp384r1`&, or &`P-512`&. Consult your OpenSSL manual
17835for valid selections.
17836
17837For OpenSSL versions before (and not including) 1.0.2, the string
17838&`auto`& selects &`prime256v1`&. For more recent OpenSSL versions
17839&`auto`& tells the library to choose.
17840
17841If the option expands to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
17842
17843
17844.option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
17845.cindex TLS "certificate status"
17846.cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
17847This option
17848must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
17849status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
17850Certificate Authority.
17851
17852Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
17853The macro "_HAVE_TLS_OCSP" will be defined for those versions.
17854
17855For OpenSSL 1.1.0 or later, and
17856for GnuTLS 3.5.6 or later the expanded value of this option can be a list
17857of files, to match a list given for the &%tls_certificate%& option.
17858The ordering of the two lists must match.
17859The macro "_HAVE_TLS_OCSP_LIST" will be defined for those versions.
17860
17861The file(s) should be in DER format,
17862except for GnuTLS 3.6.3 or later
17863or for OpenSSL,
17864when an optional filetype prefix can be used.
17865The prefix must be one of "DER" or "PEM", followed by
17866a single space. If one is used it sets the format for subsequent
17867files in the list; the initial format is DER.
17868If multiple proofs are wanted, for multiple chain elements
17869(this only works under TLS1.3)
17870they must be coded as a combined OCSP response.
17871
17872Although GnuTLS will accept PEM files with multiple separate
17873PEM blobs (ie. separate OCSP responses), it sends them in the
17874TLS Certificate record interleaved with the certificates of the chain;
17875although a GnuTLS client is happy with that, an OpenSSL client is not.
17876
17877.option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
17878.cindex SSMTP
17879.cindex SMTPS
17880This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
17881operate the SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
17882set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
17883further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
17884
17885
17886
17887.option tls_privatekey main string list&!! unset
17888.cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
17889The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17890files which contains the server's private keys.
17891If this option is unset, or if
17892the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
17893key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
17894&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17895
17896See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17897
17898
17899.option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
17900.cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
17901.cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
17902If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
17903&"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
17904support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
17905TLS session.
17906
17907
17908.option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
17909.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
17910.cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
17911This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
17912The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
17913connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
17914different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
17915permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
17916in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
17917preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
17918&<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
17919
17920
17921.option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17922.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17923.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17924See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
17925
17926
17927.option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
17928.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17929.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17930The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
17931word "system"
17932or the absolute path to
17933a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
17934match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
17935
17936The "system" value for the option will use a
17937system default location compiled into the SSL library.
17938This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
17939and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
17940must be specified.
17941
17942The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
17943preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
17944
17945With OpenSSL the certificates specified
17946explicitly
17947either by file or directory
17948are added to those given by the system default location.
17949
17950These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
17951than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
17952the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
17953connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
17954Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
17955use the explicit directory version.
17956
17957See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17958
17959A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
17960being unset.
17961
17962
17963.option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17964.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17965.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17966This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
17967certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
17968&%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
17969either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
17970&%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
17971
17972Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
17973&%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
17974present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
17975aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
17976the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
17977connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
17978ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
17979
17980A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
17981matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
17982certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
17983abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
17984state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
17985such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
17986but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
17987certificate"&.
17988
17989Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
17990certificates.
17991
17992
17993.option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
17994.cindex "trusted groups"
17995.cindex "groups" "trusted"
17996This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17997option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
17998which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
17999specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
18000details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
18001&%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
18002are trusted.
18003
18004.option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
18005.cindex "trusted users"
18006.cindex "user" "trusted"
18007This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
18008option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
18009trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
18010&<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
18011If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
18012Exim user are trusted.
18013
18014.option unknown_login main string&!! unset
18015.cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
18016.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
18017This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
18018the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
18019gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
18020used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
18021can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
18022is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
18023&%-F%& option.
18024
18025.option unknown_username main string unset
18026See &%unknown_login%&.
18027
18028.option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
18029.cindex "trusted users"
18030.cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
18031.cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
18032.cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
18033.cindex "envelope from"
18034.cindex "envelope sender"
18035When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
18036normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
18037default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
18038senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
18039is used) is ignored.
18040
18041However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
18042to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
18043.code
18044exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
18045.endd
18046.vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
18047The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
18048other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
18049users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
18050patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
18051identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
18052users to setting senders that start with their login ids
18053followed by a hyphen
18054by a setting like this:
18055.code
18056untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
18057.endd
18058If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
18059restriction, you can use
18060.code
18061untrusted_set_sender = *
18062.endd
18063The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
18064only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
18065to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
18066parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
18067&'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
18068necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
18069overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
18070described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
18071
18072The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
18073&"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
18074&%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
18075envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
18076sender address.
18077
18078
18079.option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
18080.cindex "&""From""& line"
18081.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
18082Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
18083an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
18084particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
18085of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
18086matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
18087&%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
18088default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
18089.code
18090From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
18091From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
18092.endd
18093The pattern can be seen by running
18094.code
18095exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
18096.endd
18097It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
18098year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
18099regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
18100&%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
18101(&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
18102&%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
18103
18104
18105.option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
18106See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
18107
18108
18109.option warn_message_file main string unset
18110.cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
18111.cindex "customizing" "warning message"
18112This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
18113for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
18114been in the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
18115&%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
18116&<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
18117
18118
18119.option write_rejectlog main boolean true
18120.cindex "reject log" "disabling"
18121If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
18122See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
18123.ecindex IIDconfima
18124.ecindex IIDmaiconf
18125
18126
18127
18128
18129. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18130. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18131
18132.chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
18133.scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
18134.scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
18135This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
18136Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
18137
18138For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
18139&<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
18140which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
18141provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
18142&%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
18143
18144
18145
18146.option address_data routers string&!! unset
18147.cindex "router" "data attached to address"
18148The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
18149precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
18150router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
18151&%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
18152delivery of the address to be deferred.
18153
18154.vindex "&$address_data$&"
18155When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
18156accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
18157routers, and the eventual transport.
18158
18159&*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
18160that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
18161in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
18162either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
18163put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
18164
18165Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
18166with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
18167on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
18168&$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
18169&"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
18170
18171The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
18172for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
18173you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
18174.code
18175uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
18176.endd
18177In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
18178.code
18179file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
18180.endd
18181This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
18182lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
18183
18184See also the &%set%& option below.
18185
18186.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
18187.vindex "&$address_data$&"
18188The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
18189from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
18190&$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
18191ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
18192verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
18193
18194
18195
18196.option address_test routers&!? boolean true
18197.oindex "&%-bt%&"
18198.cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
18199If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
18200by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
18201your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
18202having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
18203routing.
18204
18205
18206
18207.option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
18208.cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
18209.cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
18210This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
18211routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
18212&"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
18213&%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
18214value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
18215includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
18216well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
18217you could put:
18218.code
18219cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
18220.endd
18221on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
18222and
18223.code
18224cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
18225.endd
18226on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
18227this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
18228explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
18229logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
18230
18231
18232.option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
18233.cindex "case of local parts"
18234.cindex "router" "case of local parts"
18235By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
18236manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
18237If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
18238this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
18239part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
18240turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
18241more details.
18242
18243.vindex "&$local_part$&"
18244.vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
18245.vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
18246The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
18247router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
18248an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
18249is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
18250addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
18251and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
18252
18253This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
18254recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
18255modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
18256(see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
18257
18258
18259
18260.option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
18261.cindex "local user, checking in router"
18262.cindex "router" "checking for local user"
18263.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
18264.vindex "&$home$&"
18265When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
18266address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
18267local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
18268than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
18269holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
18270user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
18271preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
18272given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
18273overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
18274the router is skipped.
18275
18276If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
18277or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
18278setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
18279two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
18280setting to achieve this. For example:
18281.code
18282local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
18283.endd
18284Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
18285up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
18286&%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
18287
18288
18289
18290.option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
18291.cindex "router" "customized precondition"
18292This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
18293router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
18294evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
18295result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
18296&"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
18297router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
18298
18299If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
18300precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
18301
18302This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
18303All &%condition%& options must succeed.
18304
18305The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
18306running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
18307the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
18308.code
18309condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
18310.endd
18311Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
18312.code
18313condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
18314.endd
18315
18316A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
18317.code
18318condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
18319condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
18320condition = foobar
18321.endd
18322
18323If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
18324of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
18325be specified using &%condition%&.
18326
18327Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
18328are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
18329they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
18330parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
18331ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
18332Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
18333Router rules processing behavior.
18334
18335This is best illustrated in an example:
18336.code
18337# If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
18338# in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
18339
18340$ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
18341true {yes} {no}}
18342
18343$ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
18344 {yes} {no}}
18345.endd
18346In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
18347&"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
18348default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
18349(which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
18350string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
18351with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
18352resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
18353&" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
18354
18355In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
18356&%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
18357mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
18358conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
18359string characters.
18360
18361Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
18362true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
18363match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
18364contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
18365expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
18366
18367
18368.option debug_print routers string&!! unset
18369.cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
18370If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
18371option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
18372the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
18373If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
18374output, and Exim carries on processing.
18375This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
18376so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
18377option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
18378variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
18379&%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
18380are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
18381The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
18382
18383
18384
18385.option disable_logging routers boolean false
18386If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
18387or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
18388unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
18389transport option of the same name.
18390
18391.option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" *
18392.cindex "MX record" "security"
18393.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
18394.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
18395.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
18396DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
18397the dnssec request bit set.
18398This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
18399
18400.option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
18401.cindex "MX record" "security"
18402.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
18403.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
18404.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
18405DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
18406the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
18407(AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
18408This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
18409
18410
18411.option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
18412.cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
18413.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
18414If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
18415the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
18416lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
18417expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
18418a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
18419
18420
18421
18422.option driver routers string unset
18423This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
18424to be used.
18425
18426
18427.option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
18428.cindex "DSN" "success"
18429.cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
18430If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
18431Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
18432instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
18433Not effective on redirect routers.
18434
18435
18436
18437.option errors_to routers string&!! unset
18438.cindex "envelope from"
18439.cindex "envelope sender"
18440.cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
18441If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
18442transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
18443there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
18444message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
18445provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
18446expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
18447
18448The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
18449subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
18450settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
18451setting.
18452
18453If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
18454the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
18455address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
18456expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
18457
18458If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
18459SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
18460any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
18461sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
18462settings:
18463.code
18464errors_to =
18465errors_to = ""
18466.endd
18467An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
18468this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
18469no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
18470address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
18471overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
18472
18473.vindex "&$address_data$&"
18474If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
18475MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
18476path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
18477setting &%return_path%&.
18478
18479The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
18480manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
18481implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
18482
18483
18484
18485.option expn routers&!? boolean true
18486.cindex "address" "testing"
18487.cindex "testing" "addresses"
18488.cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
18489.cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
18490If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
18491as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
18492want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
18493on for the system alias file.
18494See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18495are evaluated.
18496
18497The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
18498&<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
18499an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
18500
18501
18502
18503.option fail_verify routers boolean false
18504.cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
18505Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
18506&%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18507
18508
18509
18510.option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
18511If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18512verifying a recipient, verification fails.
18513
18514
18515
18516.option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
18517If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18518verifying a sender, verification fails.
18519
18520
18521
18522.option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
18523.cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
18524.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
18525String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
18526colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
18527changed (see section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&), and a port can be specified with
18528each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
18529defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
18530&<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
18531
18532If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
18533associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
18534list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
18535randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
18536transport for further details.
18537
18538
18539.option group routers string&!! "see below"
18540.cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
18541.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18542.cindex "transport" "local"
18543.cindex "router" "setting group"
18544When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18545specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
18546process.
18547The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18548error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18549The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
18550is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
18551and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18552
18553
18554
18555.option headers_add routers list&!! unset
18556.cindex "header lines" "adding"
18557.cindex "router" "adding header lines"
18558This option specifies a list of text headers,
18559newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
18560that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18561Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18562option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18563the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
18564&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
18565message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
18566header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
18567&"see"& the added header lines.
18568
18569The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
18570&%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
18571an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
18572failures are treated as configuration errors.
18573
18574Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
18575for a router; all listed headers are added.
18576
18577&*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18578router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18579
18580.cindex "duplicate addresses"
18581.oindex "&%unseen%&"
18582&*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18583additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
18584For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
18585address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
18586modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
18587circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
18588which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
18589avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18590
18591
18592
18593.option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
18594.cindex "header lines" "removing"
18595.cindex "router" "removing header lines"
18596This option specifies a list of text headers,
18597colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
18598that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18599Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18600option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18601the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
18602section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
18603the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
18604to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
18605&"see"& the original header lines.
18606
18607The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
18608&%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
18609the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
18610errors.
18611
18612Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
18613for a router; all listed headers are removed.
18614
18615&*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18616router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18617
18618&*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18619removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
18620routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
18621warning for &%headers_add%& above.
18622
18623&*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
18624items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
18625To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
18626
18627
18628
18629.option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
18630.cindex "IP address" "discarding"
18631.cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
18632Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
18633entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
18634IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
18635address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
18636like
18637.code
18638remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
18639.endd
18640by setting
18641.code
18642ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
18643.endd
18644on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
18645discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
18646attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
18647domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
18648Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
18649router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
18650
18651You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
18652means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
18653.code
18654ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
18655ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
18656.endd
18657The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
18658in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
18659
18660This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
18661addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18662is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
18663domain that is being routed.
18664
18665.vindex "&$host_address$&"
18666During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
18667checked.
18668
18669.option initgroups routers boolean false
18670.cindex "additional groups"
18671.cindex "groups" "additional"
18672.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18673.cindex "transport" "local"
18674If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
18675the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
18676&[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
18677any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
18678and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18679
18680
18681
18682.option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
18683.cindex affix "router precondition"
18684.cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
18685.cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
18686If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
18687one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
18688section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
18689evaluated.
18690
18691The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
18692used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
18693asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
18694the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
18695some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
18696.cindex "multiple mailboxes"
18697.cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
18698Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
18699section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
18700
18701.vindex "&$local_part$&"
18702.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
18703During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
18704running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
18705expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
18706the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
18707a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
18708command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
18709This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
18710the relevant transport.
18711
18712When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
18713behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
18714means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
18715callout.
18716
18717The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
18718&%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
18719&%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
18720to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
18721immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
18722.code
18723real_localuser:
18724 driver = accept
18725 local_part_prefix = real-
18726 check_local_user
18727 transport = local_delivery
18728.endd
18729For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
18730router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
18731.code
18732 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
18733 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
18734.endd
18735
18736If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
18737both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
18738are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
18739separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
18740
18741
18742.option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
18743See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
18744
18745
18746
18747.option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
18748.cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
18749.cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
18750This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
18751local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
18752&%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
18753mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
18754character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
18755parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
18756&%username-foo%&.
18757
18758
18759.option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
18760See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
18761
18762
18763
18764.option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
18765.cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
18766.cindex "local part" "checking in router"
18767The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
18768See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18769are evaluated, and
18770section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
18771string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
18772example:
18773.code
18774local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
18775.endd
18776.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
18777If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
18778for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
18779expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
18780example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
18781send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
18782each virtual domain:
18783.code
18784postmaster:
18785 driver = redirect
18786 local_parts = postmaster
18787 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
18788.endd
18789
18790
18791.option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
18792.cindex "log" "delivery line"
18793.cindex "delivery" "log line format"
18794Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
18795deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
18796recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
18797this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
18798router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
18799router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
18800redirect addresses.
18801
18802
18803
18804.option more routers boolean&!! true
18805The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18806that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18807result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18808fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
18809delivery to be deferred.
18810
18811If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
18812further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
18813.oindex "&%self%&"
18814However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
18815means of the setting
18816.code
18817self = pass
18818.endd
18819or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
18820does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
18821case, the address is always passed to the next router.
18822
18823Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
18824expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
18825controls what happens next.
18826
18827
18828.option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
18829.cindex "timeout" "of router"
18830.cindex "router" "timeout"
18831If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
18832address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
18833router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
18834intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
18835host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
18836
18837There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
18838lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
18839applies to all of them.
18840
18841
18842
18843.option pass_router routers string unset
18844.cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
18845Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
18846&(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
18847routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
18848these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
18849router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
18850of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
18851be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
18852to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
18853&"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
18854
18855
18856
18857.option redirect_router routers string unset
18858.cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
18859Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
18860generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
18861example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
18862point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
18863
18864The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
18865It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
18866instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
18867which it is set does not generate new addresses.
18868
18869
18870
18871.option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
18872.cindex "file" "requiring for router"
18873.cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
18874This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
18875router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
18876Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
18877through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
18878
18879Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
18880be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used
18881(&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
18882If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
18883failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
18884
18885If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
18886below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
18887&"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
18888existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
18889preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
18890
18891.cindex "NFS"
18892If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
18893the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
18894unavailable.
18895
18896This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
18897options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
18898look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
18899full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
18900these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
18901to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
18902that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
18903transport (e.g., &_.procmailrc_&).
18904
18905During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
18906facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
18907This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
18908operates as follows:
18909
18910If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
18911characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
18912comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
18913but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
18914used. For example:
18915.code
18916require_files = mail:/some/file
18917require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
18918.endd
18919If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
18920&%require_files%& condition fails.
18921
18922Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
18923checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
18924directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
18925access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
18926
18927&*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
18928incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
18929may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
18930may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
18931user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
18932
18933&*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
18934&[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
18935without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
18936is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
18937check again in that process.
18938
18939The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
18940be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
18941existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
18942circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
18943not exist. If the filename (or the exclamation mark that precedes the filename
18944for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
18945as if the file did not exist. For example:
18946.code
18947require_files = +/some/file
18948.endd
18949If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
18950handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
18951option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
18952
18953
18954
18955.option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
18956.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
18957.cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
18958When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
18959in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
18960domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
18961other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
18962Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
18963latter kind.
18964
18965This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
18966hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
18967router. The default value is true for any router that has any of
18968&%check_local_user%&,
18969&%local_parts%&,
18970&%condition%&,
18971&%local_part_prefix%&,
18972&%local_part_suffix%&,
18973&%senders%& or
18974&%require_files%&
18975set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
18976for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
18977same name.
18978
18979Failing to set this option when it is needed
18980(because a remote router handles only some of the local-parts for a domain)
18981can result in incorrect error messages being generated.
18982
18983The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
18984appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
18985independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
18986
18987
18988
18989.option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
18990.cindex "router" "home directory for"
18991.cindex "home directory" "for router"
18992.vindex "&$home$&"
18993This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
18994&%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
18995transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
18996sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
18997forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
18998cause the router to defer.
18999
19000Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
19001&%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
19002place.
19003(See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19004are evaluated.)
19005While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
19006&$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
19007
19008When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
19009the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
19010delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
19011of these values that is set:
19012
19013.ilist
19014The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
19015.next
19016The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
19017.next
19018The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
19019.next
19020The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
19021.endlist
19022
19023In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
19024router, but not for the transport.
19025
19026
19027
19028.option self routers string freeze
19029.cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
19030.cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
19031This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
19032list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
19033and &(manualroute)& routers.
19034Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
19035of remote hosts.
19036Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
19037&(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
19038host on the list turns out to be the local host.
19039The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
19040&<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
19041
19042Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
19043example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
19044error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
19045reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
19046freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
19047cases:
19048
19049.vlist
19050.vitem &%defer%&
19051Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
19052
19053.vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
19054The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
19055be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
19056behaviour is essentially a redirection.
19057
19058.vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
19059The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
19060reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
19061rewritten.
19062
19063.vitem &%pass%&
19064.oindex "&%more%&"
19065.vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
19066The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
19067&%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
19068subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
19069name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
19070distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
19071combination
19072.code
19073self = pass
19074no_more
19075.endd
19076ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
19077Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
19078be passed to the next router.
19079
19080.vitem &%fail%&
19081Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
19082
19083.vitem &%send%&
19084.cindex "local host" "sending to"
19085The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
19086setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
19087makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
19088is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
19089different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
19090.endlist
19091
19092
19093
19094.option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
19095.cindex "router" "checking senders"
19096If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
19097address matches something on the list.
19098See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19099are evaluated.
19100
19101There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
19102dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
19103setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
19104to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
19105set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
19106verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
19107SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
19108matters.
19109
19110
19111.option set routers "string list" unset
19112.cindex router variables
19113This option may be used multiple times on a router;
19114because of this the list aspect is mostly irrelevant.
19115The list separator is a semicolon but can be changed in the
19116usual way.
19117
19118Each list-element given must be of the form &"name = value"&
19119and the names used must start with the string &"r_"&.
19120Values containing a list-separator should have them doubled.
19121When a router runs, the strings are evaluated in order,
19122to create variables which are added to the set associated with
19123the address.
19124The variable is set with the expansion of the value.
19125The variables can be used by the router options
19126(not including any preconditions)
19127and by the transport.
19128Later definitions of a given named variable will override former ones.
19129Variable use is via the usual &$r_...$& syntax.
19130
19131This is similar to the &%address_data%& option, except that
19132many independent variables can be used, with choice of naming.
19133
19134
19135.option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
19136.cindex "IP address" "translating"
19137.cindex "packet radio"
19138.cindex "router" "IP address translation"
19139There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
19140it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
19141mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
19142routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
19143is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
19144code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
19145SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
19146
19147.vindex "&$host_address$&"
19148The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
19149by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
19150expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
19151For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
19152If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
19153address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
19154up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
19155produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
19156addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
19157.code
19158translate_ip_address = \
19159 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
19160 {$value}fail}}
19161.endd
19162The file would contain lines like
19163.code
1916410.2.3.128/26 some.host
1916510.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
19166.endd
19167You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
19168are doing.
19169
19170
19171
19172.option transport routers string&!! unset
19173This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
19174and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
19175only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
19176after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
19177and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
19178delivery is deferred.
19179
19180The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
19181have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
19182(see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
19183
19184
19185
19186.option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
19187.cindex "current directory for local transport"
19188This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
19189to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
19190explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
19191file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
19192option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
19193overridden by a setting on the transport.
19194If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19195logged, and delivery is deferred.
19196See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
19197environment.
19198
19199
19200
19201
19202.option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
19203.cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
19204This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
19205local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
19206configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
19207pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
19208string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
19209setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
19210If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19211logged, and delivery is deferred.
19212
19213If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
19214&%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
19215the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
19216the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
19217is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
19218
19219See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
19220environment.
19221
19222
19223
19224
19225.option unseen routers boolean&!! false
19226.cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
19227The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
19228that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
19229result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
19230fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
19231delivery to be deferred.
19232
19233When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
19234address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
19235overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
19236&%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
19237the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
19238sometimes true and sometimes false).
19239
19240.cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
19241Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
19242qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
19243delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
19244In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
19245&-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
19246to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
19247&%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
19248
19249&*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
19250this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
19251only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
19252no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
19253a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
19254duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
19255duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
19256&<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
19257so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
19258&%redirect%& router may be of help.
19259
19260Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
19261&%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
19262subsequent routers.
19263
19264
19265.option user routers string&!! "see below"
19266.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
19267.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19268.cindex "transport" "local"
19269.cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
19270.cindex "filter" "user for processing"
19271When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
19272specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
19273The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
19274error is logged and delivery is deferred.
19275This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
19276The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
19277the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
19278a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
19279See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
19280&<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
19281
19282
19283
19284.option verify routers&!? boolean true
19285Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
19286&%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
19287
19288
19289.option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
19290.cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
19291.oindex "&%-bv%&"
19292.cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
19293If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
19294delivering in cutthrough mode or
19295testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
19296with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
19297restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
19298&%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
19299
19300&*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
19301SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
19302accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
19303user or group.
19304
19305
19306.option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
19307If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
19308addresses,
19309delivering in cutthrough mode
19310or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
19311See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19312are evaluated.
19313See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
19314
19315
19316.option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
19317If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
19318or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
19319See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19320are evaluated.
19321See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
19322.ecindex IIDgenoprou1
19323.ecindex IIDgenoprou2
19324
19325
19326
19327
19328
19329
19330. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19331. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19332
19333.chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
19334.cindex "&(accept)& router"
19335.cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
19336The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
19337used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
19338be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
19339specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
19340it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
19341up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
19342.code
19343localusers:
19344 driver = accept
19345 domains = mydomain.example
19346 check_local_user
19347 transport = local_delivery
19348.endd
19349The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
19350&%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
19351When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
19352address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
19353
19354
19355
19356
19357
19358
19359. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19360. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19361
19362.chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
19363.scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
19364.scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
19365The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
19366recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
19367unless &%verify_only%& is set.
19368
19369If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
19370SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
19371MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
19372However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
19373records.
19374
19375MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
19376looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
19377When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
19378except that IPv6 addresses are sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
19379IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
19380generic option, the router declines.
19381
19382Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
19383to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
19384are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
19385
19386.cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
19387.cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
19388.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
19389If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
19390address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
19391happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
19392
19393
19394.section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
19395There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
19396Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
19397SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
19398MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
19399problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
19400
19401For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
19402&%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
19403&(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
19404an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
19405domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
19406such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
19407proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
19408look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
19409case routing fails.
19410
19411
19412.section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
19413.cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
19414There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
19415an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
19416domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
19417
19418The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
19419is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
19420
19421Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
19422.ilist
19423The domain does not exist in DNS
19424.next
19425The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
19426convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
19427for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
19428.next
19429Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
19430.next
19431MX record points to a non-existent host.
19432.next
19433MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
19434&%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
19435.next
19436MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
19437addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
19438.next
19439The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
19440&%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
19441.next
19442&%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
19443not be found in the MX records (see below)
19444.endlist
19445
19446
19447
19448
19449.section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
19450.cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
19451The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
19452
19453.option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
19454.cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
19455If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
19456(and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
19457process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
19458differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
19459the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
19460
19461
19462.option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
19463.cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
19464The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
19465addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
19466enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
19467required. For example,
19468.code
19469check_srv = smtp
19470.endd
19471looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
19472expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
19473to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
19474submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
19475option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
19476normal way.
19477
19478When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
19479the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
19480host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
19481this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
19482SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
19483according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
19484
19485When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
19486the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
19487records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
19488this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
19489defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
19490and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
19491have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
19492trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
19493
19494See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
19495when there is a DNS lookup error.
19496
19497
19498
19499
19500.option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19501.cindex "MX record" "not found"
19502DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
19503which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
19504rather than the default behaviour of decline.
19505This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
19506domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
19507However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
19508also being queued.
19509
19510
19511.option ipv4_only "string&!!" unset
19512.cindex IPv6 disabling
19513.cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
19514The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
19515or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
19516(checked without regard to the case of the letters),
19517only A records are used.
19518
19519.option ipv4_prefer "string&!!" unset
19520.cindex IPv4 preference
19521.cindex DNS "IPv4 preference"
19522The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
19523or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
19524(checked without regard to the case of the letters),
19525A records are sorted before AAAA records (inverting the default).
19526
19527.option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19528.cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
19529.cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
19530A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
19531record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
19532For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
19533records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
19534setting:
19535.code
19536mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
19537.endd
19538This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
19539has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
19540the address record.
19541
19542
19543.option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19544If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19545DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
19546&<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19547
19548
19549
19550
19551.option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
19552.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19553.cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
19554When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
19555lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
19556single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
19557called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
19558&'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
19559resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
19560&'resolv.conf'&.
19561
19562
19563
19564.option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
19565.cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
19566.cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
19567If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
19568qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
19569an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
19570expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
19571occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
19572&%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
19573any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
19574header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
19575
19576This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
19577ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
19578sense.
19579
19580When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
19581servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
19582making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
19583some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
19584name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
19585header rewriting.
19586
19587
19588.option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
19589.cindex "address" "copying routing"
19590Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
19591to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
19592options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19593default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19594servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19595any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19596
19597If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19598domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
19599local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19600lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
19601routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
19602message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
19603without processing them independently,
19604provided the following conditions are met:
19605
19606.ilist
19607No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
19608&%headers_remove%&.
19609.next
19610The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
19611the domain.
19612.endlist
19613
19614
19615
19616
19617.option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
19618.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19619When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
19620lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
19621applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
19622the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
19623domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
19624up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
19625&'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
19626actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
19627
19628Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
19629record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
19630local wildcard.
19631
19632
19633
19634.option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19635If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19636DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
19637&<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19638
19639
19640
19641
19642.option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
19643.cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
19644If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
19645added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
19646if
19647.code
19648widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
19649.endd
19650is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
19651&'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
19652&'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
19653and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
19654the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
19655when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
19656
19657
19658.section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
19659When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
19660of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
19661corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
19662is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
19663
19664These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
19665for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
19666such as that implied by
19667.code
19668domains = @mx_any
19669.endd
19670that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
19671entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
19672.ecindex IIDdnsrou1
19673.ecindex IIDdnsrou2
19674
19675
19676
19677
19678
19679
19680
19681
19682
19683. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19684. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19685
19686.chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
19687.cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
19688.cindex "domain literal" "routing"
19689.cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
19690This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
19691verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
19692generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
19693takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
19694router handles the address
19695.code
19696root@[192.168.1.1]
19697.endd
19698by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
19699consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
19700are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
19701.code
19702postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
19703.endd
19704Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
19705grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
19706
19707.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
19708If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
19709declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
19710&%self%& option determines what happens.
19711
19712The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
19713controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
19714also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
19715Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
19716
19717
19718
19719. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19720. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19721
19722.chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
19723.cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
19724.cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
19725The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
19726Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
19727not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
19728must set
19729.code
19730ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
19731.endd
19732in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
19733
19734The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
19735connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
19736a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
19737message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
19738this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
19739can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
19740must not be specified for it.
19741
19742.cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
19743.option hosts iplookup string unset
19744This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
19745names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
19746(or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
19747and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
19748happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
19749
19750
19751.option optional iplookup boolean false
19752If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
19753is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
19754delivery to the address is deferred.
19755
19756
19757.option port iplookup integer 0
19758.cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
19759This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
19760call.
19761
19762
19763.option protocol iplookup string udp
19764This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
19765protocols is to be used.
19766
19767
19768.option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
19769This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
19770default value is:
19771.code
19772$local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
19773.endd
19774The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
19775query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
19776
19777
19778.option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
19779If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
19780returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
19781string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
19782in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
19783&$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
19784whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
19785up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
19786
19787
19788.option response_pattern iplookup string unset
19789This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
19790returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
19791router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
19792response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
19793check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
19794address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
19795the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
19796following could be used:
19797.code
19798response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
19799reroute = $local_part@$1
19800.endd
19801
19802.option timeout iplookup time 5s
19803This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
19804machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
19805call. It does not apply to UDP.
19806
19807
19808
19809
19810. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19811. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19812
19813.chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
19814.scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
19815.scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
19816.cindex "domain" "manually routing"
19817The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
19818routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
19819route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
19820normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
19821route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
19822messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
19823
19824The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
19825it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
19826has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
19827include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
19828&"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
19829generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
19830being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
19831
19832.vindex "&$host$&"
19833In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
19834router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
19835an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
19836transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
19837with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
19838passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
19839host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
19840text string.
19841
19842The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
19843&%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
19844or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
19845any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
19846below, following the list of private options.
19847
19848
19849.section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
19850
19851.cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
19852The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
19853
19854.option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
19855See &%host_find_failed%&.
19856
19857.option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
19858This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
19859address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
19860of the following values:
19861.code
19862decline
19863defer
19864fail
19865freeze
19866ignore
19867pass
19868.endd
19869The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
19870error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
19871forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
19872&%pass_router%&),
19873.oindex "&%more%&"
19874overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
19875router only if &%more%& is true.
19876
19877The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
19878cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
19879controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
19880as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
19881
19882The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
19883state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
19884generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
19885
19886
19887.option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
19888.cindex "randomized host list"
19889.cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
19890If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
19891is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
19892overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
19893crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
19894same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
19895(even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
19896deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
19897
19898When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
19899into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
19900set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
19901item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
19902.code
19903route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
19904.endd
19905The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
19906randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
19907If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
19908randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
19909&%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
19910
19911
19912.option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
19913If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
19914Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
19915example:
19916.code
19917route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
19918.endd
19919If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
19920router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
19921deferred.
19922
19923
19924.option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
19925This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
19926unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
19927that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
19928
19929
19930.option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
19931.cindex "address" "copying routing"
19932Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
19933router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
19934router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19935default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19936servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19937any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19938
19939If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19940domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
19941local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19942lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
19943&(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
19944addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
19945same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
19946if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
19947
19948
19949
19950
19951.section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
19952The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
19953rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
19954entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
19955described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
19956Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
19957.display
19958<&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
19959.endd
19960The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
19961no options:
19962.code
19963route_list = \
19964 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
19965 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19966.endd
19967The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
19968list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
19969usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
19970single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
19971pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
19972&<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
19973except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
19974That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
19975lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
19976in a &%route_list%&).
19977
19978The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
19979matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
19980then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
19981&%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
19982
19983
19984
19985.section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
19986The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
19987routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
19988hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
19989The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
19990Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
19991expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
19992like this:
19993.code
19994dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
19995thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19996.endd
19997This data can be accessed by setting
19998.code
19999route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
20000.endd
20001Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
20002decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
20003requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
20004possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
20005be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
20006
20007
20008
20009
20010.section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
20011A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
20012always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
20013declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
20014and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports.
20015If the list is written with spaces, it must be protected with quotes.
20016The format of each item
20017in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
20018as described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&.
20019
20020If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
20021variables are set during its expansion:
20022
20023.ilist
20024.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
20025If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
20026&$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
20027.code
20028route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
20029.endd
20030.next
20031&$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
20032.next
20033&$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
20034
20035.next
20036.vindex "&$value$&"
20037If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
20038looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
20039.code
20040route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
20041.endd
20042.endlist
20043
20044Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
20045semicolon is the default route list separator.
20046
20047
20048
20049.section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
20050Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
20051optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
20052is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
20053specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
20054by a colon. This leads to some complications:
20055
20056.ilist
20057Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
20058the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
20059be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
20060.code
20061route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
20062route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
20063.endd
20064.next
20065When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
20066colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
20067enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
20068number follows. For example:
20069.code
20070route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
20071.endd
20072.endlist
20073
20074.section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
20075When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
20076the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
20077delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
20078option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
20079transport.
20080
20081Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
20082hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
20083interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
20084records in the DNS. For example:
20085.code
20086route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
20087.endd
20088If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
20089example:
20090.code
20091route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
20092.endd
20093If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
20094randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
20095that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
20096be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
20097Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
20098happens is controlled by the
20099.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
20100&%self%& option of the router.
20101
20102A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
20103hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
20104lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
20105below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
20106preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
20107randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
20108defined by MX preferences.
20109
20110If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
20111not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
20112preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
20113
20114If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
20115depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
20116is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
20117Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
20118
20119If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
20120most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
20121router.
20122
20123DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
20124failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
20125&%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
20126
20127The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
20128whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
20129
20130
20131
20132.section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
20133The options are a sequence of words, space-separated.
20134One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
20135&%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
20136other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
20137per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
20138routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
20139
20140.ilist
20141&%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
20142setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
20143.next
20144&%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
20145overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
20146.next
20147&%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
20148find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
20149also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
20150.next
20151&%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
20152no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
20153timeout), delivery is deferred.
20154.next
20155&%ipv4_only%&: in direct DNS lookups, look up only A records.
20156.next
20157&%ipv4_prefer%&: in direct DNS lookups, sort A records before AAAA records.
20158.endlist
20159
20160For example:
20161.code
20162route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
20163 domain2 host4:host5
20164.endd
20165If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
20166DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
20167result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
20168or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
20169call.
20170
20171&*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
20172called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
20173instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
20174lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
20175function called.
20176
20177&*Compatibility*&: From Exim 4.85 until fixed for 4.90, there was an
20178inadvertent constraint that a transport name as an option had to be the last
20179option specified.
20180
20181
20182
20183If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
20184&%host_find_failed%& option.
20185
20186.vindex "&$host$&"
20187When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
20188The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
20189
20190
20191
20192.section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
20193In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
20194transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
20195
20196.ilist
20197.cindex "smart host" "example router"
20198The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
20199&'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
20200named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
20201.code
20202domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
20203.endd
20204You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
20205your first router something like this:
20206.code
20207smart_route:
20208 driver = manualroute
20209 domains = !+local_domains
20210 transport = remote_smtp
20211 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
20212.endd
20213This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
20214&'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
20215they are tried in order
20216(but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
20217Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
20218.code
20219smart_route:
20220 driver = manualroute
20221 transport = remote_smtp
20222 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
20223.endd
20224There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
20225However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
20226example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
20227precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
20228always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
20229would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
20230always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
20231&%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
20232
20233.next
20234.cindex "mail hub example"
20235A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
20236records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
20237the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
20238machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
20239&(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
20240to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
20241using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
20242lookup is easier to manage.
20243
20244If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
20245to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
20246example:
20247.code
20248hub_route:
20249 driver = manualroute
20250 transport = remote_smtp
20251 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
20252.endd
20253This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
20254whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
20255if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
20256that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
20257domain can be used to find the host:
20258.code
20259through_firewall:
20260 driver = manualroute
20261 transport = remote_smtp
20262 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
20263.endd
20264The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
20265hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
20266data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
20267next router.
20268
20269.next
20270.cindex "batched SMTP output example"
20271.cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
20272You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
20273SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
20274storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
20275can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
20276.code
20277save_in_file:
20278 driver = manualroute
20279 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
20280 route_list = saved.domain.example
20281.endd
20282though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
20283several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
20284different transports can be listed in the routing information:
20285.code
20286save_in_file:
20287 driver = manualroute
20288 route_list = \
20289 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
20290 *.saved.domain2.example \
20291 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
20292 batch_pipe
20293.endd
20294.vindex "&$domain$&"
20295.vindex "&$host$&"
20296The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
20297doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
20298file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
20299the address if the lookup fails.
20300
20301.next
20302.cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
20303Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
20304&(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
20305one way it can be done:
20306.code
20307# Transport
20308uucp:
20309 driver = pipe
20310 user = nobody
20311 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
20312 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
20313 return_fail_output = true
20314
20315# Router
20316uucphost:
20317 transport = uucp
20318 driver = manualroute
20319 route_data = \
20320 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
20321.endd
20322The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
20323.code
20324darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
20325.endd
20326It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
20327makes clear the distinction between the domain name
20328&'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
20329.endlist
20330.ecindex IIDmanrou1
20331.ecindex IIDmanrou2
20332
20333
20334
20335
20336
20337
20338
20339
20340. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20341. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20342
20343.chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
20344.scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
20345.scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
20346.cindex "routing" "by external program"
20347The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
20348and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
20349mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
20350However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
20351&%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
20352be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
20353options:
20354.cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
20355
20356.option command queryprogram string&!! unset
20357This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
20358command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
20359expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
20360&<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
20361
20362
20363.option command_group queryprogram string unset
20364.cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
20365This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
20366address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
20367uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
20368gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
20369
20370
20371.option command_user queryprogram string unset
20372.cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
20373This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
20374command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
20375it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
20376using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
20377not set, a value for the gid also.
20378
20379&*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
20380root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
20381However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
20382usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
20383is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
20384the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
20385gid.
20386
20387
20388.option current_directory queryprogram string /
20389This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
20390before running the command.
20391
20392
20393.option timeout queryprogram time 1h
20394If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
20395is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
20396timeout.
20397
20398
20399The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
20400the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
20401containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
20402the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
20403field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
20404
20405.ilist
20406&'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
20407below).
20408.next
20409&'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
20410&%no_more%& is set.
20411.next
20412&'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
20413subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
20414of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
20415included in the SMTP response.
20416.next
20417&'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
20418subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
20419included in any SMTP response.
20420.next
20421&'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
20422.next
20423&'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
20424&%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
20425.next
20426&'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
20427new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
20428or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
20429.endlist
20430
20431When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
20432number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
20433the page):
20434.code
20435ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
20436LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
20437.endd
20438The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
20439is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
20440used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
20441an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
20442
20443The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
20444As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
20445in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
20446&`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
20447(see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
20448
20449If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
20450find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
20451anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
20452goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
20453result of the lookup is the result of that call.
20454
20455.vindex "&$address_data$&"
20456If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
20457variable. For example, this return line
20458.code
20459accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
20460.endd
20461routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
20462the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
20463.ecindex IIDquerou1
20464.ecindex IIDquerou2
20465
20466
20467
20468
20469. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20470. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20471
20472.chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
20473.scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
20474.scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
20475.cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
20476.cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
20477The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
20478common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
20479(usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
20480files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
20481redirected in several different ways:
20482
20483.ilist
20484It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
20485independently.
20486.next
20487It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
20488.next
20489It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
20490.next
20491It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
20492.next
20493It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
20494.next
20495It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
20496.next
20497It can be discarded.
20498.endlist
20499
20500The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
20501However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
20502files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
20503&%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
20504
20505If success DSNs have been requested
20506.cindex "DSN" "success"
20507.cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
20508redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
20509
20510
20511
20512.section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
20513The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
20514expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
20515contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
20516options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
20517aliases, in a configuration like this:
20518.code
20519system_aliases:
20520 driver = redirect
20521 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
20522.endd
20523If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
20524expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
20525expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
20526cause delivery to be deferred.
20527
20528A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
20529&_.forward_& files, like this:
20530.code
20531userforward:
20532 driver = redirect
20533 check_local_user
20534 file = $home/.forward
20535 no_verify
20536.endd
20537If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
20538empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
20539is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
20540yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
20541comments.
20542
20543.new
20544&*Warning*&: It is unwise to use &$local_part$& or &$domain$&
20545directly for redirection,
20546as they are provided by a potential attacker.
20547In the examples above, &$local_part$& is used for looking up data held locally
20548on the system, and not used directly (the second example derives &$home$& via
20549the passsword file or database, using &$local_part$&).
20550.wen
20551
20552
20553
20554.section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
20555.cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
20556It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
20557&_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
20558
20559.ilist
20560When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
20561running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
20562the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
20563practice the router may not be able to operate.
20564.next
20565However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
20566is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
20567local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
20568saves some resources.
20569.endlist
20570
20571
20572
20573
20574
20575
20576.section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
20577.cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20578.cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20579The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
20580can be interpreted in two different ways:
20581
20582.ilist
20583If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
20584&"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
20585&'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
20586respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
20587in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
20588document is intended for use by end users.
20589.next
20590Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
20591described in the next section.
20592.endlist
20593
20594When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the filename given
20595in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
20596generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
20597configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
20598for the &(appendfile)& transport.
20599
20600
20601
20602.section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
20603.cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
20604When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
20605comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
20606addresses, filenames, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
20607&<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
20608disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
20609depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
20610commas or newlines.
20611If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
20612quotes.
20613
20614Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
20615also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
20616next newline character is ignored.
20617
20618If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
20619double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
20620(but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
20621&"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
20622removed.
20623
20624.vindex "&$local_part$&"
20625&*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
20626and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
20627of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
20628special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
20629&'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
20630setting:
20631.code
20632data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
20633.endd
20634
20635
20636.section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
20637.cindex "routing" "loops in"
20638.cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
20639.cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
20640A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
20641consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
20642automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
20643is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
20644Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
20645as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
20646complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
20647
20648.cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
20649Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
20650filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
20651mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
20652&'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
20653.code
20654cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
20655.endd
20656.cindex "backslash in alias file"
20657.cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
20658For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
20659preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
20660it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
20661synonymously.
20662
20663If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
206642822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
20665domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
20666addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
20667force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
20668
20669Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
20670Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
20671contains:
20672.code
20673Sam.Reman: spqr
20674.endd
20675Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
20676messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
20677this forward file:
20678.code
20679Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20680.endd
20681With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
20682&(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
20683second time round, because it has previously routed it,
20684and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
20685should really contain
20686.code
20687spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20688.endd
20689but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
20690below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
20691&(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
20692
20693
20694
20695.section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
20696In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
20697lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
20698
20699.ilist
20700.cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
20701.cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
20702An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
20703as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
20704command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
20705Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20706which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20707
20708Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
20709the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
20710the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
20711in double quotes, for example:
20712.code
20713"|/some/command ready,steady,go"
20714.endd
20715since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
20716quote just the command. An item such as
20717.code
20718|"/some/command ready,steady,go"
20719.endd
20720is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
20721
20722Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
20723of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
20724redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
20725quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
20726string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
20727are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
20728data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
20729transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
20730an &%accept%& router.
20731
20732.next
20733.cindex "file" "in redirection list"
20734.cindex "address redirection" "to file"
20735An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
20736parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
20737.code
20738/home/world/minbari
20739.endd
20740is treated as a filename, but
20741.code
20742/s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
20743.endd
20744is treated as an address. For a filename, a transport must be specified using
20745the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
20746forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
20747filename, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
20748
20749Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20750which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20751
20752.cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
20753However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
20754bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
20755instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
20756
20757.next
20758.cindex "included address list"
20759.cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
20760If an item is of the form
20761.code
20762:include:<path name>
20763.endd
20764a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
20765point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
20766out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
20767by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
20768item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
20769the alias name. This example is incorrect:
20770.code
20771list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
20772.endd
20773It must be given as
20774.code
20775list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
20776.endd
20777.next
20778.cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
20779.cindex "delivery" "discard"
20780.cindex "delivery" "blackhole"
20781.cindex "black hole"
20782.cindex "abandoning mail"
20783Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
20784&%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
20785the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
20786.code
20787:blackhole:
20788.endd
20789can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
20790done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
20791&_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
20792
20793&*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
20794delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
20795are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
20796database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
20797&_/dev/null_&.
20798
20799.next
20800.cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
20801.cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
20802.cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
20803.cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
20804.cindex "customizing" "failure message"
20805An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
20806redirection items of the form
20807.code
20808:defer:
20809:fail:
20810.endd
20811respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
20812to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
20813text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
20814associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
20815.code
20816X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
20817.endd
20818In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
20819of a
20820.cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
20821VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
20822default.
20823.cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
20824The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
20825the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
20826
20827.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20828By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
20829&':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
20830space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
20831followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
20832code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
20833incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
20834suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
20835&%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
20836ignored.
20837
20838.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
20839In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
20840default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
20841therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
20842
20843Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
20844not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
20845normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
20846as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
20847lookup and in &':include:'& files.
20848
20849During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
20850containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
20851whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain in the queue so that a
20852subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
20853deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
20854rules still apply.
20855
20856.next
20857.cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
20858Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
20859chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
20860for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
20861&':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
20862router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
20863results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
20864.endlist
20865
20866
20867.section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
20868.cindex "duplicate addresses"
20869.cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
20870.cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
20871Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
20872to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
20873routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
20874aliasing scheme of the type
20875.code
20876pipe: |/some/command $local_part
20877localpart1: pipe
20878localpart2: pipe
20879.endd
20880does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
20881when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
20882discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
20883such as
20884.code
20885localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
20886localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
20887.endd
20888does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
20889the pipes are distinct.
20890
20891
20892
20893.section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
20894.cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
20895.cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
20896When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
20897leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
20898afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
20899delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
20900members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
20901can be used to avoid this.
20902
20903
20904.section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
20905.cindex "address redirection" "errors"
20906If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
20907error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
20908for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
20909detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
20910deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
20911
20912
20913
20914.section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
20915
20916.cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
20917The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
20918
20919
20920.option allow_defer redirect boolean false
20921Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
20922data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
20923
20924
20925.option allow_fail redirect boolean false
20926.cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
20927If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
20928and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
20929
20930
20931.option allow_filter redirect boolean false
20932.cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
20933.cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
20934Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
20935&"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
20936are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
20937lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
20938
20939It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
20940the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
20941
20942
20943The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
20944&%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
20945&%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
20946files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
20947true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
20948
20949
20950
20951.option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
20952.cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
20953Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
20954This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
20955default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
20956let ordinary users do.
20957
20958
20959
20960.option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
20961This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
20962as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
20963Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
20964configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
20965for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
20966
20967When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
20968is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
20969the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
20970and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
20971domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
20972&_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
20973.code
20974\Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
20975.endd
20976Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
20977&"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
20978originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
20979(having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
20980&"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
20981&%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
20982file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
20983original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
20984
20985
20986.option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
20987When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
20988when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
20989&%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
20990&%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
20991deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
20992is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
20993&%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
20994
20995
20996
20997.option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
20998When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
20999this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
21000permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
21001option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
21002&%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
21003
21004
21005.option data redirect string&!! unset
21006This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
21007set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
21008list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
21009expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
21010has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
21011
21012When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
21013filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
21014terminated with newline characters. For example:
21015.code
21016data = #Exim filter\n\
21017 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
21018.endd
21019If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
21020you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
21021choice into a newline.
21022
21023
21024.option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
21025A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
21026ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
21027specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
21028configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
21029
21030
21031.option file redirect string&!! unset
21032This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
21033is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
21034use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
21035failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
21036must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
21037data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
21038entirely of comments), the router declines.
21039
21040.cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
21041If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
21042runs a check on the containing directory,
21043unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
21044If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
21045happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
21046is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
21047not, the router declines.
21048
21049
21050.option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
21051.vindex "&$address_file$&"
21052A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
21053ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
21054specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
21055configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
21056it is running, the filename is in &$address_file$&.
21057
21058
21059.option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
21060When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
21061relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
21062relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
21063relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
21064
21065
21066.option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
21067.cindex "restricting access to features"
21068.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21069If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
21070redirection list.
21071
21072
21073.option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
21074.cindex "restricting access to features"
21075.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21076If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
21077&%allow_filter%& is true.
21078
21079
21080
21081
21082.option forbid_file redirect boolean false
21083.cindex "restricting access to features"
21084.cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
21085.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21086.cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
21087.cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
21088If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
21089specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
21090conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
21091set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
21092locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
21093
21094
21095.option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
21096.cindex "restricting access to features"
21097.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21098If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
21099make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
21100functions.
21101
21102.option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
21103.cindex "restricting access to features"
21104.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21105.cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
21106If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
21107make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
21108
21109.option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
21110.cindex "restricting access to features"
21111.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21112If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
21113permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
21114under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
21115&_.forward_& files).
21116
21117
21118.option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
21119.cindex "restricting access to features"
21120.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21121If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21122to make use of &%lookup%& items.
21123
21124
21125.option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
21126.cindex "restricting access to features"
21127.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21128This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
21129it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
21130of the embedded Perl support.
21131
21132
21133.option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
21134.cindex "restricting access to features"
21135.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21136If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21137to make use of &%readfile%& items.
21138
21139
21140.option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
21141.cindex "restricting access to features"
21142.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21143If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21144to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
21145
21146
21147.option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
21148.cindex "restricting access to features"
21149.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21150If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
21151message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
21152files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
21153&%one_time%& is set.
21154
21155
21156.option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
21157.cindex "restricting access to features"
21158.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21159If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21160to make use of &%run%& items.
21161
21162
21163.option forbid_include redirect boolean false
21164.cindex "restricting access to features"
21165.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21166If this option is true, items of the form
21167.code
21168:include:<path name>
21169.endd
21170are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
21171
21172
21173.option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
21174.cindex "restricting access to features"
21175.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21176.cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
21177If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
21178specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
21179forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
21180
21181
21182.option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
21183.cindex "restricting access to features"
21184.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21185If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
21186&%allow_filter%& is true.
21187
21188
21189.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
21190.option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
21191If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
21192of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
21193the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
21194
21195
21196
21197
21198.option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
21199.cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
21200If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
21201generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
21202generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
21203bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
21204bounce may well quote the generated address.
21205
21206
21207.option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
21208.cindex "EACCES"
21209If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
21210EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
21211file did not exist.
21212
21213
21214.option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
21215.cindex "ENOTDIR"
21216If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
21217ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
21218router behaves as if the file did not exist.
21219
21220Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
21221router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
21222(the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
21223against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
21224is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
21225is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
21226a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
21227that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
21228
21229
21230
21231.option include_directory redirect string unset
21232If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
21233redirection list must start with this directory.
21234
21235
21236.option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
21237This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
21238&%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
21239
21240
21241.option one_time redirect boolean false
21242.cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
21243.cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
21244.cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
21245.cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
21246.cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
21247Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
21248files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
21249of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
21250is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
21251but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
21252message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
21253lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
21254before they subscribed.
21255
21256If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
21257deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
21258&"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
21259&"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
21260attempt.
21261
21262&*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
21263router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
21264reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
21265permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
21266
21267&*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
21268to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
21269and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
21270
21271&*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
21272&%one_time%&.
21273
21274The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
21275addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
21276addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
21277&%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
21278typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
21279expansion.
21280
21281
21282.option owners redirect "string list" unset
21283.cindex "ownership" "alias file"
21284.cindex "ownership" "forward file"
21285.cindex "alias file" "ownership"
21286.cindex "forward file" "ownership"
21287This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
21288This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
21289See &%check_owner%& above.
21290
21291
21292.option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
21293This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
21294The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
21295&%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
21296
21297
21298.option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
21299.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
21300A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
21301starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
21302transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
21303name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
21304When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
21305
21306
21307.option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
21308.vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
21309If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
21310generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
21311in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
21312expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
21313to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
21314&$qualify_recipient$&.
21315
21316This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
21317but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
21318not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
21319addresses.
21320
21321.option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
21322.cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
21323.cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
21324.cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
21325If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
21326set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
21327without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
21328address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
21329&%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
21330this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
21331
21332
21333.option repeat_use redirect boolean true
21334If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
21335any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
21336the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
21337only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
21338&%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
21339
21340
21341.option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
21342A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
21343&%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
21344by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
21345transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
21346are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
21347
21348
21349.option rewrite redirect boolean true
21350.cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
21351If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
21352subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
21353and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
21354
21355
21356.option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
21357The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
21358:subaddress part of an address.
21359
21360.option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
21361The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
21362of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
21363(including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
21364
21365
21366.option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
21367.cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
21368To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
21369&%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
21370(do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
21371&%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
21372needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
21373
21374
21375
21376.option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
21377.cindex "forward file" "broken"
21378.cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
21379.cindex "alias file" "broken"
21380.cindex "broken alias or forward files"
21381.cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
21382.cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
21383.cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
21384If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
21385non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
21386&%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
21387giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
21388are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
21389&%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
21390be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
21391&%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
21392
21393If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
21394errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
21395the following routers.
21396
21397If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
21398error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
21399taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
21400so it is passed to the following routers.
21401
21402.cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
21403Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
21404action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
21405&%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
21406
21407&%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
21408lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
21409option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
21410notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
21411.code
21412userforward:
21413 driver = redirect
21414 allow_filter
21415 check_local_user
21416 file = $home/.forward
21417 file_transport = address_file
21418 pipe_transport = address_pipe
21419 reply_transport = address_reply
21420 no_verify
21421 skip_syntax_errors
21422 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
21423 syntax_errors_text = \
21424 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
21425 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
21426 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
21427 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
21428 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
21429 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
21430 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
21431 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
21432 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
21433 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
21434.endd
21435You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
21436&`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
21437put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
21438.code
21439real_localuser:
21440 driver = accept
21441 check_local_user
21442 local_part_prefix = real-
21443 transport = local_delivery
21444.endd
21445For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
21446router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
21447.code
21448 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
21449 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
21450.endd
21451
21452
21453.option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
21454See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
21455
21456
21457.option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
21458See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
21459.ecindex IIDredrou1
21460.ecindex IIDredrou2
21461
21462
21463
21464
21465
21466
21467. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21468. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21469
21470.chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
21471 "Environment for local transports"
21472.scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
21473.scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment" "local transports"
21474.scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
21475Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
21476transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
21477in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
21478mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
21479
21480Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
21481some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
21482transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
21483&<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
21484
21485The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
21486different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
21487settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
21488or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
21489configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
21490
21491
21492
21493.section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
21494.cindex "concurrent deliveries"
21495.cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
21496If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
21497simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
21498the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
21499rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
21500time.
21501
21502However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
21503locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
21504.code
21505my_transport:
21506 driver = pipe
21507 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
21508.endd
21509This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
21510messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
21511&%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
21512file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
21513
21514
21515
21516
21517.section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
21518.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
21519.cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
21520All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
21521overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
21522set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
21523delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
21524group (set by the transport). For example:
21525.code
21526# Routers ...
21527# User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
21528local_users:
21529 driver = accept
21530 check_local_user
21531 transport = group_delivery
21532
21533# Transports ...
21534# This transport overrides the group
21535group_delivery:
21536 driver = appendfile
21537 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
21538 group = mail
21539.endd
21540If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
21541address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
21542gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
21543set.
21544
21545.oindex "&%initgroups%&"
21546When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
21547function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
21548&%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
21549by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
21550for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
21551
21552.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
21553The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
21554is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
21555receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
21556original gid is also used.
21557
21558This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
21559following that is set is used:
21560
21561.ilist
21562A &%group%& setting of the transport;
21563.next
21564A &%group%& setting of the router;
21565.next
21566A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
21567&%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
21568.next
21569The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
21570.next
21571In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
21572the uid is the creator's uid;
21573.next
21574The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
21575.endlist
21576
21577If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
21578no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
21579This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
21580The first of the following that is set is used:
21581
21582.ilist
21583A &%user%& setting of the transport;
21584.next
21585In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
21586.next
21587A &%user%& setting of the router;
21588.next
21589A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
21590.next
21591The Exim uid.
21592.endlist
21593
21594Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
21595&%never_users%& list.
21596
21597
21598
21599
21600
21601.section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
21602.cindex "current directory for local transport"
21603.cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
21604.cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
21605.cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
21606Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
21607the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
21608However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
21609are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
21610for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21611
21612.ilist
21613The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
21614.next
21615The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
21616.next
21617The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
21618.next
21619The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
21620.endlist
21621
21622The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21623
21624.ilist
21625The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
21626.next
21627The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
21628.endlist
21629
21630
21631If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
21632value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
21633directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
21634
21635
21636
21637.section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
21638.vindex "&$domain$&"
21639.vindex "&$local_part$&"
21640.vindex "&$original_domain$&"
21641Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
21642variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
21643deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
21644at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
21645other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
21646never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
21647and &$original_domain$& is never set.
21648.ecindex IIDenvlotra1
21649.ecindex IIDenvlotra2
21650.ecindex IIDenvlotra3
21651
21652
21653
21654
21655
21656
21657
21658. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21659. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21660
21661.chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
21662.scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
21663.scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
21664.scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
21665The following generic options apply to all transports:
21666
21667
21668.option body_only transports boolean false
21669.cindex "transport" "body only"
21670.cindex "message" "transporting body only"
21671.cindex "body of message" "transporting"
21672If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
21673mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
21674or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
21675&%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
21676automatically suppress them.
21677
21678
21679.option current_directory transports string&!! unset
21680.cindex "transport" "current directory for"
21681This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
21682transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
21683If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
21684logged, and delivery is deferred.
21685
21686
21687.option disable_logging transports boolean false
21688If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
21689deliveries by the transport or for any
21690transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
21691what you are doing.
21692
21693
21694.option debug_print transports string&!! unset
21695.cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
21696If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
21697option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
21698transport is run.
21699If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
21700output, and Exim carries on processing.
21701This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
21702so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
21703option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
21704variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
21705one.
21706The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
21707transport and the router that called it.
21708
21709.option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
21710.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
21711If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
21712This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
21713header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
21714requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
21715safely be resent to other recipients.
21716
21717
21718.option driver transports string unset
21719This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
21720There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
21721
21722
21723.option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
21724.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21725If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
21726This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
21727delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
21728configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
21729address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
21730header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
21731its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
21732resent to other recipients.
21733
21734
21735.option event_action transports string&!! unset
21736.cindex events
21737This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
21738For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
21739
21740
21741.option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
21742.cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
21743This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
21744value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
21745&%user%& (see below).
21746
21747
21748.option headers_add transports list&!! unset
21749.cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
21750.cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
21751This option specifies a list of text headers,
21752newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
21753which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
21754portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
21755&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
21756routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21757is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21758errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21759
21760Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
21761for a transport; all listed headers are added.
21762
21763
21764.option headers_only transports boolean false
21765.cindex "transport" "header lines only"
21766.cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
21767.cindex "header lines" "transporting"
21768If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
21769exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
21770transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
21771checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
21772
21773
21774.option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
21775.cindex "header lines" "removing"
21776.cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
21777This option specifies a list of header names,
21778colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&);
21779these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
21780in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
21781routers.
21782Each list item is separately expanded.
21783If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21784is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21785errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21786
21787Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
21788for a transport; all listed headers are removed.
21789
21790&*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
21791items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
21792To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
21793
21794
21795
21796.option headers_rewrite transports string unset
21797.cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
21798.cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
21799This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
21800that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
21801option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
21802the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
21803message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
21804example,
21805.code
21806headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
21807 x@y w@z
21808.endd
21809changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
21810&'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
21811header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
21812only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
21813the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
21814filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
21815affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
21816envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
21817change envelope recipients at this time.
21818
21819
21820.option home_directory transports string&!! unset
21821.cindex "transport" "home directory for"
21822.vindex "&$home$&"
21823This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
21824overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
21825placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
21826used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
21827&%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
21828&%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
21829for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
21830deferred.
21831
21832
21833.option initgroups transports boolean false
21834.cindex "additional groups"
21835.cindex "groups" "additional"
21836.cindex "transport" "group; additional"
21837If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
21838transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
21839to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
21840
21841
21842.option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
21843.cindex limit "transport parallelism"
21844.cindex transport "parallel processes"
21845.cindex transport "concurrency limit"
21846.cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
21847If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
21848it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
21849The control does not apply to shadow transports.
21850
21851.cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
21852Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
21853incremented whenever a transport process is being created. The record
21854is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
21855Obviously there is scope for
21856records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
21857guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
21858
21859If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
21860relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
21861start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
21862may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
21863are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
21864
21865
21866.option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
21867.cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
21868.cindex "size" "of message, limit"
21869.cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
21870This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
21871expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
21872digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
21873including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
21874delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
21875message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
21876the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
21877ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
21878&%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
21879delivered.
21880
21881
21882
21883.option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
21884.cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
21885.cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
21886.cindex "local part" "prefix"
21887.cindex "local part" "suffix"
21888When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
21889affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
21890form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
21891that contains
21892.code
21893local_part_prefix = *-
21894.endd
21895routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
21896is delivered with
21897.code
21898RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
21899.endd
21900This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
21901recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
21902whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
21903deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
21904&(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
21905
21906
21907.option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
21908.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
21909When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
21910in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
21911is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
21912deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
21913part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
21914temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
21915deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
21916
21917However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
21918as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
21919(For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
21920this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
21921
21922For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
21923the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
21924on a remote transport in the current implementation.
21925
21926
21927.option return_path transports string&!! unset
21928.cindex "envelope sender"
21929.cindex "envelope from"
21930.cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
21931.cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
21932If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
21933the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
21934that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
21935designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
21936SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
21937only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
21938header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
21939
21940&*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
21941&%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
21942
21943.vindex "&$return_path$&"
21944The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
21945either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
21946&%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
21947replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
21948option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
21949section &<<SECTverp>>&.
21950
21951&*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
21952remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
21953the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
21954This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
21955&%errors_to%& in a router.
21956
21957
21958
21959.option return_path_add transports boolean false
21960.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
21961If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
21962Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
21963mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
21964have easy access to it.
21965
21966RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
21967the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
21968header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
21969option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
21970incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
21971recipients.
21972
21973
21974.option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
21975See &%shadow_transport%& below.
21976
21977
21978.option shadow_transport transports string unset
21979.cindex "shadow transport"
21980.cindex "transport" "shadow"
21981A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
21982another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
21983
21984Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
21985&%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
21986string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
21987passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
21988expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
21989cause a log line to be written.
21990
21991The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
21992subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
21993provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
21994is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
21995ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
21996of the form
21997.code
21998ST=<shadow transport name>
21999.endd
22000If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
22001parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
22002purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
22003provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
22004headers that some sites insist on.
22005
22006
22007.option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
22008.cindex "transport" "filter"
22009.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22010This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
22011at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
22012individual users or via a system filter.
22013If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
22014
22015When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
22016&%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
22017the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
22018input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
22019command must be specified as an absolute path.
22020
22021The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
22022terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
22023SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
22024lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
22025settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
22026&(pipe)& transports.
22027
22028The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
22029standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
22030destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
22031filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
22032are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
22033
22034The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
22035care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
22036test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
22037SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
22038
22039.cindex "content scanning" "per user"
22040A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
22041at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
22042message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
22043a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
22044not possible to discard a message at this stage.
22045
22046.cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
22047A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
22048being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
22049support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
22050at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
22051more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
22052the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
22053additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
22054
22055.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22056The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
22057the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
22058parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
22059Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
22060section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
22061to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
22062of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
22063an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
22064&(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
22065
22066.vindex "&$host$&"
22067.vindex "&$host_address$&"
22068The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
22069transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
22070which the message is being sent. For example:
22071.code
22072transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
22073 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
22074.endd
22075
22076Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
22077generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
22078command is split up &'before'& expansion.
22079.ilist
22080If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
22081part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
22082expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
22083example:
22084.code
22085transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
22086.endd
22087This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
22088&(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
22089stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
22090the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
22091&`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
22092Exim tried to expand the first one.
22093.next
22094Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
22095expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
22096arguments. Consider this example:
22097.code
22098transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
22099 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
22100.endd
22101The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
22102if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
22103.code
22104transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
22105 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
22106.endd
22107.endlist
22108
22109The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
22110For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
22111normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
22112A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
22113serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
22114the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
22115bounced from a transport filter.
22116
22117If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
22118passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
22119message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
22120
22121
22122.option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
22123.cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
22124When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
22125that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
22126temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
22127&(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
22128way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
22129error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
22130becomes a temporary error.
22131
22132
22133.option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
22134.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
22135.cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
22136This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
22137run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
22138given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
22139associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
22140option is not set.
22141
22142For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
22143specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
22144&%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
22145
22146.cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
22147For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
22148sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
22149to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
22150retry data.
22151.ecindex IIDgenoptra1
22152.ecindex IIDgenoptra2
22153.ecindex IIDgenoptra3
22154
22155
22156
22157
22158
22159
22160. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22161. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22162
22163.chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
22164 "Address batching"
22165.cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
22166The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
22167one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
22168remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
22169normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
22170transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
22171copy of the message is delivered each time.
22172
22173.cindex "batched local delivery"
22174.oindex "&%batch_max%&"
22175.oindex "&%batch_id%&"
22176In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
22177local transport, for example:
22178
22179.ilist
22180In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
22181delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
22182recipients saves space.
22183.next
22184In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
22185a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
22186.next
22187In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
22188to a scanner program or
22189to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
22190acceptable.
22191.endlist
22192
22193These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
22194(&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
22195repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
22196
22197The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
22198delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
22199(no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
22200&%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
22201(that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
22202to certain conditions:
22203
22204.ilist
22205.vindex "&$local_part$&"
22206If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
22207batching is possible.
22208.next
22209.vindex "&$domain$&"
22210If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
22211addresses with the same domain are batched.
22212.next
22213.cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
22214If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
22215addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
22216customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
22217including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
22218from taking place.
22219.next
22220Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
22221delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
22222group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
22223be the same.
22224.endlist
22225
22226In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
22227both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
22228is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
22229course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
22230option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
22231&"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
22232&%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
22233.code
22234check_string = "."
22235escape_string = ".."
22236.endd
22237when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
22238given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
22239&%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
22240
22241.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
22242If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
22243&'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
22244that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
22245transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
22246addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
22247
22248.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
22249.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22250If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
22251transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
22252the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
22253of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
22254argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
22255delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
22256are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
22257
22258
22259
22260
22261. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22262. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22263
22264.chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
22265.scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
22266.scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
22267.cindex "directory creation"
22268.cindex "creating directories"
22269The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
22270file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
22271files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
22272format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
22273University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
22274being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
22275to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
22276delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
22277supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
22278directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
22279
22280The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
22281default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
22282SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
22283included.
22284
22285.cindex "quota" "system"
22286Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
22287also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
22288system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
22289
22290If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
22291partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
22292modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
22293creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
22294
22295Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
22296file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
22297private options.
22298
22299The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
22300users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
22301putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
22302&"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
22303option).
22304
22305
22306
22307.section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
22308The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
22309the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
22310the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
22311normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
22312
22313.vindex "&$address_file$&"
22314.vindex "&$local_part$&"
22315However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
22316directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
22317forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
22318user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
22319the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
22320name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
22321operation. There are two cases:
22322
22323.ilist
22324If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
22325must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
22326common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
22327different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
22328default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
22329name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
22330&%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
22331.next
22332If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
22333used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
22334contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
22335.endlist
22336
22337
22338.cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
22339.cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
22340As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
22341have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
22342form:
22343.code
22344save folder23
22345.endd
22346or Sieve filter commands of the form:
22347.code
22348require "fileinto";
22349fileinto "folder23";
22350.endd
22351In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
22352must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute filename. In the
22353case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
22354is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
22355way of handling this requirement:
22356.code
22357file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
22358 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
22359 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
22360 {$address_file} \
22361 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
22362 }} \
22363 }
22364.endd
22365With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
22366location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
22367&_mail_& directory within the home directory.
22368
22369&*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
22370&_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
22371the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
22372you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
22373&%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
22374path to the transport.
22375
22376&*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
22377the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
22378
22379
22380
22381
22382.section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
22383.cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
22384
22385
22386
22387.option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
22388.cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
22389.cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
22390.cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
22391Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
22392regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
22393delivery is deferred.
22394
22395
22396.option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
22397.cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
22398.cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
22399By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
22400that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
22401are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
22402what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
22403are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
22404
22405
22406.option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
22407See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22408However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
22409happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
22410file.
22411
22412
22413.option batch_max appendfile integer 1
22414See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22415
22416
22417.option check_group appendfile boolean false
22418When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
22419option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
22420delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
22421file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
22422
22423
22424.option check_owner appendfile boolean true
22425When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
22426is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
22427process is running.
22428
22429
22430.option check_string appendfile string "see below"
22431.cindex "&""From""& line"
22432As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
22433matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
22434replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
22435a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
22436contains is significant.
22437
22438If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
22439are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
22440configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
22441&">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
22442&%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
22443
22444The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
22445suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
22446&"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
22447if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
22448.cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
22449.cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
22450.code
22451check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22452escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
22453message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22454message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22455.endd
22456.option create_directory appendfile boolean true
22457.cindex "directory creation"
22458When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
22459directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
22460is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
22461
22462The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
22463operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
22464example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
22465is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
22466in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
22467
22468
22469
22470.option create_file appendfile string anywhere
22471This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
22472by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
22473directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
22474delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
22475beneath.
22476
22477The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
22478&"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
22479set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit filename is
22480given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when filenames
22481are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
22482by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
22483&%file_must_exist%&.
22484
22485
22486.option directory appendfile string&!! unset
22487This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
22488or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
22489redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
22490
22491When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
22492into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
22493appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
22494(see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
22495&<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
22496
22497
22498.option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
22499.cindex "base62"
22500.vindex "&$inode$&"
22501When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
22502&%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
22503whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
22504.code
22505q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
22506.endd
22507This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
22508inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
22509option.
22510
22511
22512.option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
22513If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
22514&%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
22515
22516
22517.option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
22518See &%check_string%& above.
22519
22520
22521.option file appendfile string&!! unset
22522This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
22523&%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
22524of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
22525specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
22526&%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
22527&%file%&.
22528
22529.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22530.cindex "locking files"
22531.cindex "lock files"
22532If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
22533mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
22534
22535The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
22536path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
22537examples:
22538.code
22539file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
22540file = /home/$local_part/inbox
22541file = $home/inbox
22542.endd
22543.cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
22544In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
22545is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
22546create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
22547deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
22548run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
22549
22550
22551
22552.option file_format appendfile string unset
22553.cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
22554This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
22555before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
22556start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
22557colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
22558second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
22559string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
22560transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
22561this added to it:
22562.code
22563file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
22564 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
22565.endd
22566Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
22567a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
22568to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
22569to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
22570is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
22571match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
22572delivery is deferred.
22573
22574
22575.option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
22576If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
22577A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
22578If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
22579
22580
22581.option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
22582.cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22583.cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
22584.cindex "locking files"
22585By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
22586when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
22587sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
22588Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
22589for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
22590deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
22591mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
22592misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
22593
22594On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
22595not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
22596is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
22597and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
22598
22599If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
22600timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
22601retries is
22602.code
22603(lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
22604.endd
22605rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
22606which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
22607&%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
22608
22609You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
22610local deliveries because of errors of the form
22611.code
22612failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
22613.endd
22614
22615.option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
22616This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
22617&%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
22618&%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
22619
22620
22621.option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
22622This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
22623for details of locking.
22624
22625
22626.option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
22627This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
22628is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
22629
22630
22631.option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22632This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
22633used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
22634
22635
22636.option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
22637.cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22638When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
22639exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
22640accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
22641
22642
22643.option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
22644.cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22645.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22646If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22647number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
22648followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
22649external source that maintains the data.
22650
22651
22652.option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
22653.cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22654.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22655If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22656size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
22657This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
22658maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
22659it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
22660
22661
22662
22663.option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
22664.cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
22665If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
22666file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
22667transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
22668&(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
22669&%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
22670directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
22671SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
22672&<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22673
22674
22675.option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
22676.cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
22677.cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
22678This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
22679a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
22680directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
22681calculation. The default value is:
22682.code
22683maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
22684.endd
22685This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
22686(directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
22687&_Trash_&
22688folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
22689.code
22690maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
22691.endd
22692This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
22693directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
22694calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
22695directly into that directory.
22696
22697
22698.option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
22699This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
22700&"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22701
22702
22703.option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
22704This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
22705section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22706
22707
22708.option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
22709.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22710The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
22711If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
22712creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
22713quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
22714value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
22715&<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22716
22717.option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
22718.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
22719.cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
22720The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
22721effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
22722matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
22723containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
22724delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
22725&_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
22726See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
22727
22728
22729.option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
22730.cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
22731If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
22732new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
22733SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
22734below for further details.
22735
22736
22737.option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
22738This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22739section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22740
22741
22742.option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
22743This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22744section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22745
22746
22747.option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
22748.cindex "locking files"
22749.cindex "file" "locking"
22750.cindex "file" "MBX format"
22751.cindex "MBX format, specifying"
22752This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22753set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
22754the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
22755traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
22756IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
22757
22758&*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
22759automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
22760empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
22761combination:
22762.code
22763mbx_format = true
22764message_prefix =
22765message_suffix =
22766.endd
22767If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
22768&%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
22769is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
22770&%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
22771interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
22772should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
22773going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
22774mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
22775
22776If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
22777the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
22778(this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
22779append messages to it.
22780
22781
22782.option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22783.cindex "&""From""& line"
22784The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22785The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22786in which case it is:
22787.code
22788message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
22789 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
22790.endd
22791&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22792&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22793
22794.option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22795The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22796The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22797in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
22798setting
22799.code
22800message_suffix =
22801.endd
22802&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22803&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22804
22805.option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22806If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
22807has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
22808permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
22809if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
22810a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
22811value, and this option is ignored.
22812
22813
22814.option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
22815This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
22816mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
22817true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
22818continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
22819
22820
22821.option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
22822If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
22823successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
22824on users about incoming mail.
22825
22826
22827.option quota appendfile string&!! unset
22828.cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
22829This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
22830or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
22831is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
22832all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
22833individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
22834&%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
22835have no shell access to their mailboxes).
22836
22837As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
22838multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
22839For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
22840
22841A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
22842may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
22843If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
22844become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
22845Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
22846the obvious value which users understand most easily.
22847
22848The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
22849(decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
22850for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, optionally followed by a slash
22851and further option modifiers. If Exim is running on a system with
22852large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
22853be handled.
22854
22855The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22856quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22857
22858&*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
22859
22860The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
22861the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
22862be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
22863fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
22864system quota failures.
22865
22866By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
22867mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
22868last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
22869during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
22870refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
22871message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
22872changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
22873for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
22874continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
22875delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
22876
22877
22878.option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
22879This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
22880into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
22881called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
22882delivery directory.
22883
22884
22885.option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
22886This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
22887number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
22888can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
22889failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
22890&"no quota"&.
22891
22892The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22893quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22894
22895.option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
22896See &%quota%& above.
22897
22898
22899.option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
22900This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
22901for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
22902these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
22903If this is set to a regular expression that matches the filename, and it
22904captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
22905file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
22906
22907This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
22908&-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
22909facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
22910the file length to the filename. For example:
22911.code
22912maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
22913quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
22914.endd
22915An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
22916number of lines in the message.
22917
22918The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
22919filename (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
22920sometimes add other information onto the ends of message filenames.
22921
22922Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
22923
22924This option should not be used when other message-handling software
22925may duplicate messages by making hardlinks to the files. When that is done Exim
22926will count the message size once for each filename, in contrast with the actual
22927disk usage. When the option is not set, calculating total usage requires
22928a system-call per file to get the size; the number of links is then available also
22929as is used to adjust the effective size.
22930
22931
22932.option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
22933See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
22934&%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
22935.code
22936quota_warn_message = "\
22937 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
22938 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
22939 This message is automatically created \
22940 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
22941 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
22942 a warning threshold that is\n\
22943 set by the system administrator.\n"
22944.endd
22945
22946
22947.option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
22948.cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
22949.cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
22950.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22951This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
22952resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
22953size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
22954threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
22955may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
22956sign. For example:
22957.code
22958quota = 10M
22959quota_warn_threshold = 75%
22960.endd
22961If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
22962percent sign is ignored.
22963
22964The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
22965and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
22966warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
22967the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
22968can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
22969&'From:'& line, the default is:
22970.code
22971From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
22972.endd
22973.oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
22974If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
22975option.
22976
22977The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
22978are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
22979percentage.
22980
22981
22982.option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
22983.cindex "envelope from"
22984.cindex "envelope sender"
22985If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
22986format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
22987you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
22988so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
22989for details of batch SMTP.
22990
22991
22992.option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
22993.cindex "carriage return"
22994.cindex "linefeed"
22995This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
22996(carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
22997of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
22998of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
22999
23000&*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
23001(which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
23002in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
23003carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
23004have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
23005changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
23006
23007
23008.option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
23009This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
23010exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
23011&%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
23012that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
23013&%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
23014
23015
23016.option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
23017This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
23018the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
23019&[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
23020each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
23021
23022This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
23023&[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
23024where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
23025both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
23026
23027.cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
23028Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
23029have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
23030&[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
23031the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
23032error.
23033
23034&*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
23035is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
23036
23037
23038.option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
23039If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
23040appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
23041&[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
23042sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
23043&[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
23044delivering over NFS from more than one host.
23045
23046.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
23047In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
23048necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
23049achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
23050file corruption.
23051
23052The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
23053It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
23054except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
23055
23056
23057.option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
23058This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
23059set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
23060locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
23061of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
23062are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
23063the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
23064rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
23065does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
23066
23067You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
23068&%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
23069MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
23070without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
23071
23072
23073
23074
23075.section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
23076.cindex "appending to a file"
23077.cindex "file" "appending"
23078Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
23079
23080.ilist
23081If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
23082return is given.
23083
23084.next
23085.cindex "directory creation"
23086If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
23087&%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
23088&%directory_mode%& option.
23089
23090.next
23091If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
23092indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
23093transport.
23094
23095.next
23096.cindex "file" "locking"
23097.cindex "locking files"
23098.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
23099If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
23100reliably over NFS, as follows:
23101
23102.olist
23103Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
23104current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
23105as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
23106.next
23107Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock filename.
23108.next
23109If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
23110Unlink the hitching post name.
23111.next
23112Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
23113then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
23114of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
23115restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
23116.next
23117If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
23118up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
23119mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
23120lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
23121existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
23122it before trying again.
23123.endlist olist
23124
23125.next
23126A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
23127so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
23128than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
23129
23130.next
23131.cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
23132.cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
23133If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
23134&%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
23135checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
23136is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
23137ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
23138directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
23139idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
23140checked.
23141
23142.next
23143If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
23144and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
23145different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
23146delivery is deferred.
23147
23148.next
23149If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
23150If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
23151is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
23152permissions.
23153
23154.next
23155The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
23156If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
23157hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
23158
23159.next
23160If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
23161changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
23162have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
23163
23164.next
23165If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
23166option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
23167directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
23168open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
23169except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
23170set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
23171the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
23172that prevents link following.
23173
23174.next
23175.cindex "loop" "while file testing"
23176If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
23177existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
23178being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
23179after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
23180
23181.next
23182If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
23183
23184.next
23185.cindex "file" "locking"
23186.cindex "locking files"
23187Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
23188are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
23189&%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
23190However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
23191file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
23192.code
23193/tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
23194.endd
23195using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
23196the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
23197the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
23198
23199If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
23200depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
23201&%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
23202
23203If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
23204&%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
23205to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
23206delivery is deferred.
23207
23208If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
23209&[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
23210waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
23211immediately. It retries up to
23212.code
23213(lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
23214.endd
23215times (rounded up).
23216.endlist
23217
23218At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
23219and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
23220
23221
23222.section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
23223.cindex "delivery" "to single file"
23224.cindex "&""From""& line"
23225When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
23226delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
23227activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
23228&%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
23229router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
23230configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
23231ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
23232
23233No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
23234locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
23235separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
23236of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
23237newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
23238&%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
23239any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
23240
23241If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
23242the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
23243different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
23244deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
23245
23246
23247.cindex "maildir format"
23248.cindex "mailstore format"
23249There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
23250done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
23251&%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
23252formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
23253SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
23254
23255.cindex "directory creation"
23256In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
23257sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
23258option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
23259constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
23260the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
23261&%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
23262deferred.
23263
23264
23265
23266.section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
23267.cindex "maildir format" "description of"
23268If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
23269it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
23270directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
23271directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
23272&_new_& subdirectory.
23273
23274In the filename, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
23275<&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
23276Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
23277before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
23278filename. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
23279opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
23280Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
23281
23282Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
23283called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
23284do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
23285path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
23286&%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
23287contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
23288&_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
23289&_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
23290
23291These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
23292and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
23293folders. Consider this example:
23294.code
23295maildir_format = true
23296directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
23297 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
23298 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
23299maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
23300.endd
23301If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
23302delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
23303the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
23304not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
23305&_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
23306&_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
23307
23308However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
23309delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
23310does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
23311&_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
23312directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
23313
23314&*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
23315not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
23316&_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
23317
23318.cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
23319.cindex "maildir++"
23320If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
23321&%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
23322the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
23323Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
23324down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
23325the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
23326amount of space used.
23327
23328One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
23329computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
23330checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
23331needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
23332use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
23333of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
23334
23335
23336
23337
23338.section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
23339If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
23340When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
23341tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
23342name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
23343the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
23344
23345
23346.vindex "&$message_size$&"
23347Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
23348&%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
23349happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
23350variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
23351forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
23352be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
23353Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
23354empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
23355colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
23356maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
23357backwards compatibility).
23358
23359For one common implementation, you might set:
23360.code
23361maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
23362.endd
23363but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
23364
23365It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
23366as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
23367&[stat()]& each message file.
23368
23369
23370.section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
23371.cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
23372.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
23373If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
23374storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
23375within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
23376creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
23377the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
23378to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
23379
23380The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
23381messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
23382in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
23383value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
23384is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
23385need to know the quota.
23386
23387If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
23388file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
23389
23390A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
23391maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
23392See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
23393details.
23394
23395
23396.section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
23397.cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
23398If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
23399files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
23400message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
23401this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
23402contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
23403itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
23404
23405During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
23406&_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
23407&_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
23408mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
23409file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
23410the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
23411
23412The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
23413option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
23414the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
23415There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
23416greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
23417appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
23418
23419If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
23420failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
23421configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
23422&$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
23423
23424
23425.section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
23426If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
23427file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
23428messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
23429section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
23430.code
23431directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
23432.endd
23433might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
23434then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
23435expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
23436.ecindex IIDapptra1
23437.ecindex IIDapptra2
23438
23439
23440
23441
23442
23443
23444. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23445. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23446
23447.chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
23448.scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
23449.scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
23450The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
23451the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
23452automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
23453&'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
23454to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
23455
23456If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
23457&%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
23458delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
23459that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
23460another router can set up a normal message delivery.
23461
23462
23463The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
23464&"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
23465directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
23466message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
23467empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
23468
23469The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
23470by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
23471passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
23472transport is run as a consequence of a
23473&%mail%&
23474or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
23475supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
23476that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
23477case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
23478is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
23479&%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
23480
23481&(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
23482command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
23483gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
23484&<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
23485
23486There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
23487that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
23488&(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
23489address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
23490separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
23491the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
23492message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
23493
23494Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
23495message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
23496immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
23497the transport defers.
23498Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
23499controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
23500
23501If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
23502&%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
23503of the original message that is included in the generated message when
23504&%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
23505
23506.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
23507If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
23508the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
23509as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
23510is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
23511problems. They are just discarded.
23512
23513
23514
23515.section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
23516.cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
23517
23518.option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
23519This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
23520message when the message is specified by the transport.
23521
23522
23523.option cc autoreply string&!! unset
23524This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
23525when the message is specified by the transport.
23526
23527
23528.option file autoreply string&!! unset
23529The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
23530is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
23531string comes first.
23532
23533
23534.option file_expand autoreply boolean false
23535If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
23536subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
23537
23538
23539.option file_optional autoreply boolean false
23540If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
23541option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
23542
23543
23544.option from autoreply string&!! unset
23545This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
23546specified by the transport.
23547
23548
23549.option headers autoreply string&!! unset
23550This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
23551when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
23552&"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
23553
23554
23555.option log autoreply string&!! unset
23556This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
23557the message is specified by the transport.
23558
23559
23560.option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
23561If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
23562used.
23563
23564
23565.option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
23566If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
23567item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
23568discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
23569generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
23570
23571
23572
23573.option once autoreply string&!! unset
23574This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
23575recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
23576This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
23577
23578If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
23579By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty filename, the message
23580is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
23581However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
23582message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
23583this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
23584prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
23585infinity.
23586
23587If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
23588and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
23589greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
23590Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
23591regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
23592
23593In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
23594which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
23595be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
23596means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
23597unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
23598file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
23599
23600
23601.option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
23602See &%once%& above.
23603
23604
23605.option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
23606See &%once%& above.
23607After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
23608
23609
23610.option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
23611This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
23612specified by the transport.
23613
23614
23615.option return_message autoreply boolean false
23616If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
23617message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
23618configuration option.
23619
23620
23621.option subject autoreply string&!! unset
23622This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
23623specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
23624automatic responses. For example:
23625.code
23626subject = Re: $h_subject:
23627.endd
23628There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
23629subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
23630bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
23631non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
23632small.
23633
23634
23635
23636.option text autoreply string&!! unset
23637This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
23638message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
23639the text comes first.
23640
23641
23642.option to autoreply string&!! unset
23643This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
23644when the message is specified by the transport.
23645.ecindex IIDauttra1
23646.ecindex IIDauttra2
23647
23648
23649
23650
23651. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23652. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23653
23654.chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
23655.cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
23656.cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
23657.cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
23658.cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
23659The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
23660specified command
23661or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
23662This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
23663transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
23664implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
23665to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
23666has it commented out. You need to ensure that
23667.code
23668TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
23669.endd
23670.cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
23671is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
23672included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
23673as follows:
23674
23675.option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
23676See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23677
23678
23679.option batch_max lmtp integer 1
23680This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23681Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
23682good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
23683batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23684
23685
23686.option command lmtp string&!! unset
23687This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
23688is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
23689arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
23690number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
23691is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
23692LMTP protocol.
23693
23694.option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
23695.cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23696If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
23697commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
23698in its response to the LHLO command.
23699
23700.option socket lmtp string&!! unset
23701This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
23702be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
23703delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
23704
23705
23706.option timeout lmtp time 5m
23707The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
23708respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
23709is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
23710LMTP transport:
23711.code
23712lmtp:
23713 driver = lmtp
23714 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
23715 batch_max = 20
23716 user = exim
23717.endd
23718This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
23719necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
23720
23721
23722
23723. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23724. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23725
23726.chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
23727.scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
23728.scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
23729The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
23730running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
23731pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
23732(such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
23733their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
23734following ways:
23735
23736.ilist
23737.vindex "&$local_part$&"
23738A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
23739transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
23740contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
23741is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
23742.next
23743.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23744If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
23745transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
23746more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
23747(because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
23748(described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
23749that are routed to the transport.
23750.next
23751.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
23752A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
23753alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
23754pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
23755&%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
23756(&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
23757this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
23758.endlist
23759
23760
23761The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
23762deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
23763implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
23764
23765In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
23766&_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
23767other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
23768transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
23769directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
23770details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
23771for a discussion of local delivery batching.
23772
23773
23774.section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
23775If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
23776delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
23777any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
23778write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
23779Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
23780of "1" to enforce serialization.
23781
23782
23783
23784
23785.section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
23786.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
23787If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
23788have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
23789the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
23790in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
23791later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
23792logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
23793&"local delivery failed"&.
23794
23795If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
23796the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
23797will be sent as normal.
23798
23799If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
23800script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
23801value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
23802apply in this case.
23803
23804If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
23805return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
23806asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
23807a non-existent command may be the problem.
23808
23809The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
23810set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
23811error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
23812return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
23813included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
23814similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
23815failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
23816&%temp_errors%&.
23817
23818
23819
23820.section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
23821.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
23822The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
23823by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
23824&%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
23825run.
23826
23827.cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
23828Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
23829double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
23830way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
23831
23832String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
23833traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
23834expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
23835For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
23836quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
23837.code
23838command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
23839.endd
23840will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
23841arguments. You have to write
23842.code
23843command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
23844.endd
23845to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
23846argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
23847result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
23848interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
23849generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
23850expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
23851example:
23852.code
23853command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
23854.endd
23855
23856.cindex "transport" "filter"
23857.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23858.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23859Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
23860&`$pipe_addresses`& (no quotes).
23861This is not a general expansion variable; the only
23862place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
23863transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
23864inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
23865avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
23866&(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
23867
23868If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, special handling takes place
23869for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
23870is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
23871argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
23872&'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
23873the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
23874should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
23875run while preserving the argument vector separation.
23876
23877After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
23878in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
23879message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
23880standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
23881read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
23882may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
23883control what is done with it.
23884
23885Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
23886in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
23887taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
23888explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
23889where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
23890under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
23891an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
23892works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
23893as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
23894&%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
23895with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
23896
23897
23898
23899.section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
23900.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23901.cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23902The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
23903This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
23904the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
23905environment. The environment for the &(pipe)& transport is not subject
23906to the &%add_environment%& and &%keep_environment%& main config options.
23907.display
23908&`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
23909&`HOME `& the home directory, if set
23910&`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
23911&`LOCAL_PART `& see below
23912&`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
23913&`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
23914&`LOGNAME `& see below
23915&`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
23916&`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
23917&`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
23918&`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
23919&`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
23920&`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
23921&`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
23922&`USER `& see below
23923.endd
23924When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
23925router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
23926called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
23927the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
23928removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
23929LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
23930same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
23931
23932.cindex "HOST"
23933HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
23934associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
23935pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
23936the router.
23937
23938.cindex "HOME"
23939If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
23940for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
23941by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
23942user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
23943
23944
23945.section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
23946.cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
23947
23948
23949
23950.option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
23951.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
23952The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23953permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
23954permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
23955paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
23956&%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
23957in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
23958the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
23959&%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
23960otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
23961example, if
23962.code
23963allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
23964.endd
23965and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
23966&_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
23967&%use_shell%& is set.
23968
23969
23970.option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
23971See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23972
23973
23974.option batch_max pipe integer 1
23975This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23976See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23977
23978
23979.option check_string pipe string unset
23980As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
23981&%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
23982by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
23983&%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
23984any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
23985of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
23986the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
23987ignored.
23988
23989
23990.option command pipe string&!! unset
23991This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
23992obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
23993set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
23994the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
23995Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
23996&<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
23997
23998
23999.option environment pipe string&!! unset
24000.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
24001.cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
24002This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
24003command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
24004a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
24005environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
24006
24007
24008.option escape_string pipe string unset
24009See &%check_string%& above.
24010
24011
24012.option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
24013.cindex "exec failure"
24014.cindex "failure of exec"
24015.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
24016Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
24017any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
24018is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
24019frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
24020
24021
24022.option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
24023.cindex "signal exit"
24024.cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
24025Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
24026a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
24027frozen in Exim's queue instead.
24028
24029
24030.option force_command pipe boolean false
24031.cindex "force command"
24032.cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
24033Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
24034the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
24035is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
24036useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
24037command. For example:
24038.code
24039command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
24040force_command
24041.endd
24042
24043Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
24044&%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
24045separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
24046
24047
24048.option ignore_status pipe boolean false
24049If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
24050run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
24051Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
24052from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
24053&%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
24054
24055&*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
24056See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
24057
24058
24059.option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
24060.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
24061If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
24062one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
24063and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
24064written to the main log.
24065
24066
24067.option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
24068If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
24069stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
24070the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
24071failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
24072option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
24073be set.
24074
24075
24076.option log_output pipe boolean false
24077If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
24078stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
24079the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
24080exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
24081
24082
24083.option max_output pipe integer 20K
24084This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
24085standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
24086process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
24087catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
24088the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
24089&%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
24090exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
24091
24092
24093.option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
24094The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
24095The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
24096.code
24097message_prefix = \
24098 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
24099 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
24100.endd
24101.cindex "Cyrus"
24102.cindex "&%tmail%&"
24103.cindex "&""From""& line"
24104This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
24105However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
24106or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
24107setting
24108.code
24109message_prefix =
24110.endd
24111&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
24112&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
24113
24114
24115.option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
24116The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
24117The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
24118The suffix can be suppressed by setting
24119.code
24120message_suffix =
24121.endd
24122&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
24123&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
24124
24125
24126.option path pipe string&!! "/bin:/usr/bin"
24127This option is expanded and
24128specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
24129variable of the subprocess.
24130If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
24131sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
24132apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
24133
24134
24135.option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
24136Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
24137a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
24138during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
24139It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
24140for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
24141resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
24142installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
24143of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
24144
24145
24146.option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
24147.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
24148If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
24149process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
24150to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
24151&%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
24152accept the message is used.
24153
24154
24155.option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
24156When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
24157contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
24158in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
24159command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
24160handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
24161
24162
24163.option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
24164If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
24165return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
24166is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
24167However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
24168message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
24169&%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
24170
24171
24172
24173.option return_output pipe boolean false
24174If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
24175deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
24176is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
24177However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
24178output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
24179option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
24180of them may be set.
24181
24182
24183
24184.option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
24185.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
24186This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
24187asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
24188and &%return_output%& is not set,
24189and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
24190temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
24191numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
24192codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
24193defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
24194compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
24195and 73, respectively.
24196
24197
24198.option timeout pipe time 1h
24199If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
24200causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
24201specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
24202command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
24203and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
24204if one of the processes starts a new process group.
24205
24206.option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
24207A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
24208runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
24209treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
24210is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
24211delivery to be deferred.
24212
24213.option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
24214This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
24215
24216
24217.option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
24218.cindex "envelope sender"
24219If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
24220SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
24221commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
24222you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
24223&<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
24224
24225.option use_classresources pipe boolean false
24226.cindex "class resources (BSD)"
24227This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
24228BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
24229resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
24230limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
24231class database.
24232
24233
24234.option use_crlf pipe boolean false
24235.cindex "carriage return"
24236.cindex "linefeed"
24237This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
24238(carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
24239of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
24240of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
24241
24242The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
24243written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
24244are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
24245&%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
24246values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
24247
24248
24249.option use_shell pipe boolean false
24250.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
24251If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
24252instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
24253&<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
24254where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
24255modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
24256&`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
24257command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
24258its &%-c%& option.
24259
24260
24261
24262.section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
24263.cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
24264.cindex "&'procmail'&"
24265.cindex "external local delivery"
24266.cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
24267.cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
24268The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
24269delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
24270this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
24271uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
24272by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
24273necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
24274appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
24275configuration for &%procmail%&:
24276.code
24277# transport
24278procmail_pipe:
24279 driver = pipe
24280 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
24281 return_path_add
24282 delivery_date_add
24283 envelope_to_add
24284 check_string = "From "
24285 escape_string = ">From "
24286 umask = 077
24287 user = $local_part
24288 group = mail
24289
24290# router
24291procmail:
24292 driver = accept
24293 check_local_user
24294 transport = procmail_pipe
24295.endd
24296In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
24297&'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
24298or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
24299user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
24300&%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
24301home directory is the user's home directory by default.
24302
24303&*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
24304.code
24305IFS=" "
24306.endd
24307as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
24308use a shell to run pipe commands.
24309
24310.cindex "Cyrus"
24311The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
24312deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
24313.code
24314# transport
24315local_delivery_cyrus:
24316 driver = pipe
24317 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
24318 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
24319 user = cyrus
24320 group = mail
24321 return_output
24322 log_output
24323 message_prefix =
24324 message_suffix =
24325
24326# router
24327local_user_cyrus:
24328 driver = accept
24329 check_local_user
24330 local_part_suffix = .*
24331 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
24332.endd
24333Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
24334&%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
24335sender.
24336.ecindex IIDpiptra1
24337.ecindex IIDpiptra2
24338
24339
24340. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24341. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24342
24343.chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
24344.scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
24345.scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
24346The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
24347or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
24348that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
24349explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
24350&<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
24351
24352
24353.section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
24354The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
24355two ways:
24356
24357.ilist
24358If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
24359routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
24360that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
24361the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
24362does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
24363value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
24364section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
24365.next
24366.cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
24367When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
24368looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
24369connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
24370for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
24371process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
24372process.
24373.endlist
24374
24375
24376For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
24377incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
24378no further messages are sent over that connection.
24379
24380
24381
24382.section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
24383.vindex "&$host$&"
24384.vindex "&$host_address$&"
24385At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
24386&$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
24387passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
24388specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
24389&$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
24390that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
24391&%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
24392
24393
24394.section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
24395.vindex &$tls_bits$&
24396.vindex &$tls_cipher$&
24397.vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
24398.vindex &$tls_sni$&
24399At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
24400&$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
24401are the values that were set when the message was received.
24402These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
24403SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
24404variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
24405appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
24406are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
24407&%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
24408
24409These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
24410and will be removed in a future release.
24411
24412
24413.section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
24414.cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
24415The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
24416
24417
24418.option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
24419.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
24420When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
24421is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
24422runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
24423reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
24424setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
24425problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
24426
24427.option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
24428.cindex "local host" "sending to"
24429.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
24430When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
24431to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
24432deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
24433the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
24434configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
24435configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
24436
24437
24438.option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
24439.cindex "Cyrus"
24440When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
24441is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
24442overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
24443forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
24444to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
24445ignored.
24446
24447The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
24448started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
24449&$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
24450particular connection.
24451
24452If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
24453&%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
24454deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
24455unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
24456
24457This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
24458deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
24459&"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
24460.code
24461authenticated_sender = $local_part
24462.endd
24463This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
24464allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
24465
24466Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
24467domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
24468value.
24469
24470
24471.option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
24472If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
24473is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
24474authenticated as a client.
24475
24476
24477.option command_timeout smtp time 5m
24478This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
24479sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
24480remote host. Its value must not be zero.
24481
24482
24483.option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
24484This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
24485to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
24486several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
24487less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
24488systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
24489option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
24490
24491
24492.option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
24493.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
24494.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
24495.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24496This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
24497over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
24498For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
24499option.
24500
24501
24502.option dane_require_tls_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
24503.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers for DANE"
24504.cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
24505.cindex DANE "TLS ciphers"
24506This option may be used to override &%tls_require_ciphers%& for connections
24507where DANE has been determined to be in effect.
24508If not set, then &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used.
24509Normal SMTP delivery is not able to make strong demands of TLS cipher
24510configuration, because delivery will fall back to plaintext. Once DANE has
24511been determined to be in effect, there is no plaintext fallback and making the
24512TLS cipherlist configuration stronger will increase security, rather than
24513counter-intuitively decreasing it.
24514If the option expands to be empty or is forced to fail, then it will
24515be treated as unset and &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used instead.
24516
24517
24518.option data_timeout smtp time 5m
24519This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
24520the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
24521of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
24522
24523
24524.option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
24525DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24526.option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
24527DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24528.option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
24529DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24530.option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
24531DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24532.option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
24533DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24534.option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
24535DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24536.option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
24537DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24538.option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "per RFC"
24539DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24540.option dkim_timestamps smtp string&!! unset
24541DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24542
24543
24544.option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
24545.cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
24546.cindex retry "final cutoff"
24547This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
24548domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
24549cutoff times.
24550
24551In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
24552them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
24553Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
24554retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
24555a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
24556unhappy at this prospect, so...
24557
24558If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
24559addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
24560IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
24561none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
24562delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
24563addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
24564continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
24565&%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
24566to them.
24567
24568
24569.option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
24570If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
24571and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
24572the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
24573in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
24574
24575
24576.option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
24577If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
24578&%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
24579See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
24580details.
24581
24582
24583.option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" *
24584.cindex "MX record" "security"
24585.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24586.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24587.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24588DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
24589the dnssec request bit set. Setting this transport option is only useful if the
24590transport overrides or sets the host names. See the &%dnssec_request_domains%&
24591router option.
24592
24593
24594
24595.option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
24596.cindex "MX record" "security"
24597.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24598.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24599.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24600DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
24601the dnssec request bit set. Setting this transport option is only
24602useful if the transport overrides or sets the host names. See the
24603&%dnssec_require_domains%& router option.
24604
24605
24606
24607.option dscp smtp string&!! unset
24608.cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
24609This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
24610of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
24611The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
24612Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
24613&`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
24614
24615The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
24616(for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
24617that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
24618equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
24619Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
24620
24621
24622.option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
24623.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
24624String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
24625colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
24626port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
24627&<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24628item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24629in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
24630
24631Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
24632addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
24633&%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
24634not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
24635&%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
24636However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
24637
24638If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
24639the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
24640transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
24641address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
24642list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
24643
24644Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
24645re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
24646addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
24647copy of the message is sent.
24648
24649The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
24650&%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
24651both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
24652from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
24653fails"& facility.
24654
24655
24656.option final_timeout smtp time 10m
24657This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
24658line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
24659zero.
24660
24661.option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
24662If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
24663being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
24664(or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
24665instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
24666it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
24667
24668.option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
24669This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
24670server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
24671implementations of TLS.
24672
24673.option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
24674.cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
24675.cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
24676.cindex "LHLO argument setting"
24677The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
24678been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
24679command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
24680option is:
24681.code
24682$primary_hostname
24683.endd
24684During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
24685the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
24686&$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
24687used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
24688servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
24689that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
24690interface address, you could use this:
24691.code
24692helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
24693 {$primary_hostname}}
24694.endd
24695The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
24696callouts.
24697
24698.option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
24699Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
24700finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
24701&(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
24702email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
24703all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
24704
24705The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
24706processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
24707&%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
24708&%hosts_override%& is set.
24709
24710The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
24711list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
24712separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
24713&<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24714item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24715in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
24716of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
24717
24718If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
24719the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
24720well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
24721address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
24722&[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
24723&%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
24724that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
24725address are used.
24726
24727During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
24728unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
24729
24730
24731.option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24732.cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
24733.cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
24734.cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
24735.cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24736This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
24737example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
24738matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
24739start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
24740facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
24741
24742
24743.option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
24744.cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24745Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
24746that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
24747
24748.option hosts_pipe_connect smtp "host list&!!" unset
24749.cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
24750.cindex "pipelining" PIPE_CONNECT
24751If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
24752this option controls which to hosts the facility watched for
24753and recorded, and used for subsequent connections.
24754
24755The retry hints database is used for the record,
24756and records are subject to the &%retry_data_expire%& option.
24757When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
24758It also turns SMTP into a client-first protocol
24759so combines well with TCP Fast Open.
24760
24761See also the &%pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts%& main option.
24762
24763Note:
24764When the facility is used, the transport &%helo_data%& option
24765will be expanded before the &$sending_ip_address$& variable
24766is filled in.
24767A check is made for the use of that variable, without the
24768presence of a &"def:"& test on it, but suitably complex coding
24769can avoid the check and produce unexpected results.
24770You have been warned.
24771
24772
24773.option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24774.cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24775Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24776matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24777
24778.option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24779.cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24780Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
24781or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
24782to any host that matches this list.
24783
24784
24785.option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
24786.cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
24787.cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
24788.cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
24789.cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
24790This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
24791delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
24792&<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
24793
24794
24795.option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
24796This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
24797tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
24798why it exists.
24799
24800
24801
24802.option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24803.cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24804.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24805.cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24806For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
24807been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24808message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
24809explanation of when this might be needed.
24810
24811.option hosts_noproxy_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24812.cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24813.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24814.cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24815For any host that matches this list, a TLS session which has
24816been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24817message on the same session.
24818
24819The traditional implementation closes down TLS and re-starts it in the new
24820process, on the same open TCP connection, for each successive message
24821sent. If permitted by this option a pipe to to the new process is set up
24822instead, and the original process maintains the TLS connection and proxies
24823the SMTP connection from and to the new process and any subsequents.
24824The new process has no access to TLS information, so cannot include it in
24825logging.
24826
24827
24828
24829.option hosts_override smtp boolean false
24830If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
24831attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
24832&%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
24833&%fallback_hosts%&.
24834
24835
24836.option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
24837.cindex "randomized host list"
24838.cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
24839.cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
24840If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
24841&%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
24842were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
24843router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
24844is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
24845list can be used to do crude load sharing.
24846
24847When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
24848order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
24849behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
24850&`+`& in the host list. For example:
24851.code
24852hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
24853.endd
24854The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
24855randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
24856If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
24857
24858.option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24859.cindex "authentication" "required by client"
24860This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
24861before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
24862servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
24863authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
24864temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
24865hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
24866&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24867
24868
24869.option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
24870.cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24871Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
24872TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24873&%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24874
24875.option hosts_require_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
24876.cindex DANE "transport options"
24877.cindex DANE "requiring for certain servers"
24878If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
24879TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
24880and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made. See
24881the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router and transport options.
24882There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
24883See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
24884
24885.option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24886.cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24887Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
24888TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24889&%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24890
24891.option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24892.cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24893Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24894matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24895&*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
24896incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
24897
24898.option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24899.cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
24900This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24901authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
24902connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
24903unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
24904&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24905
24906.option hosts_try_chunking smtp "host list&!!" *
24907.cindex CHUNKING "enabling, in client"
24908.cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
24909.cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
24910This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24911CHUNKING support, Exim will attempt to use BDAT commands rather than DATA.
24912.new
24913Unless DKIM signing is being done,
24914.wen
24915BDAT will not be used in conjunction with a transport filter.
24916
24917.option hosts_try_dane smtp "host list&!!" *
24918.cindex DANE "transport options"
24919.cindex DANE "attempting for certain servers"
24920If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
24921TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
24922and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made. See
24923the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router and transport options.
24924There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
24925See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
24926
24927.option hosts_try_fastopen smtp "host list&!!" *
24928.cindex "fast open, TCP" "enabling, in client"
24929.cindex "TCP Fast Open" "enabling, in client"
24930.cindex "RFC 7413" "TCP Fast Open"
24931This option provides a list of servers to which, provided
24932the facility is supported by this system, Exim will attempt to
24933perform a TCP Fast Open.
24934No data is sent on the SYN segment but, if the remote server also
24935supports the facility, it can send its SMTP banner immediately after
24936the SYN,ACK segment. This can save up to one round-trip time.
24937
24938The facility is only active for previously-contacted servers,
24939as the initiator must present a cookie in the SYN segment.
24940
24941On (at least some) current Linux distributions the facility must be enabled
24942in the kernel by the sysadmin before the support is usable.
24943There is no option for control of the server side; if the system supports
24944it it is always enabled. Note that lengthy operations in the connect ACL,
24945such as DNSBL lookups, will still delay the emission of the SMTP banner.
24946
24947.option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
24948.cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
24949This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24950PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
24951for multi-recipient messages.
24952The option can usually be left as default.
24953
24954.option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
24955.cindex "bind IP address"
24956.cindex "IP address" "binding"
24957.vindex "&$host$&"
24958.vindex "&$host_address$&"
24959This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
24960call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
24961&`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
24962message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
24963&$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
24964outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
24965interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
24966unknown.
24967
24968During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
24969&$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
24970during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
24971string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
24972string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
24973separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
24974For example:
24975.code
24976interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
24977.endd
24978The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
24979connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
24980&%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
24981interface to use if the host has more than one.
24982
24983
24984.option keepalive smtp boolean true
24985.cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
24986This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
24987connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
24988periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
24989of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
24990or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
24991that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
24992that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
24993TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
24994unreachable hosts.
24995
24996
24997.option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
24998.cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
24999If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
25000string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
25001has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
25002
25003.option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
25004.cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
25005This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
25006SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
25007so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
25008permits this.
25009
25010
25011.option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
25012.vindex "&$domain$&"
25013When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
25014addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
25015to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
25016handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
25017&$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
25018is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
25019
25020It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
25021&$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
25022&$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
25023
25024.option port smtp string&!! "see below"
25025.cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
25026.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
25027This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
25028&*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
25029received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
25030The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
25031variable that contains an outgoing port.
25032
25033If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
25034otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
25035normally &"smtp"&,
25036but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"& the default is &"lmtp"&
25037and if &%protocol%& is set to &"smtps"& the default is &"smtps"&.
25038If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
25039is deferred.
25040
25041Note that at least one Linux distribution has been seen failing
25042to put &"smtps"& in its &"/etc/services"& file, resulting is such deferrals.
25043
25044
25045
25046.option protocol smtp string smtp
25047.cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
25048.cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
25049.cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
25050.vindex "&$port$&"
25051If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
25052the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
25053protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
25054deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
25055over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
25056
25057If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
25058changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
25059connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
25060The Internet standards bodies used to strongly discourage use of this mode,
25061but as of RFC 8314 it is perferred over STARTTLS for message submission
25062(as distinct from MTA-MTA communication).
25063
25064
25065.option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
25066Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
25067constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
25068means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
25069tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
25070addresses is not affected.
25071
25072However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
25073each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
25074the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
25075Exim to use only the host name.
25076Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
25077
25078
25079.option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
25080.cindex "serializing connections"
25081.cindex "host" "serializing connections"
25082Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
25083host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
25084the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
25085slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
25086Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
25087&%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
25088
25089.cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
25090Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
25091written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
25092is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
25093records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
25094guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
25095
25096If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
25097relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
25098start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
25099may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
25100are used for ETRN serialization.
25101
25102See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
25103
25104
25105.option size_addition smtp integer 1024
25106.cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
25107.cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
25108.cindex "size" "of message"
25109.cindex "transport" "filter"
25110.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
25111If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
25112MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
25113an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
25114sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
25115configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
25116this if a lot of text is added to messages.
25117
25118Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
25119the use of the SIZE option altogether.
25120
25121
25122.option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
25123.cindex proxy SOCKS
25124This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
25125transport. For details see section &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
25126
25127
25128.option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
25129.cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
25130.cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
25131.vindex "&$host$&"
25132.vindex "&$host_address$&"
25133The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
25134client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
25135connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
25136address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
25137details of TLS.
25138
25139&*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
25140certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
25141name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
25142assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
25143client.
25144
25145
25146.option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
25147.cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
25148.cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
25149This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
25150be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
25151
25152
25153.option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
25154.cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
25155When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
25156key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
25157for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
25158If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
25159will fail.
25160
25161Only supported when using GnuTLS.
25162
25163
25164.option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
25165.cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
25166.vindex "&$host$&"
25167.vindex "&$host_address$&"
25168The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
25169client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
25170connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
25171&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25172expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
25173result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
25174the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25175
25176
25177.option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
25178.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
25179.cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
25180.vindex "&$host$&"
25181.vindex "&$host_address$&"
25182The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
25183when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
25184the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
25185&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25186expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
25187is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
25188&<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
25189ciphers is a preference order.
25190
25191
25192
25193.option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
25194.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
25195.vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
25196If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
25197TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
25198the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
25199certificate and private key for the session.
25200
25201See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
25202
25203Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
25204TLS extensions.
25205
25206
25207
25208
25209.option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
25210.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
25211When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
25212setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
25213to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
25214current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
25215option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
25216response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
25217TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
25218unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
25219in clear.
25220
25221
25222.option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
25223.cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25224.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25225This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
25226certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
25227The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
25228Note that unless the host is in this list
25229TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
25230when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
25231The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
25232certificate verification succeeds.
25233
25234
25235.option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
25236.cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
25237.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25238This option give a list of hosts for which,
25239while verifying the server certificate,
25240checks will be included on the host name
25241(note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
25242versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
25243limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
25244
25245There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
25246
25247
25248.option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
25249.cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25250.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25251.vindex "&$host$&"
25252.vindex "&$host_address$&"
25253The value of this option must be either the
25254word "system"
25255or the absolute path to
25256a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
25257for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
25258
25259The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
25260This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
25261is taken as empty and an explicit location
25262must be specified.
25263
25264The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
25265preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
25266
25267With OpenSSL the certificates specified
25268explicitly
25269either by file or directory
25270are added to those given by the system default location.
25271
25272The values of &$host$& and
25273&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25274expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25275
25276For back-compatibility,
25277if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
25278(a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
25279and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
25280
25281
25282.option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
25283.cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25284.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25285This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
25286certificate verification must succeed.
25287The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
25288If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
25289operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
25290
25291.option utf8_downconvert smtp integer!! unset
25292.cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
25293.cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
25294If built with internationalization support,
25295this option controls conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
25296to a-label form.
25297For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
25298
25299
25300
25301
25302.section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
25303 "SECTvalhosmax"
25304.cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
25305.cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
25306There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
25307tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
25308&%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
25309
25310
25311The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
25312for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
25313option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
25314multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
25315retrying.
25316
25317Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
25318multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
25319created as a result of routing one of these domains.
25320
25321Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
25322several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
25323problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
25324&%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
25325delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
25326
25327Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
25328arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
25329limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
25330some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
25331&%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
25332that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
25333see below for an exception).
25334
25335Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
25336list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
25337If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
25338but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
25339that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
25340
25341Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
25342higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
25343hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
25344which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
25345tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
25346reached their retry times.
25347
25348However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
25349large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
25350Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
25351of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
25352time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
25353without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
25354all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
25355there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
25356the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
25357every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
25358reached.
25359
25360The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
25361particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
25362out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
25363reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
25364been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
25365take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
25366
25367The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
25368Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
25369and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
25370possible IP addresses have been tried.
25371.ecindex IIDsmttra1
25372.ecindex IIDsmttra2
25373
25374
25375
25376
25377
25378. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25379. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25380
25381.chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
25382.scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
25383There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
25384addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
25385(referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
25386abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
25387
25388Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
25389messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
25390&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
25391appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
25392locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
25393unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
25394lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
25395
25396One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
25397when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
25398such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
25399do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
25400
25401
25402.section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
25403This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
25404main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
25405&%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
25406
25407Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
25408Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
25409facility; you do not have to use it.
25410
25411The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
25412configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
25413addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
25414address to which it applies.
25415
25416Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
25417the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
25418rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
25419those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
25420by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
25421are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
25422rules.
25423
25424Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
25425applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
25426well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
25427headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
25428
25429
25430In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
25431legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
25432in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
25433used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
25434Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
25435discouraged.
25436
25437There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
25438illustrated by these examples:
25439
25440.ilist
25441The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
25442exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
25443gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
25444&'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
25445.next
25446A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
25447&'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
25448.endlist
25449
25450
25451
25452.section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
25453.cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
25454.cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
25455Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
25456message's processing.
25457
25458.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
25459At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
25460by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
25461ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
25462is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
25463rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
25464rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
25465RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
25466rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
25467
25468.vindex "&$domain$&"
25469.vindex "&$local_part$&"
25470Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
25471may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
25472rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
25473from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
25474for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
25475value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
25476as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
25477SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
25478
25479As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
25480recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
25481the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
25482any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
25483.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
25484before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
25485
25486When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
25487rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
25488redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
25489
25490.cindex "envelope from"
25491.cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
25492.cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
25493.cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
25494At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
25495specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
25496This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
25497section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
25498header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
25499applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
25500
25501The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
25502transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
25503transport time.
25504
25505
25506
25507
25508.section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
25509.cindex "rewriting" "testing"
25510.cindex "testing" "rewriting"
25511Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the runtime
25512configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
25513&%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
255142822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
25515transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
25516appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
25517envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
25518.code
25519exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
25520.endd
25521might produce the output
25522.code
25523sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25524from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25525to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25526cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25527bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25528reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25529env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25530env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25531.endd
25532which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
25533the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
25534present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
25535set for a particular transport.
25536
25537
25538.section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
25539.cindex "rewriting" "rules"
25540The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
25541rules in the form
25542.display
25543<&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
25544.endd
25545Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
25546transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
25547takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
25548any colons must be doubled, of course).
25549
25550The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
25551Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
25552case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
25553characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
25554ignored.
25555
25556For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
25557order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
25558replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
25559
25560The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
25561releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
25562received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
25563lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
25564address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
25565(or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
25566that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
25567
25568.vindex "&$domain$&"
25569.vindex "&$local_part$&"
25570The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
25571string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
25572rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
25573.code
25574*@* ${lookup ...
25575.endd
25576where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
25577refer to the address that is being rewritten.
25578
25579
25580.section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
25581.cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
25582.cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
25583The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
25584address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
25585single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
25586against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
25587you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
25588facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
25589
25590Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
25591case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
25592can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
25593
25594.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
25595After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
25596depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
25597replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
25598refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
25599numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
25600of pattern they are set as follows:
25601
25602.ilist
25603If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
25604refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
25605the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
25606pattern
25607.code
25608*queen@*.fict.example
25609.endd
25610is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
25611.code
25612$0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
25613$1 = hearts-
25614$2 = wonderland
25615.endd
25616Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
25617does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
25618
25619.next
25620If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
25621of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
25622for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
25623rewriting rule of the form
25624.display
25625&`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
25626.endd
25627and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
25628.code
25629$1 = foo
25630$2 = bar
25631$3 = baz.example
25632.endd
25633If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
25634wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
25635&$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
25636partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
25637whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
25638.endlist
25639
25640
25641.section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
25642.cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
25643If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
25644match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
25645rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
25646.code
25647hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
25648.endd
25649specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
25650&'From:'& headers.
25651
25652.vindex "&$domain$&"
25653.vindex "&$local_part$&"
25654If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
25655yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
25656&$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
25657Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
25658cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
25659matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
25660the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
25661current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
25662expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
25663entry written to the panic log.
25664
25665
25666
25667.section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
25668There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
25669
25670.ilist
25671Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
25672c, f, h, r, s, t.
25673.next
25674A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
25675.next
25676Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
25677.endlist
25678
25679For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
25680E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
25681
25682
25683
25684.section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
25685 "SECID154"
25686.cindex "rewriting" "flags"
25687If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
25688&<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
25689and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
25690transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
25691rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
25692.display
25693&`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
25694&`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
25695&`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
25696&`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
25697&`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
25698&`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
25699&`h`& rewrite all headers
25700&`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
25701&`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
25702&`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
25703.endd
25704"All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
25705individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
25706other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
25707
25708You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
25709restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
25710
25711
25712.section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
25713.cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
25714.cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
25715.cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
25716The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
25717SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
25718before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
25719required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
25720data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
25721
25722.vindex "&$domain$&"
25723.vindex "&$local_part$&"
25724This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
25725compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
25726input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
25727the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
25728expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
25729original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
25730
25731
25732.section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
25733There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
25734take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
25735correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
25736
25737.ilist
25738If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
25739unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
25740absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
25741.next
25742If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
25743even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
25744expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
25745(does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
25746.next
25747The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
25748address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
25749rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
25750.next
25751.cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
25752When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
25753to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
25754left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
25755.code
25756From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
25757.endd
25758into
25759.code
25760From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
25761.endd
25762.cindex "RFC 2047"
25763Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
25764done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
25765causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
25766replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
257672822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
25768brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
25769(except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
25770is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
25771
25772When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
25773rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
25774.endlist
25775
25776
25777.section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
25778Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
25779.code
25780*@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
25781*@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
25782 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
25783.endd
25784Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
25785the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
25786has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
25787consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
25788present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
25789explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
25790at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
25791error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
25792
25793The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
25794domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
25795.code
25796root@*.hitch.fict.example *
25797.endd
25798were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
25799local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
25800
25801Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
25802&${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
25803messages that originate outside the local host:
25804.code
25805*@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
25806 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
25807.endd
25808The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
25809space.
25810
25811.cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
25812.cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
25813Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
25814an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
25815the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
25816remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
25817sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
25818components. For example, the rule
25819.code
25820\N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
25821.endd
25822rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
25823&'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
25824a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
25825method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
25826to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
25827use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
25828can be done on the rewritten addresses.
25829.ecindex IIDaddrew
25830
25831
25832
25833
25834
25835. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25836. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25837
25838.chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
25839.scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
25840.scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
25841The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
25842retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
25843be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
25844empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
25845errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
25846general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
25847line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
25848address, domain and error.
25849
25850The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
25851host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
25852Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
25853address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
25854been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
25855tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
25856log selector is set, the message
25857.cindex "retry" "time not reached"
25858&"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
25859skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
25860the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
25861
25862Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
25863in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
25864actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
25865failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
25866the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
25867added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
25868same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
25869domain are maintained independently.
25870
25871When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
25872receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
25873always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
25874behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
25875quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
25876suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
25877subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
25878the local address is reached.
25879
25880.section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
25881If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
25882whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
25883files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
25884always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
25885
25886The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
25887rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
25888record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
25889timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
25890and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
25891messages that it should now be retaining.
25892
25893
25894
25895.section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
25896.cindex "retry" "rules"
25897Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
25898separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
25899addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
25900enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
25901in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
25902present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
25903message's sender, respectively.
25904
25905
25906The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
25907&<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
25908which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
25909has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
25910list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
25911which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
25912example,
25913.code
25914lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25915.endd
25916provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
25917whereas
25918.code
25919alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25920.endd
25921applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
25922In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
25923part.
25924
25925.cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
25926&*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
25927must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
25928expressions work in address lists.
25929.display
25930&`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
25931&`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
25932.endd
25933
25934
25935.section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
25936When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
25937example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
25938against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
25939router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
25940regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
25941A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
25942&"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
25943&%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
25944
25945Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
25946failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
25947configuration is tested against the complete address only if
25948&%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
25949local transports).
25950
25951.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
25952However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
25953suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
25954whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
25955rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
25956failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
25957recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
25958reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
25959&%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
25960lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
25961commands.
25962
25963
25964
25965.section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
25966 "SECID160"
25967For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
25968example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
25969twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
25970&"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
25971the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
25972suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
25973.code
25974a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
25975 MX 6 p.q.r.example
25976 MX 7 m.n.o.example
25977.endd
25978and the retry rules are
25979.code
25980p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
25981a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
25982.endd
25983and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
25984first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
25985rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
25986to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
25987tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
25988first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
25989
25990In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
25991first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
25992&'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
25993routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
25994
25995&*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
25996However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
25997host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
25998.code
25999route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
26000.endd
26001then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
26002textual form of the IP address.
26003
26004.section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
26005.cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
26006The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
26007asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
26008
26009.vlist
26010.vitem &%auth_failed%&
26011Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
26012&%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
26013
26014.vitem &%data_4xx%&
26015A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
26016after the command, or after sending the message's data.
26017
26018.vitem &%mail_4xx%&
26019A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
26020
26021.vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
26022A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
26023.endlist
26024
26025For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
26026as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
26027recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
26028and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
26029retry rule of this form:
26030.code
26031the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
26032.endd
26033These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
26034LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
26035
26036.vlist
26037.vitem &%lost_connection%&
26038A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
26039legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
26040for the same host, it indicates something odd.
26041
26042.vitem &%lookup%&
26043A DNS lookup for a host failed.
26044Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
26045its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
26046Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
26047its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
26048
26049.vitem &%refused_MX%&
26050A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
26051
26052.vitem &%refused_A%&
26053A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
26054
26055.vitem &%refused%&
26056A connection was refused.
26057
26058.vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
26059A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
26060
26061.vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
26062A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
26063
26064.vitem &%timeout_connect%&
26065A connection attempt timed out.
26066
26067.vitem &%timeout_MX%&
26068There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
26069obtained from an MX record.
26070
26071.vitem &%timeout_A%&
26072There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
26073obtained from an MX record.
26074
26075.vitem &%timeout%&
26076There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
26077
26078.vitem &%tls_required%&
26079The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
26080&(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
26081to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
26082
26083.vitem &%quota%&
26084A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
26085transport.
26086
26087.vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
26088.cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
26089.cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
26090A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
26091transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
26092&'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
26093for four days.
26094.endlist
26095
26096.cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
26097The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
26098timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
26099it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
26100However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
26101heuristic rules:
26102
26103.ilist
26104If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
26105used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
26106quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
26107.next
26108.cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
26109For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
26110subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
26111the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
26112change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
26113MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
26114time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
26115.next
26116For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
26117obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
26118.endlist
26119
26120The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
26121mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
26122when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
26123error).
26124
26125
26126
26127.section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
26128.cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
26129You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
26130specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
26131apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
26132form:
26133.display
26134&`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
26135.endd
26136The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
26137.code
26138* rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
26139.endd
26140matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
26141host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
26142For example:
26143.code
26144a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
26145.endd
26146&*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
26147(which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
26148only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
26149its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
26150all messages, not just those with specific senders.
26151
26152When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
26153&%-f%& command line option, like this:
26154.code
26155exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
26156.endd
26157If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
26158list is never matched.
26159
26160
26161
26162
26163
26164.section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
26165.cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
26166The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
26167sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
26168.display
26169<&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
26170.endd
26171The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
26172time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
26173arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
26174time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
26175relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
26176
26177.cindex "retry" "algorithms"
26178.cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
26179.cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
26180.cindex "retry" "random intervals"
26181The available algorithms are:
26182
26183.ilist
26184&'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
26185the interval.
26186.next
26187&'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
26188specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
26189is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
26190.next
26191&'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
26192retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
26193maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
26194the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
26195rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
26196members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
26197queue processing times.
26198.endlist
26199
26200When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
26201order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
26202used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
26203case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
26204current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
26205computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
26206interval is found. The main configuration variable
26207.cindex "limit" "retry interval"
26208.cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
26209.oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
26210&%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
26211cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
26212
26213A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
26214host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
26215basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
26216for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
26217generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
26218time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
26219time.
26220
26221.cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
26222Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
26223run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
26224starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
26225new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
26226If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
26227occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
26228messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
26229processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
26230your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
26231number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
26232sending everything to a smart host, for example).
26233
26234The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
26235&'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
26236&<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
26237&'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
26238are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
26239deliveries that have been deferred.
26240
26241
26242.section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
26243Here are some example retry rules:
26244.code
26245alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
26246wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
26247wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
26248lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
26249* refused_A F,2h,20m;
26250* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
26251.endd
26252The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
26253&'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
26254mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
26255hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
26256parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
26257effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
26258fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
26259days.
26260
26261The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
26262happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
26263intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
26264first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
26265so on (this is a rather extreme example).
26266
26267The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
26268They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
26269all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
26270were not obtained from an MX record.
26271
26272The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
26273first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
26274not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
26275hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
262761.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
26277
26278
26279
26280.section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
26281.cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
26282.oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
26283.cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
26284.cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
26285Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
26286consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
26287set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
26288been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
26289arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
26290failing for the first time.
26291
26292This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
26293backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
26294Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
26295down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
26296
26297If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
26298every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
26299message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
26300
26301
26302
26303
26304.section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
26305.cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
26306.cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
26307Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
26308that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
26309default retry rule:
26310.code
26311* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
26312.endd
26313the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
26314long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
26315failure for the recipient address that counts.
26316
26317When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
26318addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
26319causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
26320In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
26321time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
26322
26323For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
26324messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
26325post-cutoff retry time is not used.
26326
26327.cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
26328.cindex retry "final cutoff"
26329If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
26330.oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
26331&%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
26332default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses,
26333as set by the &%retry_data_expire%& option, is
26334reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
26335attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
26336those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
26337the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
26338
26339In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
26340for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
26341times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
26342behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
26343to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
26344notice.
26345
26346If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
26347addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
26348addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
26349no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
26350words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
26351addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
26352If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
26353&%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
26354deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
26355true.
26356
26357.section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
26358.cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
26359Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
26360intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
26361its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
26362because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
26363host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
26364failing messages remain in the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
26365reached.
26366
26367Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
26368applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
26369Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
26370examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
26371commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
26372time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
26373is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
26374time out the address.
26375
26376The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
26377the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
26378given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
26379time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
26380not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
26381considered immediately.
26382.ecindex IIDretconf1
26383.ecindex IIDregconf2
26384
26385
26386
26387
26388
26389
26390. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26391. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26392
26393.chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
26394.scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
26395.scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
26396The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's runtime configuration is concerned
26397with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
26398described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
26399to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
26400permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
26401transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
26402other.
26403
26404.cindex "AUTH" "description of"
26405Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
26406
26407.ilist
26408The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
26409the client's EHLO command.
26410.next
26411The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
26412may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
26413.next
26414The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
26415appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
26416just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
26417any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
26418with the AUTH command.
26419.next
26420The server either accepts or denies authentication.
26421.next
26422If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
26423option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
26424mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
26425connection.
26426.next
26427If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
26428authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
26429unauthenticated connection.
26430.endlist
26431
26432If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
26433mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
26434SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
26435includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
26436.display
26437&`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
26438&`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
26439&`Connected to server.example.`&
26440&`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
26441&`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
26442&*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
26443&`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
26444&`250-SIZE 52428800`&
26445&`250-PIPELINING`&
26446&`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
26447&`250 HELP`&
26448.endd
26449The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
26450authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
26451mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
26452routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
26453controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
26454included by setting
26455.code
26456AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
26457AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
26458AUTH_DOVECOT=yes
26459AUTH_EXTERNAL=yes
26460AUTH_GSASL=yes
26461AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
26462AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
26463AUTH_SPA=yes
26464AUTH_TLS=yes
26465.endd
26466in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
26467authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
26468the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
26469The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
26470work via a socket interface.
26471The fourth provides for negotiation of authentication done via non-SMTP means,
26472as defined by RFC 4422 Appendix A.
26473The fifth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
26474provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
26475The sixth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
26476supporting setting a server keytab.
26477The seventh can be configured to support
26478the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
26479not formally documented, but used by several MUAs.
26480The eighth authenticator
26481supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
26482The last is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
26483instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
26484
26485The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
26486section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
26487authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
26488authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
26489is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
26490messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
26491options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
26492
26493To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
26494&%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
26495either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
26496functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
26497to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
26498both sets of options, is required. For example:
26499.code
26500cram:
26501 driver = cram_md5
26502 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26503 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
26504 client_name = ph10
26505 client_secret = secret2
26506.endd
26507The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
26508&%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
26509
26510Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
26511The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
26512authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
26513in Exim.
26514
26515&*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
26516per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
26517account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
26518authenticating data.
26519
26520Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
26521&'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
26522and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
26523Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
26524used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
26525second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
26526user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
26527configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
26528&'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
26529as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
26530choose to honour.
26531
26532A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
26533to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
26534mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
26535typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
26536
26537
26538
26539.section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
26540.cindex "authentication" "generic options"
26541.cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
26542
26543.option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26544When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
26545&%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
26546used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
26547encrypted by a setting such as:
26548.code
26549client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
26550.endd
26551
26552
26553.option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
26554When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
26555result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
26556Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
26557
26558
26559.option driver authenticators string unset
26560This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
26561authenticators is to be used.
26562
26563
26564.option public_name authenticators string unset
26565This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
26566implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
26567contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
26568but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
26569defaults to the driver's instance name.
26570
26571
26572.option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26573When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
26574is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
26575mechanism is not advertised.
26576If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
26577forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
26578See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
26579
26580
26581.option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26582This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
26583is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
26584for details.
26585
26586For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
26587mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
26588
26589For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
26590authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
26591authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
26592authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
26593to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
26594error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
26595string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
26596expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
26597other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
26598the error text.
26599
26600
26601.option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
26602If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
26603command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
26604output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
26605out the values of variables.
26606If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
26607output, and Exim carries on processing.
26608
26609
26610.option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
26611.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26612.vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
26613When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
26614expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
26615messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
26616lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
26617configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
26618refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
26619On a failing authentication the expansion result is instead saved in
26620the &$authenticated_fail_id$& variable.
26621If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
26622
26623
26624.option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26625This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
26626as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
26627driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
26628as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
26629remembered for later use.
26630How it is used is described in the following section.
26631
26632
26633
26634
26635
26636.section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
26637.cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
26638.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26639When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
26640the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
26641message:
26642
26643.ilist
26644If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
26645than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
26646.next
26647If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
26648.next
26649.vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
26650If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
26651running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
26652from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
26653&$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
26654return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
26655given for the MAIL command.
26656.next
26657If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
26658is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
26659authenticated.
26660.next
26661If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
26662the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
26663&%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
26664valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
26665fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
26666&$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
26667the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
26668message.
26669.endlist
26670
26671
26672When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
26673hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
26674&$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
26675process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
26676
26677.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
26678Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
26679MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
26680therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
26681value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
26682ACL is run.
26683
26684
26685
26686.section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
26687.cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
26688When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
26689authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
26690conditions:
26691
26692.ilist
26693The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
26694.next
26695It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
26696yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
26697.endlist
26698
26699The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
26700the mechanisms are advertised.
26701
26702Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
26703provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
26704even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
26705set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
26706You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
26707For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
26708that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
26709.code
26710auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
26711.endd
26712so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
26713
26714The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
26715authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
26716advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
26717such as:
26718.code
26719server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
26720.endd
26721.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
26722If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
26723yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
26724
26725When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
26726immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
26727command. This is the case if
26728
26729.ilist
26730The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
26731.next
26732No authenticators are configured with server options; or
26733.next
26734Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
26735server authenticators.
26736.endlist
26737
26738
26739Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
26740to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
26741AUTH is accepted from any client host.
26742
26743If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
26744server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
26745that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
26746the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
26747fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
26748rejected with a 504 error.
26749
26750.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
26751.vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
26752When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
26753&$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
26754or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
26755public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
26756client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
26757no successful authentication.
26758
26759.cindex authentication "expansion item"
26760Successful authentication sets up information used by the
26761&%authresults%& expansion item.
26762
26763
26764
26765
26766.section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
26767.cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
26768.cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
26769.cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
26770Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
26771configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
26772encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
26773script:
26774.code
26775use MIME::Base64;
26776printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
26777.endd
26778.cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
26779This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
26780interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
26781some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
26782command line to run this script on such data might be
26783.code
26784encode '\0user\0password'
26785.endd
26786Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
26787backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
26788whose code value is zero.
26789
26790&*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
26791digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
26792you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
26793interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
26794
26795&*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
26796specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
26797example, a command such as
26798.code
26799encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
26800.endd
26801gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
26802
26803If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
26804base64-encoded strings is to run the command
26805.code
26806echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
26807.endd
26808The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
26809in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
26810output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
26811should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
26812
26813
26814
26815.section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
26816.cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
26817The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
26818&%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
26819announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
26820of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
26821
26822.ilist
26823For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
26824they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
26825mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
26826of the authenticator.
26827.next
26828.vindex "&$host$&"
26829.vindex "&$host_address$&"
26830When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
26831variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
26832that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
26833any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
26834Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
26835delivery to be deferred.
26836.next
26837If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
26838Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
26839try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
26840usual way.
26841.next
26842If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
26843carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
26844possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
26845no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
26846what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
26847&%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
26848delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
26849turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
26850deliver the message unauthenticated.
26851.endlist
26852
26853Note that the hostlist test for whether to do authentication can be
26854confused if name-IP lookups change between the time the peer is decided
26855upon and the time that the transport runs. For example, with a manualroute
26856router given a host name, and with DNS "round-robin" used by that name: if
26857the local resolver cache times out between the router and the transport
26858running, the transport may get an IP for the name for its authentication
26859check which does not match the connection peer IP.
26860No authentication will then be done, despite the names being identical.
26861
26862For such cases use a separate transport which always authenticates.
26863
26864.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26865When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
26866parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
26867the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
26868is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
26869incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
26870allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
26871to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
26872&%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
26873&%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
26874the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
26875.ecindex IIDauthconf1
26876.ecindex IIDauthconf2
26877
26878
26879
26880
26881
26882
26883. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26884. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26885
26886.chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
26887.scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
26888.scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
26889The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
26890LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
26891plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
26892security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
26893(see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
26894use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
26895connections as you do for login accounts.
26896
26897.section "Avoiding cleartext use" "SECTplain_TLS"
26898The following generic option settings will disable &(plaintext)& authenticators when
26899TLS is not being used:
26900.code
26901 server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
26902 client_condition = ${if def:tls_out_cipher}
26903.endd
26904
26905&*Note*&: a plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not vulnerable to casual snooping,
26906but is still vulnerable to a Man In The Middle attack unless certificates
26907(including their names) have been properly verified.
26908
26909.section "Plaintext server options" "SECID171"
26910.cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
26911When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
26912
26913.option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26914This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
26915configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
26916
26917.option server_prompts plaintext "string list&!!" unset
26918The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
26919prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
26920given.
26921
26922.section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
26923.cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26924.cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26925.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
26926 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26927.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26928.cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26929
26930When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
26931expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
26932response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
26933values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
26934a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
26935are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
26936(neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
26937
26938For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
26939the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
26940variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
26941string expansions that also use them for other things.
26942
26943If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
26944supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
26945data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
26946
26947.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26948Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
26949&%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
26950authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
26951to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
26952&"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
26953expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
26954generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
26955For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
26956string as the error text.
26957
26958&*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
26959password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
26960There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
26961
26962
26963
26964.section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
26965.cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
26966.cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
26967.cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26968The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
26969sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
26970separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
26971subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
26972
26973The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
26974Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
26975configured as follows:
26976.code
26977fixed_plain:
26978 driver = plaintext
26979 public_name = PLAIN
26980 server_prompts = :
26981 server_condition = \
26982 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
26983 server_set_id = $auth2
26984.endd
26985Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
26986are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
26987password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
26988or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
26989
26990The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
26991the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
26992AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
26993authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
26994.code
26995250-AUTH PLAIN
26996.endd
26997and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
26998.code
26999AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
27000.endd
27001As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
27002data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
27003.code
27004AUTH PLAIN
27005.endd
27006to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
27007prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
27008
27009The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
27010when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
27011represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
27012is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
27013second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
27014
27015Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
27016realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
27017authenticating clients it could make sense.
27018
27019A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
27020&$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
27021comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
27022this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
27023This is an incorrect example:
27024.code
27025server_condition = \
27026 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
27027.endd
27028The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
27029which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
27030incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
27031non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
27032strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
27033the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
27034name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
27035.code
27036server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
27037 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
27038.endd
27039In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
27040fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
27041used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
27042always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
27043writing the test makes the logic clearer.
27044
27045
27046.section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
27047.cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
27048.cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
27049The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
27050in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
27051user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
27052plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
27053.code
27054fixed_login:
27055 driver = plaintext
27056 public_name = LOGIN
27057 server_prompts = User Name : Password
27058 server_condition = \
27059 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
27060 server_set_id = $auth1
27061.endd
27062Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
27063with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
27064if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
27065strings are used to obtain two data items.
27066
27067Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
27068example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
27069&"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
27070strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
27071name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
27072.code
27073login:
27074 driver = plaintext
27075 public_name = LOGIN
27076 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
27077 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
27078 !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
27079 ldapauth{\
27080 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
27081 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
27082 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
27083 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
27084.endd
27085We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
27086does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
27087operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
27088&%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
27089correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
27090the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
27091uninterpreted string.
27092
27093
27094.section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
27095A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
27096interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
27097traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
27098Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
27099&<<SECTexpcond>>&.
27100
27101
27102
27103
27104.section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
27105.cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
27106The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
27107
27108.option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
27109If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
27110authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
27111the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
27112usual.
27113
27114.option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
27115The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
27116string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
27117string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
27118to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
27119most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
27120with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
27121way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
27122(with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
27123so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
27124&%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
27125&$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
27126
27127&*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
27128splitting takes priority and happens first.
27129
27130Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
27131the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
27132there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
27133NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
27134the string.
27135
27136This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
27137authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
27138.code
27139fixed_plain:
27140 driver = plaintext
27141 public_name = PLAIN
27142 client_send = ^username^mysecret
27143.endd
27144The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
27145command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
27146that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
27147.code
27148fixed_login:
27149 driver = plaintext
27150 public_name = LOGIN
27151 client_send = : username : mysecret
27152.endd
27153The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
27154the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
27155prompts.
27156.ecindex IIDplaiauth1
27157.ecindex IIDplaiauth2
27158
27159
27160
27161
27162. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27163. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27164
27165.chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
27166.scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
27167.scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
27168.cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
27169.cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
27170The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
27171sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
27172name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
27173string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
27174is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
27175secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
27176available in plain text at either end.
27177
27178
27179.section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
27180.cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
27181This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
27182authenticator as a server:
27183
27184.option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
27185.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
27186When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
27187the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
27188obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
27189that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
27190string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
27191fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
27192returned to the client.
27193
27194For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
27195in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
27196deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
27197numeric variables for other things.
27198
27199For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
27200client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
27201user name, authentication fails.
27202.code
27203fixed_cram:
27204 driver = cram_md5
27205 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27206 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
27207 server_set_id = $auth1
27208.endd
27209.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27210If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
27211name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
27212secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
27213.code
27214lookup_cram:
27215 driver = cram_md5
27216 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27217 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
27218 {$value}fail}
27219 server_set_id = $auth1
27220.endd
27221Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
27222because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
27223
27224As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
27225using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
27226lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
27227realm, with:
27228.code
27229cyrusless_crammd5:
27230 driver = cram_md5
27231 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27232 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
27233 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
27234 server_set_id = $auth1
27235.endd
27236
27237.section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
27238.cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
27239When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
27240
27241
27242
27243.option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
27244This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
27245computing the response to the server's challenge.
27246
27247
27248.option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
27249This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
27250expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
27251
27252
27253.vindex "&$host$&"
27254.vindex "&$host_address$&"
27255Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
27256to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
27257expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
27258prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
27259authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
27260send the message to the current server.
27261
27262A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
27263strings, is:
27264.code
27265fixed_cram:
27266 driver = cram_md5
27267 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27268 client_name = ph10
27269 client_secret = secret
27270.endd
27271.ecindex IIDcramauth1
27272.ecindex IIDcramauth2
27273
27274
27275
27276. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27277. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27278
27279.chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
27280.scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
27281.scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
27282.cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
27283.cindex "Kerberos"
27284The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick while
27285at A L Digital Ltd.
27286
27287The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
27288library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
27289Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
27290including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
27291directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
27292
27293The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
27294the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
27295then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
27296name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
27297
27298Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example, in GSSAPI
27299or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
27300user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
27301by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
27302depending on the driver you are using.
27303
27304The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
27305be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
27306Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
27307changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
27308layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
27309implementation.
27310
27311For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
27312may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
27313variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
27314Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
27315With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
27316environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
27317is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
27318the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
27319
27320
27321.section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
27322The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
27323(on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
27324previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
27325use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
27326confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
27327things.
27328
27329
27330.option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
27331This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
27332library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
27333SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
27334
27335
27336.option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
27337This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
27338default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
27339you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
27340example:
27341.code
27342sasl:
27343 driver = cyrus_sasl
27344 public_name = X-ANYTHING
27345 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
27346 server_set_id = $auth1
27347.endd
27348
27349.option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
27350This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
27351
27352
27353.option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
27354This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
27355
27356
27357For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
27358private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
27359the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
27360PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
27361.code
27362sasl_cram_md5:
27363 driver = cyrus_sasl
27364 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27365 server_set_id = $auth1
27366
27367sasl_plain:
27368 driver = cyrus_sasl
27369 public_name = PLAIN
27370 server_set_id = $auth2
27371.endd
27372Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
27373not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
27374but it is present in many binary distributions.
27375.ecindex IIDcyrauth1
27376.ecindex IIDcyrauth2
27377
27378
27379
27380
27381. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27382. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27383.chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
27384.scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
27385.scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
27386This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
27387Dovecot 2 POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
27388Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
27389If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
27390to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
27391authenticator only. There is only one option:
27392
27393.option server_socket dovecot string unset
27394
27395This option must specify the UNIX socket that is the interface to Dovecot
27396authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
27397mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
27398authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
27399.code
27400dovecot_plain:
27401 driver = dovecot
27402 public_name = PLAIN
27403 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
27404 server_set_id = $auth1
27405
27406dovecot_ntlm:
27407 driver = dovecot
27408 public_name = NTLM
27409 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
27410 server_set_id = $auth1
27411.endd
27412If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
27413&$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
27414option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
27415connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
27416option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
27417who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
27418
27419.new
27420The Dovecot configuration to match the above wil look
27421something like:
27422.code
27423conf.d/10-master.conf :-
27424
27425service auth {
27426...
27427#SASL
27428 unix_listener auth-client {
27429 mode = 0660
27430 user = mail
27431 }
27432...
27433}
27434
27435conf.d/10-auth.conf :-
27436
27437auth_mechanisms = plain login ntlm
27438.endd
27439.wen
27440
27441.ecindex IIDdcotauth1
27442.ecindex IIDdcotauth2
27443
27444
27445. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27446. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27447.chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
27448.scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
27449.scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
27450.cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
27451.cindex "authentication" "SASL"
27452.cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
27453.cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
27454.cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
27455.cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
27456.cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
27457.cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
27458.cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
27459.cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1-PLUS"
27460.cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-256"
27461.cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-256-PLUS"
27462The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides integration for the GNU SASL
27463library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
27464and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
27465scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
27466made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
27467without code changes in Exim.
27468
27469.new
27470The library is expected to add support in an upcoming
27471realease for the SCRAM-SHA-256 method.
27472The macro _HAVE_AUTH_GSASL_SCRAM_SHA_256 will be defined
27473when this happens.
27474
27475
27476.option client_authz gsasl string&!! unset
27477This option can be used to supply an &'authorization id'&
27478which is different to the &'authentication_id'& provided
27479by &%client_username%& option.
27480If unset or (after expansion) empty it is not used,
27481which is the common case.
27482
27483.option client_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
27484See &%server_channelbinding%& below.
27485
27486.option client_password gsasl string&!! unset
27487This option is exapanded before use, and should result in
27488the password to be used, in clear.
27489
27490.option client_username gsasl string&!! unset
27491This option is exapanded before use, and should result in
27492the account name to be used.
27493.wen
27494
27495.option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
27496Do not set this true and rely on the properties
27497without consulting a cryptographic engineer.
27498
27499Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
27500of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
27501authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
27502ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
27503context.
27504
27505This should have meant that certificate identity and verification becomes a
27506non-issue, as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and
27507server to see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
27508
27509.new
27510This is
27511only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
27512writing, that's the SCRAM family.
27513When using this feature the "-PLUS" variants of the method names need to be used.
27514.wen
27515
27516This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
27517this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
27518of Exim might have switched the default to be true.
27519
27520However, Channel Binding in TLS has proven to be vulnerable in current versions.
27521Do not plan to rely upon this feature for security, ever, without consulting
27522with a subject matter expert (a cryptographic engineer).
27523
27524
27525.option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
27526This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
27527library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
27528Some mechanisms will use this data.
27529
27530
27531.option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
27532This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
27533default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
27534you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
27535example:
27536.code
27537sasl:
27538 driver = gsasl
27539 public_name = X-ANYTHING
27540 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
27541 server_set_id = $auth1
27542.endd
27543
27544
27545.option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
27546Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
27547that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
27548the password itself.
27549
27550The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
27551In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
27552The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
27553if available, else the empty string.
27554The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
27555else the empty string.
27556
27557A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
27558
27559If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
27560option to be simply "true".
27561
27562
27563.option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
27564This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
27565Some mechanisms will use this data.
27566
27567
27568.option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! 4096
27569This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
27570.new
27571The &$auth1$&, &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& variables are available for expansion.
27572
27573The result of expansion should be a decimal number,
27574and represents both a lower-bound on the security, and
27575a compute cost factor imposed on the client
27576(if it does not cache results, or the server changes
27577either the iteration count or the salt).
27578A minimum value of 4096 is required by the standards
27579for all current CRAM mechanism variants.
27580.wen
27581
27582
27583.option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
27584This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
27585.new
27586The &$auth1$&, &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& variables are available for expansion.
27587If unset or empty after expansion the library will provides a value for the
27588protocol conversation.
27589.wen
27590
27591
27592.option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
27593This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
27594Some mechanisms will use this data.
27595
27596
27597.section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
27598.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27599These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
27600They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
27601
27602Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
27603meanings for these variables:
27604
27605.ilist
27606.vindex "&$auth1$&"
27607&$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
27608.next
27609.vindex "&$auth2$&"
27610&$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
27611.next
27612.vindex "&$auth3$&"
27613&$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
27614.endlist
27615
27616On a per-mechanism basis:
27617
27618.ilist
27619.cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
27620EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
27621the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27622.next
27623.cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
27624ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
27625the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27626.next
27627.cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
27628GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
27629&$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
27630the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27631.endlist
27632
27633An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
27634identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
27635email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
27636
27637
27638An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
27639and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
27640.code
27641gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
27642 driver = gsasl
27643 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27644 server_realm = imap.example.org
27645 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
27646 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
27647 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
27648 server_condition = yes
27649.endd
27650
27651
27652. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27653. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27654
27655.chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
27656.scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
27657.scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
27658.cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
27659.cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
27660The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
27661Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
27662reliably.
27663
27664.option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
27665This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
27666for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
27667identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
27668
27669.option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
27670If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
27671&_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
27672The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
27673
27674.option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
27675This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
27676&%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
27677from the keytab.
27678
27679
27680.section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
27681Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
27682to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
27683not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
27684
27685The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
27686Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
27687Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
27688role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
27689
27690.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27691.ilist
27692.vindex "&$auth1$&"
27693&$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
27694.next
27695.vindex "&$auth2$&"
27696&$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
27697authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
27698GSS Display Name.
27699.endlist
27700
27701
27702. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27703. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27704
27705.chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
27706.scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
27707.scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
27708.cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
27709.cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
27710.cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
27711.cindex "NTLM authentication"
27712The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
27713Password Authentication'& mechanism,
27714which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
27715this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
27716taken from the Samba project (&url(https://www.samba.org/)). The code for the
27717server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
27718follows:
27719
27720.ilist
27721After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
27722authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
27723.next
27724The server sends back a challenge.
27725.next
27726The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
27727and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
27728.endlist
27729
27730Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
27731
27732
27733
27734.section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
27735.cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
27736The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
27737
27738.option server_password spa string&!! unset
27739.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
27740This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
27741authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
27742compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
27743&$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
27744it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
27745for other things. For example:
27746.code
27747spa:
27748 driver = spa
27749 public_name = NTLM
27750 server_password = \
27751 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
27752.endd
27753If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27754failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27755
27756
27757
27758
27759
27760.section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
27761.cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
27762The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
27763
27764
27765
27766.option client_domain spa string&!! unset
27767This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
27768
27769
27770.option client_password spa string&!! unset
27771This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
27772
27773
27774.option client_username spa string&!! unset
27775This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
27776configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
27777&'msn.com'&:
27778.code
27779msn:
27780 driver = spa
27781 public_name = MSN
27782 client_username = msn/msn_username
27783 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
27784 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
27785.endd
27786.ecindex IIDspaauth1
27787.ecindex IIDspaauth2
27788
27789
27790
27791
27792
27793. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27794. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27795
27796.chapter "The external authenticator" "CHAPexternauth"
27797.scindex IIDexternauth1 "&(external)& authenticator"
27798.scindex IIDexternauth2 "authenticators" "&(external)&"
27799.cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
27800.cindex "authentication" "X509"
27801.cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
27802The &(external)& authenticator provides support for
27803authentication based on non-SMTP information.
27804The specification is in RFC 4422 Appendix A
27805(&url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4422)).
27806It is only a transport and negotiation mechanism;
27807the process of authentication is entirely controlled
27808by the server configuration.
27809
27810The client presents an identity in-clear.
27811It is probably wise for a server to only advertise,
27812and for clients to only attempt,
27813this authentication method on a secure (eg. under TLS) connection.
27814
27815One possible use, compatible with the
27816K-9 Mail Andoid client (&url(https://k9mail.github.io/)),
27817is for using X509 client certificates.
27818
27819It thus overlaps in function with the TLS authenticator
27820(see &<<CHAPtlsauth>>&)
27821but is a full SMTP SASL authenticator
27822rather than being implicit for TLS-connection carried
27823client certificates only.
27824
27825The examples and discussion in this chapter assume that
27826client-certificate authentication is being done.
27827
27828The client must present a certificate,
27829for which it must have been requested via the
27830&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
27831(see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
27832For authentication to be effective the certificate should be
27833verifiable against a trust-anchor certificate known to the server.
27834
27835.section "External options" "SECTexternsoptions"
27836.cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (server)"
27837The &(external)& authenticator has two server options:
27838
27839.option server_param2 external string&!! unset
27840.option server_param3 external string&!! unset
27841.cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(external)& authenticator"
27842These options are expanded before the &%server_condition%& option
27843and the result are placed in &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& resectively.
27844If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27845failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27846
27847They can be used to clarify the coding of a complex &%server_condition%&.
27848
27849.section "Using external in a server" "SECTexternserver"
27850.cindex "AUTH" "in &(external)& authenticator"
27851.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
27852 "in &(external)& authenticator"
27853.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27854.cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(external)& authenticator"
27855
27856When running as a server, &(external)& performs the authentication test by
27857expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
27858response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
27859values when decoded. The decoded value is treated as
27860an identity for authentication and
27861placed in the expansion variable &$auth1$&.
27862
27863For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the value is also placed in
27864the expansion variable &$1$&. However, the use of this
27865variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
27866string expansions that also use them for other things.
27867
27868.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27869Once an identity has been received,
27870&%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
27871authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
27872to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
27873&"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
27874expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
27875generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
27876For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
27877string as the error text.
27878
27879Example:
27880.code
27881ext_ccert_san_mail:
27882 driver = external
27883 public_name = EXTERNAL
27884
27885 server_advertise_condition = $tls_in_certificate_verified
27886 server_param2 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
27887 {$tls_in_peercert}}
27888 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth2} \
27889 {eq {$item}{$auth1}}}
27890 server_set_id = $auth1
27891.endd
27892This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
27893of your configured trust-anchors
27894(which usually means the full set of public CAs)
27895and which has a mail-SAN matching the claimed identity sent by the client.
27896
27897&*Note*&: up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN.
27898The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
27899TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
27900in this way.
27901
27902
27903.section "Using external in a client" "SECTexternclient"
27904.cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (client)"
27905The &(external)& authenticator has one client option:
27906
27907.option client_send external string&!! unset
27908This option is expanded and sent with the AUTH command as the
27909identity being asserted.
27910
27911Example:
27912.code
27913ext_ccert:
27914 driver = external
27915 public_name = EXTERNAL
27916
27917 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
27918 client_send = myaccount@smarthost.example.net
27919.endd
27920
27921
27922.ecindex IIDexternauth1
27923.ecindex IIDexternauth2
27924
27925
27926
27927
27928
27929. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27930. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27931
27932.chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
27933.scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
27934.scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
27935.cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
27936.cindex "authentication" "X509"
27937.cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
27938The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
27939authentication based on client certificates.
27940
27941It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
27942advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
27943It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
27944the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
27945by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
27946the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
27947
27948The client must present a verifiable certificate,
27949for which it must have been requested via the
27950&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
27951(see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
27952
27953If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
27954run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
27955and can authenticate the connection.
27956If it does, SMTP authentication is not offered.
27957
27958A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
27959
27960
27961.cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
27962The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
27963
27964.option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
27965.cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
27966This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
27967the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
27968If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27969failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27970
27971.option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
27972.option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
27973As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
27974
27975&%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
27976
27977
27978Example:
27979.code
27980tls:
27981 driver = tls
27982 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
27983 {$tls_in_peercert}}
27984 server_condition = ${if and { {eq{$tls_in_certificate_verified}{1}} \
27985 {forany {$auth1} \
27986 {!= {0} \
27987 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
27988 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
27989 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
27990 } } } }}}
27991 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
27992.endd
27993This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
27994of your configured trust-anchors
27995(which usually means the full set of public CAs)
27996and which has a SAN with a good account name.
27997
27998Note that, up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
27999The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
28000TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
28001in this way.
28002Likewise, a traditional plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
28003
28004. An alternative might use
28005. .code
28006. server_param1 = ${sha256:$tls_in_peercert}
28007. .endd
28008. to require one of a set of specific certs that define a given account
28009. (the verification is still required, but mostly irrelevant).
28010. This would help for per-device use.
28011.
28012. However, for the future we really need support for checking a
28013. user cert in LDAP - which probably wants a base-64 DER.
28014
28015.ecindex IIDtlsauth1
28016.ecindex IIDtlsauth2
28017
28018
28019Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
28020the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
28021a connect- or helo-ACL.
28022
28023
28024
28025. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28026. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28027
28028.chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
28029 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
28030.scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
28031.scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
28032.cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
28033.cindex "OpenSSL"
28034.cindex "GnuTLS"
28035Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
28036Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
28037GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
28038cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
28039order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
28040version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
28041You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
28042level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
28043certificates are used.
28044
28045RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
28046connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
28047server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
28048mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
28049between them is encrypted.
28050
28051Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
28052and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
28053certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
28054possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
28055encryption state.
28056
28057&*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
28058disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
28059in order to get TLS to work.
28060
28061
28062
28063.section "Support for the &""submissions""& (aka &""ssmtp""& and &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
28064 "SECID284"
28065.cindex "submissions protocol"
28066.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
28067.cindex "smtps protocol"
28068.cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
28069.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
28070.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
28071The history of port numbers for TLS in SMTP is a little messy and has been
28072contentious. As of RFC 8314, the common practice of using the historically
28073allocated port 465 for "email submission but with TLS immediately upon connect
28074instead of using STARTTLS" is officially blessed by the IETF, and recommended
28075by them in preference to STARTTLS.
28076
28077The name originally assigned to the port was &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, but as
28078clarity emerged over the dual roles of SMTP, for MX delivery and Email
28079Submission, nomenclature has shifted. The modern name is now &"submissions"&.
28080
28081This approach was, for a while, officially abandoned when encrypted SMTP was
28082standardized, but many clients kept using it, even as the TCP port number was
28083reassigned for other use.
28084Thus you may encounter guidance claiming that you shouldn't enable use of
28085this port.
28086In practice, a number of mail-clients have only ever supported submissions,
28087not submission with STARTTLS upgrade.
28088Ideally, offer both submission (587) and submissions (465) service.
28089
28090Exim supports TLS-on-connect by means of the &%tls_on_connect_ports%&
28091global option. Its value must be a list of port numbers;
28092the most common use is expected to be:
28093.code
28094tls_on_connect_ports = 465
28095.endd
28096The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
28097via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
28098the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
28099the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
28100an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
28101defined elsewhere.
28102
28103There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
28104&%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the TLS-only behaviour for all ports.
28105
28106
28107
28108
28109
28110
28111.section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
28112.cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
28113TLS is supported in Exim using either the OpenSSL or GnuTLS library.
28114To build Exim to use OpenSSL you need to set
28115.code
28116USE_OPENSSL=yes
28117.endd
28118in Local/Makefile.
28119
28120To build Exim to use GnuTLS, you need to set
28121.code
28122USE_GNUTLS=yes
28123.endd
28124in Local/Makefile.
28125
28126You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
28127include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
28128
28129There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
28130
28131.ilist
28132The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
28133cannot be the path of a directory
28134for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
28135(for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
28136.next
28137The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
28138.next
28139.vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
28140.vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
28141Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
28142separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
28143affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
28144.next
28145OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
28146DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
28147RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
28148in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
28149for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
28150to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
28151&%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
28152option).
28153.next
28154The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
28155sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
28156.next
28157The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
28158When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
28159(If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
28160let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
28161.next
28162With GnuTLS, if an explicit list is used for the &%tls_privatekey%& main option
28163main option, it must be ordered to match the &%tls_certificate%& list.
28164.next
28165Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
28166This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
28167explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
28168implementation, then patches are welcome.
28169.endlist
28170
28171
28172.section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
28173This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
28174an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
28175but not the chosen filename.
28176By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
28177See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
28178
28179GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
28180to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
28181Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
28182&_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
28183of bits requested.
28184The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
28185its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
28186parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
28187that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
28188renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
28189this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
28190place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
28191
28192For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
28193recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
28194If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
28195are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
28196not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
28197
28198Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
28199values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
28200parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
28201If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
28202until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
28203a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
28204
28205The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
28206in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
28207generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
28208
28209To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
28210and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
28211&(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
28212renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
28213.code
28214# ls
28215[ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
28216# rm -f new-params
28217# touch new-params
28218# chown exim:exim new-params
28219# chmod 0600 new-params
28220# certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
28221# openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
28222[ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
28223 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
28224 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
28225# chmod 0400 new-params
28226# mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
28227.endd
28228If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
28229stalling is removed.
28230
28231The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
28232Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
28233the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
28234a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
28235and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
28236failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
28237of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
28238which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
28239GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
28240to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
28241limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
28242
28243The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
28244value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
28245&%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
282462432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
28247
28248In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
28249increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
28250bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
28251procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
28252the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
28253
28254
28255.section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
28256.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
28257.oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
28258There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
28259suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
28260are acceptable for TLS versions prior to 1.3.
28261The list is colon separated and may contain names like
28262DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
28263directly to this function call.
28264Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
28265&'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
28266The following quotation from the OpenSSL
28267documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
28268
28269.ilist
28270It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
28271.next
28272It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
28273or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
28274ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
28275SSL v3 algorithms.
28276.next
28277Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
28278the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
28279SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
28280algorithms.
28281.endlist
28282
28283Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
28284&`-`& or &`+`&.
28285.ilist
28286If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
28287ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
28288stated.
28289.next
28290If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
28291of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
28292.next
28293If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
28294option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
28295.endlist
28296
28297If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
28298a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
28299includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
28300not be moved to the end of the list.
28301.endlist
28302
28303The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
28304string:
28305.code
28306# note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
28307$ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
28308.endd
28309
28310This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
28311there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
28312submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
28313choice of clients used:
28314.code
28315# OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
28316tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
28317 {DEFAULT}\
28318 {HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1}}
28319.endd
28320
28321This example will prefer ECDSA-authenticated ciphers over RSA ones:
28322.code
28323tls_require_ciphers = ECDSA:RSA:!COMPLEMENTOFDEFAULT
28324.endd
28325
28326For TLS version 1.3 the control available is less fine-grained
28327and Exim does not provide access to it at present.
28328The value of the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is ignored when
28329TLS version 1.3 is negotiated.
28330
28331As of writing the library default cipher suite list for TLSv1.3 is
28332.code
28333TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256
28334.endd
28335
28336
28337.section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
28338 "SECTreqciphgnu"
28339.cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
28340.cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
28341.cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
28342.cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
28343.cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
28344.cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
28345.oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
28346The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
28347as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
28348ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
28349
28350The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
28351and controls both protocols and ciphers.
28352
28353The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
28354controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
28355&(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
28356the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
28357the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
28358aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
28359
28360Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
28361"Priority strings". This is online as
28362&url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
28363but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
28364installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
28365then the example code
28366&url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string)
28367on that site can be used to test a given string.
28368
28369For example:
28370.code
28371# Disable older versions of protocols
28372tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
28373.endd
28374
28375Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
28376additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
28377"&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
28378
28379This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
28380there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
28381by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
28382where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
28383used:
28384.code
28385# GnuTLS variant
28386tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
28387 {NORMAL:%COMPAT}\
28388 {SECURE128}}
28389.endd
28390
28391
28392.section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
28393.cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
28394When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
28395the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
28396but not to any others. The default value of this option is *, which means
28397that STARTTLS is always advertised. Set it to blank to never advertise;
28398this is reasonable for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
28399
28400If STARTTLS is to be used you
28401need to set some other options in order to make TLS available.
28402
28403If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
28404problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
28405persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
28406with the error
28407.code
28408554 Security failure
28409.endd
28410If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
28411rejected with a 554 error code.
28412
28413To enable TLS operations on a server, the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option
28414must be set to match some hosts. The default is * which matches all hosts.
28415
28416If this is all you do, TLS encryption will be enabled but not authentication -
28417meaning that the peer has no assurance it is actually you he is talking to.
28418You gain protection from a passive sniffer listening on the wire but not
28419from someone able to intercept the communication.
28420
28421Further protection requires some further configuration at the server end.
28422
28423To make TLS work you need to set, in the server,
28424.code
28425tls_certificate = /some/file/name
28426tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
28427.endd
28428These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
28429the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
28430contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
28431that goes with it. These files need to be
28432PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
28433always be given as full path names.
28434The key must not be password-protected.
28435They can be the same file if both the
28436certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
28437set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
28438is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
28439certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
28440the server's certificate.
28441
28442For dual-stack (eg. RSA and ECDSA) configurations, these options can be
28443colon-separated lists of file paths. Ciphers using given authentication
28444algorithms require the presence of a suitable certificate to supply the
28445public-key. The server selects among the certificates to present to the
28446client depending on the selected cipher, hence the priority ordering for
28447ciphers will affect which certificate is used.
28448
28449If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
28450source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
28451few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
28452
28453&*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
28454they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
28455Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
28456transport.
28457
28458With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
28459require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
28460this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
28461.code
28462tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
28463.endd
28464is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
28465with the parameters contained in the file.
28466Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
28467available:
28468.code
28469tls_dhparam = none
28470.endd
28471This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
28472DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
28473used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
28474documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
28475
28476See the command
28477.code
28478openssl dhparam
28479.endd
28480for a way of generating file data.
28481
28482The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
28483host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
28484for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
28485in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
28486forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
28487
28488.cindex "cipher" "logging"
28489.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
28490.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
28491The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
28492an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
28493incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
28494also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
28495&"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
28496condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
28497
28498Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
28499can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
28500cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
28501example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
28502contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
28503documentation for more details.
28504
28505For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
28506(again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
28507
28508
28509.section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
28510.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
28511.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
28512If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
28513session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
28514&%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
28515apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
28516Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
28517contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
28518expected trust-anchors or certificates.
28519These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
28520an explicit file or,
28521depending on library version, a directory, identified by
28522&%tls_verify_certificates%&.
28523
28524A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
28525directory is used
28526(OpenSSL only),
28527each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
28528of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
28529certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
28530.code
28531openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
28532.endd
28533where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
28534
28535There is no checking of names of the client against the certificate
28536Subject Name or Subject Alternate Names.
28537
28538The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
28539what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
28540does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
28541&%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
28542attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
28543dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
28544session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
28545fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
28546example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
28547relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
28548
28549.vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
28550When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
28551the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
28552&$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
28553
28554.cindex "log" "distinguished name"
28555Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
28556&'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
28557&"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
28558&%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
28559certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
28560
28561
28562.section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
28563.cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
28564.cindex "revocation list"
28565.cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
28566.cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
28567Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
28568certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
28569server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
28570an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
28571of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
28572CRL in PEM format.
28573The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
28574file from every certificate authority they know of.
28575
28576The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
28577Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
28578against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
28579usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
28580private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
28581is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
28582
28583The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
28584comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
28585connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
28586re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
28587
28588The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
28589issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
28590the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
28591negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
28592CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
28593resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
28594starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
28595proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
28596
28597Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
28598or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
28599support for OCSP stapling is included.
28600
28601There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
28602The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
28603an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
28604option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
28605contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
28606
28607Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
28608proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
28609Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
28610contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
28611on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
28612next connection.
28613
28614When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
28615in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
28616ignored.
28617
28618For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
28619also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
28620certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
28621of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
28622intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
28623file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
28624
28625Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
28626not any of the chain from CA to it.
28627
28628There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
28629
28630.code
28631 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
28632 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
28633 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
28634
28635 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
28636 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
28637 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
28638.endd
28639
28640
28641
28642
28643.section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECTclientTLS"
28644.cindex "cipher" "logging"
28645.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
28646.cindex "log" "distinguished name"
28647.cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
28648The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
28649deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
28650server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
28651within the &(smtp)& transport.
28652
28653It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
28654transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
28655server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
28656this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
28657transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
28658
28659If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
28660to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
28661&%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
28662those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
28663set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
28664usual way.
28665
28666When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
28667the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
28668a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
28669session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
28670&%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
28671delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
28672it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
28673STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
28674negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
28675unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
28676unencrypted.
28677
28678The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
28679transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
28680if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
28681&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
28682
28683&*Note*&: Do not use a certificate which has the OCSP-must-staple extension,
28684for client use (they are usable for server use).
28685As the TLS protocol has no means for the client to staple before TLS 1.3 it will result
28686in failed connections.
28687
28688If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
28689specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
28690These may be
28691the system default set (depending on library version),
28692a file,
28693or (depending on library version) a directory.
28694The client verifies the server's certificate
28695against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
28696in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
28697Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
28698&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
28699
28700The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
28701certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
28702or need not succeed respectively.
28703
28704The &%tls_verify_cert_hostnames%& option lists hosts for which additional
28705checks are made: that the host name (the one in the DNS A record)
28706is valid for the certificate.
28707The option defaults to always checking.
28708
28709The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
28710&%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
28711is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
28712value is empty.
28713&%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
28714a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
28715value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
28716otherwise.
28717
28718The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
28719&%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
28720for OCSP to be relevant.
28721
28722If
28723&%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
28724list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
28725the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
28726alternative hosts, if any.
28727
28728 &*Note*&:
28729These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
28730is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
28731by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
28732client.
28733
28734.vindex "&$host$&"
28735.vindex "&$host_address$&"
28736All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
28737&$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
28738which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
28739behave as if the relevant option were unset.
28740
28741.vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
28742.vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
28743.vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
28744.vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
28745Before an SMTP connection is established, the
28746&$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
28747variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
28748that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
28749successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
28750outgoing connection.
28751
28752
28753
28754.section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
28755.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
28756.vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
28757.oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
28758With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
28759information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
28760extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
28761&"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
28762client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
28763within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
28764for this session.
28765
28766This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
28767which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
28768address.
28769
28770With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
28771against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
28772provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
28773be of limited use in that environment.
28774
28775With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
28776connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
28777choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
28778wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
28779different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
28780
28781The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
28782if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
28783nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
28784only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
28785for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
28786
28787Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
28788received from a client.
28789It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
28790
28791If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
28792option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
28793during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
28794
28795.ilist
28796&%tls_certificate%&
28797.next
28798&%tls_crl%&
28799.next
28800&%tls_privatekey%&
28801.next
28802&%tls_verify_certificates%&
28803.next
28804&%tls_ocsp_file%&
28805.endlist
28806
28807Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
28808attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
28809can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_in_sni$& is
28810arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
28811Further, the initial certificate is loaded before SNI has arrived, so
28812an expansion for &%tls_certificate%& must have a default which is used
28813when &$tls_in_sni$& is empty.
28814
28815The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
28816are re-expanded.
28817
28818When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
28819for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
28820enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
28821see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
28822
28823When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
288240.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
28825built, then you have SNI support).
28826
28827
28828
28829.section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
28830 "SECTmulmessam"
28831.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
28832.cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
28833Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
28834an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
28835one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
28836of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
28837connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
28838to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, for sending using TLS Exim
28839starts an additional proxy process for handling the encryption, piping the
28840unencrypted data stream from and to the delivery processes.
28841
28842An older mode of operation can be enabled on a per-host basis by the
28843&%hosts_noproxy_tls%& option on the &(smtp)& transport. If the host matches
28844this list the proxy process described above is not used; instead Exim
28845shuts down an existing TLS session being run by the delivery process
28846before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
28847try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
28848if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
28849
28850The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
28851after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
28852just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
28853reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
28854successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
28855SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
28856should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
28857subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
28858and delay other deliveries to that host.
28859
28860To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
28861closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
28862closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
28863information is recorded.
28864
28865There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
28866&(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
28867connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
28868
28869
28870
28871
28872.section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
28873.cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
28874In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
28875certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities.
28876This is a large topic and an introductory guide is unsuitable for the Exim
28877reference manual, so instead we provide pointers to existing documentation.
28878
28879The Apache web-server was for a long time the canonical guide, so their
28880documentation is a good place to start; their SSL module's Introduction
28881document is currently at
28882.display
28883&url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_intro.html)
28884.endd
28885and their FAQ is at
28886.display
28887&url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_faq.html)
28888.endd
28889
28890Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
288910-201-61598-3) in 2001, contains both introductory and more in-depth
28892descriptions.
28893More recently Ivan Ristić's book &'Bulletproof SSL and TLS'&,
28894published by Feisty Duck (ISBN 978-1907117046) in 2013 is good.
28895Ivan is the author of the popular TLS testing tools at
28896&url(https://www.ssllabs.com/).
28897
28898
28899.section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
28900The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
28901certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
28902sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
28903not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
28904First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
28905certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
28906intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
28907certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
28908The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
28909validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
28910root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
28911install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
28912
28913Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
28914even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
28915server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
28916diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
28917
28918
28919
28920.section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
28921.cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
28922You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
28923with OpenSSL, like this:
28924. ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
28925. ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
28926.code
28927openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
28928 -days 9999 -nodes
28929.endd
28930&_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
28931delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
28932specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
28933important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
28934that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
28935prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
28936this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
28937
28938. ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
28939. ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
28940. ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
28941. ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
28942. ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
28943. ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
28944. ==== -pdp, 2012
28945NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
28946epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
28947the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
28948the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
28949of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
28950writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
28951progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
28952be a sensible resolution).
28953
28954A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
28955may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
28956encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
28957
28958However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
28959user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
28960certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
28961must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
28962authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
28963signed with that self-signed certificate.
28964
28965For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
28966user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
28967Open-source PKI book, available online at
28968&url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/ospkibook/).
28969.ecindex IIDencsmtp1
28970.ecindex IIDencsmtp2
28971
28972
28973
28974.section DANE "SECDANE"
28975.cindex DANE
28976DNS-based Authentication of Named Entities, as applied to SMTP over TLS, provides assurance to a client that
28977it is actually talking to the server it wants to rather than some attacker operating a Man In The Middle (MITM)
28978operation. The latter can terminate the TLS connection you make, and make another one to the server (so both
28979you and the server still think you have an encrypted connection) and, if one of the "well known" set of
28980Certificate Authorities has been suborned - something which *has* been seen already (2014), a verifiable
28981certificate (if you're using normal root CAs, eg. the Mozilla set, as your trust anchors).
28982
28983What DANE does is replace the CAs with the DNS as the trust anchor. The assurance is limited to a) the possibility
28984that the DNS has been suborned, b) mistakes made by the admins of the target server. The attack surface presented
28985by (a) is thought to be smaller than that of the set of root CAs.
28986
28987It also allows the server to declare (implicitly) that connections to it should use TLS. An MITM could simply
28988fail to pass on a server's STARTTLS.
28989
28990DANE scales better than having to maintain (and side-channel communicate) copies of server certificates
28991for every possible target server. It also scales (slightly) better than having to maintain on an SMTP
28992client a copy of the standard CAs bundle. It also means not having to pay a CA for certificates.
28993
28994DANE requires a server operator to do three things: 1) run DNSSEC. This provides assurance to clients
28995that DNS lookups they do for the server have not been tampered with. The domain MX record applying
28996to this server, its A record, its TLSA record and any associated CNAME records must all be covered by
28997DNSSEC.
289982) add TLSA DNS records. These say what the server certificate for a TLS connection should be.
289993) offer a server certificate, or certificate chain, in TLS connections which is is anchored by one of the TLSA records.
29000
29001There are no changes to Exim specific to server-side operation of DANE.
29002Support for client-side operation of DANE can be included at compile time by defining SUPPORT_DANE=yes
29003in &_Local/Makefile_&.
29004If it has been included, the macro "_HAVE_DANE" will be defined.
29005
29006A TLSA record consist of 4 fields, the "Certificate Usage", the
29007"Selector", the "Matching type", and the "Certificate Association Data".
29008For a detailed description of the TLSA record see
29009&url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7671#page-5,RFC 7671).
29010
29011The TLSA record for the server may have "Certificate Usage" (1st) field of DANE-TA(2) or DANE-EE(3).
29012These are the "Trust Anchor" and "End Entity" variants.
29013The latter specifies the End Entity directly, i.e. the certificate involved is that of the server
29014(and if only DANE-EE is used then it should be the sole one transmitted during the TLS handshake);
29015this is appropriate for a single system, using a self-signed certificate.
29016DANE-TA usage is effectively declaring a specific CA to be used; this might be a private CA or a public,
29017well-known one.
29018A private CA at simplest is just a self-signed certificate (with certain
29019attributes) which is used to sign server certificates, but running one securely
29020does require careful arrangement.
29021With DANE-TA, as implemented in Exim and commonly in other MTAs,
29022the server TLS handshake must transmit the entire certificate chain from CA to server-certificate.
29023DANE-TA is commonly used for several services and/or servers, each having a TLSA query-domain CNAME record,
29024all of which point to a single TLSA record.
29025DANE-TA and DANE-EE can both be used together.
29026
29027Our recommendation is to use DANE with a certificate from a public CA,
29028because this enables a variety of strategies for remote clients to verify
29029your certificate.
29030You can then publish information both via DANE and another technology,
29031"MTA-STS", described below.
29032
29033When you use DANE-TA to publish trust anchor information, you ask entities
29034outside your administrative control to trust the Certificate Authority for
29035connections to you.
29036If using a private CA then you should expect others to still apply the
29037technical criteria they'd use for a public CA to your certificates.
29038In particular, you should probably try to follow current best practices for CA
29039operation around hash algorithms and key sizes.
29040Do not expect other organizations to lower their security expectations just
29041because a particular profile might be reasonable for your own internal use.
29042
29043When this text was last updated, this in practice means to avoid use of SHA-1
29044and MD5; if using RSA to use key sizes of at least 2048 bits (and no larger
29045than 4096, for interoperability); to use keyUsage fields correctly; to use
29046random serial numbers.
29047The list of requirements is subject to change as best practices evolve.
29048If you're not already using a private CA, or it doesn't meet these
29049requirements, then we encourage you to avoid all these issues and use a public
29050CA such as &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt) instead.
29051
29052The TLSA record should have a "Selector" (2nd) field of SPKI(1) and
29053a "Matching Type" (3rd) field of SHA2-512(2).
29054
29055For the "Certificate Authority Data" (4th) field, commands like
29056
29057.code
29058 openssl x509 -pubkey -noout <certificate.pem \
29059 | openssl rsa -outform der -pubin 2>/dev/null \
29060 | openssl sha512 \
29061 | awk '{print $2}'
29062.endd
29063
29064are workable to create a hash of the certificate's public key.
29065
29066An example TLSA record for DANE-EE(3), SPKI(1), and SHA-512 (2) looks like
29067
29068.code
29069 _25._tcp.mail.example.com. TLSA 3 1 2 8BA8A336E...
29070.endd
29071
29072At the time of writing, &url(https://www.huque.com/bin/gen_tlsa)
29073is useful for quickly generating TLSA records.
29074
29075
29076For use with the DANE-TA model, server certificates must have a correct name (SubjectName or SubjectAltName).
29077
29078The Certificate issued by the CA published in the DANE-TA model should be
29079issued using a strong hash algorithm.
29080Exim, and importantly various other MTAs sending to you, will not
29081re-enable hash algorithms which have been disabled by default in TLS
29082libraries.
29083This means no MD5 and no SHA-1. SHA2-256 is the minimum for reliable
29084interoperability (and probably the maximum too, in 2018).
29085
29086The use of OCSP-stapling should be considered, allowing for fast revocation of certificates (which would otherwise
29087be limited by the DNS TTL on the TLSA records). However, this is likely to only be usable with DANE-TA. NOTE: the
29088default of requesting OCSP for all hosts is modified iff DANE is in use, to:
29089
29090.code
29091 hosts_request_ocsp = ${if or { {= {0}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} \
29092 {= {4}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} } \
29093 {*}{}}
29094.endd
29095
29096The (new) variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& is a bitfield with numbered bits set for TLSA record usage codes.
29097The zero above means DANE was not in use, the four means that only DANE-TA usage TLSA records were
29098found. If the definition of &%hosts_request_ocsp%& includes the
29099string "tls_out_tlsa_usage", they are re-expanded in time to
29100control the OCSP request.
29101
29102This modification of hosts_request_ocsp is only done if it has the default value of "*". Admins who change it, and
29103those who use &%hosts_require_ocsp%&, should consider the interaction with DANE in their OCSP settings.
29104
29105
29106For client-side DANE there are three new smtp transport options, &%hosts_try_dane%&, &%hosts_require_dane%&
29107and &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%&.
29108The &"require"& variant will result in failure if the target host is not
29109DNSSEC-secured. To get DNSSEC-secured hostname resolution, use
29110the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router or transport option.
29111
29112DANE will only be usable if the target host has DNSSEC-secured MX, A and TLSA records.
29113
29114A TLSA lookup will be done if either of the above options match and the host-lookup succeeded using dnssec.
29115If a TLSA lookup is done and succeeds, a DANE-verified TLS connection
29116will be required for the host. If it does not, the host will not
29117be used; there is no fallback to non-DANE or non-TLS.
29118
29119If DANE is requested and usable, then the TLS cipher list configuration
29120prefers to use the option &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%& and falls
29121back to &%tls_require_ciphers%& only if that is unset.
29122This lets you configure "decent crypto" for DANE and "better than nothing
29123crypto" as the default. Note though that while GnuTLS lets the string control
29124which versions of TLS/SSL will be negotiated, OpenSSL does not and you're
29125limited to ciphersuite constraints.
29126
29127If DANE is requested and useable (see above) the following transport options are ignored:
29128.code
29129 hosts_require_tls
29130 tls_verify_hosts
29131 tls_try_verify_hosts
29132 tls_verify_certificates
29133 tls_crl
29134 tls_verify_cert_hostnames
29135.endd
29136
29137If DANE is not usable, whether requested or not, and CA-anchored
29138verification evaluation is wanted, the above variables should be set appropriately.
29139
29140The router and transport option &%dnssec_request_domains%& must not be
29141set to &"never"&, and &%dnssec_require_domains%& is ignored.
29142
29143If verification was successful using DANE then the "CV" item in the delivery log line will show as "CV=dane".
29144
29145There is a new variable &$tls_out_dane$& which will have "yes" if
29146verification succeeded using DANE and "no" otherwise (only useful
29147in combination with events; see &<<CHAPevents>>&),
29148and a new variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& (detailed above).
29149
29150.cindex DANE reporting
29151An event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "dane:fail" will be raised on failures
29152to achieve DANE-verified connection, if one was either requested and offered, or
29153required. This is intended to support TLS-reporting as defined in
29154&url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/draft-ietf-uta-smtp-tlsrpt-17).
29155The &$event_data$& will be one of the Result Types defined in
29156Section 4.3 of that document.
29157
29158Under GnuTLS, DANE is only supported from version 3.0.0 onwards.
29159
29160DANE is specified in published RFCs and decouples certificate authority trust
29161selection from a "race to the bottom" of "you must trust everything for mail
29162to get through". There is an alternative technology called MTA-STS, which
29163instead publishes MX trust anchor information on an HTTPS website. At the
29164time this text was last updated, MTA-STS was still a draft, not yet an RFC.
29165Exim has no support for MTA-STS as a client, but Exim mail server operators
29166can choose to publish information describing their TLS configuration using
29167MTA-STS to let those clients who do use that protocol derive trust
29168information.
29169
29170The MTA-STS design requires a certificate from a public Certificate Authority
29171which is recognized by clients sending to you.
29172That selection of which CAs are trusted by others is outside your control.
29173
29174The most interoperable course of action is probably to use
29175&url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt), with automated certificate
29176renewal; to publish the anchor information in DNSSEC-secured DNS via TLSA
29177records for DANE clients (such as Exim and Postfix) and to publish anchor
29178information for MTA-STS as well. This is what is done for the &'exim.org'&
29179domain itself (with caveats around occasionally broken MTA-STS because of
29180incompatible specification changes prior to reaching RFC status).
29181
29182
29183
29184. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29185. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29186
29187.chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
29188.scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
29189.cindex "control of incoming mail"
29190.cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
29191.cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
29192Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the runtime
29193configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
29194name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
29195one very small ACL:
29196.code
29197begin acl
29198small_acl:
29199 accept hosts = one.host.only
29200.endd
29201You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
29202which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
29203
29204The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
29205certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
29206when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
29207option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
29208in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
29209local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
29210a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
29211&<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
29212
29213
29214.section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
29215The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
29216configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
29217
29218
29219.section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
29220.cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
29221In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
29222options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
29223.cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
29224.cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
29225.cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
29226.cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
29227.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
29228.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
29229.cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
29230.cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
29231.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
29232.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
29233.cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
29234.cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
29235.cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
29236.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
29237.cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
29238.cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
29239
29240.table2 140pt
29241.irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
29242.irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
29243.irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
29244.irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
29245.irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
29246.irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
29247.irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
29248.irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
29249.irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
29250.irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
29251.irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
29252.irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
29253.irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
29254.irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
29255.irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
29256.irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
29257.irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
29258.irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
29259.irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
29260.irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
29261.endtable
29262
29263For example, if you set
29264.code
29265acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
29266.endd
29267the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
29268in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
29269done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
29270sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
29271command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
29272trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
29273testing as possible at RCPT time.
29274
29275
29276.section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
29277.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
29278The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
29279apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
29280really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
29281the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
29282relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
29283are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
29284&$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
29285&$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
29286in any of these ACLs.
29287
29288The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
29289non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
29290analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
29291batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
29292result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
29293really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
29294on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
29295controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
29296.code
29297control = suppress_local_fixups
29298.endd
29299This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
29300run, it is too late.
29301
29302The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29303content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29304
29305The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
29306kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
29307temporary error for these kinds of message.
29308
29309
29310.section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
29311.cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
29312.oindex &%smtp_banner%&
29313The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
29314session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
29315an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
29316accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
29317the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
29318&%smtp_banner%& option.
29319
29320
29321.section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
29322.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
29323.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
29324The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
29325EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
29326&%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
29327Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
29328session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
29329setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
29330
29331Note also that a deny neither forces the client to go away nor means that
29332mail will be refused on the connection. Consider checking for
29333&$sender_helo_name$& being defined in a MAIL or RCPT ACL to do that.
29334
29335If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
29336modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
29337at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
29338affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
29339an EHLO response.
29340
29341
29342.section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
29343.cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
29344Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
29345command, with two responses being sent to the client.
29346When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
29347is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
29348the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
29349response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
29350added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
29351are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
29352
29353You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
29354in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
29355tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
29356received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
29357the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
29358associated with the DATA command.
29359
29360.cindex CHUNKING "BDAT command"
29361.cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
29362.cindex "RFC 3030" CHUNKING
29363If CHUNKING was advertised and a BDAT command sequence is received,
29364the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL is not run.
29365. XXX why not? It should be possible, for the first BDAT.
29366The &%acl_smtp_data%& is run after the last BDAT command and all of
29367the data specified is received.
29368
29369For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
29370error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
29371MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
29372before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
29373and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
29374your resources.
29375
29376The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
29377the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
29378the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
29379and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
29380
29381.section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
29382The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
29383enabled (which is the default).
29384
29385The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
29386received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
29387otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
29388
29389This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29390
29391For details on the operation of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
29392
29393
29394.section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
29395The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29396content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29397
29398This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29399
29400
29401.section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
29402.cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
29403.oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
29404The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
29405with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
29406It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
29407client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
29408has been accepted.
29409
29410The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
29411has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
29412with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
29413The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
29414The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
29415can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
29416for some or all recipients.
29417
29418PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
29419one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
29420content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
29421.cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
29422for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
29423is &"yes"&.
29424Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
29425ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
29426will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
29427
29428See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
29429and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
29430
29431This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29432If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
29433the feature was not requested by the client.
29434
29435.section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
29436.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
29437The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
29438does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
29439does not in fact control any access.
29440For this reason, it may only accept
29441or warn as its final result.
29442
29443This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
29444session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
29445messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
29446more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
29447
29448&*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
29449the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
29450
29451You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
29452&%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
29453response to QUIT.
29454
29455This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
29456failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
29457because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
29458client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
29459connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
29460
29461
29462.section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
29463.vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
29464The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
29465an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
29466trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
29467because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
29468situation even worse.
29469
29470Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
29471logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
29472modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
29473and &%warn%&.
29474
29475.vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
29476When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
29477to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
29478connection. The possible values are:
29479.table2
29480.irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
29481.irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
29482.irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
29483.irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
29484.irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
29485.irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
29486.irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
29487.irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
29488.irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
29489.irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
29490.endtable
29491In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
29492Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
29493With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
29494overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
29495&%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
29496used.
29497
29498
29499.section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
29500.cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
29501The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
29502you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
29503.code
29504acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
29505 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
29506.endd
29507In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
29508providing an RFC 4409 message &"submission"& service on port 587 and
29509an RFC 8314 &"submissions"& service on port 465. You can use a string
29510expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
29511more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
29512
29513The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
29514configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
29515string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
29516
29517.ilist
29518If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a filename, and reads its
29519contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
29520Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
29521lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
29522If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
29523causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
29524.code
29525acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
29526 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
29527 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
29528.endd
29529This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
29530back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
29531file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
29532can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
29533.next
29534If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
29535Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
29536matches the string.
29537.next
29538If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
29539the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
29540want to have something like
29541.code
29542acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
29543.endd
29544in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
29545newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
29546.endlist
29547
29548
29549
29550
29551.section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
29552.cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
29553Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
29554section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
29555&"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
29556database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
29557return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
29558&"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
29559This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
29560
29561For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
29562&"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
29563submitters of non-SMTP messages.
29564
29565
29566ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
29567has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
29568individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
29569blackholing facility. Use it with care.
29570
29571If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
29572ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
29573RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
29574recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
29575run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
29576remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
29577&%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
29578
29579If the ACL for VRFY returns &"accept"&, a recipient verify (without callout)
29580is done on the address and the result determines the SMTP response.
29581
29582
29583.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
29584The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
29585recipients; it may create new recipients.
29586
29587
29588
29589.section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
29590.cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
29591The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
29592all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
29593not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
29594reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
29595
29596For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
29597these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
29598used to accept or reject anything.
29599
29600For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
29601&%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
29602&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
29603when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
29604
29605For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
29606&%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
29607This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
29608messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
29609configuration file.
29610
29611
29612
29613
29614.section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
29615.cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
29616.vindex &$domain$&
29617.vindex &$local_part$&
29618.vindex &$sender_address$&
29619.vindex &$sender_host_address$&
29620.vindex &$smtp_command$&
29621When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
29622that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
29623&$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
29624statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
29625&$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
29626is available in &$smtp_command$&.
29627
29628When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
29629contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
29630set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
29631how it is used.
29632
29633.vindex "&$message_size$&"
29634The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
29635the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
29636that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
29637the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
29638received).
29639
29640.vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
29641.vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
29642The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
29643The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
29644accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
29645of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
29646&$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
29647&$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
29648
29649
29650
29651
29652
29653.section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
29654.cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
29655.vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
29656.vindex &$smtp_command$&
29657When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
29658the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
29659and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
29660These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
29661here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
29662encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
29663does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
29664unencrypted connections.
29665.code
29666acl_check_auth:
29667 accept encrypted = *
29668 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
29669 {CRAM-MD5}}
29670 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
29671.endd
29672(Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
29673that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
29674encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
29675option to do this.)
29676
29677
29678
29679.section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
29680.cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
29681.cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
29682An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
29683with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
29684Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
29685set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
29686
29687If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
29688used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
29689provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
29690example:
29691.code
29692deny dnslists = list1.example
29693 dnslists = list2.example
29694.endd
29695If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
29696the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
29697happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
29698all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
29699test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
29700
29701
29702.section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
29703The ACL verbs are as follows:
29704
29705.ilist
29706.cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
29707&%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
29708of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
29709appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
29710is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
29711after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
29712check a RCPT command:
29713.code
29714accept domains = +local_domains
29715 endpass
29716 verify = recipient
29717.endd
29718If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
29719passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
29720the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
29721fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
29722&%endpass%&.
29723
29724The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
29725use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
29726that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
29727configuration.
29728
29729.cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
29730If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
29731depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
29732(when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
29733statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
29734SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
29735.display
29736&`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
29737&` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
29738.endd
29739You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
29740response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
29741same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
29742
29743If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
29744an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
29745for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
29746of &%endpass%&.
29747
29748
29749.next
29750.cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
29751&%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
29752an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
29753&%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
29754temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
29755&(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
29756be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
29757
29758
29759.next
29760.cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
29761&%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
29762the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
29763example,
29764.code
29765deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29766.endd
29767rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
29768
29769
29770.next
29771.cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
29772&%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
29773&"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
29774that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
29775the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
29776recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
29777recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
29778message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
29779do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
29780
29781If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
29782its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
29783The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
29784
29785
29786.next
29787.cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
29788&%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
29789forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
29790.code
29791drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
29792 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
29793.endd
29794There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
29795The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
29796
29797.next
29798.cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
29799&%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
29800statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
29801example, when checking a RCPT command,
29802.code
29803require message = Sender did not verify
29804 verify = sender
29805.endd
29806passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
29807verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
29808&%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
29809discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
29810
29811.next
29812.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
29813&%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
29814&%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
29815to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
29816written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
29817message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
29818duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
29819
29820If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
29821and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
29822&%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
29823first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
29824&<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
29825
29826If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
29827some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
29828This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
29829is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
29830conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
29831is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
29832onwards.
29833
29834
29835.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29836When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
29837text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
29838want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
29839.code
29840warn !verify = sender
29841 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
29842.endd
29843.endlist
29844
29845At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
29846
29847As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
29848written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
29849subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
29850continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
29851mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
29852
29853
29854
29855.section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
29856.cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
29857There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
29858can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
29859of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
29860transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
29861variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
29862an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
29863alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
29864the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
29865.ilist
29866The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
29867throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
29868while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
29869on the same SMTP connection.
29870.next
29871The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
29872while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
29873reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
29874.endlist
29875
29876When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
29877preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
29878time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
29879.code
29880accept hosts = whatever
29881 set acl_m4 = some value
29882accept authenticated = *
29883 set acl_c_auth = yes
29884.endd
29885&*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
29886be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
29887&%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
29888
29889.oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
29890What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
29891referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
29892false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
29893error is generated.
29894
29895Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
29896their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
29897
29898
29899.section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
29900.cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
29901.cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
29902An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
29903.code
29904deny domains = *.dom.example
29905 !verify = recipient
29906.endd
29907causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
29908&'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
29909negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
29910two statements are equivalent:
29911.code
29912deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
29913deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
29914.endd
29915However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
29916side negation of the whole condition is possible.
29917
29918The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
29919of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
29920condition is true. Consider these two statements:
29921.code
29922accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
29923 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
29924accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
29925 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
29926.endd
29927Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
29928the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
29929different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
29930condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
29931therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
29932the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
29933and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
29934
29935ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
29936specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
29937others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
29938warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
29939message is handled.
29940
29941The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
29942processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
29943modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
29944consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
29945.code
29946require message = Can't verify sender
29947 verify = sender
29948 message = Can't verify recipient
29949 verify = recipient
29950 message = This message cannot be used
29951.endd
29952If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
29953&"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
29954so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
29955recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
29956verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
29957because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
29958
29959For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
29960modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
29961happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
29962the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
29963.code
29964deny hosts = ...
29965 !senders = *@my.domain.example
29966 message = Invalid sender from client host
29967.endd
29968The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
29969by which time Exim has set up the message.
29970
29971
29972
29973.section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
29974.cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
29975The ACL modifiers are as follows:
29976
29977.vlist
29978.vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29979This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
29980incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
29981accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
29982
29983.vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29984.cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
29985.cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
29986This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
29987continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
29988the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
29989update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
29990write rather ugly lines like this:
29991.display
29992&`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
29993.endd
29994Instead, all you need is
29995.display
29996&`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
29997.endd
29998
29999.vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30000.cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
30001This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
30002incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
30003lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
30004lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
30005controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
30006even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
30007
30008As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
30009separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
30010in several different ways. For example:
30011
30012. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
30013. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
30014. ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
30015. ==== way.
30016
30017.ilist
30018It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
30019.code
30020 accept ...some conditions
30021 control = queue_only
30022.endd
30023In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
30024other words, when the conditions are all true.
30025
30026.next
30027It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
30028.code
30029 accept ...some conditions...
30030 control = queue_only
30031 ...some more conditions...
30032.endd
30033If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
30034statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
30035In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
30036to be relevant.
30037
30038.next
30039It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
30040decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
30041example:
30042.code
30043 warn ...some conditions...
30044 control = freeze
30045 accept ...
30046.endd
30047This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
30048&%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
30049log entry.
30050
30051.next
30052If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
30053&%require%& verb. For example:
30054.code
30055 require control = no_multiline_responses
30056.endd
30057.endlist
30058
30059.vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
30060.cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
30061.oindex "&%-bh%&"
30062This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
30063the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
30064&%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
30065output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
30066happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
30067output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
30068
30069Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
30070example:
30071.code
30072deny ...some conditions...
30073 delay = 30s
30074.endd
30075The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
30076&"deny"&. Compare this with:
30077.code
30078deny delay = 30s
30079 ...some conditions...
30080.endd
30081which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
30082can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
30083.code
30084warn ...some conditions...
30085 delay = 2m
30086 control = freeze
30087accept ...
30088.endd
30089
30090If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
30091responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
30092they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
30093delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
30094appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
30095unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
30096using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
30097
30098
30099.vitem &*endpass*&
30100.cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
30101This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
30102&%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
30103failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
30104failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
30105confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
30106&"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
30107
30108
30109.vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30110.cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
30111This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
30112ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
30113.code
30114require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
30115 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
30116.endd
30117&%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
30118example:
30119.display
30120&`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
30121&` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
30122.endd
30123When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
30124that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
30125recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
30126message.
30127
30128The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
30129the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
30130denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
30131available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
30132variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
30133&%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
30134ignored.
30135
30136.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30137If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
30138verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
30139error message.
30140
30141If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
30142the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
30143more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
30144actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
30145of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
30146is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
30147
30148If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
30149example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
30150the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
30151logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
30152both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
30153logging rejections.
30154
30155
30156.vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
30157.cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
30158.cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
30159This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
30160about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
30161be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
30162may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
30163ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
30164.display
30165&`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
30166&` log_reject_target =`&
30167.endd
30168This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
30169permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
30170current ACL.
30171
30172
30173.vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30174.cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
30175.cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
30176This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
30177processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
30178&%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
30179access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
30180ACLs. For example:
30181.display
30182&`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
30183&` control = freeze`&
30184&` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
30185.endd
30186By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
30187with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
30188another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
30189example:
30190.code
30191logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
30192logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
30193.endd
30194
30195
30196.vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30197.cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
30198This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
30199message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
30200or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
30201there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
30202&%accept%& for details.)
30203
30204The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
30205to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
30206generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
30207&%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
30208the &%hosts%& condition fails:
30209.code
30210require message = Host not recognized
30211 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
30212.endd
30213(Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
30214processed.)
30215
30216.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
30217.oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
30218For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
30219of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
30220is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
30221is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
30222overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
30223accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
30224truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
30225EHLO options.
30226
30227When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
30228consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
30229of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
30230.code
30231deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
30232 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
30233.endd
30234The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
30235by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
30236access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
302372&'xx'&.
30238
30239Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
30240the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
30241
30242The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
30243literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
30244anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
30245response.
30246
30247.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30248For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
30249stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
30250
30251If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
30252specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
30253However, the original message is available in the variable
30254&$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
30255wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
30256routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
30257use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
30258
30259For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
30260is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
30261modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
30262all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
30263&%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
30264&%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
30265effect.
30266
30267
30268.vitem &*queue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30269.cindex "&%queue%& ACL modifier"
30270.cindex "named queues" "selecting in ACL"
30271This modifier specifies the use of a named queue for spool files
30272for the message.
30273It can only be used before the message is received (i.e. not in
30274the DATA ACL).
30275This could be used, for example, for known high-volume burst sources
30276of traffic, or for quarantine of messages.
30277Separate queue-runner processes will be needed for named queues.
30278If the text after expansion is empty, the default queue is used.
30279
30280
30281.vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30282This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
30283 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
30284the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
30285
30286
30287.vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
30288.cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
30289This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
30290&<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
30291
30292
30293.vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
30294.cindex "UDP communications"
30295This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
30296collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
30297the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
30298of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
30299server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
30300separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
30301example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
30302when:
30303.code
30304udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
30305 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
30306.endd
30307.endlist
30308
30309
30310
30311
30312.section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
30313.cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
30314The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
30315
30316.vlist
30317.vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
30318This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
30319has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
30320apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
30321HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
30322really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
30323not work without it. For example:
30324.code
30325warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
30326 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
30327.endd
30328Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
30329the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
30330matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
30331mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
30332by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
30333
30334
30335.vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
30336 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
30337.cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
30338.cindex "case of local parts"
30339.vindex "&$local_part$&"
30340These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
30341(that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
30342are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
30343any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
30344for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
30345is encountered.
30346
30347These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
30348local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
30349in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
30350handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
30351configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
30352
30353This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
30354containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
30355spam score:
30356.code
30357warn control = caseful_local_part
30358 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
30359 $acl_m4 + \
30360 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
30361 }
30362 control = caselower_local_part
30363.endd
30364Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
30365is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
30366
30367
30368.vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery/*&<&'options'&>
30369.cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
30370.cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
30371This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
30372
30373The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
30374If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
30375and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
30376is used for all recipients of the message,
30377then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
30378and data is copied from one to the other.
30379
30380An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
30381for a mail will be quietly ignored.
30382If a recipient-verify callout
30383(with use_sender)
30384connection is subsequently
30385requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
30386any subsequent recipients and the data,
30387otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
30388
30389Note that routers are used in verify mode,
30390and cannot depend on content of received headers.
30391Note also that headers cannot be
30392modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
30393Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
30394The &'Received-By:'& header is generated as soon as the body reception starts,
30395rather than the traditional time after the full message is received;
30396this will affect the timestamp.
30397
30398All the usual ACLs are called; if one results in the message being
30399rejected, all effort spent in delivery (including the costs on
30400the ultimate destination) will be wasted.
30401Note that in the case of data-time ACLs this includes the entire
30402message body.
30403
30404Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
30405of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
30406before the entire message has been received from the source.
30407It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR
30408or CHUNKING
30409options in use.
30410
30411Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
30412a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
30413If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
30414the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
30415before the acceptance "<=" line.
30416
30417If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
30418usual fashion.
30419This behaviour can be adjusted by appending the option &*defer=*&<&'value'&>
30420to the control; the default value is &"spool"& and the alternate value
30421&"pass"& copies an SMTP defer response from the target back to the initiator
30422and does not queue the message.
30423Note that this is independent of any recipient verify conditions in the ACL.
30424
30425Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
30426(possibly faked)
30427sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
30428
30429
30430.vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
30431.cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
30432.cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
30433This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
30434with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile in the usual logs directory,
30435by default called &'debuglog'&.
30436The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
30437may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
30438the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
30439option.
30440Logging started this way may be stopped, and the file removed,
30441with the &'kill'& option.
30442Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
30443contexts):
30444.code
30445 control = debug
30446 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
30447 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
30448 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
30449 control = debug/kill
30450.endd
30451
30452
30453.vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
30454.cindex "disable DKIM verify"
30455.cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
30456This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
30457the operation and configuration of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
30458
30459
30460.vitem &*control&~=&~dmarc_disable_verify*&
30461.cindex "disable DMARC verify"
30462.cindex "DMARC" "disable verify"
30463This control turns off DMARC verification processing entirely. For details on
30464the operation and configuration of DMARC, see section &<<SECDMARC>>&.
30465
30466
30467.vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
30468.cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
30469.cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
30470This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
30471connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
30472strings or to numeric value.
30473The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
30474Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
30475&`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
30476
30477The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
30478(for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
30479that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
30480equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
30481Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
30482
30483
30484.vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
30485 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
30486.cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
30487.cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
30488These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
30489is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
30490state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
30491in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
30492
30493The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
30494connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
30495messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
30496&%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
30497before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
30498synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
30499work with.
30500
30501
30502.vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
30503.cindex "fake defer"
30504.cindex "defer, fake"
30505This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
30506except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
30507550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
30508messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
30509use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
30510
30511.vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
30512.cindex "fake rejection"
30513.cindex "rejection, fake"
30514This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
30515words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
30516message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
30517However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
30518only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
30519the same SMTP connection.
30520
30521The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
30522message is supplied, the following is used:
30523.code
30524550-Your message has been rejected but is being
30525550-kept for evaluation.
30526550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
30527550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
30528.endd
30529This facility should be used with extreme caution.
30530
30531.vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
30532.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
30533This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
30534other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
30535it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
30536current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
30537SMTP connection.
30538
30539This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
30540&%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
30541is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
30542are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
30543
30544.vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
30545.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
30546Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
30547avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
30548use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
30549disables such output flushing.
30550
30551.vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
30552.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
30553Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
30554avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
30555use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
30556that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
30557
30558.vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
30559This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
30560extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
30561of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
30562or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
30563needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
30564only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
30565the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
30566to be useful in production.
30567
30568.vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
30569.cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
30570This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
30571It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
30572SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
30573
30574If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
30575suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
30576one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
30577(&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
30578responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
30579sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
30580
30581.ilist
30582Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
30583sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
30584verification failed"&) is sent.
30585.next
30586If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
30587line is output.
30588.endlist
30589
30590The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
30591calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
30592
30593.vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
30594.cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
30595This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
30596the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
30597response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
30598controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
30599&%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
30600
30601.vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
30602.oindex "&%queue_only%&"
30603.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
30604This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
30605other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
30606it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
30607runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
30608effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
30609to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
30610same SMTP connection.
30611
30612.vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
30613.cindex "message" "submission"
30614.cindex "submission mode"
30615This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
30616latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
30617the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
30618operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
30619necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
30620This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
30621late (the message has already been created).
30622
30623Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
30624messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
30625submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
30626The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
30627that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
30628
30629.vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
30630.cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
30631This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
30632complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
30633normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
30634
30635.ilist
30636Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
30637dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
30638.next
30639No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
30640.next
30641There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
30642.endlist ilist
30643
30644This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
30645passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
30646used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
30647and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
30648data is read.
30649
30650&*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
30651that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
30652
30653.vitem &*control&~=&~utf8_downconvert*&
30654This control enables conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
30655to a-label form.
30656For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
30657.endlist vlist
30658
30659
30660.section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
30661All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
30662
30663.ilist
30664Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
30665.next
30666Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
30667&`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
30668.next
30669Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
30670.next
30671Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
30672.endlist
30673
30674
30675
30676.section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
30677.cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
30678.cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
30679.cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
30680The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
30681to an incoming message, as in this example:
30682.code
30683warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30684 dialup.mail-abuse.org
30685 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
30686.endd
30687The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
30688MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
30689receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
30690&%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
30691any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
30692RCPT ACL).
30693
30694Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
30695DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
30696
30697Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
30698the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
30699contains one or more newlines that
30700are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
30701lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
30702front of any line that is not a valid header line.
30703
30704Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
30705They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
30706However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
30707is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
30708during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
30709with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
30710lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
30711In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
30712non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
30713message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
30714are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
30715
30716.cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
30717Header lines are not visible in string expansions
30718of message headers
30719until they are added to the
30720message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
30721ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
30722header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
30723ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
30724passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
30725this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
30726&<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
30727
30728The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
30729
30730The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
30731processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
30732.display
30733&`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
30734&` `&<&'some condition'&>
30735
30736&`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
30737&` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
30738.endd
30739In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
30740condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
30741condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
30742ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
30743honoured.
30744
30745.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
30746For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
30747&%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
30748effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
30749them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
30750usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
30751are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
30752specifications.
30753
30754By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
30755header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
30756be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
30757after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
30758that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
30759
30760This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
30761&":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
30762header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
30763to be a header name first.) For example:
30764.code
30765warn add_header = \
30766 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
30767.endd
30768If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
30769each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
30770you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
30771up in reverse order.
30772
30773&*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
30774added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
30775system filter or in a router or transport.
30776
30777
30778
30779.section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
30780.cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
30781.cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
30782.cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
30783The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
30784from an incoming message, as in this example:
30785.code
30786warn message = Remove internal headers
30787 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
30788.endd
30789The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
30790MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
30791receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
30792&%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
30793with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
30794any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
30795
30796Headers will not be removed from the message if the modifier is used in
30797DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
30798
30799More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
30800list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
30801not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
30802create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
30803are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
30804.code
30805warn hosts = +internal_hosts
30806 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
30807warn message = Remove internal headers
30808 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
30809.endd
30810Header names for removal are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
30811Matching header lines are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
30812If multiple header lines match, all are removed.
30813There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor in removing
30814a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
30815during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
30816if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
30817accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
30818all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
30819ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
30820would have been removed.
30821
30822.cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
30823Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
30824is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
30825not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
30826removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
30827this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
30828passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
30829you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
30830&<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
30831
30832The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
30833processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
30834.display
30835&`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
30836&` `&<&'some condition'&>
30837
30838&`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
30839&` remove_header = X-Internal`&
30840.endd
30841In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
30842condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
30843condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
30844same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
30845are honoured.
30846
30847&*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
30848present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
30849in a system filter or in a router or transport.
30850
30851
30852
30853
30854.section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
30855.cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
30856Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
30857compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
30858for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
30859content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30860
30861Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
30862senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
30863result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
30864done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
30865can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
30866same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
30867The conditions are as follows:
30868
30869
30870.vlist
30871.vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
30872.cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
30873.cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
30874.cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
30875.cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
30876The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
30877&%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
30878&"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
30879false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
30880condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
30881condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
30882ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
30883
30884If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
30885can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
30886and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
30887Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
30888The name and values are expanded separately.
30889Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
30890will act as argument separators.
30891
30892If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
30893the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
30894&%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
30895conditions are tested.
30896
30897ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
30898loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
30899circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
30900for different local users or different local domains.
30901
30902.vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
30903.cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
30904.cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
30905.cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
30906If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
30907the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
30908authentication by any authenticator, you can set
30909.code
30910authenticated = *
30911.endd
30912
30913.vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
30914.cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
30915.cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
30916.cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
30917.cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
30918This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
30919expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
30920&"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
30921number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
30922any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
30923&"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
30924ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
30925negative.
30926
30927.vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
30928.cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
30929This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30930content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
30931&%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
30932If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
30933problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
30934chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30935
30936.vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
30937.cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
30938.cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
30939.cindex "black list (DNS)"
30940.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
30941This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
30942&"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
30943use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
30944different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
30945&<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
30946
30947.vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
30948.cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
30949.cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
30950.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
30951.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
30952This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
30953of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
30954enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
30955lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
30956&%domains%& test.
30957
30958&*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
30959use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
30960
30961
30962.vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
30963.cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
30964.cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
30965.cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
30966If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
30967name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
30968encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
30969.code
30970encrypted = *
30971.endd
30972
30973
30974.vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
30975.cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
30976.cindex "host" "ACL checking"
30977.cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
30978This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
30979name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
30980you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
30981.code
30982accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
30983.endd
30984The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
30985the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
30986and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
30987
30988The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
30989Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
30990but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
30991find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
30992opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
30993found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
30994
30995If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
30996address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
30997.code
30998accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
30999accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
31000.endd
31001The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
31002is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
31003statement can then check the IP address.
31004
31005.vindex "&$host_data$&"
31006If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
31007of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
31008allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
31009.code
31010deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
31011message = $host_data
31012.endd
31013which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
31014
31015.vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
31016.cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
31017.cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
31018.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
31019.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
31020This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
31021part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
31022enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
31023result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
31024the next &%local_parts%& test.
31025
31026.vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
31027.cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
31028.cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
31029.cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
31030This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31031content-scanning extension
31032and only after a DATA command.
31033It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
31034viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31035
31036.vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
31037.cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
31038.cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
31039This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31040content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
31041&%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
31042with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
31043&<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31044
31045.vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
31046.cindex "rate limiting"
31047This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
31048messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
31049
31050.vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
31051.cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
31052.cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
31053.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
31054This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
31055recipient address against a list of recipients.
31056
31057.vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
31058.cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
31059.cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
31060This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31061content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
31062non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
31063any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31064
31065.vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
31066.cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
31067.cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
31068.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
31069.vindex "&$domain$&"
31070.vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
31071This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
31072domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
31073&$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
31074of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
31075lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
31076RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
31077influence the sender checking.
31078
31079&*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
31080relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
31081
31082.vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
31083.cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
31084.cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
31085.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
31086This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
31087for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
31088.code
31089senders = :
31090.endd
31091&*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
31092relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
31093
31094.vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
31095.cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
31096.cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
31097This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31098content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
31099SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31100
31101.vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
31102.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31103.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
31104.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
31105.cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
31106.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
31107This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
31108certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
31109server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
31110or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
31111
31112.vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
31113.cindex "CSA verification"
31114This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
31115send email. Details of how this works are given in section
31116&<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
31117
31118.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
31119.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31120.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
31121.cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
31122.cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
31123This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
31124received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
31125&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
31126there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
31127allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
31128
31129Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
31130problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
31131detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
31132
31133.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
31134.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31135.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
31136.cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
31137.cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
31138.cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
31139This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
31140received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
31141&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
31142of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
31143is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
31144However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
31145that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
31146to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
31147might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
31148
31149Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
31150section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
31151&<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
31152condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
31153.code
31154deny senders = :
31155 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
31156 !verify = header_sender
31157.endd
31158
31159.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
31160.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31161.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
31162.cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
31163.cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
31164This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
31165received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
31166&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
31167lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
31168and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
31169Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
31170permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
31171&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
31172appropriate.
31173
31174Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
31175ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
31176.code
31177To: @
31178.endd
31179and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
31180common as they used to be.
31181
31182.vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
31183.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31184.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
31185.cindex "HELO" "verifying"
31186.cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
31187.cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
31188.cindex "verifying" "HELO"
31189This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
31190client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
31191attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
31192condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
31193&%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
31194independently of this condition, and for detail of the verification.
31195
31196For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
31197option), this condition is always true.
31198
31199
31200.vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind/*&<&'options'&>
31201.cindex "verifying" "not blind"
31202.cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
31203This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
31204Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
31205&'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
31206case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
31207&'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
31208used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
31209
31210There is one possible option, &`case_insensitive`&. If this is present then
31211local parts are checked case-insensitively.
31212
31213There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
31214recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
31215
31216
31217.vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
31218.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31219.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
31220.cindex "recipient" "verifying"
31221.cindex "verifying" "recipient"
31222.vindex "&$address_data$&"
31223This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
31224recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
31225&<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
31226of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
31227This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
31228verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
31229address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
31230value for the child address.
31231
31232.vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
31233.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31234.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
31235.cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
31236This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
31237address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
31238was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
31239Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
31240one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
31241original IP address.
31242
31243There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
31244DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
31245
31246If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
31247is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
31248
31249.vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
31250.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31251.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
31252.cindex "sender" "verifying"
31253.cindex "verifying" "sender"
31254This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
31255message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
31256the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
31257condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
31258
31259.vindex "&$address_data$&"
31260.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
31261If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
31262value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
31263value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
31264statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
31265want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
31266
31267Details of verification are given later, starting at section
31268&<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
31269to avoid doing it more than once per message.
31270
31271.vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
31272.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31273This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
31274verified as a sender.
31275
31276Note that '/' is legal in local-parts; if the address may have such
31277(eg. is generated from the received message)
31278they must be protected from the options parsing by doubling:
31279.code
31280verify = sender=${sg{${address:$h_sender:}}{/}{//}}
31281.endd
31282.endlist
31283
31284
31285
31286.section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
31287.cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
31288.cindex "black list (DNS)"
31289.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
31290In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
31291is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
31292address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
31293domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
31294special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
31295address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
31296.code
31297deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
31298 dialups.mail-abuse.org
31299.endd
31300the following records are looked up:
31301.code
3130243.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
3130343.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
31304.endd
31305As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
31306Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
31307to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
31308use two separate conditions:
31309.code
31310deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31311 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
31312.endd
31313If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
31314behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
31315record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
31316processed.
31317
31318This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
31319(which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
31320blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
31321following special items in the list:
31322.display
31323&`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
31324&`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
31325&`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
31326.endd
31327.cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
31328.cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
31329.cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
31330Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
31331.code
31332deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
31333.endd
31334Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
31335warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
31336.code
31337deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31338warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
31339 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
31340.endd
31341.cindex caching "of dns lookup"
31342.cindex DNS TTL
31343DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
31344(but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
31345so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
31346connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
31347Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
31348connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
31349
31350There are a number of DNS lists to choose from, some commercial, some free,
31351or free for small deployments. An overview can be found at
31352&url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Comparison_of_DNS_blacklists).
31353
31354
31355
31356.section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
31357.cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
31358By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
31359of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
31360after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
31361.code
31362deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
31363.endd
31364This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
31365use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
31366MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
31367&<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
31368
31369
31370
31371
31372.section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
31373.cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
31374There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
31375addresses (see, e.g., the &'domain based zones'& link at
31376&url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
31377with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
31378listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
31379.code
31380deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
31381 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
31382.endd
31383This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
31384RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
31385example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
31386up by this example is
31387.code
31388tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
31389.endd
31390A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
31391addresses. For example:
31392.code
31393deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31394 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
31395.endd
31396The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
31397name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
31398
31399
31400
31401
31402.section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
31403.cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
31404The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
31405names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
31406name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
31407As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
31408this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
31409either to double the separators like this:
31410.code
31411dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
31412.endd
31413or to change the separator character, like this:
31414.code
31415dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
31416.endd
31417If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
31418blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
31419occurs. Consider this condition:
31420.code
31421dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
31422.endd
31423The DNS lookups that occur are:
31424.code
314252.1.168.192.black.list.tld
31426a.domain.black.list.tld
31427.endd
31428Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
31429address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
31430are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
31431or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
31432only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
31433successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
31434error for a previous item.
31435
31436The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
31437syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
31438.code
31439dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
31440dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
31441.endd
31442However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
31443is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
31444.code
31445deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
31446 $sender_address_domain \
31447 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
31448 see $dnslist_text.
31449 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
31450 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
31451 $sender_address_domain} }} }
31452.endd
31453Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
31454multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
31455and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
31456of expanding the condition might be something like this:
31457.code
31458dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
31459.endd
31460Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
31461domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
31462
31463The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
31464&$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
31465
31466
31467
31468
31469.section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
31470.cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
31471DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
31472just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
31473RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
31474The values used on the RBL+ list are:
31475.display
31476127.1.0.1 RBL
31477127.1.0.2 DUL
31478127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
31479127.1.0.4 RSS
31480127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
31481127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
31482127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
31483.endd
31484Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
31485different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
31486see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
31487
31488
31489.section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
31490.cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
31491.cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
31492.vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
31493.vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
31494.vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
31495.vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
31496When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
31497the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
31498&`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
31499(for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
31500the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
31501&$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
31502cases, for example:
31503.code
31504deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
31505.endd
31506the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
31507&$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
31508For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
31509might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
31510.code
31511deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
31512.endd
31513If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
31514&`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
31515
31516If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
31517addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
31518The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
31519record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
31520very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
31521information.
31522
31523You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
31524&-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
31525expanded until after it has failed. For example:
31526.code
31527deny hosts = !+local_networks
31528 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
31529 at $dnslist_domain
31530 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
31531.endd
31532
31533
31534
31535.section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
31536.cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
31537You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
31538in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
31539For example,
31540.code
31541deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
31542.endd
31543rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
31544any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
31545that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
31546describes how multiple records are handled.
31547
31548More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
31549separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
31550&%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
31551.code
31552deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31553.endd
31554If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
31555addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
31556first. For example:
31557.code
31558deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
31559 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
31560.endd
31561
31562If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
31563listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
31564In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
31565true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
31566tested. For example:
31567.code
31568dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
31569.endd
31570matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
31571want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
31572being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
31573.code
31574dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
31575.endd
31576matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
31577an odd number.
31578
31579
31580
31581.section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
31582You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
31583condition. Whereas
31584.code
31585deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31586.endd
31587means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
31588IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
31589.code
31590deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31591.endd
31592means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
31593IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
31594words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
31595the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
31596
31597&*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
31598host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
31599
31600If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
31601previous example is precisely equivalent to
31602.code
31603deny dnslists = a.b.c
31604 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31605.endd
31606However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
31607Consider this example:
31608.code
31609deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31610 list.dsbl.org : \
31611 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
31612 relays.ordb.org
31613.endd
31614Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
31615.code
31616deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31617 list.dsbl.org
31618deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
31619 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
31620deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
31621.endd
31622which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
31623
31624
31625
31626
31627.section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
31628A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
31629thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
31630is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
31631the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
31632the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
31633.code
31634dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
31635.endd
31636What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
31637127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
31638condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
31639because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
31640affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
31641additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
31642
31643.ilist
31644If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
31645IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
31646condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
31647.next
31648If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
31649looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
31650changed to:
31651.code
31652dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
31653.endd
31654and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31655false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
31656.code
31657dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
31658.endd
31659for the condition to be true.
31660.endlist
31661
31662When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
31663the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
31664.ilist
31665If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
31666addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
31667.code
31668dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
31669.endd
31670If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31671false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
31672.next
31673If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
31674looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
31675.code
31676dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
31677.endd
31678If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31679true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
31680.code
31681dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
31682.endd
31683for the condition to be false.
31684.endlist
31685When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
31686between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
31687
31688
31689
31690
31691.section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
31692.cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
31693When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
31694the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
31695the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
31696address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
31697only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
31698can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
31699in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
31700lists.
31701
31702A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
31703two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
31704do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
31705If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
31706restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
31707a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
31708domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
31709.code
31710deny message = \
31711 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
31712 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
31713 dnslists = \
31714 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
31715 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
31716.endd
31717For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
31718&'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
31719match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
31720value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
31721record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
31722The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
31723
31724If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
31725given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
31726the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
31727.code
31728deny dnslists = \
31729 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
31730 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
31731 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
31732 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
31733.endd
31734In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
31735values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
31736done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
31737
31738
31739
31740.section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
31741.cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
31742.cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
31743If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
31744nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
317453ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
31746.code
317471.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
31748 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31749.endd
31750(split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
31751lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
31752IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
31753.code
31754*.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
31755.endd
31756is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
31757Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
31758
31759You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
31760&%condition%& condition, as in this example:
31761.code
31762deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
31763 dnslists = some.list.example
31764.endd
31765
31766If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
31767address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
31768(DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
31769.code
31770 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
31771.endd
31772
31773.section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
31774.cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
31775.cindex "limiting client sending rates"
31776.oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
31777The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
31778which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
31779&%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
31780commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
31781works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
31782host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
31783.display
31784&`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
31785.endd
31786If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
31787period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
31788
31789As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
31790&$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
31791configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
31792of &'p'&.
31793
31794The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
31795time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
31796means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
31797parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
31798send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
31799in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
31800constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
31801changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
31802both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
31803
31804There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
31805log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
31806when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
31807instructions when it is run with no arguments.
31808
31809The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
31810sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
31811retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
31812which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
31813By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
31814of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
31815user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
31816&$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
31817example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
31818authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
31819
31820The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
31821rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
31822&`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
31823ACL.
31824
31825Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
31826specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example, messages or recipients
31827or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
31828&%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
31829using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
31830separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
31831
31832Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
31833any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
31834stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
31835remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
31836remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
31837behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
31838the &%count=%& option.
31839
31840
31841.section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
31842.cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
31843The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
31844normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
31845&%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
31846
31847The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
31848the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
31849&%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
31850&%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
31851
31852The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
31853the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
31854in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
31855used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
31856in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
31857follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
31858in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
31859
31860The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
31861accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
31862&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
31863&%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
31864ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
31865in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
31866recipients as a large high-speed burst.
31867
31868The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
31869number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
31870last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
31871recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
31872&%acl_smtp_rcpt%&.
31873
31874The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
31875condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
31876command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
31877multiple different commands.
31878
31879The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
31880measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
31881&`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
31882increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
31883other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
31884
31885The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
31886
31887
31888.section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
31889.cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
31890You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
31891control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
31892mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
31893
31894If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
31895previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
31896
31897For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
31898it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
31899can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
31900in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
31901new rate.
31902.code
31903acl_check_connect:
31904 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
31905 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
31906 (max $sender_rate_limit)
31907# ...
31908acl_check_mail:
31909 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
31910 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
31911 (max $sender_rate_limit)
31912.endd
31913
31914If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
31915processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
31916it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
31917in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
31918same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
31919multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
31920checks.
31921
31922The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
31923use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
31924update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
31925&%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
31926next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
31927
31928
31929.section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
31930.cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
31931If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
31932engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
31933&%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
31934counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
31935rest of the ACL.
31936
31937The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
31938updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
31939client's average rate of successfully sent email,
31940up to the given limit.
31941This is appropriate if the countermeasure when the condition is true
31942consists of refusing the message, and
31943is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
31944If the action when true is anything more complex then this option is
31945likely not what is wanted.
31946
31947The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
31948updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
31949of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
31950actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
31951counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
31952pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
31953again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
31954attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
31955.code
31956 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
31957.endd
31958
31959
31960.section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
31961.cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
31962The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
31963rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
31964mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
31965sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
31966&`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
31967measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
31968options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
31969
31970For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
31971has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
31972rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
31973per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
31974go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
31975recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
31976
31977When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
31978&%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
31979rate.
31980
31981The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
31982other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
31983unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
31984required increases with larger limits.
31985
31986The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
31987will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
31988the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
31989the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
31990events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
31991times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
31992throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
31993limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
31994are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
31995as intended.
31996
31997
31998.section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
31999Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
32000when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
32001(for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
32002policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
32003message. For example:
32004.code
32005# Log all senders' rates
32006warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
32007 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
32008
32009# Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
32010# at the decimal point.
32011warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
32012 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
32013 $sender_rate_limit }s
32014
32015# Keep authenticated users under control
32016deny authenticated = *
32017 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
32018
32019# System-wide rate limit
32020defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
32021 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
32022
32023# Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
32024# set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
32025defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
32026 messages per $sender_rate_period
32027 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
32028 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
32029 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
32030.endd
32031&*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
32032especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
32033bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
32034making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
32035RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
32036this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
32037hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
32038
32039
32040
32041.section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
32042.cindex "verifying address" "options for"
32043.cindex "policy control" "address verification"
32044Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
32045&<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
32046&<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
32047The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
32048verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
32049other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
32050.code
32051verify = sender/callout
32052verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
32053.endd
32054The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
32055address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
32056difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
32057be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
32058(see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
32059The available options are as follows:
32060
32061.ilist
32062If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
32063remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
32064check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
32065.next
32066If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
32067normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
32068options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
32069verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
32070.next
32071The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
32072discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
32073.next
32074The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
32075immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
32076generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
32077discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
32078.endlist
32079
32080.cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
32081.vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
32082.vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
32083.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
32084After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
32085error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
32086coding like this:
32087.code
32088warn !verify = sender
32089 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
32090.endd
32091If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
32092denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
32093verification failure.
32094
32095In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
32096appropriate) contains one of the following words:
32097
32098.ilist
32099&%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
32100was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
32101.next
32102&%route%&: Routing failed.
32103.next
32104&%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
32105occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
32106connection, HELO, or MAIL).
32107.next
32108&%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
32109.next
32110&%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
32111.endlist
32112
32113The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
32114rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
32115
32116The above variables may also be set after a &*successful*&
32117address verification to:
32118
32119.ilist
32120&%random%&: A random local-part callout succeeded
32121.endlist
32122
32123
32124
32125
32126.section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
32127.cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
32128.cindex "callout" "verification"
32129.cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
32130For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
32131checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
32132the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
32133&'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
32134a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
32135address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
32136sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
32137deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
32138sender's domain.
32139
32140Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
32141request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
32142described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
32143lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
32144cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
32145caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
32146
32147Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
32148the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
32149callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
32150callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
32151on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
32152
32153If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
32154second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
32155one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
32156&(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
32157router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
32158&%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
32159&%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
32160supplies a host list.
32161Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
32162
32163The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
32164remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
32165specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
32166specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
32167specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
32168the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
32169&$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
32170
32171For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
32172test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
32173following SMTP commands are sent:
32174.display
32175&`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
32176&`MAIL FROM:<>`&
32177&`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
32178&`QUIT`&
32179.endd
32180LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
32181set to &"lmtp"&.
32182
32183The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
32184settings.
32185
32186A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
32187for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
32188the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
32189that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
32190do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
32191&%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
32192
32193If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
32194succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
32195Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
32196hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
32197&%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
32198
32199.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
32200A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
32201output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
32202clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
32203disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
32204
32205
32206
32207
32208.section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
32209.cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
32210The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
32211optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
32212.code
32213verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
32214.endd
32215The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
32216separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
32217deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
32218
32219
32220.vlist
32221.vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
32222.cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
32223This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
32224For example:
32225.code
32226verify = sender/callout=5s
32227.endd
32228The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
32229remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
32230the &%connect%& parameter.
32231
32232
32233.vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
32234.cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
32235This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
32236for making the SMTP connection. For example:
32237.code
32238verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
32239.endd
32240If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
32241
32242.vitem &*defer_ok*&
32243.cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
32244When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
32245of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
32246updated in this circumstance.
32247
32248.vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
32249.cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
32250This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
32251&'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
32252accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
32253unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
32254
32255
32256.vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
32257.cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
32258When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
32259verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
32260sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
32261whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
32262MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
32263as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
32264(empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
32265address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
32266.code
32267require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
32268.endd
32269This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
32270
32271
32272.vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
32273.cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
32274This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
32275For example:
32276.code
32277verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
32278.endd
32279This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
32280commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
32281be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
32282very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
32283(for example, when network connections are timing out).
32284
32285
32286.vitem &*no_cache*&
32287.cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
32288.cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
32289When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
32290
32291.vitem &*postmaster*&
32292.cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
32293When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
32294check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
32295rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
32296the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
32297used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
32298made, until the cache record expires.
32299
32300.vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
32301The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
32302You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
32303For example:
32304.code
32305require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
32306.endd
32307If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
32308one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
32309.code
32310require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
32311.endd
32312&*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
32313account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
32314a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
32315postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
32316
32317
32318.vitem &*random*&
32319.cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
32320When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
32321check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
32322really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
32323&%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
32324.code
32325$primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
32326.endd
32327The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
32328parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
32329specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
32330a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
32331succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
32332
32333.vitem &*use_postmaster*&
32334.cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
32335This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32336.code
32337deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
32338.endd
32339.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
32340It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
32341performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
32342that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
32343domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
32344
32345.vitem &*use_sender*&
32346This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32347.code
32348require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
32349.endd
32350It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
32351command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
32352need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
32353sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
32354usefulness of callout caching.
32355
32356.vitem &*hold*&
32357This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32358.code
32359require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender,hold
32360.endd
32361It causes the connection to be held open and used for any further recipients
32362and for eventual delivery (should that be done quickly).
32363Doing this saves on TCP and SMTP startup costs, and TLS costs also
32364when that is used for the connections.
32365The advantage is only gained if there are no callout cache hits
32366(which could be enforced by the no_cache option),
32367if the use_sender option is used,
32368if neither the random nor the use_postmaster option is used,
32369and if no other callouts intervene.
32370.endlist
32371
32372If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
32373command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
32374&%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
32375usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
32376that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
32377Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
32378these circumstances.
32379
32380However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
32381host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
32382callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
32383sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
32384callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
32385own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
32386is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
32387
32388Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
32389caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
32390by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
32391actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
32392
32393
32394
32395
32396.section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
32397.cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
32398.cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
32399.cindex "caching" "callout"
32400Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
32401used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
32402option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
32403different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
32404a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
32405entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
32406
32407When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
32408the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
32409is not available.
32410
32411The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
32412independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
32413(default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
32414
32415If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
32416commands up to and including
32417.code
32418MAIL FROM:<>
32419.endd
32420(but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
32421any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
32422domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
32423making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
32424separate expiry times for domain cache records:
32425&%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
32426&%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
32427
32428Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
32429cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
32430Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
32431ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
32432will eventually be noticed.
32433
32434The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
32435being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
32436behaviour will be the same.
32437
32438
32439
32440.section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
32441.cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
32442See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
32443verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
32444failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
32445relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
32446you might see:
32447.code
32448MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
32449250 OK
32450RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
32451550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
32452550-Called: 192.168.34.43
32453550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
32454550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
32455550 Sender verification failed
32456.endd
32457If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
32458only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
32459out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
32460&`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
32461example:
32462.code
32463verify = sender/no_details
32464.endd
32465
32466.section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
32467.cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
32468.cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
32469A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
32470during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
32471or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
32472it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
32473
32474.ilist
32475When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
32476continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
32477verification also fails.
32478.next
32479When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
32480verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
32481.endlist
32482
32483This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
32484way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
32485example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
32486.code
32487A.Wol: aw123
32488aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
32489.endd
32490work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
32491redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
32492mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
32493verification to succeed.
32494
32495It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
32496redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
32497generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
32498option. For example:
32499.code
32500require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
32501.endd
32502In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
32503the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
32504
32505When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
32506redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
32507also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
32508address and a report is output for each of them.
32509
32510
32511
32512.section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
32513.cindex "CSA" "verifying"
32514Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
32515which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
32516special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
32517domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
32518Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
32519.code
32520verify = csa
32521.endd
32522This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
32523valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
32524succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
32525&$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
32526&"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
32527be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
32528
32529The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
32530detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
32531looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
32532address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
32533
32534.ilist
32535The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
32536.next
32537The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
32538.next
32539The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
32540(for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
32541.next
32542The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
32543that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
32544.endlist
32545
32546The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
32547use for the DNS query. The default is:
32548.code
32549verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
32550.endd
32551This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
32552is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
32553address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
32554the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
32555meaningful to say:
32556.code
32557verify = csa/$sender_host_address
32558.endd
32559In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
32560This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
32561&%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
32562
32563If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
32564is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
32565making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
32566using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
32567default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
32568default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
32569(&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
32570of legitimate HELO domains.
32571
32572The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
32573direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
32574search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
32575addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
32576lookup such as:
32577.code
32578${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
32579.endd
32580has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
32581The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
32582authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
32583
32584
32585
32586
32587.section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
32588.cindex "BATV, verifying"
32589Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
32590of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
32591Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
32592recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
32593bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
32594spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
32595
32596There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
32597&"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
32598the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
32599address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
32600item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
32601The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
32602&<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
32603The validity period on signed addresses is seven days.
32604
32605As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
32606database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
32607like this:
32608.code
32609PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
32610 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
32611 }{$value}}
32612.endd
32613Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
32614list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
32615use this:
32616.code
32617# Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
32618deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
32619 senders = :
32620 recipients = +batv_senders
32621
32622# Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
32623deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
32624 senders = :
32625 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
32626 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
32627 !condition = $prvscheck_result
32628.endd
32629The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
32630to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
32631send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
32632recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
32633the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
32634
32635A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
32636&%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
32637prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
32638the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
32639the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
32640timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
32641of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
32642
32643There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
32644you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
32645deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
32646router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
32647.code
32648batv_redirect:
32649 driver = redirect
32650 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
32651.endd
32652This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
32653of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
32654address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
32655local addresses.
32656
32657To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
32658can be used:
32659.code
32660external_smtp_batv:
32661 driver = smtp
32662 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
32663 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
32664 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
32665 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
32666 {$value}fail}}}
32667.endd
32668If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
32669
32670
32671
32672.section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
32673.cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
32674.cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
32675.cindex "policy control" "relay control"
32676An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
32677delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
32678within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
32679passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
32680.cindex "&""percent hack""&"
32681but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
32682
32683Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
32684A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
32685relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
32686a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
32687with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
32688same host is fulfilling both functions,
32689. ///
32690. as illustrated in the diagram below,
32691. ///
32692but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
32693not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
32694system to arbitrary domains.
32695
32696
32697You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
32698runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
32699Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
32700example, suppose you want to do the following:
32701
32702.ilist
32703Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
32704locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
32705&'my.dom2.example'&.
32706.next
32707Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
32708These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
32709.next
32710Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
32711Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
32712.endlist
32713
32714
32715In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
32716.code
32717domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
32718domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
32719hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
32720.endd
32721Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
32722command:
32723.code
32724acl_check_rcpt:
32725 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
32726 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
32727.endd
32728The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
32729the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
32730statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
32731hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
32732than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
32733default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
32734in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
32735
32736
32737
32738.section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
32739.cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
32740You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
32741that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
32742the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
32743.ecindex IIDacl
32744
32745
32746
32747. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32748. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32749
32750.chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
32751.scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
32752The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
32753as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
32754was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
32755maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
32756specification.
32757
32758It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
32759&[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
32760scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
32761messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
32762chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
32763
32764If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
32765Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
32766&_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
32767
32768.ilist
32769Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
32770for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
32771.next
32772Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
32773&%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
32774run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
32775.next
32776An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
32777of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
32778.next
32779Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
32780conditions.
32781.next
32782Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
32783.endlist
32784
32785Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
32786added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
32787changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
32788EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
32789this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
32790&_doc/experimental.txt_&.
32791
32792All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
32793temporarily created in a file called:
32794.display
32795<&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
32796.endd
32797The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
32798expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
32799first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
32800scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
32801removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
32802.code
32803control = no_mbox_unspool
32804.endd
32805has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
32806same directory by default.
32807
32808
32809
32810.section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
32811.cindex "virus scanning"
32812.cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
32813.cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
32814The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
32815It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
32816specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
32817in memory and thus are much faster.
32818
32819Since message data needs to have arrived,
32820the condition may be only called in ACL defined by
32821&%acl_smtp_data%&,
32822&%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
32823&%acl_smtp_mime%& or
32824&%acl_smtp_dkim%&
32825
32826A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
32827if it expires then a defer action is taken.
32828
32829.oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
32830You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
32831to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
32832are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
32833.display
32834&`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
32835.endd
32836If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
32837.code
32838av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
32839.endd
32840If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
32841before use.
32842The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
32843The following scanner types are supported in this release,
32844though individual ones can be included or not at build time:
32845
32846.vlist
32847.vitem &%avast%&
32848.cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
32849This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
32850Security (currently at version 2.2.0).
32851You can get a trial version at &url(https://www.avast.com) or for Linux
32852at &url(https://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
32853This scanner type takes one option,
32854which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
32855or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
32856The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
32857single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
32858A list of options may follow. These options are interpreted on the
32859Exim's side of the malware scanner, or are given on separate lines to
32860the daemon as options before the main scan command.
32861
32862.cindex &`pass_unscanned`& "avast"
32863If &`pass_unscanned`&
32864is set, any files the Avast scanner can't scan (e.g.
32865decompression bombs, or invalid archives) are considered clean. Use with
32866care.
32867
32868For example:
32869.code
32870av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
32871av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:pass_unscanned:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
32872av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
32873.endd
32874If you omit the argument, the default path
32875&_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
32876is used.
32877If you use a remote host,
32878you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
32879as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
32880For information about available commands and their options you may use
32881.code
32882$ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
32883 FLAGS
32884 SENSITIVITY
32885 PACK
32886.endd
32887
32888If the scanner returns a temporary failure (e.g. license issues, or
32889permission problems), the message is deferred and a paniclog entry is
32890written. The usual &`defer_ok`& option is available.
32891
32892.vitem &%aveserver%&
32893.cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
32894This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
32895at &url(https://www.kaspersky.com/). This scanner type takes one option,
32896which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
32897example:
32898.code
32899av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
32900.endd
32901
32902
32903.vitem &%clamd%&
32904.cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
32905This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
32906&url(https://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
32907unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
32908in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
32909
32910The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
32911a UNIX socket specification,
32912a TCP socket specification,
32913or a (global) option.
32914
32915A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
32916For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
32917for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
32918and the second a port number,
32919Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
32920These per-server options are supported:
32921.code
32922retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
32923.endd
32924
32925The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
32926a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
32927
32928If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
32929
32930Examples:
32931.code
32932av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
32933av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
32934av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
32935av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
32936av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
32937.endd
32938If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
32939&`local`&
32940option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
32941to be scanned, which should normally result in less I/O happening and be
32942more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
32943Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
32944
32945The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
32946randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
32947that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
32948socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
32949unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
32950When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
32951not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
32952selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
32953email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
32954.code
329552013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
32956 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
32957 (Connection refused)
32958.endd
32959
32960If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
32961contributing the code for this scanner.
32962
32963.vitem &%cmdline%&
32964.cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
32965This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
32966used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
32967type takes 3 mandatory options:
32968
32969.olist
32970The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
32971and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
32972
32973.next
32974A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
32975virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
32976absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
32977the &"trigger"& expression.
32978
32979.next
32980Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
32981match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
32982&"name"& expression.
32983.endlist olist
32984
32985For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
32986.code
32987Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
32988.endd
32989For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
32990name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
32991for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
32992configuration setting:
32993.code
32994av_scanner = cmdline:\
32995 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
32996 found in file:'(.+)'
32997.endd
32998.vitem &%drweb%&
32999.cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
33000The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(https://www.sald.ru/)) interface
33001takes one option,
33002either a full path to a UNIX socket,
33003or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
33004The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
33005single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
33006For example:
33007.code
33008av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
33009av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
33010.endd
33011If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
33012is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
33013
33014.vitem &%f-protd%&
33015.cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
33016The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
33017One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
33018(or port-range).
33019For example:
33020.code
33021av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
33022.endd
33023If you omit the argument, the default values shown above are used.
33024
33025.vitem &%f-prot6d%&
33026.cindex "virus scanners" "f-prot6d"
33027The f-prot6d scanner is accessed using the FPSCAND protocol over TCP.
33028One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number.
33029For example:
33030.code
33031av_scanner = f-prot6d:localhost 10200
33032.endd
33033If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
33034
33035.vitem &%fsecure%&
33036.cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
33037The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(https://www.f-secure.com/)) takes one
33038argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
33039.code
33040av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
33041.endd
33042If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
33043Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
33044
33045.vitem &%kavdaemon%&
33046.cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
33047This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
33048Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
33049scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
33050For example:
33051.code
33052av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
33053.endd
33054The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
33055
33056.vitem &%mksd%&
33057.cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
33058This was a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users,
33059though some documentation was available in English.
33060The history can be shown at &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Mks_vir)
33061and this appears to be a candidate for removal from Exim, unless
33062we are informed of other virus scanners which use the same protocol
33063to integrate.
33064The only option for this scanner type is
33065the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
33066provided that mksd has
33067been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
33068.code
33069av_scanner = mksd:2
33070.endd
33071You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
33072
33073.vitem &%sock%&
33074.cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
33075This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
33076running on the local machine.
33077There are four options:
33078an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
33079a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
33080the path to the mail file to be scanned),
33081an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
33082and an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
33083For example:
33084.code
33085av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)$
33086.endd
33087Note that surrounding whitespace is stripped from each option, meaning
33088there is no way to specify a trailing newline.
33089The socket specifier and both regular-expressions are required.
33090Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_& (note this does have a trailing newline);
33091specify an empty element to get this.
33092
33093.vitem &%sophie%&
33094.cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
33095Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
33096You can get Sophie at &url(http://sophie.sourceforge.net/). The only option
33097for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
33098client communication. For example:
33099.code
33100av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
33101.endd
33102The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
33103the option.
33104.endlist
33105
33106When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
33107the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
33108ACL.
33109
33110The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
33111makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
33112The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
33113for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
33114However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
33115which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
33116message.
33117
33118The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
33119use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
33120The first element can then be one of
33121
33122.ilist
33123&"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
33124The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
33125recommended usage.
33126.next
33127&"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
33128the condition fails immediately.
33129.next
33130A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
33131condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
33132expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
33133Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
33134unless the separator is changed (in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
33135.endlist
33136
33137You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
33138messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
33139Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
33140
33141You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
33142specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
33143For example:
33144.code
33145malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
33146.endd
33147A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
33148
33149.vindex "&$callout_address$&"
33150When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
33151is set to record the actual address used.
33152
33153.vindex "&$malware_name$&"
33154When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
33155&$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
33156&%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
33157logging data.
33158
33159Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
33160imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
33161
33162Here is a very simple scanning example:
33163.code
33164deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33165 malware = *
33166.endd
33167The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
33168.code
33169deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33170 malware = */defer_ok
33171.endd
33172The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
33173aveserver. It assumes you have set:
33174.code
33175av_scanner = $acl_m0
33176.endd
33177in the main Exim configuration.
33178.code
33179deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33180 set acl_m0 = sophie
33181 malware = *
33182
33183deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
33184 set acl_m0 = aveserver
33185 malware = *
33186.endd
33187
33188
33189.section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
33190.cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
33191.cindex "spam scanning"
33192.cindex "SpamAssassin"
33193.cindex "Rspamd"
33194The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
33195score and a report for the message.
33196Support is also provided for Rspamd.
33197
33198For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
33199Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
33200&url(https://spamassassin.apache.org/) and &url(https://www.rspamd.com/)
33201
33202SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
33203.code
33204perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
33205.endd
33206SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
33207documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
33208nicely, however.
33209
33210.oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
33211By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
33212intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
33213&%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
33214you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
33215configuration as follows (example):
33216.code
33217spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 783
33218.endd
33219The SpamAssassin protocol relies on a TCP half-close from the client.
33220If your SpamAssassin client side is running a Linux system with an
33221iptables firewall, consider setting
33222&%net.netfilter.nf_conntrack_tcp_timeout_close_wait%& to at least the
33223timeout, Exim uses when waiting for a response from the SpamAssassin
33224server (currently defaulting to 120s). With a lower value the Linux
33225connection tracking may consider your half-closed connection as dead too
33226soon.
33227
33228
33229To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
33230on TCP port 11333)
33231you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
33232.code
33233spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
33234.endd
33235
33236As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
33237sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
33238filename instead of an address/port pair:
33239.code
33240spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
33241.endd
33242You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
33243reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
33244&%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
33245option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&):
33246.code
33247spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
33248 192.168.2.11 783 : \
33249 192.168.2.12 783
33250.endd
33251Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
33252When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
33253servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
33254condition defers.
33255
33256Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
33257Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
33258and changeable in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&);
33259take care to not double the separator.
33260
33261For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
33262subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
33263and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
33264In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
33265
33266Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
33267are options.
33268The supported options are:
33269.code
33270pri=<priority> Selection priority
33271weight=<value> Selection bias
33272time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
33273retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
33274tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
33275variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
33276.endd
33277
33278The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
33279higher values being tried first.
33280The default priority is 1.
33281
33282The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
33283Within a priority set
33284servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
33285The default value for selection bias is 1.
33286
33287Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
33288in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
33289Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
33290characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
33291
33292Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
33293are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
33294
33295The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
33296The default value is two minutes.
33297
33298The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
33299a failed connect is made.
33300The default is to not retry.
33301
33302The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
33303a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
33304used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
33305expansion.
33306
33307.vindex "&$callout_address$&"
33308When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
33309is set to record the actual address used.
33310
33311.section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
33312Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
33313.code
33314deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33315 spam = joe
33316.endd
33317The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
33318relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
33319to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
33320default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
33321Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
33322right-hand side.
33323
33324The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
33325principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
33326have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
33327&%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
33328read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
33329are not set.
33330Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
33331(e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
33332after the first),
33333or the use of PRDR,
33334.cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
33335are needed to use this feature.
33336
33337The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
33338you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
33339&"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
33340
33341
33342Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
33343large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
33344are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
33345example:
33346.code
33347deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33348 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
33349 spam = nobody
33350.endd
33351
33352The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
33353SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
33354&%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
33355it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
33356
33357.cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
33358When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
33359variables.
33360Except for &$spam_report$&,
33361these variables are saved with the received message so are
33362available for use at delivery time.
33363
33364.vlist
33365.vitem &$spam_score$&
33366The spam score of the message, for example, &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
33367for inclusion in log or reject messages.
33368
33369.vitem &$spam_score_int$&
33370The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
33371example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
33372because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
33373The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
33374
33375.vitem &$spam_bar$&
33376A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
33377integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
33378&$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
33379headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
33380spam bar is 50 characters.
33381
33382.vitem &$spam_report$&
33383A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
33384message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
33385This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
33386Beware that SpamAssassin may return non-ASCII characters, especially
33387when running in country-specific locales, which are not legal
33388unencoded in headers.
33389
33390.vitem &$spam_action$&
33391For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
33392spam score versus threshold.
33393For Rspamd, the recommended action.
33394
33395.endlist
33396
33397The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
33398spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
33399does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
33400
33401The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
33402the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
33403failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
33404statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
33405spam condition, like this:
33406.code
33407deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33408 spam = joe/defer_ok
33409.endd
33410This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
33411
33412Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
33413condition:
33414.code
33415# put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
33416warn spam = nobody:true
33417 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
33418 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
33419
33420# add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
33421# is over threshold
33422warn spam = nobody
33423 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
33424
33425# reject spam at high scores (> 12)
33426deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
33427 spam = nobody:true
33428 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
33429.endd
33430
33431
33432
33433.section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
33434.cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
33435.cindex "MIME content scanning"
33436.oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
33437.oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
33438The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
33439each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
33440of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
33441specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
33442options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
33443cases.
33444
33445These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
33446ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
33447the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
33448message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
33449ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
33450result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
33451&%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
33452
33453You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
33454only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
33455condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
33456&%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
33457&<<SECTscanregex>>&).
33458
33459At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
33460information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
33461of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
33462parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
33463part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
33464syntax is:
33465.display
33466&`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
33467.endd
33468The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
33469the value can be:
33470
33471.olist
33472&"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
33473.next
33474The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
33475&"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
33476a sequential filename consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
33477full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
33478.next
33479A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
33480directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
33481is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
33482the full path and filename.
33483.next
33484If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
33485filename, and the default path is then used.
33486.endlist
33487The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
33488errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
33489a file with its original, proposed filename using
33490.code
33491decode = $mime_filename
33492.endd
33493However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
33494anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
33495automatically unlinked.
33496
33497For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
33498content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
33499as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
33500variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
33501before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
33502
33503The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
33504used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
33505respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
33506
33507.cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
33508The following list describes all expansion variables that are
33509available in the MIME ACL:
33510
33511.vlist
33512.vitem &$mime_boundary$&
33513If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
33514have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
33515has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
33516contains the empty string.
33517
33518.vitem &$mime_charset$&
33519This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
33520&'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
33521.code
33522us-ascii
33523gb2312 (Chinese)
33524iso-8859-1
33525.endd
33526Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
33527case-insensitively.
33528
33529.vitem &$mime_content_description$&
33530This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
33531header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
33532implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
33533only used for display purposes.
33534
33535.vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
33536This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
33537header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
33538
33539.vitem &$mime_content_id$&
33540This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
33541This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
33542
33543.vitem &$mime_content_size$&
33544This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
33545successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
33546size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
33547has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
33548
33549.vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
33550This variable contains the normalized content of the
33551&'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
33552type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
33553
33554.vitem &$mime_content_type$&
33555If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
33556value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
33557are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
33558.code
33559text/plain
33560text/html
33561application/octet-stream
33562image/jpeg
33563audio/midi
33564.endd
33565If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
33566empty string.
33567
33568.vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
33569This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
33570successfully run. It contains the full path and filename of the file
33571containing the decoded data.
33572.endlist
33573
33574.cindex "RFC 2047"
33575.vlist
33576.vitem &$mime_filename$&
33577This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
33578proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
33579&'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
33580RFC2047
33581or RFC2231
33582decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
33583 If no filename was
33584found, this variable contains the empty string.
33585
33586.vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
33587This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
33588attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
33589content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
33590
33591The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
33592cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
33593follows:
33594
33595.olist
33596The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
33597
33598.next
33599If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
33600so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
33601
33602.next
33603If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
33604and the rest are attachments.
33605
33606.next
33607All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
33608.endlist olist
33609
33610As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
33611alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
33612coverletter mail attached to non-HTML coverletter mail will also be allowed:
33613.code
33614deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
33615!condition = $mime_is_rfc822
33616condition = $mime_is_coverletter
33617condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
33618.endd
33619.vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
33620This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
33621&"multipart"&, for example, &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
33622Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
33623want to carry out specific actions on them.
33624
33625.vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
33626This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
33627checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
33628decoding is fully recursive.
33629
33630.vitem &$mime_part_count$&
33631This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
33632starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
33633counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
33634&$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
33635complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
33636parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
33637.endlist
33638
33639
33640
33641.section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
33642.cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
33643.cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
33644You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
33645the message, or on individual MIME parts.
33646
33647The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
33648matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
33649MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
33650linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
33651have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
33652
33653The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
33654to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
33655part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
33656is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
33657and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
3365832K characters are checked.
33659
33660The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
33661literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
33662expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
33663with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
33664Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
33665.code
33666deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
33667 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
33668.endd
33669The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
33670&$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
33671matching regular expression.
33672The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
33673are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
33674
33675&*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
33676CPU-intensive.
33677
33678.ecindex IIDcosca
33679
33680
33681
33682
33683. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33684. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33685
33686.chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
33687 "Local scan function"
33688.scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
33689.cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
33690.cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
33691In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
33692want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
33693
33694The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
33695passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
33696a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
33697condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
33698non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
33699
33700To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
33701possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
33702in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
33703can of course use a little C stub to call it.
33704
33705The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
33706when Exim is just about to accept the message.
33707It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
33708well as messages arriving via SMTP.
33709
33710Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
33711option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
33712Zero means &"no timeout"&.
33713Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
33714before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
33715are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
33716incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
33717For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
33718code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
33719
33720
33721
33722.section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
33723.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
33724To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
33725function is before building Exim, by setting
33726both HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN and
33727LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
33728&_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
33729directory, so you might set
33730.code
33731HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN=yes
33732LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
33733.endd
33734for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&;
33735.new
33736the source file(s) for it should first #define LOCAL_SCAN
33737and then #include "local_scan.h".
33738.wen
33739It is called by
33740Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
33741be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
33742function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
33743commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
33744_src/local_scan.c_.
33745
33746If you want to make use of Exim's runtime configuration file to set options
33747for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
33748.code
33749LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
33750.endd
33751in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
33752
33753
33754
33755
33756.section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
33757.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
33758.cindex &%dlfunc%& "API description"
33759You must include this line near the start of your code:
33760.code
33761#include "local_scan.h"
33762.endd
33763This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
33764prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
33765almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
33766for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
33767It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
33768strings and pointers to character strings:
33769.code
33770#define CS (char *)
33771#define CCS (const char *)
33772#define CSS (char **)
33773#define US (unsigned char *)
33774#define CUS (const unsigned char *)
33775#define USS (unsigned char **)
33776.endd
33777The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
33778.code
33779extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
33780.endd
33781The arguments are as follows:
33782
33783.ilist
33784&%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
33785(the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
33786recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
33787
33788The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
33789character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
33790id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
33791macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
33792case this changes in some future version.
33793.next
33794&%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
33795string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
33796.endlist
33797
33798The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
33799
33800.vlist
33801.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
33802.vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
33803The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
33804the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
33805newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
33806maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
33807
33808.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
33809This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
33810queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
33811
33812.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
33813This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
33814queued without immediate delivery.
33815
33816.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
33817The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
33818passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
33819they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
33820&`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
33821used.
33822
33823.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
33824The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
33825message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
33826problem"& is used.
33827
33828.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
33829This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
33830message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
33831&%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
33832&%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
33833&%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
33834same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
33835
33836.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
33837This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
33838LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
33839.endlist
33840
33841If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
33842reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
33843&%-oe%& command line options.
33844
33845
33846
33847.section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
33848.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
33849It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
33850that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
33851want to do this, you must have the line
33852.code
33853LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
33854.endd
33855in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
33856&_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
33857file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
33858to define them.
33859
33860The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
33861&`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
33862and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
33863alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
33864variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
33865entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
33866.code
33867static int my_integer_option = 42;
33868static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
33869
33870optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
33871 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
33872 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
33873};
33874
33875int local_scan_options_count =
33876 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
33877.endd
33878The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
33879configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
33880.code
33881begin local_scan
33882my_integer = 99
33883my_string = some string of text...
33884.endd
33885The available types of option data are as follows:
33886
33887.vlist
33888.vitem &*opt_bool*&
33889This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
33890variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
33891that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
33892whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
33893TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
33894values.)
33895
33896.vitem &*opt_fixed*&
33897This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
33898The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
33899multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
33900
33901.vitem &*opt_int*&
33902This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
33903&`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
33904Exim.
33905
33906.vitem &*opt_mkint*&
33907This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
33908&%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
33909printed with the suffix K or M.
33910
33911.vitem &*opt_octint*&
33912This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
33913octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
33914always output in octal.
33915
33916.vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
33917This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
33918variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
33919
33920.vitem &*opt_time*&
33921This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
33922type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
33923.endlist
33924
33925If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
33926out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
33927
33928
33929
33930.section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
33931.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
33932The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
33933are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
33934Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
33935including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
33936C variables are as follows:
33937
33938.vlist
33939.vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
33940This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
33941It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
33942
33943.vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
33944This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
33945It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
33946
33947.vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
33948This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
33949is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
33950&[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
33951
33952.ilist
33953The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
33954testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
33955other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
33956
33957.next
33958The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
33959by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
33960of debugging bits.
33961.endlist ilist
33962
33963Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
33964selected, you should use code like this:
33965.code
33966if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
33967 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
33968.endd
33969.vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
33970After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
33971variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
33972
33973.vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
33974A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
33975discussed below.
33976
33977.vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
33978A pointer to the last of the header lines.
33979
33980.vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
33981The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
33982
33983.vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
33984This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
33985&%-bh%& command line option.
33986
33987.vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
33988The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
33989is NULL for locally submitted messages.
33990
33991.vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
33992The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
33993command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
33994specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
33995
33996.vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
33997This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
33998&$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
33999
34000.vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
34001The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
34002
34003.vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
34004The number of accepted recipients.
34005
34006.vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
34007.cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
34008.cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
34009The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
34010&%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
34011can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
34012below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
34013adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
34014&%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
34015value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
34016blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
34017and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
34018
34019.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
34020The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
34021
34022.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
34023The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
34024locally-submitted messages.
34025
34026.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
34027The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
34028was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
34029
34030.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
34031The name of the sending host, if known.
34032
34033.vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
34034The port on the sending host.
34035
34036.vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
34037This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
34038
34039.vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
34040This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
34041
34042.vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
34043The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
34044requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
34045.endlist
34046
34047
34048.section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
34049The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
34050You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
34051(see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
34052their type to *.
34053
34054
34055.vlist
34056.vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
34057A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
34058
34059.vitem &*int&~type*&
34060A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
34061characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
34062Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
34063with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
34064rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
34065lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
34066
34067.vitem &*int&~slen*&
34068The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
34069internal newlines.
34070
34071.vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
34072A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
34073a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
34074.endlist
34075
34076
34077
34078.section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
34079The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
34080
34081.vlist
34082.vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
34083This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
34084
34085.vitem &*int&~pno*&
34086This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
34087the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
34088and must always contain -1 at this stage.
34089
34090.vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
34091If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
34092recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
34093envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
34094router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
34095an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
34096&%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
34097is NULL for all recipients.
34098.endlist
34099
34100
34101
34102.section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
34103.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
34104The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
34105These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
34106release:
34107
34108.vlist
34109.vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
34110 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
34111
34112This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
34113&%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
34114be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
34115for the process in &%newumask%&.
34116
34117Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
34118and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
34119standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
34120descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
34121argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
34122
34123The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
34124
34125.vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
34126This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
34127seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
34128return value is as follows:
34129
34130.ilist
34131>= 0
34132
34133The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
34134ending status.
34135
34136.next
34137< 0 and > &--256
34138
34139The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
34140signal number.
34141
34142.next
34143&--256
34144
34145The process timed out.
34146.next
34147&--257
34148
34149The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
34150.endlist
34151
34152.vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
34153This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
34154Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
34155want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
34156forks a subprocess that is running
34157.code
34158exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
34159.endd
34160and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
34161that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
34162of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
34163recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
34164
34165When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
34166finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
34167fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
34168addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
34169
34170
34171.vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
34172 *sender_authentication)*&
34173This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
34174that it runs is:
34175.display
34176&`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
34177.endd
34178The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
34179
34180
34181.vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
34182This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
34183output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
34184calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
34185conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
34186.code
34187if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
34188 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
34189.endd
34190
34191.vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
34192This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
34193expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
34194The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
34195expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
34196the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
34197block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
34198&<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
34199
34200.vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
34201This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
34202existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
34203character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
34204substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
34205if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
34206
34207.vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
34208 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
34209This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
34210chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
34211
34212If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
34213&%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
34214NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
34215matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
34216&%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
34217found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
34218marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
34219option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
34220top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
34221headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
34222.code
34223header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
34224 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
34225.endd
34226Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
34227there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
34228
34229
34230.vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
34231This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
34232occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
34233particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
34234match the specification, the function does nothing.
34235
34236
34237.vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
34238 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
34239This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
34240a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
34241colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
34242&"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
34243.code
34244if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
34245.endd
34246.vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
34247.cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
34248This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
34249The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
34250back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
34251zero-terminated.
34252
34253.vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
34254This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
34255zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
34256to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
34257string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
34258yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
34259easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
34260added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
34261
34262.vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
34263This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
34264matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
34265.display
34266&`OK `& match succeeded
34267&`FAIL `& match failed
34268&`DEFER `& match deferred
34269.endd
34270DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
34271inability to contact a database.
34272
34273.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
34274 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
34275This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
34276controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
34277&'lss_match_domain()'&.
34278
34279.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
34280 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
34281This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
34282controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
34283matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
34284
34285.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
34286 uschar&~*list)*&"
34287This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
34288expected to be
34289.code
34290lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
34291.endd
34292.vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
34293An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
34294is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
34295looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
34296values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
34297returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
34298failed.
34299
34300.vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
34301 *format,&~...)*&"
34302This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
34303is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
34304&`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
34305them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
34306arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
34307contain any newlines, not even at the end.
34308
34309
34310.vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
34311This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
34312is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
34313with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
34314
34315This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
34316described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
34317the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
34318value afterwards. For example:
34319.code
34320 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
34321 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
34322 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
34323.endd
34324
34325.vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
34326This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
34327recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
34328matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
34329address.
34330.endlist
34331
34332
34333.cindex "RFC 2047"
34334.vlist
34335.vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
34336 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
34337This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
34338these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
34339from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
34340a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
34341made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
34342binary string is returned with an error message.
34343
34344The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
34345maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
34346encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
34347
34348.cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
34349.cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
34350If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
34351contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
34352not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
34353
34354The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
34355&%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
34356which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
34357
34358If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
34359argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
34360set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
34361returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
34362with translation.
34363
34364
34365.vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
34366This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
34367below.
34368
34369.vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,BOOL,&~...)*&
34370The arguments of this function are almost like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
34371output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
34372stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
34373SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
34374is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
34375opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
34376test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
34377is involved.
34378
34379If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
34380output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
34381
34382The second argument is used to request that the data be buffered
34383(when TRUE) or flushed (along with any previously buffered, when FALSE).
34384This is advisory only, but likely to save on system-calls and packets
34385sent when a sequence of calls to the function are made.
34386
34387The argument was added in Exim version 4.90 - changing the API/ABI.
34388Nobody noticed until 4.93 was imminent, at which point the
34389ABI version number was incremented.
34390
34391Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
34392must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
34393LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
34394LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
34395initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
34396to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
34397that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
34398.code
34399smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
34400return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
34401.endd
34402Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
34403the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
34404&'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
34405multiple output lines.
34406
34407The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
34408does not
34409guarantee a flush of
34410pending output, and therefore does not test
34411the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
34412detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
34413you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
34414dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
34415arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
34416is an error.
34417
34418.new
34419.vitem &*void&~*store_get(int,BOOL)*&
34420This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
34421chunk of memory whose size is given by the first argument.
34422The second argument should be given as TRUE if the memory will be used for
34423data possibly coming from an attacker (eg. the message content),
34424FALSE if it is locally-sourced.
34425Exim bombs out if it ever
34426runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
34427.wen
34428
34429.vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int,BOOL)*&
34430This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
34431permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
34432
34433.vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
34434See below.
34435
34436.vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
34437See below.
34438
34439.vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
34440These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
34441The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
34442number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
34443and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
34444pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
34445more discussion.
34446.endlist
34447
34448
34449
34450.section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
34451.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
34452No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
34453The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
34454recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
34455to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
34456message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
34457terminates.
34458
34459Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
34460data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
34461connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
34462one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
34463
34464If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
34465in the same SMTP connection, you should set
34466.code
34467store_pool = POOL_PERM
34468.endd
34469before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
34470restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
34471the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
34472set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
34473
34474The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
34475&'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
34476There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
34477block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
34478&%store_pool%&.
34479.ecindex IIDlosca
34480
34481
34482
34483
34484. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34485. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34486
34487.chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
34488.scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
34489.scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
34490.scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
34491The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
34492that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
34493also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
34494they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
34495
34496The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
34497is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
34498It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
34499commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
34500The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
34501
34502The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
34503is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
34504the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
34505If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
34506of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
34507prevent it happening on retries.
34508
34509.vindex "&$domain$&"
34510.vindex "&$local_part$&"
34511&*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
34512specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
34513&$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
34514you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
34515independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
34516described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
34517
34518
34519.section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
34520.cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
34521.cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
34522The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
34523setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
34524other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
34525&%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
34526.code
34527system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
34528system_filter_user = exim
34529.endd
34530If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
34531&%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
34532specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
34533&%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
34534&%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
34535by the &%reply%& command.
34536
34537
34538.section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
34539You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
34540filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
34541are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
34542
34543If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
34544you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
34545
34546
34547
34548.section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
34549The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
34550files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
34551mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
34552available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
34553If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
34554they cause errors.
34555
34556.cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
34557There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
34558files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
34559is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
34560&%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
34561subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
34562manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
34563
34564&*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
34565specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
34566succeed, it will not be tried again.
34567If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
34568arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
34569
34570When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
34571&$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
34572users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
34573to which users' filter files can refer.
34574
34575
34576
34577.section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
34578.vindex "&$recipients$&"
34579The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
34580of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
34581filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
34582
34583
34584
34585.section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
34586.cindex "freezing messages"
34587.cindex "message" "freezing"
34588.cindex "message" "forced failure"
34589.cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
34590.cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
34591.cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
34592There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
34593always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
34594filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
34595for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
34596word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
34597.code
34598fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
34599.endd
34600The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
34601
34602The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
34603message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
34604and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
34605delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
34606that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
34607run.
34608
34609The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
34610not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
34611filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
34612is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
34613
34614.cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
34615.cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
34616The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
34617well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
34618up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
34619log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
34620two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
34621strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
34622message. For example:
34623.code
34624fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
34625 because it contains attachments that we are \
34626 not prepared to receive."
34627.endd
34628
34629.cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
34630Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
34631the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
34632the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
34633command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
34634Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
34635use, for example
34636.code
34637if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
34638then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
34639.endd
34640though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
34641alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
34642generated by the filter.
34643
34644The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
34645&%defer%&,
34646&%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
34647set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
34648as
34649.code
34650mail ...
34651freeze
34652.endd
34653to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
34654failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
34655take place.
34656
34657
34658
34659.section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
34660.cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
34661.cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
34662.cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
34663Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
34664.code
34665headers add <string>
34666headers remove <string>
34667.endd
34668The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
34669added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
34670filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
34671space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
34672forced to fail, the command has no effect.
34673
34674You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
34675continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
34676including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
34677example:
34678.code
34679headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
34680 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
34681 X-header-2: ...."
34682.endd
34683Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
34684be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
34685space after input continuations is ignored.
34686
34687The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
34688This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
34689those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
34690&'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
34691header with the same name, they are all removed.
34692
34693The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
34694of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
34695from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
34696modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
34697Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
34698used for all recipients of the message.
34699
34700During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
34701header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
34702that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
34703routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
34704routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
34705until the message is actually being written (see section
34706&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
34707
34708If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
34709added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
34710present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
34711present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
34712message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
34713conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
34714modified more than once.
34715
34716Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
34717use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
34718For example:
34719.code
34720headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
34721headers remove "Subject"
34722headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
34723headers remove "Old-Subject"
34724.endd
34725
34726
34727
34728.section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
34729.cindex "envelope from"
34730.cindex "envelope sender"
34731In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
34732.code
34733errors_to <some address>
34734.endd
34735in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
34736delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
34737user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
34738might use
34739.code
34740unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
34741.endd
34742to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
34743address if its delivery failed.
34744
34745
34746
34747.section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
34748.vindex "&$domain$&"
34749.vindex "&$local_part$&"
34750In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
34751delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
34752operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
34753such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
34754filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
34755which implements such a filter:
34756.code
34757central_filter:
34758 check_local_user
34759 driver = redirect
34760 domains = +local_domains
34761 file = /central/filters/$local_part
34762 no_verify
34763 allow_filter
34764 allow_freeze
34765.endd
34766The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
34767&%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
34768the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
34769use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
34770
34771Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
34772specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
34773its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
34774address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
34775normal way.
34776.ecindex IIDsysfil1
34777.ecindex IIDsysfil2
34778.ecindex IIDsysfil3
34779
34780
34781
34782
34783
34784
34785. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34786. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34787
34788.chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
34789.scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
34790Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
34791all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
34792these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
34793this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
34794removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
34795before it is placed on Exim's queue.
34796
34797Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
34798&"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
34799that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
34800its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
34801set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
34802
34803&*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
34804or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
34805loopback interface specially in any way.
34806
34807If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
34808that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
34809
34810
34811
34812
34813.section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
34814.cindex "message" "submission"
34815.cindex "submission mode"
34816Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
34817&%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
34818received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
34819state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
34820.code
34821control = submission
34822.endd
34823in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
34824&<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
34825a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
34826known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
34827example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
34828interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
34829.code
34830warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
34831 control = submission
34832.endd
34833.cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
34834There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
34835is used to separate options. For example:
34836.code
34837control = submission/sender_retain
34838.endd
34839Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
34840true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
34841of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
34842the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
34843authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
34844&'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
34845attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
34846
34847When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
34848domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
34849example:
34850.code
34851control = submission/domain=some.domain
34852.endd
34853The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
34854&<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
34855that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
34856&'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
34857.code
34858accept authenticated = *
34859 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
34860 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
34861 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
34862.endd
34863Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
34864option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
34865the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
34866.code
34867bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
34868.endd
34869then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
34870line would be:
34871.code
34872Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
34873.endd
34874.cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
34875By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
34876used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
34877specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
34878
34879&*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
34880ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
34881untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
34882specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
34883does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
34884spoof another's address.
34885
34886.section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
34887.cindex "line endings"
34888.cindex "carriage return"
34889.cindex "linefeed"
34890RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
34891linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
34892SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
34893conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
34894use CRLF or just CR.
34895
34896Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
34897using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
34898receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
34899Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
34900MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
34901has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
34902that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
34903other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
34904follows:
34905
34906.ilist
34907LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
34908.next
34909CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
34910is ignored.
34911.next
34912The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
34913nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
34914terminator.
34915.next
34916If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
34917the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
34918is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
34919people trying to play silly games.
34920.next
34921If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
34922bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
34923line.
34924.endlist
34925
34926
34927
34928
34929
34930.section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
34931.cindex "unqualified addresses"
34932.cindex "address" "qualification"
34933By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
34934host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
34935SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
34936messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
34937requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
34938
34939Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
34940sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
34941&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
34942cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
34943value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
34944
34945.oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
34946.oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
34947Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
34948that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
34949line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
34950are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
34951other words, such qualification is also controlled by
34952&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
34953
34954
34955
34956
34957.section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
34958.cindex "&""From""& line"
34959.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
34960.cindex "sender" "address"
34961.oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
34962.oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
34963.cindex "envelope from"
34964.cindex "envelope sender"
34965.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
34966Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
34967with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
34968&"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
34969.code
34970From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
34971From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
34972.endd
34973This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
34974Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
34975via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
34976such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
34977&%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
34978and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
34979regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
34980default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
34981that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
34982
34983.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
34984When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
34985a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
34986contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
34987then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
34988qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
34989the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
34990
34991If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
34992sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
34993that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
34994
34995Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
34996treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
34997as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
34998incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
34999
35000
35001
35002.section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
35003.cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
35004.cindex "header lines" "Resent-"
35005RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
35006&`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
35007recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
35008&'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
35009&'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
35010
35011.blockquote
35012&'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
35013processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
35014.endblockquote
35015
35016This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
35017address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
35018follows:
35019
35020.ilist
35021A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
35022is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
35023.next
35024If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
35025&%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
35026&'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
35027.next
35028For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
35029also removed.
35030.next
35031For a locally-submitted message,
35032if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
35033&'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
35034the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
35035included in log lines in this case.
35036.next
35037The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
35038&%Resent-%& header lines are present.
35039.endlist
35040
35041
35042
35043
35044.section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
35045Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
35046includes the header line:
35047.code
35048Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
35049.endd
35050
35051.section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
35052.cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
35053If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
35054message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
35055extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
35056existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
35057
35058
35059.section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
35060.cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
35061.cindex "header lines" "Date:"
35062If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
35063Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
35064&%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
35065
35066.section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
35067.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
35068.oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
35069&'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
35070set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
35071the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
35072in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
35073set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
35074messages.
35075
35076
35077.section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
35078.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
35079.cindex "header lines" "Envelope-to:"
35080.oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
35081&'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
35082Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
35083generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
35084messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
35085(the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
35086messages.
35087
35088
35089.section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
35090.cindex "&'From:'& header line"
35091.cindex "header lines" "From:"
35092.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
35093.cindex "message" "submission"
35094.cindex "submission mode"
35095If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
35096adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
35097
35098.ilist
35099The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
35100message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
35101.next
35102.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
35103The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
35104.olist
35105.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
35106If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
35107&$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
35108.next
35109If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
35110part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
35111.next
35112If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
35113&$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
35114.endlist
35115.endlist
35116
35117A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
35118
35119If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
35120line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
35121containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
35122are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
35123They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
35124&%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
35125&%qualify_domain%&.
35126
35127For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
35128&'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
35129user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
35130name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
35131
35132
35133.section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
35134.cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
35135.cindex "header lines" "Message-ID:"
35136.cindex "message" "submission"
35137.oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
35138If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
35139&'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
35140&%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
35141to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
35142creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
35143message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
35144followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
35145in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
35146&%message_id_header_domain%& options.
35147
35148
35149.section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
35150.cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
35151.cindex "header lines" "Received:"
35152A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
35153contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
35154Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
35155
35156The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
35157have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
35158line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
35159that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
35160
35161Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
35162changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
35163-H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
35164
35165
35166.section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
35167.cindex "&'References:'& header line"
35168.cindex "header lines" "References:"
35169Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
35170header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
35171section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
35172header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
35173responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
35174processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
35175than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
35176incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
3517711 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
35178
35179
35180
35181.section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
35182.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
35183.cindex "header lines" "Return-path:"
35184.oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
35185&'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
35186it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
35187transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
35188transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
35189default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
35190
35191
35192
35193.section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
35194.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
35195.cindex "message" "submission"
35196.cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
35197For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
35198existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
35199these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
35200&%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
35201control setting.
35202
35203When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
35204&%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
35205control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
35206&'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
35207that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
35208&%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
35209be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
35210appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
35211line is added to the message.
35212
35213If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
35214the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
35215&%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
35216options true at the same time.
35217
35218.cindex "submission mode"
35219By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
35220received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
35221a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
35222not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
35223
35224.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
35225First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
35226authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
35227created as follows:
35228
35229.ilist
35230.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
35231If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
35232&$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
35233.next
35234If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
35235is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
35236.next
35237If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
35238&$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
35239.endlist
35240
35241This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
35242are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
35243added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
35244by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
35245
35246.cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
35247&*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
35248the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
35249except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
35250
35251
35252
35253.section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
35254 "SECTheadersaddrem"
35255.cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
35256.cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
35257When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
35258specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
35259process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
35260modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
35261as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
35262
35263In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
35264specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
35265addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
35266changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
35267transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
35268they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
35269
35270&*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
35271the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
35272expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
35273
35274For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
35275option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
35276newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
35277.code
35278headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
35279 X-added-second: another added header line
35280.endd
35281Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
35282
35283Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
35284specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
35285Each header-line is separately expanded.
35286
35287The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
35288list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
35289often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
35290not part of the names. For example:
35291.code
35292headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
35293.endd
35294
35295Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
35296specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
35297Each item is separately expanded.
35298Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
35299form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
35300will act as list separators.
35301
35302When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
35303items are expanded at routing time,
35304and then associated with all addresses that are
35305accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
35306an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
35307forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
35308
35309.oindex "&%unseen%&"
35310However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
35311the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
35312&"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
35313
35314Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
35315settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
35316dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
35317requirements.
35318
35319The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
35320with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
35321these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
35322recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
35323consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
35324names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
35325instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
35326
35327After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
35328lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
35329the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
35330header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
35331
35332This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
35333the following consequences:
35334
35335.ilist
35336The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
35337remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
35338to it, at all times.
35339.next
35340Header lines that are added by a router's
35341&%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
35342expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
35343.next
35344Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
35345in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
35346.next
35347Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
35348a later router or by a transport.
35349.next
35350An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
35351removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
35352.code
35353headers_remove = subject
35354headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
35355.endd
35356.endlist
35357
35358&*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
35359for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
35360
35361
35362
35363
35364
35365.section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
35366.cindex "address" "constructed"
35367.cindex "constructed address"
35368When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
35369the form
35370.display
35371<&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
35372.endd
35373For example:
35374.code
35375Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
35376.endd
35377The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
35378otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
35379&"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
35380ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
35381upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
35382&%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
35383The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
35384there is no password file entry.
35385
35386.cindex "RFC 2047"
35387In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
35388parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
35389characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
35390including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
35391&%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
35392characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
35393&%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
35394is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
35395
35396
35397
35398.section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
35399.cindex "case of local parts"
35400.cindex "local part" "case of"
35401RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
35402be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
35403addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
35404because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
35405routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
35406original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
35407router option.
35408
35409.cindex "mixed-case login names"
35410If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
35411assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
35412your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
35413correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
35414.code
35415correct_case:
35416 driver = redirect
35417 domains = +local_domains
35418 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
35419 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
35420 @$domain
35421.endd
35422For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
35423(&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
35424up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
35425on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
35426local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
35427
35428
35429
35430.section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
35431.cindex "dot" "in local part"
35432.cindex "local part" "dots in"
35433RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
35434part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
35435middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
35436empty components for compatibility.
35437
35438
35439
35440.section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
35441.cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
35442Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
35443happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
35444in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
35445&'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
35446
35447Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
35448in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
35449routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
35450example, a header such as
35451.code
35452To: hare@teaparty
35453.endd
35454might get rewritten as
35455.code
35456To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
35457.endd
35458Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
35459does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
35460been routed.
35461
35462Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
35463addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
35464result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
35465deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
35466immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
35467routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
35468.ecindex IIDmesproc
35469
35470
35471
35472. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35473. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35474
35475.chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
35476.scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
35477.scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
35478Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
35479LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
35480closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
35481processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
35482
35483.ilist
35484SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
35485.next
35486SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
35487.next
35488Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
35489.endlist
35490
35491For mail delivery, the following are available:
35492
35493.ilist
35494SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
35495.next
35496LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
35497&"lmtp"&);
35498.next
35499LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
35500transport);
35501.next
35502Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
35503the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
35504.endlist
35505
35506&'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
35507stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
35508used to contain the envelope information.
35509
35510
35511
35512.section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
35513.cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
35514.cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
35515.cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
35516.cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
35517.cindex "EHLO"
35518.cindex "HELO"
35519.cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
35520Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
35521The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
35522processing is the same in both cases.
35523
35524If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
35525parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
35526command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
35527&%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
35528such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
35529.cindex "transport" "filter"
35530.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
35531transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
35532suppressed.
35533
35534If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
35535pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
35536required for the transaction.
35537
35538If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
35539was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
35540server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
35541Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
35542is called for verification.
35543
35544If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
35545the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
35546in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
35547
35548.cindex "carriage return"
35549.cindex "linefeed"
35550Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
35551LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
35552order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
35553line terminator.
35554
35555If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
35556characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
35557same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
35558even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
35559of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
35560they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
35561each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
35562in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
35563significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
35564
35565When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
35566message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
35567records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
35568particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
35569
35570.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
35571Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
35572a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
35573See the next section for more detail about error handling.
35574
35575.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
35576.cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
35577When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
35578looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
35579messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
35580creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
35581a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
35582so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
35583does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
35584turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
35585
35586The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
35587limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
35588
35589.cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
35590The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
35591identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
35592square bracket of the IP address.
35593
35594
35595
35596
35597.section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
35598.cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
35599.cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
35600.cindex "host" "error"
35601Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
35602message errors, and recipient errors.
35603
35604.vlist
35605.vitem "&*Host errors*&"
35606A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
35607particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
35608
35609.ilist
35610Connection refused or timed out,
35611.next
35612Any error response code on connection,
35613.next
35614Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
35615.next
35616Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
35617.next
35618I/O errors at any time,
35619.next
35620Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
35621the &"."& at the end of the data.
35622.endlist ilist
35623
35624For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
35625EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
35626error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
35627host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
35628the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
35629alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
35630host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
35631made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
35632
35633.vitem "&*Message errors*&"
35634.cindex "message" "error"
35635A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
35636particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
35637message errors are:
35638
35639.ilist
35640Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
35641the data,
35642.next
35643Timeout after MAIL,
35644.next
35645Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
35646timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
35647connection at any other time.
35648.endlist ilist
35649
35650For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
35651to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
35652temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
35653addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
35654a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
35655message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
35656that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
35657time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
35658affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
35659it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
35660
35661If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
35662to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
35663over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
35664response to MAIL.
35665
35666.vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
35667.cindex "recipient" "error"
35668A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
35669recipient errors are:
35670
35671.ilist
35672Any error response to RCPT,
35673.next
35674Timeout after RCPT.
35675.endlist
35676
35677For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
35678recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
35679sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
35680address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
35681used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
35682routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
35683operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
35684to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
35685if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
35686(&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
35687have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
35688the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
35689the retry clock is reset.
35690
35691The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
35692host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
35693other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
35694in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
35695proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
35696than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
35697if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
35698through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
35699recipient's retry time.
35700.endlist
35701
35702In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
35703current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
35704tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
35705own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
35706until the next delivery attempt.
35707
35708Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
35709MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
35710would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
35711host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
35712What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
35713is created.
35714
35715The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
35716these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
35717procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
35718response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
35719it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
35720message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
35721helpful to treat this case as a message error.
35722
35723Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
35724host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
35725or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
35726the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
35727then to be treated as a host error.
35728
35729There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
35730terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
35731reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
35732should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
35733host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
35734
35735
35736
35737
35738.section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
35739.cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
35740.cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
35741.cindex "inetd"
35742.cindex "daemon"
35743Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
35744listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
35745&_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
35746.code
35747smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
35748.endd
35749Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
35750agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
35751a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
35752the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
35753with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
35754stream and exits with an error code.
35755
35756By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
35757disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
35758unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
35759&%smtp_connection%& log selector.
35760
35761.cindex "carriage return"
35762.cindex "linefeed"
35763Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
35764LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
35765order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
35766line terminator.
35767Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
35768sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
35769sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
35770
35771.cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
35772.cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
35773One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
35774HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
35775commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
35776the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
35777Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
35778match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
35779
35780.cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
35781.cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
35782The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
35783a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
35784&%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
35785false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
35786&%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
35787value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
35788message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
35789
35790When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
35791its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
35792logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
35793
35794The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
35795prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
35796number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
35797&%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
35798rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
35799
35800The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
35801subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
35802for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
35803things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
35804processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
35805sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
35806it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
35807
35808When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
35809and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
35810high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
35811&%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
35812applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
35813
35814Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
35815can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
35816&%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
35817number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
35818SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
35819&%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
35820subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
35821a delivery process.
35822
35823The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
35824&%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
35825started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
35826handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
35827however, available with &'inetd'&.
35828
35829Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
35830are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
35831to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
35832section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
35833
35834Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
35835MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
35836&%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
35837
35838
35839
35840.section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
35841.cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
35842If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
35843commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
35844the error response to the last command. The default value for
35845&%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
35846abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
35847circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
35848
35849
35850.section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
35851.cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
35852.cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
35853A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
35854something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
35855address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
35856sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
35857&%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
35858drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
35859default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
35860broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
35861
35862
35863
35864.section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
35865.cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
35866The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
35867DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
35868many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
35869denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
35870client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
35871defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
35872
35873When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
35874allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
35875but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
35876or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
35877starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
35878counted.
35879
35880The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
35881STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
35882RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
35883
35884You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
35885&%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
35886&%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
35887the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
35888specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
35889
35890
35891
35892
35893.section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
35894When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
35895runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
35896appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
35897
35898.cindex "VRFY" "processing"
35899When no ACL is defined for VRFY, or if it rejects without
35900setting an explicit response code, the command is accepted
35901(with a 252 SMTP response code)
35902in order to support awkward clients that do a VRFY before every RCPT.
35903When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
35904called with the &%-bv%& option, and returns 250/451/550
35905SMTP response codes.
35906
35907.cindex "EXPN" "processing"
35908If no ACL for EXPN is defined, the command is rejected.
35909When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
35910EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
35911than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
35912as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
35913of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
35914VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
35915RCPT failures.
35916
35917
35918
35919.section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
35920.cindex "ETRN" "processing"
35921RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
35922overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
35923disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
35924the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
35925should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
35926
35927The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
35928delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
35929the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
35930text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
35931specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
35932the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
35933argument. For example,
35934.code
35935ETRN #brigadoon
35936.endd
35937runs the command
35938.code
35939exim -R brigadoon
35940.endd
35941which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
35942containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
35943default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
35944for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
35945a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
35946
35947.cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
35948Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
35949record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
35950the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
35951the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
35952a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
35953left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
35954Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
35955
35956.oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
35957For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
35958used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
35959whatever the form of its argument. For
35960example:
35961.code
35962smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
35963 $sender_host_address
35964.endd
35965.vindex "&$domain$&"
35966The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
35967expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
35968and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
35969wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
35970under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
35971for it to change them before running the command.
35972
35973
35974
35975.section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
35976.cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
35977Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
35978standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
35979line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
35980&%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
35981messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
35982sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
35983an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
35984identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
35985runs for RCPT commands:
35986.code
35987accept hosts = :
35988.endd
35989This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
35990
35991
35992
35993.section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
35994.cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
35995.cindex "batched SMTP output"
35996Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
35997batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
35998be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
35999delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
36000envelope along with the message.
36001
36002The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
36003MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
36004the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
36005HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
36006can be used to specify it.
36007
36008Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
36009one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
36010to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
36011this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
36012chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
36013
36014.vindex "&$host$&"
36015When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
36016sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
36017transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
36018router:
36019.code
36020begin routers
36021route_append:
36022 driver = manualroute
36023 transport = smtp_appendfile
36024 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
36025
36026begin transports
36027smtp_appendfile:
36028 driver = appendfile
36029 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
36030 batch_max = 1000
36031 use_bsmtp
36032 user = exim
36033.endd
36034This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
36035format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
36036message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
36037
36038
36039
36040.section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
36041.cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
36042.cindex "batched SMTP input"
36043The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
36044reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
36045is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
36046sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
36047rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
36048and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
36049as NOOP; QUIT quits.
36050
36051Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
36052ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
36053
36054If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
36055the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
36056standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
36057make some use of automatically, for example:
36058.code
36059554 Unexpected end of file
36060Transaction started in line 10
36061Error detected in line 14
36062.endd
36063It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
36064file, for example:
36065.code
36066An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
36067The error message was:
36068
36069501 '>' missing at end of address
36070
36071The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
36072The error was detected in line 12.
36073The SMTP command at fault was:
36074
36075rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
36076
360771 previous message was successfully processed.
36078The rest of the batch was abandoned.
36079.endd
36080The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
36081messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
36082accepted.
36083.ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
36084.ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
36085
36086
36087
36088. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36089. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36090
36091.chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
36092 "Customizing messages"
36093When a message fails to be delivered, or remains in the queue for more than a
36094configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
36095to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
36096the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
36097string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
36098
36099The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
36100cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
36101option. Exim also adds the line
36102.code
36103Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
36104.endd
36105to all warning and bounce messages,
36106
36107
36108.section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
36109.cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
36110.cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
36111If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
36112message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
36113delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
36114&%bounce_message_file%& is set.
36115
36116When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
36117constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
36118separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
36119opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
36120logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
36121item.
36122
36123.vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
36124.vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
36125Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
36126expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
36127the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
36128&$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
36129option, rounded to a whole number.
36130
36131The items must appear in the file in the following order:
36132
36133.ilist
36134The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
36135&'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
36136.next
36137The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
36138failing addresses with their error messages.
36139.next
36140The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
36141returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
36142.next
36143The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
36144The fields exist for back-compatibility
36145.endlist
36146
36147The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
36148following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
36149other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
36150.code
36151Subject: Mail delivery failed
36152 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
36153 {: returning message to sender}}
36154****
36155This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
36156
36157A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
36158 {that you sent }{sent by
36159
36160<$sender_address>
36161
36162}}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
36163This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
36164****
36165The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
36166****
36167------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
36168 ------
36169****
36170------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
36171 only the first
36172------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
36173****
36174.endd
36175.section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
36176.cindex "customizing" "warning message"
36177.cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
36178The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
36179warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
36180text sections:
36181
36182.ilist
36183The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
36184&'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
36185.next
36186The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
36187the delayed addresses.
36188.next
36189The third item then ends the message.
36190.endlist
36191
36192The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
36193have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
36194.code
36195Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
36196 $warn_message_delay
36197****
36198This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
36199
36200A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
36201{that you sent }{sent by
36202
36203<$sender_address>
36204
36205}}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
36206more than $warn_message_delay in the queue on $primary_hostname.
36207
36208The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
36209The subject of the message is: $h_subject
36210The date of the message is: $h_date
36211
36212The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
36213****
36214No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
36215continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
36216intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
36217mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
36218the message will be returned to you.
36219.endd
36220.vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
36221.vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
36222However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
36223appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
36224&$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
36225minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
36226of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
36227multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
36228handled them.
36229
36230
36231
36232
36233. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36234. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36235
36236.chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
36237This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
36238common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
36239
36240
36241
36242.section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
36243.cindex "smart host" "example router"
36244If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
36245should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
36246routing explicitly:
36247.code
36248send_to_smart_host:
36249 driver = manualroute
36250 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
36251 transport = remote_smtp
36252.endd
36253You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
36254If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
36255receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
36256synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
36257&<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
36258
36259
36260
36261
36262.section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
36263.cindex "mailing lists"
36264Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
36265requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
36266Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
36267
36268The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
36269is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
36270independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
36271lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
36272.code
36273lists:
36274 driver = redirect
36275 domains = lists.example
36276 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
36277 forbid_pipe
36278 forbid_file
36279 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
36280 no_more
36281.endd
36282This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
36283in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
36284such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
36285routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
36286
36287The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
36288expanded into a filename or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
36289a mailing list.
36290
36291.oindex "&%errors_to%&"
36292The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
36293taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
36294original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
36295the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
36296
36297For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
36298&'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
36299&_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
36300&'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
36301There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
36302the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
36303such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
36304or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
36305&%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
36306
36307
36308
36309.section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
36310.cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
36311If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
36312delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
36313list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
36314list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
36315addresses are not rigorously checked.
36316
36317If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
36318entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
36319&%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
36320whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
36321&%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
36322
36323
36324
36325.section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
36326.cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
36327Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
36328in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
36329recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
36330cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
36331delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
36332account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
36333the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
36334message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
36335
36336If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
36337on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
36338router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
36339&"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
36340&"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
36341subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
36342failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
36343pre-existing messages.
36344
36345The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
36346addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
36347addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
36348&%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
36349one level of expansion anyway.
36350
36351
36352
36353.section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
36354.cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
36355The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
36356send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
36357from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
36358&%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
36359
36360The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
36361of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
36362.code
36363lists_request:
36364 driver = redirect
36365 domains = lists.example
36366 local_part_suffix = -request
36367 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
36368 no_more
36369
36370lists_post:
36371 driver = redirect
36372 domains = lists.example
36373 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
36374 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
36375 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
36376 forbid_pipe
36377 forbid_file
36378 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
36379 no_more
36380
36381lists_closed:
36382 driver = redirect
36383 domains = lists.example
36384 allow_fail
36385 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
36386.endd
36387All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
36388they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
36389&%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
36390mailing list.
36391
36392The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
36393checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
36394checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
36395necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
36396because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
36397not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
36398means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
36399&%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
36400&"unrouteable address"& error.
36401
36402The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
36403a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
36404the address, giving a suitable error message.
36405
36406
36407
36408
36409.section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
36410.cindex "VERP"
36411.cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
36412.cindex "envelope from"
36413.cindex "envelope sender"
36414Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(https://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
36415are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
36416address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
36417the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
36418if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
36419original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
36420
36421.oindex &%errors_to%&
36422.oindex &%return_path%&
36423Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
36424facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
36425list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
36426these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
36427host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
36428of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
36429of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
36430.code
36431verp_smtp:
36432 driver = smtp
36433 max_rcpt = 1
36434 return_path = \
36435 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
36436 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
36437.endd
36438This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
36439SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
36440&"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
36441local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
36442example, that a message whose return path has been set to
36443&'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
36444&'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
36445rewritten as
36446.code
36447somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
36448.endd
36449.vindex "&$local_part$&"
36450For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
36451have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
36452achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
36453might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
36454&$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
36455
36456Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
36457probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
36458extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
36459can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
36460.code
36461dnslookup:
36462 driver = dnslookup
36463 domains = ! +local_domains
36464 transport = \
36465 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
36466 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
36467 no_more
36468.endd
36469If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
36470of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
36471routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
36472errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
36473address.
36474
36475On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
36476&(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
36477SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
36478and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
36479of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
36480.code
36481verp_dnslookup:
36482 driver = dnslookup
36483 domains = ! +local_domains
36484 transport = remote_smtp
36485 errors_to = \
36486 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
36487 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
36488 no_more
36489.endd
36490Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
36491configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
36492Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
36493router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
36494them.
36495
36496The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
36497message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
36498host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
36499a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
36500a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
36501than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
36502used).
36503
36504
36505
36506
36507
36508
36509.section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
36510.cindex "virtual domains"
36511.cindex "domain" "virtual"
36512The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
36513meanings:
36514
36515.ilist
36516A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
36517aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
36518top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
36519.next
36520One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
36521with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
36522have login accounts on that host.
36523.endlist
36524
36525The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
36526the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
36527aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
36528virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
36529whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
36530to a router of this form:
36531.code
36532virtual:
36533 driver = redirect
36534 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
36535 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
36536 no_more
36537.endd
36538The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
36539is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
36540domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
36541part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
36542setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
36543string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
36544
36545This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias filenames
36546follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
36547can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
36548a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
36549
36550The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
36551way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
36552valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
36553.code
36554my_domains:
36555 driver = accept
36556 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
36557 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
36558 transport = my_mailboxes
36559.endd
36560The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
36561can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
36562file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
36563option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
36564because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
36565follows:
36566.code
36567my_mailboxes:
36568 driver = appendfile
36569 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
36570 user = mail
36571.endd
36572This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
36573required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
36574
36575The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
36576requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
36577up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
36578information about the domains.
36579
36580
36581
36582.section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
36583.cindex "multiple mailboxes"
36584.cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
36585.cindex "local part" "prefix"
36586.cindex "local part" "suffix"
36587Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
36588incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
36589allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
36590identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
36591parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
36592&%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
36593example, consider this router:
36594.code
36595userforward:
36596 driver = redirect
36597 check_local_user
36598 file = $home/.forward
36599 local_part_suffix = -*
36600 local_part_suffix_optional
36601 allow_filter
36602.endd
36603.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
36604It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
36605&'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
36606cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
36607.code
36608if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
36609save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
36610endif
36611.endd
36612If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
36613fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
36614&%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
36615control over which suffixes are valid.
36616
36617Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
36618&_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
36619another MTA:
36620.code
36621userforward:
36622 driver = redirect
36623 check_local_user
36624 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
36625 local_part_suffix = -*
36626 local_part_suffix_optional
36627 allow_filter
36628.endd
36629If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
36630example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
36631does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
36632subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
36633&_.forward_& file to use as a default.
36634
36635
36636
36637.section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
36638.cindex "vacation processing"
36639The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
36640a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
36641(see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
36642This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
36643that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
36644
36645.ilist
36646A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
36647can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
36648alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
36649&_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
36650.code
36651spqr, vacation-spqr
36652.endd
36653.next
36654The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
36655vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
36656user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
36657ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
36658to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
36659message.
36660.endlist
36661
36662Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
36663use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
36664
36665
36666
36667.section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
36668.cindex "message" "copying every"
36669Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
36670be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
36671command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
36672each day's messages.
36673
36674There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
36675messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
36676delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
36677notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
36678
36679
36680
36681.section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
36682.cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
36683It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
36684Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
36685arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
36686permanently connected.
36687
36688Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
36689particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
36690Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
36691
36692
36693.section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
36694It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
36695host to remain in Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
36696approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
36697being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
36698some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
36699to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
36700resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
36701
36702A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
36703intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
36704into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
36705format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
36706destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
36707in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
36708if required.
36709
36710On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
36711you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
36712intermittent host. For example:
36713.code
36714cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
36715.endd
36716This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
36717which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
36718online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
36719options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
36720causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
36721connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
36722immediately.
36723
36724If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
36725issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
36726mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
36727used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
36728avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
36729Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
36730arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
36731
36732
36733
36734.section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
36735The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
36736increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
36737connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
36738delivered immediately.
36739
36740.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
36741.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
36742.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
36743Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
36744not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
36745possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
36746each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
36747avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
36748&%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
36749first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
36750normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
36751destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
36752single SMTP connection.
36753
36754
36755
36756. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36757. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36758
36759.chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
36760 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
36761.cindex "client, non-queueing"
36762.cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
36763On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
36764email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
36765configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
36766However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
36767configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
36768&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
36769messages this way.
36770
36771If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
36772run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
36773any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
36774continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
36775email is not desirable.
36776
36777There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
36778&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
36779any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
36780host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
36781informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
36782to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
36783to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
36784
36785There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
36786that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
36787ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
36788before sending a message to the smart host.
36789
36790Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
36791tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
36792overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
36793
36794.oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
36795There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
36796Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
36797assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
36798just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
36799compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
36800router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
36801
36802When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
36803following ways:
36804
36805.ilist
36806A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
36807In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
36808.next
36809Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
36810assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
36811&%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
36812does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
36813successful, a zero return code is given.
36814.next
36815Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
36816be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
36817the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
36818must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
36819deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
36820are.
36821.next
36822If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
36823failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
36824successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
36825.next
36826Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
36827is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
36828smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
36829the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
36830there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
36831.next
36832If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
36833connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
36834failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
36835.next
36836When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
36837(as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
36838value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
36839are ever generated.
36840.next
36841No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
36842.next
36843A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
36844true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
36845&%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
36846.endlist
36847
36848The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
36849the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
36850deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
36851privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
36852to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
36853the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
36854
36855
36856
36857
36858. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36859. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36860
36861.chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
36862.scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
36863.cindex "log" "types of"
36864Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
36865and the panic log:
36866
36867.ilist
36868.cindex "main log"
36869The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
36870line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
36871down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
36872out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
36873them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
36874they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
36875analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
36876&<<SECTmailstat>>&).
36877.next
36878.cindex "reject log"
36879The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
36880of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
36881The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
36882the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
36883is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
36884lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
36885reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
36886host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
36887can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
36888false.
36889.next
36890.cindex "panic log"
36891.cindex "system log"
36892When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
36893error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
36894are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
36895other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
36896therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
36897regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
36898panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
36899is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
36900message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
36901.endlist
36902
36903Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
36904example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
36905In the log file, this would be all on one line:
36906.code
369072001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
36908 by QUIT
36909.endd
36910By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
36911ways of changing this:
36912
36913.ilist
36914You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
36915you set
36916.code
36917timezone = UTC
36918.endd
36919the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
36920.next
36921If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
36922example:
36923.code
369242003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
36925.endd
36926.endlist
36927
36928.cindex "log" "process ids in"
36929.cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
36930Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
36931request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
36932&<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
36933brackets, immediately after the time and date.
36934
36935
36936
36937
36938.section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
36939.cindex "log" "destination"
36940.cindex "log" "to file"
36941.cindex "log" "to syslog"
36942.cindex "syslog"
36943The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
36944should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
36945are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
36946arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
36947It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
36948need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
36949Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
36950
36951The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
36952&_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the runtime
36953configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
36954references to the host name:
36955.code
36956log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
36957.endd
36958It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
36959rather than at runtime, because then the setting is available right from the
36960start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
36961before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
36962configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
36963log at all.
36964
36965The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
36966list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
36967facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
36968colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
36969otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
36970point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
36971implying the use of a default path.
36972
36973When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
36974LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
36975&"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
36976mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
36977files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
36978equivalent to the setting:
36979.code
36980log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
36981.endd
36982If you do not specify anything at build time or runtime,
36983or if you unset the option at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
36984that is where the logs are written.
36985
36986A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log filenames
36987are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
36988
36989Here are some examples of possible settings:
36990.display
36991&`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
36992&`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
36993&`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
36994&`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
36995.endd
36996If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
36997error is logged.
36998
36999
37000
37001.section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
37002.cindex "log" "cycling local files"
37003.cindex "cycling logs"
37004.cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
37005.cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
37006Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
37007log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
37008provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
37009main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
37010keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
37011
37012An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
37013and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
37014example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
37015message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
37016that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
37017something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
37018ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
37019&[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
37020does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
37021tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
37022for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
37023renamed.
37024
37025
37026
37027.section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
37028.cindex "log" "datestamped files"
37029Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
37030periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
37031for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
37032&_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
37033the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
37034point where the datestamp is required. For example:
37035.code
37036log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
37037log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
37038log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
37039log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
37040.endd
37041As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
37042examples of names generated by the above examples:
37043.code
37044/var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
37045/var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
37046/var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
37047/var/log/exim/main.200212
37048.endd
37049When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
37050files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
37051will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
37052run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
37053
37054The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
37055is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
37056When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
37057the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
37058non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
37059character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
37060log names:
37061.code
37062/var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
37063/var/log/exim-panic.log
37064/var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
37065/var/log/exim/panic
37066.endd
37067
37068
37069.section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
37070.cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
37071The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
37072except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
37073Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
37074that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
37075&"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
37076by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
37077&%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
37078SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
37079&_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
37080LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
37081the time and host name to each line.
37082The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
37083
37084.ilist
37085&'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
37086.next
37087&'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
37088.next
37089&'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
37090.endlist
37091
37092Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
37093written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
37094these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
37095by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
37096
37097Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
37098entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
37099these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
37100calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
37101870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
37102additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
37103replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
37104RFC 3164, you should set
37105.code
37106SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
37107.endd
37108in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
37109lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
37110
37111To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
37112entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
37113where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
37114components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
37115because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
37116delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
37117870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
37118&'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
37119name, and pid as added by syslog:
37120.code
37121[1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
37122[2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
37123[3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
37124[4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
37125[5/5] mple>)
37126.endd
37127The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
37128(LOG_NOTICE):
37129.code
37130[1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
37131[2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
37132[3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
37133[4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
37134[5\18] .example>)
37135[6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
37136[7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
37137[8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
37138[9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
37139[10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
37140[11\18] 09:43 +0100
37141[12\18] F From: <>
37142[13\18] Subject: this is a test header
37143[18\18] X-something: this is another header
37144[15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
37145[16\18] le>
37146[17\18] B Bcc:
37147[18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
37148.endd
37149Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
37150without modification.
37151
37152If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
37153display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
37154the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
37155where it is.
37156
37157
37158
37159.section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
37160One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
37161successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
37162picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
37163timestamp. The flags are:
37164.display
37165&`<=`& message arrival
37166&`(=`& message fakereject
37167&`=>`& normal message delivery
37168&`->`& additional address in same delivery
37169&`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
37170&`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
37171&`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
37172&`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
37173.endd
37174
37175
37176.section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
37177.cindex "log" "reception line"
37178The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
37179message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
37180several lines in order to fit it on the page:
37181.code
371822002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
37183 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
37184 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
37185.endd
37186The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
37187bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
37188generated, this is followed by an item of the form
37189.code
37190R=<message id>
37191.endd
37192which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
37193
37194.cindex "HELO"
37195.cindex "EHLO"
37196For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
37197record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
37198received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
37199host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
37200above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
37201&%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
37202by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
37203verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
37204EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
37205name in parentheses.
37206
37207Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
37208without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
37209the log containing text like these examples:
37210.code
37211H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
37212H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
37213.endd
37214This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
37215on.
37216
37217For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
37218the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
37219of Exim.
37220
37221.cindex "authentication" "logging"
37222.cindex "AUTH" "logging"
37223For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
37224message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
37225of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
37226extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
37227session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
37228suite that was used.
37229
37230.cindex log protocol
37231The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
37232hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
37233value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
37234there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
37235was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
37236&%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
37237authenticator name.
37238
37239.cindex "size" "of message"
37240The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
37241received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
37242headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
37243message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
37244other).
37245
37246The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
37247data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
37248
37249
37250
37251.section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
37252.cindex "log" "delivery line"
37253The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
37254delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
37255deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
37256to fit it on the page:
37257.code
372582002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
37259 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
372602002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
37261 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
37262 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
37263.endd
37264For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
37265after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
37266intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
37267last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
37268fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
37269
37270If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
37271followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
37272If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
37273option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
37274
37275If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
37276for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
37277.display
37278&`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
37279.endd
37280If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
37281parentheses afterwards.
37282
37283.cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
37284When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
37285SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
37286flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
37287down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
37288lines for the second and subsequent messages.
37289When two or more messages are delivered down a single TLS connection, the
37290DNS and some TLS-related information logged for the first message delivered
37291will not be present in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
37292TLS cipher information is still available.
37293
37294.cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
37295.cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
37296When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
37297line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
37298rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
37299
37300The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
37301&"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
37302
37303The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
37304data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
37305
37306
37307.section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
37308.cindex "discarded messages"
37309.cindex "message" "discarded"
37310.cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
37311When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
37312obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
37313.code
373142002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
37315 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
37316.endd
37317is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
37318because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
37319.code
373201999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
37321 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
37322.endd
37323
37324
37325.section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
37326When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
37327.code
373282002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
37329 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
37330.endd
37331In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
37332last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
37333written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
37334.code
373352002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
37336 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
37337.endd
37338When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
37339a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
37340appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
37341
37342
37343
37344.section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
37345.cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
37346If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
37347following form is logged:
37348.code
373491995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
37350 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
37351.endd
37352If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
37353the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
37354.code
373552002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
37356 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
37357 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
37358 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
37359 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
37360.endd
37361The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
37362used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
37363disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
37364flagged with &`**`&.
37365
37366
37367
37368.section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
37369.cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
37370If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
37371used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
37372&"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
37373
37374
37375
37376.section "Completion" "SECID257"
37377A line of the form
37378.code
373792002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
37380.endd
37381is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
37382at the end of its processing.
37383
37384
37385
37386
37387.section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
37388.cindex "log" "summary of fields"
37389A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
37390the following table:
37391.display
37392&`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
37393&`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
37394&` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
37395&`CV `& certificate verification status
37396&`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
37397&`DKIM`& domain verified in incoming message
37398&`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
37399&`DS `& DNSSEC secured lookups
37400&`DT `& on &`=>`&, &'=='& and &'**'& lines: time taken for, or to attempt, a delivery
37401&`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
37402&`H `& host name and IP address
37403&`I `& local interface used
37404&`id `& message id (from header) for incoming message
37405&`K `& CHUNKING extension used
37406&`L `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: PIPELINING extension used
37407&`M8S `& 8BITMIME status for incoming message
37408&`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
37409&` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
37410&`PRDR`& PRDR extension used
37411&`PRX `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: proxy address
37412&`Q `& alternate queue name
37413&`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
37414&` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
37415&`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
37416&` `& on &`=>`& &`>>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
37417&`RT `& on &`<=`& lines: time taken for reception
37418&`S `& size of message in bytes
37419&`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
37420&`ST `& shadow transport name
37421&`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
37422&`TFO `& connection took advantage of TCP Fast Open
37423&` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
37424&`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
37425&`X `& TLS cipher suite
37426.endd
37427
37428
37429.section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
37430Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
37431self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
37432
37433.ilist
37434.cindex "retry" "time not reached"
37435&'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
37436during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
37437This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
37438during the first delivery attempt.
37439.next
37440&'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
37441temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
37442for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
37443.next
37444.cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
37445&'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
37446some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
37447common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
37448&'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
37449doing.
37450.next
37451.cindex "error" "ignored"
37452&'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
37453message:
37454.olist
37455Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
37456&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
37457.next
37458A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
37459failed. The delivery was discarded.
37460.next
37461A delivery set up by a router configured with
37462. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
37463. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
37464.code
37465 errors_to = <>
37466.endd
37467failed. The delivery was discarded.
37468.endlist olist
37469.next
37470.cindex DKIM "log line"
37471&'DKIM: d='&&~&~Verbose results of a DKIM verification attempt, if enabled for
37472logging and the message has a DKIM signature header.
37473.endlist ilist
37474
37475
37476
37477
37478
37479.section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
37480.cindex "log" "selectors"
37481By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
37482default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
37483&%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
37484example:
37485.code
37486log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
37487.endd
37488The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
37489selection marked by asterisks:
37490.display
37491&` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
37492&`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
37493&` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
37494&` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
37495&` arguments `& command line arguments
37496&`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
37497&`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
37498&` deliver_time `& time taken to attempt delivery
37499&` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
37500&`*dkim `& DKIM verified domain on <= lines
37501&` dkim_verbose `& separate full DKIM verification result line, per signature
37502&`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
37503&` dnssec `& DNSSEC secured lookups
37504&`*etrn `& ETRN commands
37505&`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
37506&` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
37507&` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
37508&` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
37509&`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
37510&` millisec `& millisecond timestamps and RT,QT,DT,D times
37511&`*msg_id `& on <= lines, Message-ID: header value
37512&` msg_id_created `& on <= lines, Message-ID: header value when one had to be added
37513&` outgoing_interface `& local interface on => lines
37514&` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
37515&`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
37516&` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
37517&` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
37518&` pid `& Exim process id
37519&` pipelining `& PIPELINING use, on <= and => lines
37520&` proxy `& proxy address on <= and => lines
37521&` receive_time `& time taken to receive message
37522&` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
37523&` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
37524&`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
37525&`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
37526&` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
37527&` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
37528&`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
37529&`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
37530&`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
37531&`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
37532&` smtp_connection `& incoming SMTP connections
37533&` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
37534&` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
37535&` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
37536&` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
37537&` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
37538&` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
37539&`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
37540&`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
37541&` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
37542&` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
37543&` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
37544
37545&` all `& all of the above
37546.endd
37547See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
37548section &<<SECID99>>&
37549
37550More details on each of these items follows:
37551
37552.ilist
37553.cindex "8BITMIME"
37554.cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
37555&%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
37556which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
37557that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
37558&`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
37559&`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
37560.next
37561.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
37562&%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
37563its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
37564this log selector is set.
37565.next
37566.cindex "log" "rewriting"
37567.cindex "rewriting" "logging"
37568&%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
37569rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
37570such users cannot access the log).
37571.next
37572.cindex "log" "full parentage"
37573&%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
37574delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
37575parentheses between them.
37576.next
37577.cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
37578.cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
37579&%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
37580to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
37581feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
37582&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
37583privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
37584that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
37585are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
37586because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
37587only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
37588between the caller and Exim.
37589.next
37590.cindex "log" "connection rejections"
37591&%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
37592connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
37593.next
37594.cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
37595.cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
37596&%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
37597started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
37598messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
37599process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
37600.next
37601.cindex "log" "delivery duration"
37602&%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
37603perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
37604If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37605precision, eg. &`DT=0.304s`&.
37606.next
37607.cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
37608.cindex "size" "of message"
37609&%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
37610the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
37611.next
37612.cindex log "DKIM verification"
37613.cindex DKIM "verification logging"
37614&%dkim%&: For message acceptance log lines, when an DKIM signature in the header
37615verifies successfully a tag of DKIM is added, with one of the verified domains.
37616.next
37617.cindex log "DKIM verification"
37618.cindex DKIM "verification logging"
37619&%dkim_verbose%&: A log entry is written for each attempted DKIM verification.
37620.next
37621.cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
37622.cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
37623.cindex "black list (DNS)"
37624&%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
37625DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
37626.next
37627.cindex log dnssec
37628.cindex dnssec logging
37629&%dnssec%&: For message acceptance and (attempted) delivery log lines, when
37630dns lookups gave secure results a tag of DS is added.
37631For acceptance this covers the reverse and forward lookups for host name verification.
37632It does not cover helo-name verification.
37633For delivery this covers the SRV, MX, A and/or AAAA lookups.
37634.next
37635.cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
37636.cindex "ETRN" "logging"
37637&%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
37638is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
37639command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
37640selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
37641.next
37642.cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
37643&%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
37644any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
37645log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
37646routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
37647.next
37648.cindex "log" "ident timeout"
37649.cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
37650&%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
37651client's ident port times out.
37652.next
37653.cindex "log" "incoming interface"
37654.cindex "log" "local interface"
37655.cindex "log" "local address and port"
37656.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
37657.cindex "interface" "logging"
37658&%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
37659to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
37660followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
37661added to other SMTP log lines, for example, &"SMTP connection from"&, to
37662rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing &"=>"& and &"->"& lines.
37663The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
37664.next
37665.cindex log "incoming proxy address"
37666.cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
37667.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
37668&%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
37669of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
37670on a proxied connection
37671or the &"=>"& line for a message delivered on a proxied connection.
37672See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
37673.next
37674.cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
37675.cindex "port" "logging remote"
37676.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
37677.vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
37678.vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
37679&%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
37680added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
37681in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
37682changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
37683&$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
37684important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
37685.next
37686.cindex "log" "dropped connection"
37687&%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
37688connection is unexpectedly dropped.
37689.next
37690.cindex "log" "millisecond timestamps"
37691.cindex millisecond logging
37692.cindex timestamps "millisecond, in logs"
37693&%millisec%&: Timestamps have a period and three decimal places of finer granularity
37694appended to the seconds value.
37695.next
37696.cindex "log" "message id"
37697&%msg_id%&: The value of the Message-ID: header.
37698.next
37699&%msg_id_created%&: The value of the Message-ID: header, when one had to be created.
37700This will be either because the message is a bounce, or was submitted locally
37701(submission mode) without one.
37702The field identifier will have an asterix appended: &"id*="&.
37703.next
37704.cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
37705.cindex "log" "local interface"
37706.cindex "log" "local address and port"
37707.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
37708.cindex "interface" "logging"
37709&%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
37710interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
37711followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
37712off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
37713.next
37714.cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
37715.cindex "port" "logging outgoing remote"
37716.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging outgoing remote port"
37717&%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
37718containing => tags) following the IP address.
37719The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
37720&%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
37721This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
37722configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
37723local port is a random ephemeral port.
37724.next
37725.cindex "log" "process ids in"
37726.cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
37727&%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
37728immediately after the time and date.
37729.next
37730.cindex log pipelining
37731.cindex pipelining "logging outgoing"
37732&%pipelining%&: A field is added to delivery and accept
37733log lines when the ESMTP PIPELINING extension was used.
37734The field is a single "L".
37735
37736On accept lines, where PIPELINING was offered but not used by the client,
37737the field has a minus appended.
37738
37739.cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
37740If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
37741accept "L" fields have a period appended if the feature was
37742offered but not used, or an asterisk appended if used.
37743Delivery "L" fields have an asterisk appended if used.
37744
37745.next
37746.cindex "log" "queue run"
37747.cindex "queue runner" "logging"
37748&%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
37749.next
37750.cindex "log" "queue time"
37751&%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
37752local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
37753&`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
37754includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
37755This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
37756delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
37757message has been successfully received.
37758If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37759precision, eg. &`QT=1.578s`&.
37760.next
37761&%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
37762the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
37763example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
37764message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
37765.next
37766.cindex "log" "receive duration"
37767&%receive_time%&: For each message, the amount of real time it has taken to
37768perform the reception is logged as RT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`RT=1s`&.
37769If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37770precision, eg. &`RT=0.204s`&.
37771.next
37772.cindex "log" "recipients"
37773&%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
37774as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
37775that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
37776addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
37777has taken place.
37778Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
37779in the list.
37780.next
37781.cindex "log" "sender reception"
37782&%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
37783the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
37784&"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
37785.next
37786.cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
37787&%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
37788rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
37789log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
37790rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
37791.next
37792.cindex "log" "retry defer"
37793&%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
37794retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
37795message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
37796attempt.
37797.next
37798.cindex "log" "return path"
37799&%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
37800the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
37801This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
37802or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
37803.next
37804.cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
37805&%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
37806and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
37807This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
37808necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
37809.next
37810.cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
37811&%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
37812gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
37813the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
37814detail is lost.
37815.next
37816.cindex "log" "size rejection"
37817&%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
37818it is too big.
37819.next
37820.cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
37821.cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
37822&%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
37823queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
37824it.
37825.cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
37826The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
37827.next
37828.cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
37829.cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
37830.cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
37831&%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
37832outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
37833A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
37834response.
37835.next
37836.cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
37837.cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
37838&%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
37839established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
37840&%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
37841only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
37842processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
37843dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
37844not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
37845of connections unless this selector is enabled.
37846
37847For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
37848included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
37849reset if the daemon is restarted.
37850Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
37851subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
37852whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
37853match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
37854logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
37855.next
37856.cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
37857.cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
37858&%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
37859RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
37860and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
37861line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
37862.next
37863.cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
37864.cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
37865&%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
37866connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
37867the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
37868does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
37869an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
37870already have their own log lines.
37871
37872The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
37873way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
37874If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
37875an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
37876DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
37877the same logging options.
37878
37879Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
37880is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
37881.code
37882C=EHLO,QUIT
37883.endd
37884shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
37885than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
37886the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
37887setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
37888have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
37889.next
37890&%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
37891colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
37892log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
37893was accepted or used.
37894.next
37895.cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
37896.cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
37897&%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
37898encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
37899because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
37900been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
37901it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
37902received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
37903.next
37904.cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
37905.cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
37906.cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
37907.cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
37908.cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
37909&%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
37910encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
37911external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
37912using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
37913.next
37914.cindex "log" "subject"
37915.cindex "subject, logging"
37916&%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
37917preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
37918Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
37919specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
37920unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
37921.next
37922.cindex "log" "certificate verification"
37923.cindex log DANE
37924.cindex DANE logging
37925&%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
37926when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
37927verified
37928using a CA trust anchor,
37929&`CA=dane`& if using a DNS trust anchor,
37930and &`CV=no`& if not.
37931.next
37932.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
37933.cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
37934&%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
37935connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
37936.next
37937.cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
37938.cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
37939&%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
37940connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
37941added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
37942.next
37943.cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
37944.cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
37945&%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
37946the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
37947added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
37948.next
37949.cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
37950&%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
37951result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
37952.endlist
37953
37954
37955.section "Message log" "SECID260"
37956.cindex "message" "log file for"
37957.cindex "log" "message log; description of"
37958.cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
37959.oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
37960In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
37961that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
37962they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
37963message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
37964makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
37965to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
37966is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
37967only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
37968
37969On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
37970per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
37971&%message_logs%& option false.
37972.ecindex IIDloggen
37973
37974
37975
37976
37977. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37978. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37979
37980.chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
37981.scindex IIDutils "utilities"
37982A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
37983described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
37984the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
37985
37986.itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
37987.irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
37988 "list what Exim processes are doing"
37989.irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
37990.irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
37991.irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
37992.irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
37993 various criteria"
37994.irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
37995.irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
37996 "extract statistics from the log"
37997.irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
37998 "check address acceptance from given IP"
37999.irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
38000.irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
38001.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
38002.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
38003.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
38004.irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
38005.endtable
38006
38007Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
38008&'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
38009&url(https://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
38010
38011
38012
38013
38014.section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
38015.cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
38016.cindex "process, querying"
38017.cindex "SIGUSR1"
38018On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
38019(most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
38020a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
38021Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
38022processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
38023second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
38024order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
38025send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
38026
38027&*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
38028use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
38029script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
38030
38031
38032Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
38033varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
38034but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
38035system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
38036it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
38037options:
38038.display
38039&`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
38040&`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
38041&`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
38042&`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
38043.endd
38044An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
38045.code
38046164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
3804710483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
3804810492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
38049 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
3805010592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
3805110628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
38052.endd
38053The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
38054been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
38055
38056
38057
38058.section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
38059.cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
38060.cindex "queue" "grepping"
38061This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
38062.code
38063exim -bpu
38064.endd
38065or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
38066.code
38067exim -bp
38068.endd
38069The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
38070contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
38071
38072to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
38073that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
38074
38075.vlist
38076.vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
38077Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
38078tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
38079.code
38080exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
38081.endd
38082.vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
38083Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
38084tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
38085
38086.vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
38087Match against the size field.
38088
38089.vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
38090Match messages that are younger than the given time.
38091
38092.vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
38093Match messages that are older than the given time.
38094
38095.vitem &*-z*&
38096Match only frozen messages.
38097
38098.vitem &*-x*&
38099Match only non-frozen messages.
38100
38101.vitem &*-G*&&~<&'queuename'&>
38102Match only messages in the given queue. Without this, the default queue is searched.
38103.endlist
38104
38105The following options control the format of the output:
38106
38107.vlist
38108.vitem &*-c*&
38109Display only the count of matching messages.
38110
38111.vitem &*-l*&
38112Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
38113the default.
38114
38115.vitem &*-i*&
38116Display message ids only.
38117
38118.vitem &*-b*&
38119Brief format &-- one line per message.
38120
38121.vitem &*-R*&
38122Display messages in reverse order.
38123
38124.vitem &*-a*&
38125Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
38126.endlist
38127
38128There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
38129
38130
38131
38132.section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
38133.cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
38134.cindex "queue" "summary"
38135The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
38136-bp`& and produces a summary of the messages in the queue. Thus, you use it by
38137running a command such as
38138.code
38139exim -bp | exiqsumm
38140.endd
38141The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
38142it, as in the following example:
38143.code
381443 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
38145.endd
38146Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
38147volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
38148been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
38149number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
38150
38151A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
38152domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
38153the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
38154respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
38155domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
38156separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
38157sender.
38158
38159The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
38160this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
38161generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
38162option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
38163level"& addresses).
38164
38165
38166
38167
38168.section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
38169 "SECTextspeinf"
38170.cindex "&'exigrep'&"
38171.cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
38172The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
38173files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
38174extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
38175match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
38176given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
38177The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
38178If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
38179included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
38180.display
38181&`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
38182.endd
38183If no log filenames are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
38184
38185The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
38186condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
38187they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds in the queue.
38188
38189By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
38190makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
38191large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
38192option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
38193case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
38194
38195The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
38196pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
38197regular expression.
38198
38199The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
38200if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
38201
38202The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
38203that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
38204normally.
38205
38206Example of &%-M%&:
38207user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
38208&'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
38209displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
38210the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
38211when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
38212&"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
38213search term.
38214
38215If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
38216ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
38217whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
38218If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
38219autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
38220
38221
38222.section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
38223.cindex "&'exipick'&"
38224John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
38225lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
38226of &'exipick'&'s facilities, run &'exipick'& with
38227the &%--help%& option.
38228
38229
38230.section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
38231.cindex "log" "cycling local files"
38232.cindex "cycling logs"
38233.cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
38234The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
38235&'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
38236you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
38237&<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
38238for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
38239There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
38240.ilist
38241&%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
38242default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
38243.next
38244&%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
38245&%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
38246overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
38247configuration.
38248.endlist
38249
38250Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the filenames get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
38251the main log filename is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
38252run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
38253&_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
38254&%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
38255logs are handled similarly.
38256
38257If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
38258&_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
38259to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
38260any existing log files.
38261
38262If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
38263the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
38264using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
38265setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
38266root &%crontab%& entry of the form
38267.code
382681 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
38269.endd
38270assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
38271&'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
38272
38273
38274
38275.section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
38276.cindex "statistics"
38277.cindex "&'eximstats'&"
38278A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
38279information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
38280. --- 2018-09-07: LogReport's Lire appears to be dead; website is a Yahoo Japan
38281. --- 404 error and everything else points to that.
38282
38283The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
38284latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
38285lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
38286various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
38287list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
38288.code
38289eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
38290.endd
38291By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
38292messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
38293both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
38294are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
38295addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
38296options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
38297also produced per user.
38298
38299The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
38300histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
38301hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
38302example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
38303as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
38304
38305Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
38306have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
38307messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
38308and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
38309recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
38310an entirely separate message.
38311
38312&'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
38313of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
38314each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
38315not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
38316least one address that failed.
38317
38318The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
38319or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
38320transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
38321(default per hour), information about the time messages spent in the queue,
38322a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
38323senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
38324and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
38325
38326The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
38327came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
38328without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
38329
38330There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
38331outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
38332by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
38333.code
38334perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
38335.endd
38336
38337.section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
38338.cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
38339.cindex "policy control" "checking access"
38340.cindex "checking access"
38341The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
38342debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
38343policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
38344familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
38345sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
38346access?"& without bothering with any further details.
38347
38348The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
38349two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
38350.code
38351exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
38352.endd
38353The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
38354given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
38355connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
38356is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
38357.code
38358Rejected:
38359550 Relay not permitted
38360.endd
38361When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
38362for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
38363options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
38364that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
38365you can use:
38366.code
38367exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
38368 -f himself@there.example
38369.endd
38370Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
38371mandatory arguments.
38372
38373Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
38374while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
38375&%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
38376
38377
38378
38379.section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
38380.cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
38381.cindex "building DBM files"
38382.cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
38383.cindex "lower casing"
38384.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
38385The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
38386the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
38387&<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
38388names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
38389can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
38390
38391A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
38392the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
38393&'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
38394strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
38395files.
38396
38397The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
38398single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
38399It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
38400well.
38401
38402.cindex "USE_DB"
38403If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
38404configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two
38405filenames must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions
38406create a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
38407.code
38408exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
38409.endd
38410reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
38411&_/etc/aliases.db_&.
38412
38413In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
38414Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
38415environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
38416&'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
38417when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
38418recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the filename.
38419
38420If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
38421finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
38422option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
38423this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
38424&%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
38425There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
38426&%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
38427return code is 2.
38428
38429
38430
38431
38432.section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
38433.cindex "retry" "times"
38434.cindex "&'exinext'&"
38435A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
38436fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
38437complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
38438information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
38439is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
38440output. For example:
38441.code
38442$ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
38443kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
38444 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
38445 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
38446 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
38447roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
38448 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
38449 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
38450 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
38451 past final cutoff time
38452.endd
38453You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
38454will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
38455A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
38456message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
38457suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
38458&'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
38459run very often.
38460
38461The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
38462of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
38463passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
38464configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
38465file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
38466environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
38467
38468
38469
38470.section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
38471.cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
38472.cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
38473Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
38474uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
38475arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
38476second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
38477
38478.ilist
38479&'retry'&: the database of retry information
38480.next
38481&'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
38482for remote hosts
38483.next
38484&'callout'&: the callout cache
38485.next
38486&'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
38487.next
38488&'misc'&: other hints data
38489.endlist
38490
38491The &'misc'& database is used for
38492
38493.ilist
38494Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
38495.next
38496Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
38497&(smtp)& transport)
38498.next
38499Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
38500in a transport)
38501.endlist
38502
38503
38504
38505.section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
38506.cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
38507The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
38508&'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
38509spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
38510.code
38511exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
38512.endd
38513Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
38514.code
38515T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
3851631-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
38517.endd
38518The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
38519of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
38520transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
38521a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
38522address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
38523transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
38524to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
38525and a textual description of the error.
38526
38527The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
38528the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
38529ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
38530exceeded.
38531
38532Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
38533consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
38534waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
38535one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
38536may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
38537may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
38538cross-references.
38539
38540
38541
38542.section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
38543.cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
38544The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
38545database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
38546days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
38547updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
38548since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
38549for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
38550updated sufficiently often.
38551
38552The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
38553followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
38554the retry database:
38555.code
38556exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
38557.endd
38558Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
38559message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
38560they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
38561are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
38562types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
38563message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
38564queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
38565&'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
38566For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
38567removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
38568whenever it removes information from the database.
38569
38570Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
38571needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
38572down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
38573first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
38574records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
38575
38576It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
38577hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
38578a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
38579work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
38580but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
38581After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
38582point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
38583tidied.
38584
38585&*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
38586databases is likely to keep on increasing.
38587
38588
38589
38590
38591.section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
38592.cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
38593The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
38594Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
38595getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
38596is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
38597key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
38598displayed.
38599
38600If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
38601except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
38602out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
38603data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
38604by new data, for example:
38605.code
38606> 4 951102:1000
38607.endd
38608resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
38609sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
38610used as optional separators.
38611
38612
38613
38614
38615.section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
38616.cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
38617.cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
38618.cindex "locking mailboxes"
38619The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
38620Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
38621&'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
38622a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
38623the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
38624argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
38625second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
38626is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
38627is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
38628
38629.vlist
38630.vitem &%-fcntl%&
38631Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
38632
38633.vitem &%-flock%&
38634Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
38635supports it.
38636
38637.vitem &%-interval%&
38638This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
38639interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
38640
38641.vitem &%-lockfile%&
38642Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
38643
38644.vitem &%-mbx%&
38645Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
38646
38647.vitem &%-q%&
38648Suppress verification output.
38649
38650.vitem &%-retries%&
38651This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
38652the lock (default 10).
38653
38654.vitem &%-restore_time%&
38655This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
38656locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
38657example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
38658subsequently sees.
38659
38660.vitem &%-timeout%&
38661This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
38662timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
38663default), a non-blocking call is used.
38664
38665.vitem &%-v%&
38666Generate verbose output.
38667.endlist
38668
38669If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
38670default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
38671mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
38672&%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
38673requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
38674file does not last forever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
38675more than 30 minutes old.
38676
38677The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
38678&%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
38679to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
38680&_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
38681number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
38682can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
38683
38684The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
38685&%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
38686suppresses all output except error messages.
38687
38688A command such as
38689.code
38690exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
38691.endd
38692runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
38693.display
38694&`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
38695<&'some commands'&>
38696&`End`&
38697.endd
38698runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
38699suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
38700such as
38701.code
38702exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
38703 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
38704.endd
38705Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
38706second argument &-- hence the quotes.
38707.ecindex IIDutils
38708
38709
38710. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38711. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38712
38713.chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
38714.scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
38715.cindex "X-windows"
38716.cindex "&'eximon'&"
38717.cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
38718.cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
38719The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
38720about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
38721perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
38722such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
38723monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
38724
38725
38726
38727.section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
38728The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
38729script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
38730binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
38731be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
38732&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
38733parameters are for.
38734
38735The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
38736a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
38737preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
38738.code
38739EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
38740.endd
38741(in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
38742the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
38743overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
38744&'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
38745syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
38746
38747X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
38748way. For example, a resource setting of the form
38749.code
38750Eximon*background: gray94
38751.endd
38752changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
38753stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
38754black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
38755data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
38756&"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
38757For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
38758reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
38759.code
38760xrdb -merge <<End
38761Eximon*highlight: gray
38762End
38763.endd
38764.cindex "admin user"
38765In order to see the contents of messages in the queue, and to operate on them,
38766&'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
38767
38768The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
38769contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
38770if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
38771binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
38772versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
38773
38774The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
38775more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
38776main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
38777delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
38778different parts of the display.
38779
38780
38781
38782
38783.section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
38784.cindex "stripchart"
38785The first stripchart is always a count of messages in the queue. Its name can
38786be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
38787&_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
38788configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
38789it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
38790hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
38791received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
38792period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
38793parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
38794
38795The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
38796displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
38797title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
38798For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
38799
38800It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
38801a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
38802to a single partition.
38803
38804.cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
38805This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
38806the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
38807this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
38808100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
38809SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
38810&_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
38811
38812
38813
38814
38815.section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
38816.cindex "size" "of monitor window"
38817.cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
38818.cindex "window size"
38819Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
38820to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
38821shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
38822stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
38823the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
38824in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
38825
38826When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
38827currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
38828size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
38829remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
38830
38831The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
38832stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
38833the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
38834The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
38835&'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
38836the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38837
38838Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
38839built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
38840START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38841
38842
38843
38844.section "The log display" "SECID267"
38845.cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
38846The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
38847the main log is maintained.
38848To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
38849removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
38850The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
38851syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
38852to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
38853
38854The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
38855move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
38856scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
38857LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
38858to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
38859much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
38860a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
38861only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
38862available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
38863normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
38864configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38865
38866Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
38867and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
38868respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
38869It cannot go further back up the log.
38870
38871The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
38872normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
38873by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
38874by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
38875back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
38876the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
38877
38878Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
38879There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
38880the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
38881happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
38882&"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
38883^C is typed the search is cancelled.
38884
38885The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
38886widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
38887&"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
38888eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
38889However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
38890provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
38891come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
38892unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
38893on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
38894window.
38895
38896
38897
38898.section "The queue display" "SECID268"
38899.cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
38900The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
38901are in the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
38902as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
38903parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
38904at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
38905the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
38906there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
38907to force an update of the queue display at any time.
38908
38909When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
38910and this can make it hard to deal with other messages in the queue. To help
38911with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
38912pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
38913type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
38914such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
38915of the texts, the message is not displayed.
38916
38917If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
38918are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
38919example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
38920&'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
38921has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
38922cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
38923a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
38924
38925While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
38926else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
38927queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
38928pressing the &"Hide"& button.
38929
38930The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
38931time it has been in the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
38932message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
38933a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
38934recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
38935listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
38936an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
38937not shown.
38938
38939.cindex "frozen messages" "display"
38940If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
38941
38942The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
38943of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
38944The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
38945available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
38946display is updated.
38947
38948
38949
38950.section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
38951.cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
38952If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
38953pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
38954line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
38955any selected text.
38956
38957If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
38958MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
38959set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
38960value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
38961run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
38962.code
38963EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
38964.endd
38965The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
38966follows:
38967
38968.ilist
38969&'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
38970in a new text window.
38971.next
38972&'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
38973information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
38974&<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
38975.next
38976&'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
38977displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
38978amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
38979option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at runtime.
38980.next
38981&'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
38982delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
38983frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
38984a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
38985up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
38986.next
38987&'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
38988that the message be frozen.
38989.next
38990.cindex "thawing messages"
38991.cindex "unfreezing messages"
38992.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
38993&'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
38994that the message be thawed.
38995.next
38996.cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
38997&'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
38998that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
38999for any remaining undelivered addresses.
39000.next
39001&'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
39002that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
39003message.
39004.next
39005&'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
39006be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
39007is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
39008Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
39009causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
39010additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
39011which case no action is taken.
39012.next
39013&'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
39014can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
39015is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
39016Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
39017causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
39018recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
39019case no action is taken.
39020.next
39021&'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
39022mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
39023.next
39024&'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
39025sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
39026&%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
39027in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
39028bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
39029not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
39030the address is qualified with that domain.
39031.endlist
39032
39033When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
39034other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
39035particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
39036output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
39037from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
39038&_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
39039if no output is generated.
39040
39041The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
39042thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
39043&_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
39044force an update of the display after one of these actions.
39045
39046In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
39047cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
39048and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
39049.ecindex IIDeximon
39050
39051
39052
39053
39054
39055. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39056. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39057
39058.chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
39059.scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
39060This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
39061which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
39062
39063For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
39064Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
39065existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
39066chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
39067security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
39068its security as compared with other MTAs.
39069
39070What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
39071have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
39072absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
39073as soon as possible.
39074
39075
39076.section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
39077.cindex "security" "build-time features"
39078There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
39079to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
39080Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
39081penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
39082
39083.ilist
39084ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
39085start of any filenames used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these
39086filenames are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if
39087the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
39088&_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
39089default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
39090
39091If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
39092which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
39093into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
39094configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
39095.next
39096
39097If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
39098or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
39099file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
39100the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
39101root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
39102right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
39103reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
39104it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
39105privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
39106separate commands.
39107
39108.next
39109The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
39110with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
39111CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
39112requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
39113the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
39114but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
39115previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
39116.next
39117If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
39118is disabled.
39119.next
39120FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
39121never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
39122option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
39123to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
39124is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
39125.endlist
39126
39127
39128
39129.section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
39130.cindex "setuid"
39131.cindex "root privilege"
39132The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
39133privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
39134example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
39135may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
39136discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
39137is required for two things:
39138
39139.ilist
39140To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
39141the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
39142not required.
39143.next
39144To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
39145perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
39146configuration.
39147.endlist
39148
39149It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
39150receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
39151obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
39152For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
39153&_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
39154group"&. Their values can be changed by the runtime configuration, though this
39155is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
39156&'mail'& or another user name altogether.
39157
39158Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
39159abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
39160&[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
39161
39162After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
39163uid and gid in the following cases:
39164
39165.ilist
39166.oindex "&%-C%&"
39167.oindex "&%-D%&"
39168If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
39169the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
39170calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
39171the calling process.
39172However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
39173option may not be used at all.
39174If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
39175can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
39176user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
39177.next
39178.oindex "&%-be%&"
39179.oindex "&%-bf%&"
39180.oindex "&%-bF%&"
39181If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
39182(&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
39183calling process.
39184.next
39185If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
39186process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
39187uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
39188runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
39189testing address verification
39190.oindex "&%-bv%&"
39191.oindex "&%-bh%&"
39192(the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
39193option).
39194.next
39195For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
39196remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
39197.endlist
39198
39199The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
39200
39201.ilist
39202A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
39203user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
39204function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
39205will be used during message reception.
39206.next
39207A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
39208job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
39209.next
39210A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
39211but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
39212subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
39213deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
39214remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
39215subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
39216while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
39217generating bounce and warning messages.
39218
39219While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
39220process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
39221this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
39222gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
39223.next
39224A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
39225the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
39226.endlist
39227
39228
39229
39230
39231.section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
39232.cindex "privilege, running without"
39233.cindex "unprivileged running"
39234.cindex "root privilege" "running without"
39235Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
39236operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
39237by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
39238gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
39239(and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
39240routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
39241to any other uid.
39242
39243.cindex SIGHUP
39244.cindex "daemon" "restarting"
39245Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
39246that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
39247correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
39248
39249An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
39250to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
39251process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
39252when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
39253SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
39254
39255It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
39256stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
39257been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
39258effect.
39259
39260If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
39261set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
39262to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
39263
39264In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
39265those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
39266Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
39267that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
39268discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
39269have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
39270number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
39271address this problem at this time.
39272
39273For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
39274is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
39275&%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
39276be used in the most straightforward way.
39277
39278If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
39279number of restrictions on what you can do:
39280
39281.ilist
39282You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
39283&%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
39284normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
39285work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
39286explicit specification of another user causes an error.
39287.next
39288Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
39289not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
39290.next
39291Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
39292the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
39293and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
39294enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
39295.next
39296Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
39297some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
39298
39299.olist
39300They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
39301implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
39302mode of the mailbox files themselves.
39303.next
39304You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
39305owned by the Exim user.
39306.next
39307You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
39308on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
39309mailboxes need to be created manually.
39310.endlist olist
39311.endlist ilist
39312
39313
39314These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
39315However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
39316gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
39317gives more security at essentially no cost.
39318
39319If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
39320&<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
39321
39322
39323
39324
39325.section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
39326Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
39327are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
39328
39329
39330
39331.section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
39332.cindex "security" "local commands"
39333.cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
39334There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
39335commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
39336configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
39337run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
39338
39339.ilist
39340Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
39341injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
39342be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
39343allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
39344has &%use_shell%& enabled.
39345.next
39346A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
39347&%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
39348&_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
39349hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
39350NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
39351forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
39352need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
39353.next
39354The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
39355administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
39356Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
39357.next
39358Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
39359taint checking might apply to their usage.
39360.next
39361Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
39362administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
39363instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
39364.next
39365Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
39366Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
39367each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
39368of opaque strings.
39369The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
39370real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
39371injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
39372Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
39373.endlist
39374
39375
39376
39377
39378.section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
39379.cindex "security" "data sources"
39380.cindex "security" "regular expressions"
39381.cindex "regular expressions" "security"
39382.cindex "PCRE" "security"
39383If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
39384are some issues to be aware of:
39385
39386.ilist
39387Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
39388.next
39389Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
39390.next
39391Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
39392data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
39393"backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
39394expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
39395when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
39396possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
39397data.
39398.next
39399It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
39400&%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
39401items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
39402.next
39403Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
39404expected to yield one result.
39405.endlist
39406
39407
39408
39409
39410.section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
39411.cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
39412.cindex "IP source routing"
39413Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
39414some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
39415IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
39416IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
39417
39418
39419
39420.section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
39421Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
39422be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
39423
39424
39425
39426
39427.section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
39428.cindex "trusted users"
39429.cindex "admin user"
39430.cindex "privileged user"
39431.cindex "user" "trusted"
39432.cindex "user" "admin"
39433Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
39434able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
39435addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
39436local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
39437permit a remote host to be specified.
39438
39439.oindex "&%-f%&"
39440However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
39441in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
39442message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
39443but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
39444permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
39445the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
39446
39447Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
39448other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
39449the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
39450as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
39451group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
39452
39453Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
39454can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
39455them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
39456the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
39457includes the contents of files on the spool.
39458
39459.oindex "&%-M%&"
39460.oindex "&%-q%&"
39461By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
39462delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
39463restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
39464Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
39465queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
39466setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
39467
39468Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
39469the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
39470the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
39471group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
39472the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
39473unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
39474files.
39475
39476By default, regular users are trusted to perform basic testing and
39477introspection commands, as themselves. This setting can be tightened by
39478setting the &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& option.
39479This affects most of the checking options,
39480such as &%-be%& and anything else &%-b*%&.
39481
39482
39483.section "Spool files" "SECID275"
39484.cindex "spool directory" "files"
39485Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
39486set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
39487&_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
39488any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
39489
39490
39491
39492.section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
39493Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
39494of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
39495with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
39496to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
39497this.
39498
39499
39500
39501.section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
39502The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
39503are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
39504Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
39505converted output.
39506
39507
39508
39509.section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
39510Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
39511to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
39512does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
39513arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
39514
39515
39516
39517.section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
39518Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
39519defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
39520loading it.
39521
39522
39523.section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
39524.cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
39525A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
39526&'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
39527The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
39528that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
39529conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
39530
39531The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
39532the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
39533string.
39534
39535
39536
39537.section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
39538Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
39539formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
39540the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
39541
39542
39543
39544.section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
39545These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
39546enough to hold the result.
39547.ecindex IIDsecurcon
39548
39549
39550
39551
39552. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39553. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39554
39555.chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
39556.scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
39557.scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
39558.scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
39559.cindex "spool files" "editing"
39560A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
39561followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
39562the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
39563kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
39564two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
39565is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
39566themselves are recoverable.
39567
39568The file formats may be changed, or new formats added, at any release.
39569Spool files are not intended as an interface to other programs
39570and should not be used as such.
39571
39572Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
39573need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
39574on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
39575
39576.ilist
39577You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
39578fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
39579which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
39580place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
39581lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
39582.next
39583.vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
39584If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
39585&$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect and can
39586cause incomplete transmission of messages or undeliverable messages.
39587.next
39588If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
39589.next
39590If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
39591signature.
39592.endlist
39593All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
39594
39595Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
39596its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
39597files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
39598the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
39599the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
39600is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
39601file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
39602-J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
39603attempt.
39604
39605Files whose names end with -K or .eml may also be seen in the spool.
39606These are temporaries used for DKIM or malware processing, when that is used.
39607They should be tidied up by normal operations; any old ones are probably
39608relics of crashes and can be removed.
39609
39610.section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
39611.cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
39612.cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
39613The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
39614process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
39615gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
39616message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
39617normally the Exim user.
39618
39619The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
39620transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
39621empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
39622in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
39623created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
39624&%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
39625leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
39626&"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
39627
39628The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
39629was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
39630start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
39631warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
39632
39633There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
39634order, and are omitted when not relevant:
39635
39636.vlist
39637.vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39638This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
39639&%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
39640recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
39641this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
39642identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
39643the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
39644the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
39645the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
39646newlines.
39647
39648.vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39649A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
39650defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
39651The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
39652starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
39653character. It may contain internal newlines.
39654
39655.vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39656A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
39657Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
39658length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
39659starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
39660character. It may contain internal newlines.
39661
39662.vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
39663This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
39664&$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
39665
39666.vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
39667This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
39668lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
39669transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
39670messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
39671
39672.vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
39673This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
39674(to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
39675time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
39676hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
39677
39678.vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
39679The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
39680&-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
39681
39682.vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
39683The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
39684&$authenticated_sender$& variable.
39685
39686.vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
39687This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is
39688present unless &%-spool_file_wireformat%& is.
39689
39690.vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
39691This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
39692present if the number is greater than zero.
39693
39694.vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
39695This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
39696file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
39697
39698.vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
39699.cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
39700The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
39701
39702.vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
39703This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
39704command.
39705
39706.vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
39707This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
39708the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
39709messages.
39710
39711.vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
39712If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
39713the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
39714&$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
39715
39716.vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
39717This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
39718address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
39719
39720.vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
39721.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
39722.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
39723This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
39724if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
39725received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
39726
39727.vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
39728For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
39729unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
39730ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
39731supplied by the remote host, if any.
39732
39733.vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
39734This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
39735which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
39736generated messages.
39737
39738.vitem &%-local%&
39739The message is from a local sender.
39740
39741.vitem &%-localerror%&
39742The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
39743
39744.vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
39745This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
39746when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
39747variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
39748
39749.vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
39750The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
39751Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
39752
39753.vitem &%-N%&
39754A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
39755actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
39756&%-N%& is assumed.
39757
39758.vitem &%-received_protocol%&
39759This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
39760the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
39761
39762.vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
39763The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
39764to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
39765
39766.vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
39767If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
39768of &$spam_score_int$&.
39769
39770.vitem &%-spool_file_wireformat%&
39771The -D file for this message is in wire-format (for ESMTP CHUNKING)
39772rather than Unix-format.
39773The line-ending is CRLF rather than newline.
39774There is still, however, no leading-dot-stuffing.
39775
39776.vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
39777A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
39778certificate was verified by the server.
39779
39780.vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
39781When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
39782name of the cipher suite that was used.
39783
39784.vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
39785When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
39786was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
39787certificate.
39788.endlist
39789
39790Any of the above may have an extra hyphen prepended, to indicate the the
39791corresponding data is untrusted.
39792
39793Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
39794is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
39795line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
39796is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
39797the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
39798balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
39799to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
39800original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
39801addresses are complete.
39802
39803If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
39804the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
39805Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
39806tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
39807right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
39808follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
39809.code
39810YY darcy@austen.fict.example
39811NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
39812NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39813.endd
39814After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
39815This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
39816recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
39817delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
39818example:
39819.code
398204
39821editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39822darcy@austen.fict.example
39823rdo@foundation
39824alice@wonderland.fict.example
39825.endd
39826However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
39827result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
39828line is of the following form:
39829.display
39830<&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
39831 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
39832.endd
39833The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
39834the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
39835fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
39836original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
39837envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
39838length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
39839characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
39840that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
39841
39842
39843A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
39844which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
39845when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
39846character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
39847embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
39848following:
39849
39850.table2 50pt
39851.row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
39852.row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
39853.row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
39854.row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
39855.row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
39856.row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
39857.row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
39858.row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
39859.row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
39860.row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
39861.endtable
39862
39863Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
39864purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
39865typical set of headers:
39866.code
39867111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
39868id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
39869049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
39870038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
39871042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
39872049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
39873099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
39874darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39875104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
39876darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39877038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
39878.endd
39879The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
39880&'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
39881unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
39882.ecindex IIDforspo1
39883.ecindex IIDforspo2
39884.ecindex IIDforspo3
39885
39886.section "Format of the -D file" "SECID282a"
39887The data file is traditionally in Unix-standard format: lines are ended with
39888an ASCII newline character.
39889However, when the &%spool_wireformat%& main option is used some -D files
39890can have an alternate format.
39891This is flagged by a &%-spool_file_wireformat%& line in the corresponding -H file.
39892The -D file lines (not including the first name-component line) are
39893suitable for direct copying to the wire when transmitting using the
39894ESMTP CHUNKING option, meaning lower processing overhead.
39895Lines are terminated with an ASCII CRLF pair.
39896There is no dot-stuffing (and no dot-termination).
39897
39898. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39899. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39900
39901.chapter "DKIM, SPF and DMARC" "CHAPdkim" &&&
39902 "DKIM, SPF and DMARC Support"
39903
39904.section "DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" SECDKIM
39905.cindex "DKIM"
39906
39907DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
39908linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
39909be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
39910DKIM is documented in RFC 6376.
39911
39912As DKIM relies on the message being unchanged in transit, messages handled
39913by a mailing-list (which traditionally adds to the message) will not match
39914any original DKIM signature.
39915
39916DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default if TLS support is present.
39917It can be disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
39918
39919Exim's DKIM implementation allows for
39920.olist
39921Signing outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
39922It can co-exist with all other Exim features
39923(including transport filters)
39924except cutthrough delivery.
39925.next
39926Verifying signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
39927ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
39928different signature contexts.
39929.endlist
39930
39931In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
39932default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
39933Exim's standard controls.
39934
39935Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
39936on by default for logging (in the <= line) purposes.
39937
39938Additional log detail can be enabled using the &%dkim_verbose%& log_selector.
39939When set, for each signature in incoming email,
39940exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
39941signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
39942.code
399432009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
39944 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
39945 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
39946 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
39947.endd
39948
39949You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
39950or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
39951control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
39952where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
39953senders).
39954
39955
39956.section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECDKIMSIGN"
39957.cindex "DKIM" "signing"
39958
39959For signing to be usable you must have published a DKIM record in DNS.
39960Note that RFC 8301 (which does not cover EC keys) says:
39961.code
39962rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
39963
39964Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
39965Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
39966.endd
39967
39968Note also that the key content (the 'p=' field)
39969in the DNS record is different between RSA and EC keys;
39970for the former it is the base64 of the ASN.1 for the RSA public key
39971(equivalent to the private-key .pem with the header/trailer stripped)
39972but for EC keys it is the base64 of the pure key; no ASN.1 wrapping.
39973
39974Signing is enabled by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
39975These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
39976
39977.option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
39978The domain(s) you want to sign with.
39979After expansion, this can be a list.
39980Each element in turn,
39981lowercased,
39982is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable
39983while expanding the remaining signing options.
39984If it is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done,
39985and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
39986
39987.option dkim_selector smtp string list&!! unset
39988This sets the key selector string.
39989After expansion, which can use &$dkim_domain$&, this can be a list.
39990Each element in turn is put in the expansion
39991variable &%$dkim_selector%& which may be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
39992option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
39993If the option is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done for this domain,
39994and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
39995
39996.option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
39997This sets the private key to use.
39998You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
39999&%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
40000The result can either
40001.ilist
40002be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor (.pem file), including line breaks
40003.next
40004with GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
40005be a valid Ed25519 private key (same format as above)
40006.next
40007start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
40008the private key
40009.next
40010be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
40011be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
40012is set.
40013.endlist
40014
40015To generate keys under OpenSSL:
40016.code
40017openssl genrsa -out dkim_rsa.private 2048
40018openssl rsa -in dkim_rsa.private -out /dev/stdout -pubout -outform PEM
40019.endd
40020Take the base-64 lines from the output of the second command, concatenated,
40021for the DNS TXT record.
40022See section 3.6 of RFC6376 for the record specification.
40023
40024Under GnuTLS:
40025.code
40026certtool --generate-privkey --rsa --bits=2048 --password='' -8 --outfile=dkim_rsa.private
40027certtool --load-privkey=dkim_rsa.private --pubkey-info
40028.endd
40029
40030Note that RFC 8301 says:
40031.code
40032Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
40033Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
40034.endd
40035
40036EC keys for DKIM are defined by RFC 8463.
40037They are considerably smaller than RSA keys for equivalent protection.
40038As they are a recent development, users should consider dual-signing
40039(by setting a list of selectors, and an expansion for this option)
40040for some transition period.
40041The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
40042for EC keys.
40043
40044OpenSSL 1.1.1 and GnuTLS 3.6.0 can create Ed25519 private keys:
40045.code
40046openssl genpkey -algorithm ed25519 -out dkim_ed25519.private
40047certtool --generate-privkey --key-type=ed25519 --outfile=dkim_ed25519.private
40048.endd
40049
40050To produce the required public key value for a DNS record:
40051.code
40052openssl pkey -outform DER -pubout -in dkim_ed25519.private | tail -c +13 | base64
40053certtool --load_privkey=dkim_ed25519.private --pubkey_info --outder | tail -c +13 | base64
40054.endd
40055
40056Exim also supports an alternate format
40057of Ed25519 keys in DNS which was a candidate during development
40058of the standard, but not adopted.
40059A future release will probably drop that support.
40060
40061.option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
40062Can be set to any one of the supported hash methods, which are:
40063.ilist
40064&`sha1`& &-- should not be used, is old and insecure
40065.next
40066&`sha256`& &-- the default
40067.next
40068&`sha512`& &-- possibly more secure but less well supported
40069.endlist
40070
40071Note that RFC 8301 says:
40072.code
40073rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
40074.endd
40075
40076.option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
40077If set after expansion, the value is used to set an "i=" tag in
40078the signing header. The DKIM standards restrict the permissible
40079syntax of this optional tag to a mail address, with possibly-empty
40080local part, an @, and a domain identical to or subdomain of the "d="
40081tag value. Note that Exim does not check the value.
40082
40083.option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
40084This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
40085The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
40086The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
40087only supports signing with the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
40088
40089.option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
40090This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
40091should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
40092either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
40093unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
40094variables here.
40095
40096.option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "see below"
40097If set, this option must expand to a colon-separated
40098list of header names.
40099Headers with these names, or the absence or such a header, will be included
40100in the message signature.
40101When unspecified, the header names listed in RFC4871 will be used,
40102whether or not each header is present in the message.
40103The default list is available for the expansion in the macro
40104"_DKIM_SIGN_HEADERS".
40105
40106If a name is repeated, multiple headers by that name (or the absence thereof)
40107will be signed. The textually later headers in the headers part of the
40108message are signed first, if there are multiples.
40109
40110A name can be prefixed with either an '=' or a '+' character.
40111If an '=' prefix is used, all headers that are present with this name
40112will be signed.
40113If a '+' prefix if used, all headers that are present with this name
40114will be signed, and one signature added for a missing header with the
40115name will be appended.
40116
40117.option dkim_timestamps smtp integer&!! unset
40118This option controls the inclusion of timestamp information in the signature.
40119If not set, no such information will be included.
40120Otherwise, must be an unsigned number giving an offset in seconds from the current time
40121for the expiry tag
40122(eg. 1209600 for two weeks);
40123both creation (t=) and expiry (x=) tags will be included.
40124
40125RFC 6376 lists these tags as RECOMMENDED.
40126
40127
40128.section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECDKIMVFY"
40129.cindex "DKIM" "verification"
40130
40131Verification of DKIM signatures in SMTP incoming email is done for all
40132messages for which an ACL control &%dkim_disable_verify%& has not been set.
40133.cindex DKIM "selecting signature algorithms"
40134Individual classes of signature algorithm can be ignored by changing
40135the main options &%dkim_verify_hashes%& or &%dkim_verify_keytypes%&.
40136The &%dkim_verify_minimal%& option can be set to cease verification
40137processing for a message once the first passing signature is found.
40138
40139.cindex authentication "expansion item"
40140Performing verification sets up information used by the
40141&%authresults%& expansion item.
40142
40143For most purposes the default option settings suffice and the remainder
40144of this section can be ignored.
40145
40146The results of verification are made available to the
40147&%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL, which can examine and modify them.
40148A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
40149By default, the ACL is called once for each
40150syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
40151If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
40152If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message, that is
40153summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
40154
40155To evaluate the verification result in the ACL
40156a large number of expansion variables
40157containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
40158runtime of the ACL.
40159
40160Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
40161more advanced policies. For that reason, the main option
40162&%dkim_verify_signers%&, and an expansion variable
40163&%$dkim_signers%& exist.
40164
40165The main option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
40166list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
40167called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
40168the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
40169list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
40170&%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
40171it defaults as:
40172.code
40173dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
40174.endd
40175This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
40176DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
40177call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
40178.code
40179dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
40180.endd
40181This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
40182and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
40183You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
40184.code
40185dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
40186.endd
40187
40188If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
40189&%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
40190
40191Note that if the option is set using untrustworthy data
40192(such as the From: header)
40193care should be taken to force lowercase for domains
40194and for the domain part if identities.
40195The default setting can be regarded as trustworthy in this respect.
40196
40197If multiple signatures match a domain (or identity), the ACL is called once
40198for each matching signature.
40199
40200
40201Inside the DKIM ACL, the following expansion variables are
40202available (from most to least important):
40203
40204
40205.vlist
40206.vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
40207The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
40208an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
40209&%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
40210
40211.vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
40212Within the DKIM ACL,
40213a string describing the general status of the signature. One of
40214.ilist
40215&%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
40216identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
40217.next
40218&%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
40219More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
40220.next
40221&%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
40222available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
40223.next
40224&%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
40225.endlist
40226
40227This variable can be overwritten using an ACL 'set' modifier.
40228This might, for instance, be done to enforce a policy restriction on
40229hash-method or key-size:
40230.code
40231 warn condition = ${if eq {$dkim_verify_status}{pass}}
40232 condition = ${if eq {${length_3:$dkim_algo}}{rsa}}
40233 condition = ${if or {{eq {$dkim_algo}{rsa-sha1}} \
40234 {< {$dkim_key_length}{1024}}}}
40235 logwrite = NOTE: forcing DKIM verify fail (was pass)
40236 set dkim_verify_status = fail
40237 set dkim_verify_reason = hash too weak or key too short
40238.endd
40239
40240So long as a DKIM ACL is defined (it need do no more than accept),
40241after all the DKIM ACL runs have completed, the value becomes a
40242colon-separated list of the values after each run.
40243This is maintained for the mime, prdr and data ACLs.
40244
40245.vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
40246A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
40247"fail" or "invalid". One of
40248.ilist
40249&%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
40250key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
40251.next
40252&%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
40253record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
40254.next
40255&%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
40256body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
40257means that the message body was modified in transit.
40258.next
40259&%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
40260could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
40261re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
40262DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
40263.endlist
40264
40265This variable can be overwritten, with any value, using an ACL 'set' modifier.
40266
40267.vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
40268The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
40269an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
40270reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
40271
40272.vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
40273The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
40274if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
40275identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
40276
40277.vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
40278The key record selector string.
40279
40280.vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
40281The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
40282If running under GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
40283may also be 'ed25519-sha256'.
40284The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
40285for EC keys.
40286
40287Note that RFC 8301 says:
40288.code
40289rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
40290
40291DKIM signatures identified as having been signed with historic
40292algorithms (currently, rsa-sha1) have permanently failed evaluation
40293.endd
40294
40295To enforce this you must either have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
40296and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above,
40297or have set the main option &%dkim_verify_hashes%& to exclude
40298processing of such signatures.
40299
40300.vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
40301The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
40302
40303.vitem &%$dkim_canon_headers%&
40304The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
40305
40306.vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
40307A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
40308(copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
40309Note that RFC6376 requires that verification fail if the From: header is
40310not included in the signature. Exim does not enforce this; sites wishing
40311strict enforcement should code the check explicitly.
40312
40313.vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
40314The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
40315limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
40316that this variable always expands to an integer value.
40317&*Note:*& The presence of the signature tag specifying a signing body length
40318is one possible route to spoofing of valid DKIM signatures.
40319A paranoid implementation might wish to regard signature where this variable
40320shows less than the "no limit" return as being invalid.
40321
40322.vitem &%$dkim_created%&
40323UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
40324When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
40325
40326.vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
40327UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
40328signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
40329signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
40330integer size comparisons against this value.
40331Note that Exim does not check this value.
40332
40333.vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
40334A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
40335
40336.vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
40337"1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
40338
40339.vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
40340"1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
40341
40342.vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
40343Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
40344in the key record.
40345
40346.vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
40347Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
40348in the key record.
40349
40350.vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
40351Notes from the key record (tag n=).
40352
40353.vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
40354Number of bits in the key.
40355
40356Note that RFC 8301 says:
40357.code
40358Verifiers MUST NOT consider signatures using RSA keys of
40359less than 1024 bits as valid signatures.
40360.endd
40361
40362To enforce this you must have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
40363and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above.
40364As EC keys are much smaller, the check should only do this for RSA keys.
40365
40366.endlist
40367
40368In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
40369
40370.vlist
40371.vitem &%dkim_signers%&
40372ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
40373for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
40374(reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
40375verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
40376
40377.code
40378# Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no gmail signature
40379warn log_message = GMail sender without gmail.com DKIM signature
40380 sender_domains = gmail.com
40381 dkim_signers = gmail.com
40382 dkim_status = none
40383.endd
40384
40385Note that the above does not check for a total lack of DKIM signing;
40386for that check for empty &$h_DKIM-Signature:$& in the data ACL.
40387
40388.vitem &%dkim_status%&
40389ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
40390results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
40391to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
40392
40393.code
40394deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
40395 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
40396 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
40397 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
40398.endd
40399
40400The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
40401see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
40402for more information of what they mean.
40403.endlist
40404
40405
40406
40407
40408.section "SPF (Sender Policy Framework)" SECSPF
40409.cindex SPF verification
40410
40411SPF is a mechanism whereby a domain may assert which IP addresses may transmit
40412messages with its domain in the envelope from, documented by RFC 7208.
40413For more information on SPF see &url(http://www.open-spf.org), a static copy of
40414the &url(http://openspf.org).
40415. --- 2019-10-28: still not https, open-spf.org is told to be a
40416. --- web-archive copy of the now dead openspf.org site
40417. --- See https://www.mail-archive.com/mailop@mailop.org/msg08019.html for a
40418. --- discussion.
40419
40420Messages sent by a system not authorised will fail checking of such assertions.
40421This includes retransmissions done by traditional forwarders.
40422
40423SPF verification support is built into Exim if SUPPORT_SPF=yes is set in
40424&_Local/Makefile_&. The support uses the &_libspf2_& library
40425&url(https://www.libspf2.org/).
40426There is no Exim involvement in the transmission of messages;
40427publishing certain DNS records is all that is required.
40428
40429For verification, an ACL condition and an expansion lookup are provided.
40430.cindex authentication "expansion item"
40431Performing verification sets up information used by the
40432&%authresults%& expansion item.
40433
40434
40435.cindex SPF "ACL condition"
40436.cindex ACL "spf condition"
40437The ACL condition "spf" can be used at or after the MAIL ACL.
40438It takes as an argument a list of strings giving the outcome of the SPF check,
40439and will succeed for any matching outcome.
40440Valid strings are:
40441.vlist
40442.vitem &%pass%&
40443The SPF check passed, the sending host is positively verified by SPF.
40444
40445.vitem &%fail%&
40446The SPF check failed, the sending host is NOT allowed to send mail for the
40447domain in the envelope-from address.
40448
40449.vitem &%softfail%&
40450The SPF check failed, but the queried domain can't absolutely confirm that this
40451is a forgery.
40452
40453.vitem &%none%&
40454The queried domain does not publish SPF records.
40455
40456.vitem &%neutral%&
40457The SPF check returned a "neutral" state. This means the queried domain has
40458published a SPF record, but wants to allow outside servers to send mail under
40459its domain as well. This should be treated like "none".
40460
40461.vitem &%permerror%&
40462This indicates a syntax error in the SPF record of the queried domain.
40463You may deny messages when this occurs.
40464
40465.vitem &%temperror%&
40466This indicates a temporary error during all processing, including Exim's
40467SPF processing. You may defer messages when this occurs.
40468.endlist
40469
40470You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert
40471its meaning, for example "!fail" will match all results but
40472"fail". The string list is evaluated left-to-right, in a
40473short-circuit fashion.
40474
40475Example:
40476.code
40477deny spf = fail
40478 message = $sender_host_address is not allowed to send mail from \
40479 ${if def:sender_address_domain \
40480 {$sender_address_domain}{$sender_helo_name}}. \
40481 Please see http://www.open-spf.org/Why?scope=\
40482 ${if def:sender_address_domain {mfrom}{helo}};\
40483 identity=${if def:sender_address_domain \
40484 {$sender_address}{$sender_helo_name}};\
40485 ip=$sender_host_address
40486.endd
40487
40488When the spf condition has run, it sets up several expansion
40489variables:
40490
40491.cindex SPF "verification variables"
40492.vlist
40493.vitem &$spf_header_comment$&
40494.vindex &$spf_header_comment$&
40495 This contains a human-readable string describing the outcome
40496 of the SPF check. You can add it to a custom header or use
40497 it for logging purposes.
40498
40499.vitem &$spf_received$&
40500.vindex &$spf_received$&
40501 This contains a complete Received-SPF: header that can be
40502 added to the message. Please note that according to the SPF
40503 draft, this header must be added at the top of the header
40504 list. Please see section 10 on how you can do this.
40505
40506 Note: in case of "Best-guess" (see below), the convention is
40507 to put this string in a header called X-SPF-Guess: instead.
40508
40509.vitem &$spf_result$&
40510.vindex &$spf_result$&
40511 This contains the outcome of the SPF check in string form,
40512 one of pass, fail, softfail, none, neutral, permerror or
40513 temperror.
40514
40515.vitem &$spf_result_guessed$&
40516.vindex &$spf_result_guessed$&
40517 This boolean is true only if a best-guess operation was used
40518 and required in order to obtain a result.
40519
40520.vitem &$spf_smtp_comment$&
40521.vindex &$spf_smtp_comment$&
40522 This contains a string that can be used in a SMTP response
40523 to the calling party. Useful for "fail".
40524.endlist
40525
40526
40527.cindex SPF "ACL condition"
40528.cindex ACL "spf_guess condition"
40529.cindex SPF "best guess"
40530In addition to SPF, you can also perform checks for so-called
40531"Best-guess". Strictly speaking, "Best-guess" is not standard
40532SPF, but it is supported by the same framework that enables SPF
40533capability.
40534Refer to &url(http://www.open-spf.org/FAQ/Best_guess_record)
40535for a description of what it means.
40536. --- 2019-10-28: still not https:
40537
40538To access this feature, simply use the spf_guess condition in place
40539of the spf one. For example:
40540
40541.code
40542deny spf_guess = fail
40543 message = $sender_host_address doesn't look trustworthy to me
40544.endd
40545
40546In case you decide to reject messages based on this check, you
40547should note that although it uses the same framework, "Best-guess"
40548is not SPF, and therefore you should not mention SPF at all in your
40549reject message.
40550
40551When the spf_guess condition has run, it sets up the same expansion
40552variables as when spf condition is run, described above.
40553
40554Additionally, since Best-guess is not standardized, you may redefine
40555what "Best-guess" means to you by redefining the main configuration
40556&%spf_guess%& option.
40557For example, the following:
40558
40559.code
40560spf_guess = v=spf1 a/16 mx/16 ptr ?all
40561.endd
40562
40563would relax host matching rules to a broader network range.
40564
40565
40566.cindex SPF "lookup expansion"
40567.cindex lookup spf
40568A lookup expansion is also available. It takes an email
40569address as the key and an IP address
40570(v4 or v6)
40571as the database:
40572
40573.code
40574 ${lookup {username@domain} spf {ip.ip.ip.ip}}
40575.endd
40576
40577The lookup will return the same result strings as can appear in
40578&$spf_result$& (pass,fail,softfail,neutral,none,err_perm,err_temp).
40579
40580
40581
40582
40583
40584.section DMARC SECDMARC
40585.cindex DMARC verification
40586
40587DMARC combines feedback from SPF, DKIM, and header From: in order
40588to attempt to provide better indicators of the authenticity of an
40589email. This document does not explain the fundamentals; you
40590should read and understand how it works by visiting the website at
40591&url(http://www.dmarc.org/).
40592
40593If Exim is built with DMARC support,
40594the libopendmarc library is used.
40595
40596For building Exim yourself, obtain the library from
40597&url(http://sourceforge.net/projects/opendmarc/)
40598to obtain a copy, or find it in your favorite package
40599repository. You will need to attend to the local/Makefile feature
40600SUPPORT_DMARC and the associated LDFLAGS addition.
40601This description assumes
40602that headers will be in /usr/local/include, and that the libraries
40603are in /usr/local/lib.
40604
40605. subsection
40606
40607There are three main-configuration options:
40608.cindex DMARC "configuration options"
40609
40610The &%dmarc_tld_file%& option
40611.oindex &%dmarc_tld_file%&
40612defines the location of a text file of valid
40613top level domains the opendmarc library uses
40614during domain parsing. Maintained by Mozilla,
40615the most current version can be downloaded
40616from a link at &url(https://publicsuffix.org/list/public_suffix_list.dat).
40617See also the util/renew-opendmarc-tlds.sh script.
40618.new
40619The default for the option is unset.
40620If not set, DMARC processing is disabled.
40621.wen
40622
40623
40624The &%dmarc_history_file%& option, if set
40625.oindex &%dmarc_history_file%&
40626defines the location of a file to log results
40627of dmarc verification on inbound emails. The
40628contents are importable by the opendmarc tools
40629which will manage the data, send out DMARC
40630reports, and expire the data. Make sure the
40631directory of this file is writable by the user
40632exim runs as.
40633The default is unset.
40634
40635The &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& option
40636.oindex &%dmarc_forensic_sender%&
40637defines an alternate email address to use when sending a
40638forensic report detailing alignment failures
40639if a sender domain's dmarc record specifies it
40640and you have configured Exim to send them.
40641If set, this is expanded and used for the
40642From: header line; the address is extracted
40643from it and used for the envelope from.
40644If not set (the default), the From: header is expanded from
40645the dsn_from option, and <> is used for the
40646envelope from.
40647
40648. I wish we had subsections...
40649
40650.cindex DMARC controls
40651By default, the DMARC processing will run for any remote,
40652non-authenticated user. It makes sense to only verify DMARC
40653status of messages coming from remote, untrusted sources. You can
40654use standard conditions such as hosts, senders, etc, to decide that
40655DMARC verification should *not* be performed for them and disable
40656DMARC with an ACL control modifier:
40657.code
40658 control = dmarc_disable_verify
40659.endd
40660A DMARC record can also specify a "forensic address", which gives
40661exim an email address to submit reports about failed alignment.
40662Exim does not do this by default because in certain conditions it
40663results in unintended information leakage (what lists a user might
40664be subscribed to, etc). You must configure exim to submit forensic
40665reports to the owner of the domain. If the DMARC record contains a
40666forensic address and you specify the control statement below, then
40667exim will send these forensic emails. It is also advised that you
40668configure a &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& because the default sender address
40669construction might be inadequate.
40670.code
40671 control = dmarc_enable_forensic
40672.endd
40673(AGAIN: You can choose not to send these forensic reports by simply
40674not putting the dmarc_enable_forensic control line at any point in
40675your exim config. If you don't tell exim to send them, it will not
40676send them.)
40677
40678There are no options to either control. Both must appear before
40679the DATA acl.
40680
40681. subsection
40682
40683DMARC checks cam be run on incoming SMTP messages by using the
40684&"dmarc_status"& ACL condition in the DATA ACL. You are required to
40685call the &"spf"& condition first in the ACLs, then the &"dmarc_status"&
40686condition. Putting this condition in the ACLs is required in order
40687for a DMARC check to actually occur. All of the variables are set
40688up before the DATA ACL, but there is no actual DMARC check that
40689occurs until a &"dmarc_status"& condition is encountered in the ACLs.
40690
40691The &"dmarc_status"& condition takes a list of strings on its
40692right-hand side. These strings describe recommended action based
40693on the DMARC check. To understand what the policy recommendations
40694mean, refer to the DMARC website above. Valid strings are:
40695.display
40696&'accept '& The DMARC check passed and the library recommends accepting the email.
40697&'reject '& The DMARC check failed and the library recommends rejecting the email.
40698&'quarantine '& The DMARC check failed and the library recommends keeping it for further inspection.
40699&'none '& The DMARC check passed and the library recommends no specific action, neutral.
40700&'norecord '& No policy section in the DMARC record for this sender domain.
40701&'nofrom '& Unable to determine the domain of the sender.
40702&'temperror '& Library error or dns error.
40703&'off '& The DMARC check was disabled for this email.
40704.endd
40705You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert its
40706meaning, for example "!accept" will match all results but
40707"accept". The string list is evaluated left-to-right in a
40708short-circuit fashion. When a string matches the outcome of the
40709DMARC check, the condition succeeds. If none of the listed
40710strings matches the outcome of the DMARC check, the condition
40711fails.
40712
40713Of course, you can also use any other lookup method that Exim
40714supports, including LDAP, Postgres, MySQL, etc, as long as the
40715result is a list of colon-separated strings.
40716
40717Performing the check sets up information used by the
40718&%authresults%& expansion item.
40719
40720Several expansion variables are set before the DATA ACL is
40721processed, and you can use them in this ACL. The following
40722expansion variables are available:
40723
40724.vlist
40725.vitem &$dmarc_status$&
40726.vindex &$dmarc_status$&
40727.cindex DMARC result
40728A one word status indicating what the DMARC library
40729thinks of the email. It is a combination of the results of
40730DMARC record lookup and the SPF/DKIM/DMARC processing results
40731(if a DMARC record was found). The actual policy declared
40732in the DMARC record is in a separate expansion variable.
40733
40734.vitem &$dmarc_status_text$&
40735.vindex &$dmarc_status_text$&
40736Slightly longer, human readable status.
40737
40738.vitem &$dmarc_used_domain$&
40739.vindex &$dmarc_used_domain$&
40740The domain which DMARC used to look up the DMARC policy record.
40741
40742.vitem &$dmarc_domain_policy$&
40743.vindex &$dmarc_domain_policy$&
40744The policy declared in the DMARC record. Valid values
40745are "none", "reject" and "quarantine". It is blank when there
40746is any error, including no DMARC record.
40747.endlist
40748
40749. subsection
40750
40751By default, Exim's DMARC configuration is intended to be
40752non-intrusive and conservative. To facilitate this, Exim will not
40753create any type of logging files without explicit configuration by
40754you, the admin. Nor will Exim send out any emails/reports about
40755DMARC issues without explicit configuration by you, the admin (other
40756than typical bounce messages that may come about due to ACL
40757processing or failure delivery issues).
40758
40759In order to log statistics suitable to be imported by the opendmarc
40760tools, you need to:
40761.ilist
40762Configure the global option &%dmarc_history_file%&
40763.next
40764Configure cron jobs to call the appropriate opendmarc history
40765import scripts and truncating the dmarc_history_file
40766.endlist
40767
40768In order to send forensic reports, you need to:
40769.ilist
40770Configure the global option &%dmarc_forensic_sender%&
40771.next
40772Configure, somewhere before the DATA ACL, the control option to
40773enable sending DMARC forensic reports
40774.endlist
40775
40776. subsection
40777
40778Example usage:
40779.code
40780(RCPT ACL)
40781 warn domains = +local_domains
40782 hosts = +local_hosts
40783 control = dmarc_disable_verify
40784
40785 warn !domains = +screwed_up_dmarc_records
40786 control = dmarc_enable_forensic
40787
40788 warn condition = (lookup if destined to mailing list)
40789 set acl_m_mailing_list = 1
40790
40791(DATA ACL)
40792 warn dmarc_status = accept : none : off
40793 !authenticated = *
40794 log_message = DMARC DEBUG: $dmarc_status $dmarc_used_domain
40795
40796 warn dmarc_status = !accept
40797 !authenticated = *
40798 log_message = DMARC DEBUG: '$dmarc_status' for $dmarc_used_domain
40799
40800 warn dmarc_status = quarantine
40801 !authenticated = *
40802 set $acl_m_quarantine = 1
40803 # Do something in a transport with this flag variable
40804
40805 deny condition = ${if eq{$dmarc_domain_policy}{reject}}
40806 condition = ${if eq{$acl_m_mailing_list}{1}}
40807 message = Messages from $dmarc_used_domain break mailing lists
40808
40809 deny dmarc_status = reject
40810 !authenticated = *
40811 message = Message from $dmarc_used_domain failed sender's DMARC policy, REJECT
40812
40813 warn add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
40814.endd
40815
40816
40817
40818
40819
40820. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40821. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40822
40823.chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
40824 "Proxy support"
40825.cindex "proxy support"
40826.cindex "proxy" "access via"
40827
40828A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
40829Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
40830
40831
40832.section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
40833.cindex proxy inbound
40834.cindex proxy "server side"
40835.cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
40836.cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
40837
40838Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
40839that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
40840To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
40841in Local/Makefile.
40842
40843It was built on the HAProxy specification, found at
40844&url(https://www.haproxy.org/download/1.8/doc/proxy-protocol.txt).
40845
40846The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
40847such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
40848to distribute load.
40849Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
40850the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
40851There is no logging if a host passes or
40852fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
40853recorded in an ACL (example is below).
40854
40855Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
40856main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
40857hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
40858Exim supports both version 1 and version 2 of the Proxy Protocol and
40859automatically determines which version is in use.
40860
40861The Proxy Protocol header is the first data received on a TCP connection
40862and is inserted before any TLS-on-connect handshake from the client; Exim
40863negotiates TLS between Exim-as-server and the remote client, not between
40864Exim and the proxy server.
40865
40866The following expansion variables are usable
40867(&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
40868of the proxy):
40869.display
40870&'proxy_external_address '& IP of host being proxied or IP of remote interface of proxy
40871&'proxy_external_port '& Port of host being proxied or Port on remote interface of proxy
40872&'proxy_local_address '& IP of proxy server inbound or IP of local interface of proxy
40873&'proxy_local_port '& Port of proxy server inbound or Port on local interface of proxy
40874&'proxy_session '& boolean: SMTP connection via proxy
40875.endd
40876If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_external_address$& is empty
40877there was a protocol error.
40878The variables &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&
40879will have values for the actual client system, not the proxy.
40880
40881Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
40882per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
40883evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
40884handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
40885With the option set so high, you lose the ability
40886to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
40887In order to prevent your server from overload, you
40888need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
40889A possible solution is:
40890.display
40891 # Set max number of connections per host
40892 LIMIT = 5
40893 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
40894 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
40895
40896 defer message = Too many connections from this IP right now
40897 ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
40898.endd
40899
40900
40901
40902.section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
40903.cindex proxy outbound
40904.cindex proxy "client side"
40905.cindex proxy SOCKS
40906.cindex SOCKS proxy
40907Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
40908using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by RFC1928).
40909The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
40910Local/Makefile.
40911
40912Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
40913on an smtp transport.
40914The option value is expanded and should then be a list
40915(colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
40916Each proxy specifier is a list
40917(space-separated by default) where the initial element
40918is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
40919
40920Options are a string <name>=<value>.
40921The list of options is in the following table:
40922.display
40923&'auth '& authentication method
40924&'name '& authentication username
40925&'pass '& authentication password
40926&'port '& tcp port
40927&'tmo '& connection timeout
40928&'pri '& priority
40929&'weight '& selection bias
40930.endd
40931
40932More details on each of these options follows:
40933
40934.ilist
40935.cindex authentication "to proxy"
40936.cindex proxy authentication
40937&%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
40938Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per RFC 1929
40939for access to the proxy.
40940Default is &"none"&.
40941.next
40942&%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
40943Default is empty.
40944.next
40945&%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
40946Default is empty.
40947.next
40948&%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
40949Default is 1080.
40950.next
40951&%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
40952Default is 5.
40953.next
40954&%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
40955higher values being tried first.
40956The default priority is 1.
40957.next
40958&%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
40959Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
40960weighted by this value.
40961The default value for selection bias is 1.
40962.endlist
40963
40964Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
40965and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
40966overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
40967
40968.section Logging SECTproxyLog
40969To log the (local) IP of a proxy in the incoming or delivery logline,
40970add &"+proxy"& to the &%log_selector%& option.
40971This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
40972
40973. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40974. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40975
40976.chapter "Internationalisation" "CHAPi18n" &&&
40977 "Internationalisation""
40978.cindex internationalisation "email address"
40979.cindex EAI
40980.cindex i18n
40981.cindex utf8 "mail name handling"
40982
40983Exim has support for Internationalised mail names.
40984To include this it must be built with SUPPORT_I18N and the libidn library.
40985Standards supported are RFCs 2060, 5890, 6530 and 6533.
40986
40987If Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N_2008 (in addition to SUPPORT_I18N, not
40988instead of it) then IDNA2008 is supported; this adds an extra library
40989requirement, upon libidn2.
40990
40991.section "MTA operations" SECTi18nMTA
40992.cindex SMTPUTF8 "ESMTP option"
40993The main configuration option &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& specifies
40994a host list. If this matches the sending host and
40995accept_8bitmime is true (the default) then the ESMTP option
40996SMTPUTF8 will be advertised.
40997
40998If the sender specifies the SMTPUTF8 option on a MAIL command
40999international handling for the message is enabled and
41000the expansion variable &$message_smtputf8$& will have value TRUE.
41001
41002The option &%allow_utf8_domains%& is set to true for this
41003message. All DNS lookups are converted to a-label form
41004whatever the setting of &%allow_utf8_domains%&
41005when Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N.
41006
41007Both localparts and domain are maintained as the original
41008UTF-8 form internally; any comparison or regular-expression use will
41009require appropriate care. Filenames created, eg. by
41010the appendfile transport, will have UTF-8 names.
41011
41012HELO names sent by the smtp transport will have any UTF-8
41013components expanded to a-label form,
41014and any certificate name checks will be done using the a-label
41015form of the name.
41016
41017.cindex log protocol
41018.cindex SMTPUTF8 logging
41019.cindex i18n logging
41020Log lines and Received-by: header lines will acquire a "utf8"
41021prefix on the protocol element, eg. utf8esmtp.
41022
41023The following expansion operators can be used:
41024.code
41025${utf8_domain_to_alabel:str}
41026${utf8_domain_from_alabel:str}
41027${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:str}
41028${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:str}
41029.endd
41030
41031.cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
41032.cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
41033The RCPT ACL
41034may use the following modifier:
41035.display
41036control = utf8_downconvert
41037control = utf8_downconvert/<value>
41038.endd
41039This sets a flag requiring that addresses are converted to
41040a-label form before smtp delivery, for use in a
41041Message Submission Agent context.
41042If a value is appended it may be:
41043.display
41044&`1 `& (default) mandatory downconversion
41045&`0 `& no downconversion
41046&`-1 `& if SMTPUTF8 not supported by destination host
41047.endd
41048
41049If mua_wrapper is set, the utf8_downconvert control
41050is initially set to -1.
41051
41052The smtp transport has an option &%utf8_downconvert%&.
41053If set it must expand to one of the three values described above,
41054and it overrides any previously set value.
41055
41056
41057There is no explicit support for VRFY and EXPN.
41058Configurations supporting these should inspect
41059&$smtp_command_argument$& for an SMTPUTF8 argument.
41060
41061There is no support for LMTP on Unix sockets.
41062Using the "lmtp" protocol option on an smtp transport,
41063for LMTP over TCP, should work as expected.
41064
41065There is no support for DSN unitext handling,
41066and no provision for converting logging from or to UTF-8.
41067
41068
41069
41070.section "MDA operations" SECTi18nMDA
41071To aid in constructing names suitable for IMAP folders
41072the following expansion operator can be used:
41073.code
41074${imapfolder {<string>} {<sep>} {<specials>}}
41075.endd
41076
41077The string is converted from the charset specified by
41078the "headers charset" command (in a filter file)
41079or &%headers_charset%& main configuration option (otherwise),
41080to the
41081modified UTF-7 encoding specified by RFC 2060,
41082with the following exception: All occurrences of <sep>
41083(which has to be a single character)
41084are replaced with periods ("."), and all periods and slashes that are not
41085<sep> and are not in the <specials> string are BASE64 encoded.
41086
41087The third argument can be omitted, defaulting to an empty string.
41088The second argument can be omitted, defaulting to "/".
41089
41090This is the encoding used by Courier for Maildir names on disk, and followed
41091by many other IMAP servers.
41092
41093Examples:
41094.display
41095&`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}} `& yields &`Foo.Bar`&
41096&`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}{.}{/}} `& yields &`Foo&&AC8-Bar`&
41097&`${imapfolder {Räksmörgås}} `& yields &`R&&AOQ-ksm&&APY-rg&&AOU-s`&
41098.endd
41099
41100Note that the source charset setting is vital, and also that characters
41101must be representable in UTF-16.
41102
41103
41104. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41105. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41106
41107.chapter "Events" "CHAPevents" &&&
41108 "Events"
41109.cindex events
41110
41111The events mechanism in Exim can be used to intercept processing at a number
41112of points. It was originally invented to give a way to do customised logging
41113actions (for example, to a database) but can also be used to modify some
41114processing actions.
41115
41116Most installations will never need to use Events.
41117The support can be left out of a build by defining DISABLE_EVENT=yes
41118in &_Local/Makefile_&.
41119
41120There are two major classes of events: main and transport.
41121The main configuration option &%event_action%& controls reception events;
41122a transport option &%event_action%& controls delivery events.
41123
41124Both options are a string which is expanded when the event fires.
41125An example might look like:
41126.cindex logging custom
41127.code
41128event_action = ${if eq {msg:delivery}{$event_name} \
41129{${lookup pgsql {SELECT * FROM record_Delivery( \
41130 '${quote_pgsql:$sender_address_domain}',\
41131 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$sender_address_local_part}}', \
41132 '${quote_pgsql:$domain}', \
41133 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$local_part}}', \
41134 '${quote_pgsql:$host_address}', \
41135 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$host}}', \
41136 '${quote_pgsql:$message_exim_id}')}} \
41137} {}}
41138.endd
41139
41140Events have names which correspond to the point in process at which they fire.
41141The name is placed in the variable &$event_name$& and the event action
41142expansion must check this, as it will be called for every possible event type.
41143
41144.new
41145The current list of events is:
41146.wen
41147.display
41148&`dane:fail after transport `& per connection
41149&`msg:complete after main `& per message
41150&`msg:defer after transport `& per message per delivery try
41151&`msg:delivery after transport `& per recipient
41152&`msg:rcpt:host:defer after transport `& per recipient per host
41153&`msg:rcpt:defer after transport `& per recipient
41154&`msg:host:defer after transport `& per host per delivery try; host errors
41155&`msg:fail:delivery after transport `& per recipient
41156&`msg:fail:internal after main `& per recipient
41157&`tcp:connect before transport `& per connection
41158&`tcp:close after transport `& per connection
41159&`tls:cert before both `& per certificate in verification chain
41160&`smtp:connect after transport `& per connection
41161&`smtp:ehlo after transport `& per connection
41162.endd
41163New event types may be added in future.
41164
41165The event name is a colon-separated list, defining the type of
41166event in a tree of possibilities. It may be used as a list
41167or just matched on as a whole. There will be no spaces in the name.
41168
41169The second column in the table above describes whether the event fires
41170before or after the action is associates with. Those which fire before
41171can be used to affect that action (more on this below).
41172
41173The third column in the table above says what section of the configuration
41174should define the event action.
41175
41176An additional variable, &$event_data$&, is filled with information varying
41177with the event type:
41178.display
41179&`dane:fail `& failure reason
41180&`msg:defer `& error string
41181&`msg:delivery `& smtp confirmation message
41182&`msg:fail:internal `& failure reason
41183&`msg:fail:delivery `& smtp error message
41184&`msg:host:defer `& error string
41185&`msg:rcpt:host:defer `& error string
41186&`msg:rcpt:defer `& error string
41187&`tls:cert `& verification chain depth
41188&`smtp:connect `& smtp banner
41189&`smtp:ehlo `& smtp ehlo response
41190.endd
41191
41192The :defer events populate one extra variable: &$event_defer_errno$&.
41193
41194For complex operations an ACL expansion can be used in &%event_action%&
41195however due to the multiple contexts that Exim operates in during
41196the course of its processing:
41197.ilist
41198variables set in transport events will not be visible outside that
41199transport call
41200.next
41201acl_m variables in a server context are lost on a new connection,
41202and after smtp helo/ehlo/mail/starttls/rset commands
41203.endlist
41204Using an ACL expansion with the logwrite modifier can be
41205a useful way of writing to the main log.
41206
41207The expansion of the event_action option should normally
41208return an empty string. Should it return anything else the
41209following will be forced:
41210.display
41211&`tcp:connect `& do not connect
41212&`tls:cert `& refuse verification
41213&`smtp:connect `& close connection
41214.endd
41215All other message types ignore the result string, and
41216no other use is made of it.
41217
41218For a tcp:connect event, if the connection is being made to a proxy
41219then the address and port variables will be that of the proxy and not
41220the target system.
41221
41222For tls:cert events, if GnuTLS is in use this will trigger only per
41223chain element received on the connection.
41224For OpenSSL it will trigger for every chain element including those
41225loaded locally.
41226
41227. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41228. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41229
41230.chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
41231 "Adding drivers or lookups"
41232.cindex "adding drivers"
41233.cindex "new drivers, adding"
41234.cindex "drivers" "adding new"
41235The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
41236authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
41237
41238.olist
41239Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
41240existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
41241.next
41242Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
41243.display
41244<&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
41245.endd
41246where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
41247code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
41248should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
41249.next
41250Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
41251.code
41252#define <type>_NEWDRIVER
41253.endd
41254.next
41255Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
41256and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
41257.next
41258Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
41259near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
41260Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
41261As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
41262simple form that most lookups have.
41263.next
41264Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
41265&_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
41266driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
41267.next
41268Edit &_OS/Makefile-Base_& adding a &_.o_& file for the predefined-macros, to the
41269definition of OBJ_MACRO. Add a set of line to do the compile also.
41270.next
41271Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
41272&_src_&.
41273.next
41274Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
41275as for other drivers and lookups.
41276.endlist
41277
41278Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
41279proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
41280occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
41281options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
41282searched using a binary chop procedure.
41283
41284There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
41285the interface that is expected.
41286
41287
41288
41289
41290. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41291. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41292
41293. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41294. These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
41295. Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
41296. PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
41297. processors.
41298. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41299
41300.literal xml
41301<?sdop
41302 format="newpage"
41303 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
41304 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
41305?>
41306.literal off
41307
41308.makeindex "Options index" "option"
41309.makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
41310.makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
41311
41312
41313. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41314. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////